Fit Boxx Holdings Limited 偉博控股有限公司
Transcription
Fit Boxx Holdings Limited 偉博控股有限公司
The Stock Exchange of Hong Kong Limited and the Securities and Futures Commission take no responsibility for the contents of this Application Proof, make no representation as to its accuracy or completeness and expressly disclaim any liability whatsoever for any loss howsoever arising from or in reliance upon the whole or any part of the contents of this Application Proof. Application Proof of Fit Boxx Holdings Limited 偉博控股有限公司 (the “Company”) (incorporated in the Cayman Islands with limited liability) WARNING The publication of this Application Proof is required by The Stock Exchange of Hong Kong Limited (the “Exchange”) and the Securities and Futures Commission (the “Commission”) solely for the purpose of providing information to the public in Hong Kong. This Application Proof is in draft form. The information contained in it is incomplete and is subject to change which can be material. By viewing this document, you acknowledge, accept and agree with the Company, its sponsor, advisers or members of the underwriting syndicate that: (a) this document is only for the purpose of providing information about the Company to the public in Hong Kong and not for any other purposes. No investment decision should be based on the information contained in this document; (b) the publication of this document or supplemental, revised or replacement pages on the Exchange’s website does not give rise to any obligation of the Company, its sponsor, advisers or members of the underwriting syndicate to proceed with an offering in Hong Kong or any other jurisdiction. There is no assurance that the Company will proceed with the offering; (c) the contents of this document or supplemental, revised or replacement pages may or may not be replicated in full or in part in the actual final listing document; (d) the Application Proof is not the final listing document and may be updated or revised by the Company from time to time in accordance with the GEM Listing Rules; (e) this document does not constitute a prospectus, offering circular, notice, circular, brochure or advertisement offering to sell any securities to the public in any jurisdiction, nor is it an invitation to the public to make offers to subscribe for or purchase any securities, nor is it calculated to invite offers by the public to subscribe for or purchase any securities; (f) this document must not be regarded as an inducement to subscribe for or purchase any securities, and no such inducement is intended; (g) neither the Company nor any of its affiliates, advisers or underwriters is offering, or is soliciting offers to buy, any securities in any jurisdiction through the publication of this document; (h) no application for the securities mentioned in this document should be made by any person nor would such application be accepted; (i) the Company has not and will not register the securities referred to in this document under the United States Securities Act of 1933, as amended, or any state securities laws of the United States; (j) as there may be legal restrictions on the distribution of this document or dissemination of any information contained in this document, you agree to inform yourself about and observe any such restrictions applicable to you; and (k) the application to which this document relates has not been approved for listing and the Exchange and the Commission may accept, return or reject the application for the subject public offering and/or listing. If an offer or an invitation is made to the public in Hong Kong in due course, prospective investors are reminded to make their investment decisions solely based on the Company’s prospectus registered with the Registrar of Companies in Hong Kong, copies of which will be distributed to the public during the offer period. THIS APPLICATION PROOF IS IN DRAFT FORM. The information contained herein is incomplete and is subject to change. This Application Proof must be read in conjunction with the section headed “Warning” on the cover of this Application Proof. IMPORTANT If you are in any doubt about any of the contents in this document, you should obtain independent professional advice. Fit Boxx Holdings Limited 偉博控股有限公司 (incorporated in the Cayman Islands with limited liability) [REDACTED] Number of [REDACTED] : [REDACTED] : Nominal value Stock code : : [REDACTED] [REDACTED] [(subject to the [REDACTED])] Not more than HK$[REDACTED] per [REDACTED] and expected to be not less than HK$[REDACTED] per [REDACTED], plus brokerage fee of 1%, SFC transaction levy of 0.0027%, and Stock Exchange trading fee of 0.005% (payable in full on application in Hong Kong dollars and subject to refund) HK$0.01 per Share [REDACTED] Sponsor [REDACTED] [REDACTED] Hong Kong Exchanges and Clearing Limited, The Stock Exchange of Hong Kong Limited and Hong Kong Securities Clearing Company Limited take no responsibility for the contents in this document, make no representation as to its accuracy or completeness and expressly disclaim any liability whatsoever for any loss howsoever arising from or in reliance upon the whole or any part of the contents in this document. A copy in this document, having attached thereto the documents specified in the sub-section headed “Appendix V – Documents delivered to the Registrar of Companies and available for inspection” in this document, has been registered with the Registrar of Companies in Hong Kong as required by Section 342C of the Companies (Winding Up and Miscellaneous Provisions) Ordinance (Chapter 32 of the Laws of Hong Kong). The Registrar of Companies in Hong Kong and the Securities and Futures Commission of Hong Kong take no responsibility as to the contents in this document or any of the other documents referred to above. The [REDACTED] is currently expected to be fixed by an agreement between the Company and the [REDACTED] (for itself and on behalf of the [REDACTED]) at or before 5:00 p.m. on [[REDACTED]] (Hong Kong time) or such later date or time as may be agreed by the [REDACTED] (for itself and on behalf of the [REDACTED]) and the Company. The [REDACTED] is currently expected to be not more than HK$[[REDACTED]] per [REDACTED] and not less than HK$[[REDACTED]] per [REDACTED]. The [REDACTED] (for itself and on behalf of the [REDACTED]) may reduce the indicative [REDACTED] range stated in this document at any time prior to the [REDACTED]. In such a case, a notice of the reduction of the indicative [REDACTED] range will be published on the Stock Exchange’s website at www.hkexnews.hk and the Company’s website at www.fitboxx.com not later than the [REDACTED]. If, for any reason, the [REDACTED] is not agreed between the Company and the [REDACTED] (for itself and on behalf of the [REDACTED]) at or before 5:00 p.m. on [[REDACTED]] (Hong Kong time), the [REDACTED] will not become unconditional and will lapse. Prior to making an investment decision, prospective investors should consider carefully all of the information set out in this document, including but not limited to the risk factors set out in the section headed “Risk factors” in this document. Prospective investors of the [REDACTED] should note that the [REDACTED] are entitled to terminate their obligations under the [REDACTED] by notice in writing given by the [REDACTED] (for itself and on behalf of the [REDACTED]) upon the occurrence of any of the events set forth under the paragraph headed “Grounds for termination” in the section headed ‘‘Underwriting’’ in this document, at any time prior to [8:00 a.m.] (Hong Kong time) on the [REDACTED]. [REDACTED] THIS APPLICATION PROOF IS IN DRAFT FORM. The information contained herein is incomplete and is subject to change. This Application Proof must be read in conjunction with the section headed “Warning” on the cover of this Application Proof. CHARACTERISTICS OF GEM GEM has been positioned as a market designed to accommodate companies to which a higher investment risk may be attached than other companies listed on the Stock Exchange. Prospective investors should be aware of the potential risks of investing in such companies and should make the decision to invest only after due and careful consideration. The greater risk profile and other characteristics of GEM mean that it is a market more suited to professional and other sophisticated investors. Given the emerging nature of companies listed on GEM, there is a risk that securities traded on GEM may be more susceptible to higher market volatility than securities traded on the Main Board of the Stock Exchange and no assurance is given that there will be a liquid market in the securities traded on GEM. The principal means of information dissemination on GEM is publication on the internet website operated by the Stock Exchange. Listed companies are not generally required to issue paid announcements in gazette newspapers. Accordingly, prospective investors should note that they need to have access to the GEM website at www.hkgem.com in order to obtain up-to-date information on GEM-listed issuers. –i– THIS APPLICATION PROOF IS IN DRAFT FORM. The information contained herein is incomplete and is subject to change. This Application Proof must be read in conjunction with the section headed “Warning” on the cover of this Application Proof. EXPECTED TIMETABLE [REDACTED] – ii – THIS APPLICATION PROOF IS IN DRAFT FORM. The information contained herein is incomplete and is subject to change. This Application Proof must be read in conjunction with the section headed “Warning” on the cover of this Application Proof. CONTENTS This document is issued by the Company solely in connection with the [REDACTED] and does not constitute an offer to sell or a solicitation of an offer to buy any security other than the [REDACTED] offered by this document pursuant to the [REDACTED]. This document may not be used for the purpose of, and does not constitute, an offer or invitation in any other jurisdiction or in any other circumstances. No action has been taken to permit a [REDACTED] of the [REDACTED] or the distribution in this document in any jurisdiction other than Hong Kong. You should rely only on the information contained in this document to make your investment decision. The Company, the Sponsor, the [REDACTED] and the [REDACTED] have not authorised anyone to provide you with information that is different from what is contained in this document. Any information or representation not made nor contained in this document must not be relied on by you as having been authorised by the Company, the Sponsor, the [REDACTED], the [REDACTED], any of their respective directors, officers, employees, advisers, agents, representatives or affiliates of any of them or any other persons or parties involved in the [REDACTED]. The contents of the Company’s website at www.fitboxx.com do not form part in this document. Page Characteristics of GEM . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . i Expected Timetable . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ii Contents . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . iii Summary . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1 Definitions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13 Glossary of Technical Terms . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 22 Forward-looking Statements . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 23 Risk Factors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 24 ................... 37 Directors and Parties Involved in the [REDACTED] . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 41 Corporate Information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 44 Industry Overview . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 46 Information about this document and the [REDACTED] – iii – THIS APPLICATION PROOF IS IN DRAFT FORM. The information contained herein is incomplete and is subject to change. This Application Proof must be read in conjunction with the section headed “Warning” on the cover of this Application Proof. CONTENTS Regulatory Overview . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 63 ............................ 81 Business . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 95 Connected Transactions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 153 Future Plans and Use of Proceeds . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 155 Directors and Senior Management . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 162 Substantial Shareholders . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 171 Relationship with the Controlling Shareholders . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 172 ...................................................... 178 ............................................... 181 Underwriting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 229 ........................... 234 I Accountants’ Report . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . I-1 II Unaudited Pro Forma Financial Information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . II-1 III Summary of the Constitution of the Company and Cayman Islands Company Law . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . III-1 IV Statutory and General Information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . IV-1 V Documents Delivered to the Registrar of Companies and Available for Inspection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . History, Reorganisation and Group Structure Share Capital Financial Information Structure and Conditions of the [REDACTED] Appendices – iv – V-1 THIS APPLICATION PROOF IS IN DRAFT FORM. The information contained herein is incomplete and is subject to change. This Application Proof must be read in conjunction with the section headed “Warning” on the cover of this Application Proof. SUMMARY This summary aims to give you an overview of the information contained in this document. As this is a summary, it does not contain all the information that may be important to you. You should read the whole document before you decide to invest in the [REDACTED]. There are risks associated with investment in companies listed on GEM. Some of the particular risks in investing in the [REDACTED] are set out in the section headed “Risk Factors” in this document. You should read that section carefully before you decide to invest in the [REDACTED]. OVERVIEW The Group was founded in 2007 and is principally engaged in the sourcing, marketing, selling and distribution of a variety of fitness equipment and accessories, beauty gadgets and accessories, as well as other health care products, which are mainly for home use, under various brands through its sales and distribution network in Hong Kong and the PRC. The Group’s turnover is principally derived from the sales of fitness equipment, beauty gadgets and other health care products. The fitness equipment product segment mainly consists of treadmills, exercise bikes, elliptical trainers, steppers and other fitness accessories such as trampolines, yoga gears, dumbbells, boxing gears, heart rate monitors and diagnostic scales. The beauty gadgets product segment mainly consists of beauty devices for hair removal, wrinkle reduction, skin lifting, anti-acne treatment, rejuvenation of the skin’s appearance and body sliming and other healthy accessories. Other health care products include massage devices, inflated bath tubs and limb-support compression wears. For the two years ended 31 December 2015, the Group generated revenue of approximately HK$67.5 million and HK$84.7 million respectively and profit attributable to owners of the Company of approximately HK$11.4 million and HK$9.5 million respectively. BUSINESS MODEL The products of the Group are either (i) branded products purchased from independent brand owners and are sold to customers under the brand owners’ brands; or (ii) proprietary products sourced from independent external manufacturers or suppliers and are sold to customers under the Group’s proprietary brands. –1– THIS APPLICATION PROOF IS IN DRAFT FORM. The information contained herein is incomplete and is subject to change. This Application Proof must be read in conjunction with the section headed “Warning” on the cover of this Application Proof. SUMMARY (I) Sourcing of Branded Products The Group normally sources and identifies popular fitness equipment and beauty gadgets from independent brand owners around the world. Once a brand is identified, the Group approaches the brand owners directly and negotiates for the distribution right of the products of a particular brand principally in Hong Kong and in some occasions covering Macau and online sales in the PRC. The brand owners who wish to expand their business into the Hong Kong and/or the PRC market may also approach the Group directly for business cooperation. In either event, if the products are assessed by the Group as popular, the Group will strive to negotiate for the exclusive distribution right of the products in the agreed territories. As at the Latest Practicable Date, the Group entered into exclusive distribution agreements with seven brand owners. (II) Sourcing of the Group’s Proprietary Products Starting from 2007, the Group began to source fitness equipment and other health care products and develop its own proprietary brands, including “EnerGym” and “元氣達 人”. The “EnerGym” collection offers small-sized or compact fitness equipment which is easy to use, convenient to store and requires less storage space. Products under “元氣達 人” brand include inflated bath tubs. The Group does not have its own manufacturing facilities or production line. These products are produced by external manufacturers located in the PRC or sourced from third party suppliers in Hong Kong or the PRC and are delivered to the Group as finished products for distribution under the Group’s proprietary brands. Product Segments The Group’s products can be classified into three segments, namely, fitness equipment and accessories, beauty gadgets and accessories and other health care products. The table below set out the relevant breakdown of the Group’s turnover during the Track Record Period attributable to products sold under brand owners’ brands and products sold under the Group’s proprietary brands. For the year ended 31 December 2014 HK$’000 % For the year ended 31 December 2015 HK$’000 % Branded products Proprietary products 60,888 6,577 90.3 9.7 79,777 4,967 94.1 5.9 Total 67,465 100.0 84,744 100.0 –2– THIS APPLICATION PROOF IS IN DRAFT FORM. The information contained herein is incomplete and is subject to change. This Application Proof must be read in conjunction with the section headed “Warning” on the cover of this Application Proof. SUMMARY Sales and Distribution Networks As at the Latest Practicable Date, the Group’s sales network was made of its own retail outlets (retail shops, shopping mall booth and department store counter), points of sales established in the chain retailers, third party e-commerce platforms, online group buying platforms, other distributors and retailers, as well as the retail websites operated by the Group. The physical retail stores, combined with the online retail platforms, provide an integrated shopping experience to the consumers for the sales and promotion of the Group’s products. The Group has expanded its sales network to the PRC by operating three storefronts on a well-known e-commerce platform, namely, Tmall, and through storefronts on an e-commerce platform which is operated by a corporate customer, for the sales of beauty gadgets and accessories. The Directors consider that these online storefronts allow the Group to gain access to the fast-growing consumer market of the PRC without significant capital investment. Set out below is a breakdown of the Group’s turnover by types of distribution channels during the Track Record Period: For the year ended 31 December 2014 HK$’000 % Direct sales – Physical stores – Online stores Indirect sales – Chain retailers – Other distributors and retailers Total For the year ended 31 December 2015 HK$’000 % 34,314 10,361 50.9 15.3 35,514 21,318 41.9 25.1 7,365 10.9 7,676 9.1 15,425 22.9 20,236 23.9 67,465 100.0 84,744 100.0 SUPPLIERS Suppliers of the Group include (i) brand owners for branded products; and (ii) manufacturers for its major proprietary products. For each of the two years ended 31 December 2015, the Group engaged over ten and ten major brand owners respectively for branded products, and three and four manufacturers respectively for its major proprietary products. As at the Latest Practicable Date, the Group has entered into exclusive distribution agreements with seven brand owners for branded products generally for a term of one to three years. The Group has also entered into cooperation framework agreements with three major manufacturers to ensure stable supply of products. For the two years ended 31 December 2015, the total purchases from the Group’s five largest suppliers in aggregate amounted to approximately HK$20.5 million and HK$17.4 million respectively, accounted for approximately 71.3% and 70.0% respectively, of its total purchases. –3– THIS APPLICATION PROOF IS IN DRAFT FORM. The information contained herein is incomplete and is subject to change. This Application Proof must be read in conjunction with the section headed “Warning” on the cover of this Application Proof. SUMMARY CUSTOMERS The Group’s products target the general consumer market in Hong Kong and the PRC. In respect of the fitness equipment segment, the Group’s products mainly target general consumers of both genders aged between 25 to 50 who are health conscious and appearance conscious. In respect of the beauty gadgets segment, the Group’s products mainly target the female consumers aged between 25 to 50 who are appearance conscious, eager to try novel and trendy products, and are willing to pay for premium price in return for quality products. The Group sells and distributes its products to chain retailers, other distributors and retailers, which in turn sell the Group’s products directly or through sub-distributors to ultimate consumers. The Group also directly sells to the ultimate consumers through its own retail outlets, own websites and third party storefronts on the e-commerce platforms, as well as online group buying platforms. Except for the sales to Ms. Cao Xiao Wei, the wife of Mr. Chan, the Group’s five largest customers during the Track Record Period are all Independent Third Parties. The sales to the top five customers amounted to approximately HK$15.6 million and HK$17.9 million respectively, representing approximately 23.1% and 21.0% of the Group’s total revenue for the two years ended 31 December 2015 respectively. For more details on the sales to Ms. Cao Xiao Wei, please refer to the sub-paragraph headed “Business — Sales and distribution channels — (II) Indirect sales — Sales to other distributors and retailers — Sales to related parties”in this document. INDUSTRY According to the Euromonitor Report, the retail sales of home fitness equipment in Hong Kong showed an overall growth between 2010 and 2014, from approximately HK$48.2 million to approximately HK$58.4 million, at a CAGR of approximately 4.9% over the years, where the Group was ranked the top distributor of home fitness equipment in Hong Kong for 2014 with a market share of approximately 40.1%. The retail sales of beauty gadgets (comprising facial care gadgets and hair removal gadgets and excluding other beauty gadgets) in Hong Kong showed an overall growth between 2010 and 2014, from approximately HK$315.5 million to approximately HK$465.2 million, at a CAGR of approximately 10.2% over the years. The Group’s market share of beauty gadgets (comprising facial care gadgets and hair removal gadgets and excluding other beanty gadgets) in Hong Kong in 2014 were approximately 4.1%. Moreover, according to the Euromonitor Report, the online retail sales of beauty gadgets in the PRC showed an overall significant growth between 2010 and 2014, from approximately HK$62.7 million to approximately HK$333.8 million, at a CAGR of approximately 51.9% over the years. –4– THIS APPLICATION PROOF IS IN DRAFT FORM. The information contained herein is incomplete and is subject to change. This Application Proof must be read in conjunction with the section headed “Warning” on the cover of this Application Proof. SUMMARY COMPETITIVE STRENGTHS The Directors believe that the following competitive strengths of the Group have contributed to its growth and enabled it to compete effectively in the fitness equipment and beauty gadget industry in Hong Kong and China: • Diversified portfolio of fitness equipment and beauty gadget offered by the Group • Multiple sales and distribution channels • Multi-faceted marketing strategy • Experienced and dedicated management team STRATEGIES AND FUTURE PLANS The Group’s mission statement is to improve the quality of people’s lifestyle at home and become one of the leading wellness solutions retailers in Hong Kong. The Group plans to implement the following strategies to pursue further development and expansion of its business: • Further development of the Group’s business in the PRC online market by opening of display stores • Expansion of retail network in Hong Kong • Enhancing marketing and promotional activities • Increasing market presence in Hong Kong by opening pop-up stores • Enhancing the Group’s brand recognition and image by renovation of existing shops SELECTED FINANCIAL INFORMATION OF THE GROUP Selected data in the consolidated statements of profit or loss and comprehensive income of the Group For the year ended 31 December 2014 2015 HK$’000 HK$’000 Revenue Gross Profit Profit attributable to owners of the Company –5– 67,465 42,015 11,418 84,744 51,204 9,469 THIS APPLICATION PROOF IS IN DRAFT FORM. The information contained herein is incomplete and is subject to change. This Application Proof must be read in conjunction with the section headed “Warning” on the cover of this Application Proof. SUMMARY Results of operations during the Track Record Period Revenue The table below sets out the breakdown of the revenues by types of product: For the year ended 31 December 2014 2015 HK$’000 % HK$’000 Fitness equipment and accessories Beauty gadgets and accessories Other health care products Total % 23,919 35.5 22,463 26.5 41,373 61.3 60,706 71.6 2,173 3.2 1,575 1.9 67,465 100.0 84,744 100.0 The increase in revenue of the Group for the year ended 31 December 2015 by approximately 25.6% as compared to that of the year ended 31 December 2014 was mainly attributable to increase in sale of beauty gadgets and accessories resulted from the increase in sales of the Group’s flagship hair removal devices via the Group’s own online sales channels as well as sales to other distributors which in turn sold such products through various channels including their online storefronts. Gross profit margin For the two years ended 31 December 2015, the gross profit margin of the Group was approximately 62.3% and 60.4% respectively. The slight drop was mainly due to the drop in the gross profit margin of beauty gadgets and accessories, which was principally due to the increase in sale of beauty gadget products to other distributors at wholesale price during the year ended 31 December 2015. Major cost components During the Track Record Period, the Group’s major cost components for its operation were the cost of merchandise, employee benefits expense and operating lease charges of rented premises. The following table sets forth a breakdown of the major cost components and their respective percentage to revenue for the two years ended 31 December 2015. –6– THIS APPLICATION PROOF IS IN DRAFT FORM. The information contained herein is incomplete and is subject to change. This Application Proof must be read in conjunction with the section headed “Warning” on the cover of this Application Proof. SUMMARY For the year ended 31 December 2014 2015 HK$’000 % HK$’000 Cost of merchandise Employee benefits expense Operating lease charges % 24,759 36.7 32,760 38.7 9,835 14.6 12,191 14.4 6,435 9.5 7,468 8.8 During the Track Record Period, the increase of each of the major cost components for the year ended December 2015 as compared to the year ended 31 December 2014 was in line with the increase in revenue during the year. Profit attributable to owners of the Company and net profit margin The Group’s profit attributable to owners of the Company decreased by approximately HK$1.9 million, represent a decrease of approximately 17.1% from approximately HK$11.4 million for the year ended 31 December 2014 to approximately HK$9.5 million for the year ended 31 December 2015. Excluding the [REDACTED] expenses of approximately HK$3.9 million incurred by the Company during the year ended 31 December 2015, the profit attributable to owners of the Company would be increased by approximately HK$1.9 million, representing a growth of approximately 16.7%, which was in line with the growth of the Group’s revenue during the year; and the Group’s net profit margin would be approximately 16.9% and 15.7% respectively for the two years ended 31 December 2015, representing a relatively stable net profit margin over the years. Selected data in the consolidated statements of financial position of the Group As at 31 December 2014 2015 HK$’000 HK$’000 Total current assets Total current liabilities Net current assets Total non-current liabilities Total assets Net assets 43,243 20,826 22,417 714 45,616 24,076 –7– 40,883 12,090 28,793 2,602 43,308 28,616 THIS APPLICATION PROOF IS IN DRAFT FORM. The information contained herein is incomplete and is subject to change. This Application Proof must be read in conjunction with the section headed “Warning” on the cover of this Application Proof. SUMMARY Summary of consolidated statement of cash flows of the Group For the year ended 31 December 2014 2015 HK$’000 HK$’000 Cash and cash equivalents at beginning of year Net cash generated from operating activities Net cash used in investing activities Net cash (used in)/generated from financing activities 2,311 8,147 (526) 6,782 4,193 (291) (3,154) 3,439 Net increase in cash and cash equivalents Effect of foreign exchange rate changes 4,467 4 7,341 (215) Cash and cash equivalents end of year 6,782 13,908 Key financial ratios As at/For the year ended 31 December 2014 2015 Gross profit margin (%) Net profit margin before interest and tax (%) Current ratio (times) Quick ratio (times) Debt to equity ratio (%) Gearing ratio (%) Interest coverage ratio (times) Return on assets (%) Return on equity (%) Net profit margin (%) Note: 62.3 19.5 2.1 1.0 N/A 4.7 132.8 25.0 47.4 16.9 60.4 15.3 3.4 2.2 N/A 13.9 38.9 21.9 33.1 11.2 For the calculations of the financial ratios, please refer to sub-sections headed “Financial Information — Analysis of various items from the consolidated statement of financial position” and “Financial Information — Key financial ratios analysis” in this document. –8– THIS APPLICATION PROOF IS IN DRAFT FORM. The information contained herein is incomplete and is subject to change. This Application Proof must be read in conjunction with the section headed “Warning” on the cover of this Application Proof. SUMMARY RECENT DEVELOPMENTS SINCE 31 DECEMBER 2015 [Since 31 December 2015, the Group’s business model, revenue structure, financial performance, profitability and cost structure remained unchanged. Based on the Group’s unaudited management accounts, the revenue for the three months ended 31 March 2016 showed a mild increase as compared to the same period of 2015. This was mainly due to the increase in sales to other distributors, which was, however, mitigated by the decrease in retail sales of the Group’s products as affected by the downtrend of the Hong Kong economy and the prolonged winter season up to March 2016 which the Directors believe to affect the customers’ overall consumption sentiment. Moreover, the overall gross profit margin for the three months ended 31 March 2016 showed a mild decrease as compared to the same period in 2015, which was mainly due to (i) the increase in proportion of indirect sales against direct sales, where the gross profit margin of indirect sales is generally lower than that of direct sales; and (ii) the Group offered discounts for certain products at the retail level in order to boost sales under the weakening environment of the retail industry in Hong Kong. According to the statistics announced by the Hong Kong Government, the value of total retail sales for the first two months of 2016 was provisionally estimated to be decreased by 13.6% as compared with the same period in 2015. Save as disclosed above and for the total expenses for the [REDACTED] estimated to be approximately HK$[REDACTED] million, of which approximately HK$[REDACTED] million will be recorded in the Group’s consolidated statement of profit or loss and comprehensive income for the year ending 31 December 2016, the Directors confirm that, up to the date in this document, there had been no material adverse change in the operation, financial or trading positions or prospects of the Group since 31 December 2015, being the date to which the latest audited financial statements of the Group were made up, and there had been no event since 31 December 2015 which would materially affect the information shown in the Accountant’s Report set out in Appendix I to this document.] CONTROLLING SHAREHOLDERS Immediately after completion of the Capitalisation Issue and the [REDACTED], Faith Elite will legally and beneficially owns approximately [REDACTED]% of the issued share capital of the Company (without taking into account any Shares which may be issued under the [REDACTED] or the exercise of any options which may be granted under the Share Option Scheme). Faith Elite is jointly owned by Mr. Chan, an executive Director and chairman of the Group, and Mr. Li, an executive Director and the chief executive officer of the Group, as to 50% and 50% respectively. Accordingly, Faith Elite, Mr. Chan and Mr. Li are the Controlling Shareholders of the Company under the GEM Listing Rules. –9– THIS APPLICATION PROOF IS IN DRAFT FORM. The information contained herein is incomplete and is subject to change. This Application Proof must be read in conjunction with the section headed “Warning” on the cover of this Application Proof. SUMMARY PRE-IPO INVESTOR The Pre-IPO Investors, namely National Pride, Prime View, Global Excellent and Hang Kong, became the shareholders of the Group on 19 December 2014, 19 December 2014, 14 December 2015, and 14 December 2015 at cash considerations of HK$2,750,000, HK$2,750,000, HK$3,387,500 and HK$3,387,500 respectively. The considerations were determined after arm’s length negotiations between the parties based on valuations of the Group. Immediately following the completion of the [REDACTED] and the Capitalisation Issue (assuming that the [REDACTED] is not exercised), the entire issued share capital of the Company will be owned by Faith Elite (Controlling Shareholders) as to [REDACTED]%, by National Pride as to [REDACTED]%, by Prime View as to [REDACTED]%, by Global Excellent as to [REDACTED]% and by Hang Kong as to [REDACTED]%. Please refer to the sub-section headed “History, Reorganisation and Group Structure — Pre-IPO investments” for further details. [REDACTED] EXPENSES The total expenses for the [REDACTED] are estimated to be approximately HK$[REDACTED] million based on the [REDACTED] of HK$[REDACTED] (being the mid-point of the indicated [REDACTED] range stated in this document), of which approximately HK$[REDACTED] million is directly attributable to the issue of the [REDACTED] under the [REDACTED] and is expected to be accounted for as a deduction from equity. For the remaining [REDACTED] expenses of approximately HK$[REDACTED] million, approximately HK$3.9 million and HK$[REDACTED] million was/will be charged to the Group’s consolidated statements of profit or loss and comprehensive income for the year ended 31 December 2015 and for the year ending 31 December 2016 respectively. USE OF PROCEEDS The net proceeds from the [REDACTED], after deducting related expenses, are estimated to be approximately HK$[REDACTED] million, based on a [REDACTED] of HK$[REDACTED] per [REDACTED] (being the mid-point of the [REDACTED] range between HK$[REDACTED] and HK$[REDACTED] per [REDACTED]), assuming the [REDACTED] is not exercised. The Directors presently intend that the net proceeds will be applied as follows: – approximately HK$[REDACTED] million, representing approximately [REDACTED]% of the net proceeds will be used for further development of the Group’s business in the PRC online market by opening of display stores; – approximately HK$[REDACTED] million, representing approximately [REDACTED]% of the net proceeds will be used for expansion of retail network in Hong Kong; – approximately HK$[REDACTED] million, representing approximately [REDACTED]% of the net proceeds will be used for enhancing marketing and promotional activities; – approximately HK$[REDACTED] million, representing approximately [REDACTED]% of the net proceeds will be used for increasing market presence in Hong Kong by opening of pop-up stores; – 10 – THIS APPLICATION PROOF IS IN DRAFT FORM. The information contained herein is incomplete and is subject to change. This Application Proof must be read in conjunction with the section headed “Warning” on the cover of this Application Proof. SUMMARY – approximately HK$[REDACTED] million, representing approximately [REDACTED]% of the net proceeds will be used for enhancing the Group’s brand recognition and image by renovation of existing shops; – approximately HK$[REDACTED] million, representing approximately [REDACTED]% of the net proceeds, will be used as working capital for stock up of products newly launched in 2016; and – the balance of approximately HK$[REDACTED] million, representing approximately [REDACTED]% of the net proceeds will be used for the Group’s general working capital. DIVIDEND POLICY For the year ended 31 December 2015, a subsidiary of the Group declared dividend of HK$17.0 million. The Company currently does not have any specific dividend policy. A decision to declare or to pay any dividend in the future, and the amount of any dividends, depends on a number of factors, including the Group’s results of operations, financial condition, the payment by the Group’s subsidiaries of cash dividends to the Group, and other factors the Board may deem relevant. [REDACTED] STATISTICS The Company has prepared the following [REDACTED] statistics based on the respective [REDACTED] of HK$[REDACTED] and HK$[REDACTED] per Share: Based on Based on the indicative the indicative [REDACTED] of [REDACTED] of HK$[REDACTED] HK$[REDACTED] per Share per Share HK$[REDACTED] HK$[REDACTED] million million Market capitalisation of the Shares Unaudited proforma adjusted consolidated net tangible assets of the Group attributable to owners of the Company per Share Note: HK$[REDACTED] HK$[REDACTED] The calculation of the market capitalisation upon completion of the [REDACTED] is based on the assumption that [REDACTED] Shares will be in issue and outstanding immediately following the [REDACTED]. The unaudited pro forma adjusted combined net tangible asset value per Share is determined after adjustments as described in note 1 as set out in Appendix II to this document. – 11 – THIS APPLICATION PROOF IS IN DRAFT FORM. The information contained herein is incomplete and is subject to change. This Application Proof must be read in conjunction with the section headed “Warning” on the cover of this Application Proof. SUMMARY RISK FACTORS The Directors consider that there are certain risks and uncertainties involved in the Group’s operations, some of which are beyond the Group’s control. Further details of the risks to which the Group is exposed are set out in the section headed “Risk Factors” in this document. The following highlights some of the risks which are considered to be material by the Directors: – the Group’s business substantially relies on the sales of a few categories of flagship products, if any event happens which adversely affects the sales and profitability of these products, the overall results of the Group’s operation may be materially and adversely affected; – the Group relies on the supply of products by few major suppliers; – two of the Group’s major suppliers operate their business in a political instable country. If they cease business or their businesses were disrupted because of political instability, the Group’s business and financial results would be adversely affected; – If the Group is unable to rely on the services and connections of its key personnel, or retain the current key personnel, its business could be adversely affected – The Group has not entered into long-term agreements with the customers and there is no assurance that the current relationship between the Group and any customer can be continued in the future – 12 – THIS APPLICATION PROOF IS IN DRAFT FORM. The information contained herein is incomplete and is subject to change. This Application Proof must be read in conjunction with the section headed “Warning” on the cover of this Application Proof. DEFINITIONS In this document, unless the context otherwise requires, the following expressions have the following meanings: “1st Round Subscription Agreements” the two subscription agreements both dated 19 December 2014 entered into between Fit Boxx HK with each of National Pride and Prime View respectively “2nd Round Subscription Agreements” the two subscription agreements both dated 10 December 2015 entered into between the Company with each of Global Excellent and Hang Kong respectively “Ample Capital” or “Sponsor” Ample Capital Limited, a licensed corporation to carry on business in types 4, 6 and 9 regulated activities (advising on securities, advising on corporate finance and asset management) under the SFO, and the sponsor of the [REDACTED] “Articles “ or “Articles of Association” the articles of association of the Company adopted on [●] and as amended from time to time, a summary of which is set out in Appendix III to this document “associate(s)” has the same meaning as defined in the GEM Listing Rules “Audit Committee” the audit committee of the Board “Board” the board of Directors “business day(s)” a day (other than Saturday and Sunday) on which licensed banks in Hong Kong are generally open for normal banking business “BVI” the British Virgin Islands “CAGR” compound annual growth rate, a method of assessing the average growth of a value over time “Capitalisation Issue” the issue of [REDACTED] Shares to be made upon the capitalisation of an amount of HK$[REDACTED] standing to the credit of the share premium account of the Company as referred to the paragraph headed “Appendix IV — A. Further information about the Company and its subsidiaries — 3. Written resolutions of the Shareholder passed on [●]” in this document – 13 – THIS APPLICATION PROOF IS IN DRAFT FORM. The information contained herein is incomplete and is subject to change. This Application Proof must be read in conjunction with the section headed “Warning” on the cover of this Application Proof. DEFINITIONS “Cayman Companies Law” the Companies Law, Cap 22 (Law 3 of 1961, as consolidated and revised) of the Cayman Islands “CCASS” the Central Clearing and Settlement System established and operated by the HKSCC “CCASS Clearing Participant” a person admitted to participate in CCASS as a direct clearing participant or general clearing participant “CCASS Custodian Participant” a person admitted to participate in CCASS as a custodian participant “CCASS Investor Participant” a person admitted to participate in CCASS as an investor participant who may be an individual or joint individuals or a corporation “CCASS Operational Procedures” the operational procedures of HKSCC in relation to CCASS, containing the practices, procedures and administrative requirements relating to the operations and functions of CCASS, as from time to time in force “CCASS Participant” a CCASS Clearing Participant, a CCASS Custodian Participant or a CCASS Investor Participant “China” or “PRC” the People’s Republic of China, but for the purpose in this document only and except where the context requires otherwise, references in this document to “China” and the “PRC” do not include Hong Kong, Macau and Taiwan “close associate(s)” has the meaning as defined in the GEM Listing Rules “Companies Ordinance” the Companies Ordinance (Chapter 622 of the Laws of Hong Kong) which came into effect on 3 March 2014 as amended, supplemented or otherwise modified from time to time “Companies (Winding Up and Miscellaneous Provisions) Ordinance” the Companies (Winding Up and Miscellaneous Provisions) Ordinance (Chapter 32 of the Laws of Hong Kong), as amended, supplemented and/or otherwise modified from time to time – 14 – THIS APPLICATION PROOF IS IN DRAFT FORM. The information contained herein is incomplete and is subject to change. This Application Proof must be read in conjunction with the section headed “Warning” on the cover of this Application Proof. DEFINITIONS “Company” Fit Boxx Holdings Limited 偉博控股有限公司, a company incorporated in the Cayman Islands on 14 May 2015 as an exempted company with limited liability and registered as a non-Hong Kong company under Part 16 of the Companies Ordinance on 23 July 2015 “connected person(s)” has the same meaning ascribed to it in the GEM Listing Rules “Controlling Shareholders” the controlling shareholders (having the meaning ascribed to it in the GEM Listing Rules) of the Company, namely Faith Elite, Mr. Chan and Mr. Li “Deed of Indemnity” the deed of indemnity dated [●] executed by the Controlling Shareholders in favour of the Company, details of which are set out in the paragraph headed “Appendix IV – E. Other information — 1. Tax and other indemnity” in this document “Deed of Non-Competition” the deed of non-competition dated [●] executed by the Controlling Shareholders in favour of the Company, details of which are set out in the paragraph under the sub-section headed “Relationship with the Controlling Shareholders — Non-Competition Undertakings” in this document “Director(s)” the director(s) of the Company “Electrical Products (Safety) Regulation” the Electrical Products (Safety) Regulation (Chapter 406G of the Laws of Hong Kong), as amended, supplemented or otherwise modified from time to time “Euromonitor” Euromonitor International Limited, a market research and consulting company, an Independent Third Party “Euromonitor Report” an independent market research report prepared by Euromonitor on market landscape and competitive analysis for the fitness equipment and beauty gadget market in Hong Kong and the beauty gadget online retailing market in the PRC, details of which are set out in the section headed “Industry Overview” in this document – 15 – THIS APPLICATION PROOF IS IN DRAFT FORM. The information contained herein is incomplete and is subject to change. This Application Proof must be read in conjunction with the section headed “Warning” on the cover of this Application Proof. DEFINITIONS “Faith Elite” Faith Elite Limited, a limited liability company incorporated in Anguilla on 8 July 2014 and is held as to 50% by Mr. Chan and 50% by Mr. Li “Fit Boxx BVI” Fit Boxx Co. Ltd., a limited liability company incorporated in the BVI on 20 May 2015 and directly and wholly owned by the Company “Fit Boxx HK” Fit Boxx Trading Company Limited (偉博貿易有限公 司), a company incorporated in Hong Kong on 18 June 2009 with limited liability, and an operating subsidiary of the Group “Fit Boxx Shenzhen” Fit Boxx Import and Export Trading (Shenzhen) Company Limited*(偉博進出口貿易(深圳)有限公司), a company established in the PRC on 31 October 2012, and an operating subsidiary of the Group “GDP” gross domestic product “GEM” the Growth Enterprise Market of the Stock Exchange “GEM Listing Rules” the Rules Governing the Listing of Securities on GEM (as amended, supplemented or otherwise modified from time to time) “General Rules of CCASS” the terms and conditions regulating the use of CCASS, as may be amended or modified from time to time and where the context so permits, shall include the CCASS Operational Procedures “Global Excellent” Global Excellent Inc Limited (全球卓越有限公司), a limited company incorporated in Hong Kong on 5 February 2015 and is held as to 100% by Ms. Cheng Oi Yin, an Independent Third Party “Group” the Company together with its subsidiaries and in respect of the period before the Company became the holding company of its present subsidiaries, the companies that are the present subsidiaries of the Company “Hang Kong” Hang Kong Investment Consulting Limited (恒港投資 諮詢有限公司), a BVI business company incorporated in the BVI on 9 March 2010 and is held as to 100% by Mr. Wong Kwok Wai, an Independent Third Party – 16 – THIS APPLICATION PROOF IS IN DRAFT FORM. The information contained herein is incomplete and is subject to change. This Application Proof must be read in conjunction with the section headed “Warning” on the cover of this Application Proof. DEFINITIONS “HK$” or “HK dollar(s)” and “cent(s)” Hong Kong dollar(s) and cent(s) respectively, the lawful currency of Hong Kong “HKFRS” Hong Kong Financial Reporting Standards issued by the Hong Kong Institute of Certified Public Accountants “HKEx” Hong Kong Exchanges and Clearing Limited “HKSCC” Hong Kong Securities Clearing Company Limited “HKSCC Nominees” HKSCC Nominees Limited “Hong Kong” or “HKSAR” the Hong Kong Special Administrative Region of the PRC “Hong Kong Legal Counsel” Mr. Julian Yeung, Hong Kong barrister-at-law “Independent Third Party(ies)” party or parties that is or are to the best of the Directors’ knowledge, information and belief, independent of and not connected with the Company and connected persons of the Company within the meaning of the GEM Listing Rules “Israel” The State of Israel “Latest Practicable Date” [12 April 2016], being the latest practicable date for ascertaining certain information prior to the printing in this document “[REDACTED]” [REDACTED] “[REDACTED]” [REDACTED] “[REDACTED]” [REDACTED] “Listing Department” the listing department of the Stock Exchange “Macau” the Macao Special Administrative Region of the PRC “Mandatory Provident Fund Schemes Ordinance” the Mandatory Provident Fund Schemes Ordinance (Chapter 485 of the Laws of Hong Kong), as amended, supplemental or otherwise modified from time to time – 17 – THIS APPLICATION PROOF IS IN DRAFT FORM. The information contained herein is incomplete and is subject to change. This Application Proof must be read in conjunction with the section headed “Warning” on the cover of this Application Proof. DEFINITIONS “Memorandum” or “Memorandum of Association” the memorandum of association of the Company adopted on [●] upon the incorporation of the Company and as amended from time to time “MPF” mandatory provident fund “Mr. Chan” Mr. Chan Yiu Kwong, one of the founders of the Group and a Controlling Shareholder, the chairman of the Company and an executive Director “Mr. Li” Mr. Li Hon Ming, one of the founders of the Group and a Controlling Shareholder, the chief executive officer of the Company and an executive Director “National Pride” National Pride Limited, a liability company incorporated in Anguilla on 8 July 2014 and is owned as to 100% by Mr. Kwan Hoi Wang, an Independent Third Party “Nomination Committee” the nomination committee of the Board “[REDACTED]” [REDACTED] “[REDACTED]” [REDACTED] “[REDACTED]” [REDACTED] – 18 – THIS APPLICATION PROOF IS IN DRAFT FORM. The information contained herein is incomplete and is subject to change. This Application Proof must be read in conjunction with the section headed “Warning” on the cover of this Application Proof. DEFINITIONS “[REDACTED]” [REDACTED] “Predecessor Companies Ordinance” the Company Ordinance (Chapter 32 of the Laws of Hong Kong) as in force from time to time before 3 March 2014 “Pre-IPO Investors” National Pride, Prime View, Global Excellent and Hang Kong “[REDACTED]” [REDACTED] “[REDACTED]” [REDACTED] “Prime View” Prime View Enterprises Limited, a limited liability company incorporated in the Republic of Seychelles on 29 September 2014 and is held as to 100% by Mr. Ip Wai Lung, an Independent Third Party “Remuneration Committee” the remuneration committee of the Board “Reorganisation” the corporate reorganisation in preparation for [REDACTED] as more particularly described in the sub-section headed “History, Reorganisation and Group Structure — Reorganisation” in this document “RMB” Renminbi, the lawful currency of the PRC “SFC” The Securities and Futures Commission of Hong Kong – 19 – THIS APPLICATION PROOF IS IN DRAFT FORM. The information contained herein is incomplete and is subject to change. This Application Proof must be read in conjunction with the section headed “Warning” on the cover of this Application Proof. DEFINITIONS “SFO” Securities and Futures Ordinance (Chapter 571 of the Laws of Hong Kong) as amended, supplemented or otherwise modified from time to time “Share(s)” ordinary share(s) of nominal value of HK$0.01 each in the share capital of the Company “Share Option Scheme” the share option scheme conditionally approved and adopted by the Company pursuant to a resolution passed by the Shareholders on [●], the principal terms of which are summarised in the sub-section headed “Appendix IV – D. Share Option Scheme” in this document “Shareholder(s)” holder(s) of the Shares “Stock Exchange” The Stock Exchange of Hong Kong Limited “subsidiary” has the meaning ascribed thereto in section 15 of the Companies Ordinance “substantial shareholder(s)” substantial shareholder(s) of the Company having the meaning ascribed to it in the GEM Listing Rules “Takeovers Code” The Codes on Takeovers and Mergers and Share Buybacks, as amended, modified and supplements from time to time “Track Record Period” the period comprising the two years ended 31 December 2015 “Trade Description Ordinance” the Trade Description Ordinance (Chapter 362 of the Laws of Hong Kong), as amended, supplemented or otherwise modified from time to time “[REDACTED]” [REDACTED] “[REDACTED]” [REDACTED] – 20 – THIS APPLICATION PROOF IS IN DRAFT FORM. The information contained herein is incomplete and is subject to change. This Application Proof must be read in conjunction with the section headed “Warning” on the cover of this Application Proof. DEFINITIONS “United States” or “US” the United States of America “US$” or “US dollars” United States dollars, the lawful currency of the US “sq.ft” square feet “sq.m” square meters “%” per cent Certain amounts and percentage figures included in this document have been subject to rounding adjustments. Accordingly, figures shown as totals in certain tables may not be an arithmetic aggregation of the figures preceding them. If there is any inconsistency between the Chinese names of entities or enterprises established in the PRC and their English translations, the Chinese names shall prevail. The English translation of company names in Chinese or another language which are marked with ‘‘*’’ and the Chinese translation of company names in English which are marked with ‘‘*’’ is for identification purpose only. – 21 – THIS APPLICATION PROOF IS IN DRAFT FORM. The information contained herein is incomplete and is subject to change. This Application Proof must be read in conjunction with the section headed “Warning” on the cover of this Application Proof. GLOSSARY OF TECHNICAL TERMS This glossary contains explanations of certain terms, definitions and abbreviations used in this document in connection with the Group and the business. The terms and their meanings may not correspond to standard industry meaning or usage of those terms. “3G” third generation of mobile telecommunication technology “4G” fourth generation of mobile telecommunication technology “brand owner(s)” owner(s) of branded products, or their authorised distributor(s) or agent(s) with whom the Group negotiates for procurement of the distribution rights for the branded products “e-commerce” electronic commerce, being the trading or facilitation of trading in products or services using computer networks “Taobao” Taobao.com (淘寶網), is a Chinese language website for consumer-to-consumer online retail that is operated in the PRC by a well-known Chinese e-commerce company. It is a platform for small businesses and individual entrepreneurs to open online stores that mainly cater to consumers in Chinese-speaking regions (the PRC, Hong Kong, Macau and Taiwan) “Tmall” Tmall.com (天貓), is a Chinese language website for business-to-consumer online retail that is operated in the PRC by a well-known Chinese e-commerce company. It is a platform for local Chinese and international businesses to sell brand name goods mainly to consumers in the PRC, Hong Kong, Macau and Taiwan – 22 – THIS APPLICATION PROOF IS IN DRAFT FORM. The information contained herein is incomplete and is subject to change. This Application Proof must be read in conjunction with the section headed “Warning” on the cover of this Application Proof. FORWARD-LOOKING STATEMENTS This document contains forward-looking statements that are, by their nature, subject to significant risks and uncertainties. These forward-looking statements include, without limitation, statements relating to: • the business strategies and plans of operations; • the capital expenditure plans; • the amount and nature of, and potential for, future development of the Group’s business; • the operations and business prospects; • the dividend policy; • the projects under planning; • the regulatory environment of the relevant industry in general; • the future development in relevant industry; and • other factors referenced in this document, including, without limitation, under the sections entitled ‘‘Risk factors’’, ‘‘Industry overview’’, ‘‘Business’’, and ‘‘Financial information’’. The words ‘‘anticipate’’, ‘‘believe’’, ‘‘could’’, ‘‘expect’’, ‘‘intend’’, ‘‘may’’, ‘‘plan’’, ‘‘project’’, ‘seek’’, ‘‘will’’, ‘‘would’’ and similar expressions, as they relate to the Group, are intended to identify a number of these forward-looking statements. These forward-looking statements reflecting the Group’s current views with respect to future events are not a guarantee of future performance and are subject to certain risks, uncertainties and assumptions, including the risk factors described in this document. One or more of these risks or uncertainties may materialise, or underlying assumptions may prove incorrect. Subject to the requirements of the GEM Listing Rules, the Company does not intend to publicly update or otherwise revise the forward-looking statements in this document, whether as a result of new information, future events or otherwise. As a result of these and other risks, uncertainties and assumptions, the forward-looking events and circumstances discussed in this document might not occur in the way the Company expects, or at all. Accordingly, you should not place undue reliance on any forward-looking information. All forward-looking statements in this document are qualified by reference to this cautionary statement. – 23 – THIS APPLICATION PROOF IS IN DRAFT FORM. The information contained herein is incomplete and is subject to change. This Application Proof must be read in conjunction with the section headed “Warning” on the cover of this Application Proof. RISK FACTORS Potential investors should consider carefully all the information set out in this document and, in particular, should consider and evaluate the following risks associated with an investment in the Company before making any investment decision in relation to the Company. The trading price of the Shares could decline due to any of these risks, and you may lose part or all of your investment. RISKS RELATING TO THE GROUP AND ITS BUSINESS The Group’s business substantially relies on the sales of a few categories of flagship products, if any event happens which adversely affects the sales and profitability of these products, the overall results of the Group’s operation may be materially and adversely affected For each of the two years ended 31 December 2015, sales of the Group’s flagship products, namely, hair removal devices under the “Silk’n” brand and radio frequency skin tightening and cellulite reduction treatment devices under the “Tripollar” brand, had in aggregate accounted for approximately 47.0% and 59.5%, respectively of the Group’s revenue. Thus, the Group’s business had relied heavily on the demand for and the profitability of these categories of flagship products. If any event happens which would adversely affect the sales and profitability of these products, such as change of consumer preferences, presence of competitive products, pricing pressure or regulatory restrictions on their sale or related advertising activities, the overall results of the Group’s operation may be materially and adversely affected. The Group relies on the supply of products by a few major suppliers For each of the two years ended 31 December 2015, suppliers from the Group’s top five suppliers accounted for approximately 71.3% and 70.0% of the total purchase of the Group respectively. Four and three of the top five suppliers respectively for the two years ended 31 December 2015 had entered into exclusive distribution agreements with the Group. For each of the two years ended 31 December 2015, purchases of “Silk’n” beauty gadgets from its brand owner, which is one of the Group’s top five suppliers and the largest supplier of the Group for beauty gadgets, amounted to approximately HK$9.6 million and HK$7.9 million, representing approximately 33.4% and 31.8% of the Group’s total purchases respectively. For the two years ended 31 December 2015, purchases of “La-fit” and “Reebok” fitness equipment from the respective brand owner, which is one of the Group’s top five suppliers and the largest supplier for fitness equipment for the years ended 31 December 2014 and 2015 respectively, amounted to approximately HK$1.9 million and HK$1.8 million, representing approximately 6.7% and 7.2% of the Group’s total purchases respectively. The success of the Group’s business depends, to a large extent, on its ability to secure exclusive distribution agreements with certain major brand owners for a steady supply of fitness equipment and beauty gadgets. Currently, the group had entered into exclusive distribution agreements with seven brand owners, pursuant to which they have granted exclusive distribution rights to the Group for distribution of certain beauty – 24 – THIS APPLICATION PROOF IS IN DRAFT FORM. The information contained herein is incomplete and is subject to change. This Application Proof must be read in conjunction with the section headed “Warning” on the cover of this Application Proof. RISK FACTORS gadgets and fitness equipment in Hong Kong, Macau and/or the PRC. Save for one of the exclusive distribution agreements, the Group is required to achieve the minimum purchase requirement prescribed by the respective brand owners. If the Group cannot fulfil its obligations under the exclusive distribution agreements, the brand owners are entitled to revoke the exclusivity rights or even terminate the distribution agreements with the Group. Please refer to the paragraph headed “Business — Operation flow — Entering into the exclusive distribution agreements with brand owners” in this document for the salient terms of these distribution agreements. Furthermore, the duration of each of these exclusive distribution agreements with brand owners is generally from one to three years and the Group cannot assure that such exclusive distribution agreements can be renewed, or can be renewed on commercially reasonable terms in the future. If the Group fails to renew the distribution agreements with the major brand owners on an exclusive basis, the exclusive distribution rights of such products may fall into the hands of the Group’s competitors and the Group’s market share and business results would be materially and adversely affected. Save and except for entering into exclusive distribution agreements with the seven brand owners, which accounted for approximately 66.0% and 66.4% of the Group’s purchase for the two years ended 31 December 2015 respectively, the Group has not entered into any long-term supply agreement with other suppliers. There is no assurance that the Group’s suppliers will continue to supply their products to the Group in the future at all or maintain a stable source of supply of products to the Group. If the suppliers are unable or unwilling to do so, there is also no assurance that the Group would be able to source similar products from alternative channels at all, or at commercially reasonable prices, or in a timely manner or at favourable terms, the Group’s business and financial results would be adversely affected. Two of the Group’s major suppliers operate their business in a political instable country. If they cease business or their businesses were disrupted because of political instability, the Group’s business and financial results would be adversely affected The Group’s top two suppliers for the Track Record Period who are brand owners of the Group’s certain beauty gadgets are based in Israel. More information on these two brand owners are set out in the sub-section headed “Business — Suppliers” in this document. Israel is situated around certain politically instable countries such as Jordan, Syria, and Egypt. Israel is also currently engaged in conflicts with other Middle East countries which may result in an outbreak of war should conflicts continue. Furthermore, there is an increase of political turmoil within Israel as the political parties are sharing different views. This may ultimately result in riots and protests. The Group cannot assure that these top two suppliers will continue to conduct and operate their business should political instability continues in Israel. There is no assurance that the Group would be able to source similar products from alternative channels at all, or at commercially reasonable prices, or in a timely manner or at favourable terms. The Group’s business and financial results would be adversely affected. Measures taken by the Group to counter this risk are set out in details in the sub-section headed “Business — Inventory control” in this document. – 25 – THIS APPLICATION PROOF IS IN DRAFT FORM. The information contained herein is incomplete and is subject to change. This Application Proof must be read in conjunction with the section headed “Warning” on the cover of this Application Proof. RISK FACTORS If the Group is unable to rely on the services and connections of its key personnel, or retain the current key personnel, its business could be adversely affected The Group’s growth has been heavily dependent on the services provided by its management team, in particular the executive Directors, Mr. Chan and Mr. Li. They manage the Group’s business operation, develop and execute the Group’s business strategies and manage the relationship with the Group’s key product suppliers and corporate customers. Therefore, the future success of the Group relies on its ability to retain the services of these key management personnel. If any of these key personnel are unable or unwilling to continue to provide services to the Group in his or her original position, and the Group is unable to find suitable replacements, the Group may not be able to continue their operations effectively and efficiently, and the Group’s business and financial conditions could be adversely affected. The Group has not entered into long-term agreements with the customers and there is no assurance that the current relationship between the Group and any customer can be continued in the future During the two years ended 31 December 2015, approximately 66.2% and 67.0% respectively of the Group’s sales were direct sales to general public consumers. They generally place a single purchase order with the Group for each purchase. The rest of 33.8% and 33.0% are the sales to the Group’s corporate customers, such as chain retailers and other distributors and retailers. None of them have entered into any long-term purchase agreements with the Group. The volume of the customers’ purchase orders and the product mix may vary significantly subject to trends and needs, and it may be difficult to forecast the number of future orders. As a result, the Group’s business, results of operations and financial condition may vary from period to period, depending on the volume of purchase orders from the customers, whether existing or new. Moreover, as there is no long-term agreement with the Group, there is no assurance that the relationship between the Group and any customer will continue on the same or similar terms, and the customers are free to terminate their respective relationship with the Group at any time in the future. The Group’s business and sales are subject to the business strategies of the brand owners For the two years ended 31 December 2015, approximately 90.3% and 94.1% of the Group’s revenue were attributed by sales of branded products sourced from brand owners around the world. Therefore the Group’s business and sales are heavily dependent on the market receptiveness of, and demand for, the products being provided by various brand owners. The overall business strategies and product development plans adopted by these brand owners and their ability to maintain and develop the brands are therefore essential to the Group’s business. As the Group has limited or no influence on the decisions made by the brand owners in relation to their business strategies, in particular, the production of their existing products and development of new products, the Group cannot assure that the brand owners will be able to maintain and further develop their brands and/or products, or that – 26 – THIS APPLICATION PROOF IS IN DRAFT FORM. The information contained herein is incomplete and is subject to change. This Application Proof must be read in conjunction with the section headed “Warning” on the cover of this Application Proof. RISK FACTORS the Group’s customers will continue to show preferences to their brands and/or products. If the strategies of the brand owners turn out to be unsuccessful or due to any other reasons the marketability of the brands falls substantially, the profitability of the Group’s business would be materially and adversely affected. The Group cannot assure that its products can meet consumer preferences and needs, and will continue to gain market acceptance and secure market share The Group sells and distributes a variety of fitness equipment and beauty gadgets to general public consumers through its distribution network, which includes chain retailers, third party e-commerce platforms, online group buying platforms, other distributors and retailers and the Group’s own retail outlets and websites. The general acceptance by consumers of the brands and products marketed by the Group is of vital importance to the Group’s success and it hinges on a number of factors such as brand image, product quality and customer loyalty. The Group’s success also depends, to a large extent, on its ability to offer a diversified portfolio of products that can meet the changing consumer preferences and needs. There is no assurance that the existing products distributed and sold by the Group will be able to satisfy changes in consumer preferences and needs. The Group may also fail to anticipate, identify or respond to the constant changes in relation to consumer preferences and needs on a timely basis, nor can the Group assure that it will be able to gain or increase market receptiveness and market share for its products. Consumer preferences and needs for products and brands can change from time to time for various reasons, including negative publicity regarding the Group’s products, emergence of competitive products and brands, or a general decrease in demand for the fitness equipment and beauty gadgets distributed and sold by the Group. Any of these events could adversely affect the Group’s competitive advantage and market share, which in turn could materially and adversely affect the Group’s business, financial condition and results of operation. The Group may not be able to renew its existing leases for its retail outlets when they expire, or if they are terminated, on terms acceptable to it The Group enters into leases in order to obtain retail space for its retail outlets. Generally, the terms of its leases of retail outlets are for a period of two years. The Group typically negotiates with the landlords three to six months prior to the expiration of the leases for their renewal. The Group cannot assure that it will be able to renew any of its leases on favourable or otherwise acceptable terms and conditions, in particular, those regarding rental amount. If existing leases cannot be renewed, the Group will have to find alternative premises that may not be located in areas that offer similar business environments and competitive advantage or similar pricing. In addition, failure to renew such leases will provide an opportunity for competitors to move into such retail spaces previously identified and occupied by the Group as strategically favourable point of sale. Accordingly, failure to secure such retail spaces on terms that are acceptable to the Group may materially and adversely affect its business, financial condition and results of operations. – 27 – THIS APPLICATION PROOF IS IN DRAFT FORM. The information contained herein is incomplete and is subject to change. This Application Proof must be read in conjunction with the section headed “Warning” on the cover of this Application Proof. RISK FACTORS The Group’s marketing activities are essential to maintain and enhance the brand images of the Group’s products and the success of the Group’s business The Group’s success depends considerably on its ability to develop, maintain and enhance the brand image of both the branded products sold by the Group and the Group’s proprietary products. The ability to maintain and enhance the Group’s brand recognition and reputation depends primarily on the success of the Group’s marketing and promotional efforts. During the Track Record Period, the Group has put substantial resources into promoting the products by various media advertisements and sponsorships of events in order to enhance the brand recognition of the Group’s products. However, there is no assurance that the Group’s marketing and promotional efforts will achieve the expected results. If the Group fails to successfully market and promote the carried brands, the brand recognition of the products distributed and sold by the Group may be adversely affected and there may be a possible decline in demand. Further, the Group’s advertising activities are subject to the relevant laws and regulations of the jurisdictions where the Group operates. For instance, the Trade Description Ordinance provides that no person(s) shall publish any advertisements that contain misleading information and/or a false trade description of the goods. If the Group’s marketing materials or advertisements contain anything contrary to the relevant laws and regulations, the Group would be liable for breach of the relevant laws and regulations. The Group’s reputation would also be adversely affected. The Group may not be able to maintain its profit margin in the future During the two years ended 31 December 2015, the Group’s profit attributable to owners of the Company amounted to approximately HK$11.4 million and HK$9.5 million respectively, while the Group’s overall gross profit margin was approximately 62.3% and 60.4% respectively. In addition, the Group’s overall gross profit margin is subject to the proportion of sales of different type of products. The Directors consider that the Group’s overall gross profit margin is subject to the proportion of sales through different types of sales channels, i.e. direct and indirect sales channels. Nevertheless, the Group cannot assure that it will be able to continue to maintain the current gross profit margin and growth in profit in the future if the operating costs continue to increase as a result of, among other factors, rising costs of labour, manufacturing, rent and shipping. Furthermore, the Group cannot guarantee its ability to maintain the current product mix or percentage of sales through direct and indirect sales channels and sustain the growth in sales of products that entail higher gross profit margin, hence any changes in the product mix or percentage of sales through direct and indirect sales channels in the future may adversely affect the Group’s profitability. – 28 – THIS APPLICATION PROOF IS IN DRAFT FORM. The information contained herein is incomplete and is subject to change. This Application Proof must be read in conjunction with the section headed “Warning” on the cover of this Application Proof. RISK FACTORS The Group conducts its business in the PRC through e-commerce platforms. Risks associated with e-commerce platforms may adversely affect the Group’s business and reputation The Group sells its beauty gadgets to the PRC market mainly via a third party e-commerce platform, namely, Tmall. The Group cannot assure that technical error, system failure, computer virus, loss of data or other electronic related system failures would not occur when a transaction is made via the trading platform. As it is normally a term of use that these e-commerce platforms will not be liable for any losses or damages caused by technical error, system failure, computer virus or such, the Group may have to bear the loss of any business due to the interruption to the transaction. Furthermore, if any e-commerce platform is found or perceived to be associated with selling of counterfeit products, the Group’s brand image and reputation may be tarnished and its business may be adversely affected accordingly. The Group relies on external manufacturers for production of its proprietary products The Group does not have any production facilities or production lines of its own. The Group’s major proprietary products are fitness equipment sourced from independent external manufacturers in the PRC. For the two years ended 31 December 2015, sales of proprietary products accounted for approximately 9.7% and 5.9% of the Group’s revenue respectively. Thus, the Group’s control over these external manufacturers in respect of their production process and quality of products is limited. The Group cannot assure that (i) there will not be any unexpected interruption of supply of products by these external manufacturers due to any reason beyond the Group’s control or expectation, such as introduction of new regulatory requirements, import restrictions, revocation of business licenses, power interruptions, fires or other force majeure; or (ii) the products provided to the Group by these external manufacturers can meet the Group’s quality requirements. Any such problems in relation to the supply of the Group’s proprietary products by external manufacturers could have a material adverse impact on the Group’s business. The Group is exposed to credit risks of its corporate customers. If any of the Group’s major corporate customer experiences any financial difficulty, the Group’s business with such corporate customers and the settlement process of their outstanding amounts owing to the Group may be adversely affected which may in turn adversely affect the liquidity, results of operations and profitability of the Group Aside from the businesses generated from the general public consumers, the Group also relies on the businesses generated from its corporate customers. The Group normally grants corporate customers a credit period of 30 to 60 days. The Group does not have access to all information of its corporate customers to determine their creditworthiness. The complete financial and operational conditions of the corporate customers are not always available to the Group, and the Group may not be in any position to obtain such information. As a result, if any of the Group’s major corporate customers experience any financial difficulty, the Group’s business with such corporate customers and the settlement process of their outstanding amounts owing to the Group may be adversely affected, which may in turn adversely affect the liquidity, the results of operations and profitability of the Group. – 29 – THIS APPLICATION PROOF IS IN DRAFT FORM. The information contained herein is incomplete and is subject to change. This Application Proof must be read in conjunction with the section headed “Warning” on the cover of this Application Proof. RISK FACTORS The Group’s products may cause unexpected or undesirable side effects unknown to the Group that may result in costly product returns or recalls, or even legal actions against the Group The Group’s proprietary products are assembled with various mechanical parts and are produced by external manufacturers, who may have inconsistencies in relation to the product quality. Although the Group believes that there are measures in place to control the quality of the finished products, the Group cannot assure that it will be able to detect defective products in every circumstance. In relation to the branded products distributed by the Group, the Group has no control of the manufacturing process of the brand owners and can only rely on the product warranty, quality control report and/or clinical study certificates/reports provided by them. However, if any side effects occur or if the Group’s products are perceived to have certain side effects, the Group may have to recall the products sold to the market. Substantial amount of product returns or recalls could materially and adversely affect the Group’s business, financial condition and results of operations. In addition, the Group may be exposed to the risk of product liability claims, litigation, complaints or adverse publicity under the circumstance. Currently, the Group does not maintain any product liability insurance and the product liability insurance policies maintained by the brand owners may not be able to be extended to cover the Group in a legally effective way. If the Group faces any litigation proceedings and the Group is held liable for any product liability claim, the Group will have to bear the costs, damages and other legal and related expenses arising therefrom to the extent that the Group may not be able to recover them from the relevant brand owner or manufacturer. As a result, the Group’s business, financial condition and results of operations may be materially and adversely affected. Please refer to the sub-section headed “Business — Insurance” in this document for the Group’s insurance coverage. The operation of certain retail stores of the Group will be affected due to removal of unauthorised building works As set out in the sub-section headed “Business – Properties” in this document, there are suspected unauthorised building works at the Group’s retail outlets at Causeway Bay and Yuen Long. If the unauthorised building works are required to be removed and/or rectified, the operation of the relevant retail stores will be affected and there will be adverse effect on the Group’s performance and profitability. The Group’s products may be subject to counterfeiting, imitation, and/or infringement by third parties The Group cannot assure that counterfeiting or imitation of its products will not occur in the future or, if it does occur, that the Group will be able to detect or address the problem effectively. Any occurrence of counterfeiting or imitation of the Group’s products could negatively affect the Group’s reputation and brand image and the products that the – 30 – THIS APPLICATION PROOF IS IN DRAFT FORM. The information contained herein is incomplete and is subject to change. This Application Proof must be read in conjunction with the section headed “Warning” on the cover of this Application Proof. RISK FACTORS Group sells, leading to a loss of consumer confidence in the Group and its products, and as a consequence, adversely affect the Group’s results of operations. Any litigation to prosecute counterfeiting and infringements of the Group’s rights and products will be expensive and will divert the management’s attention as well as other resources away from the Group’s business. Furthermore, the Group has acquired intellectual property rights in its proprietary products. The Group relies on trademark registrations to protect its intellectual property rights. However, it may be possible for third parties to use the Group’s intellectual property without authorisation. Any unauthorised use or infringement of the Group’s intellectual property rights may have an adverse impact on its business. If the Group has to resort to litigation to enforce its intellectual property rights, significant costs may be incurred. Conversely, there can be no assurance that the Group’s proprietary products sourced from external manufacturers will not infringe any third parties’ alleged design right. Should any infringement claim be initiated against the Group, it may incur significant legal expenditure to defend its rights and interests or be required to pay substantial damages. As a result, the Group’s reputation and business can be materially and adversely affected. The Group’s operating results may fluctuate due to seasonality and other factors The Group’s sales is subject to certain degree of seasonal fluctuations. Generally, demand for the Group’s beauty gadgets is relatively higher during spring season in March and April. The Group also experienced higher sales during Christmas holidays in 2014, and in November 2015 when Tmall launched special promotional activities to boost online shopping. Sales may also fluctuate during the course of a financial year for a number of other reasons, including the timing of launching new products and advertising and promotional campaigns. As a result, these seasonal consumption patterns may cause the Group’s operating results to fluctuate from period to period and therefore, comparisons of revenue and results of operations across different periods of a given year as an indicator of the Group’s performance may not be meaningful and should not be relied upon as indicators of the Group’s future performance. The Group may be unable to maintain rapid growth and implement its future plans The Group’s future business growth primarily depends on the successful implementation of its business objectives, business strategies and future plans as set out in the sub-section headed “Business – Business Strategies” in this document. These business objectives are based on the existing plans and intentions of the Group, most of which are at initial stages and have not proceeded to the stage of actual implementation and are therefore subject to high degree of risks and uncertainties. Furthermore, the Group may not be able to achieve the anticipated growth and expansion of its business due to factors which are beyond its control, such as changes in economic environment, market demands, government policies and relevant laws and regulations. As such, there is no assurance that the Group’s business objectives, business strategies and future plans will be accomplished, whether in whole or in part or be implemented within the estimated timeline. In the event that the Group’s future plans are not implemented and its business – 31 – THIS APPLICATION PROOF IS IN DRAFT FORM. The information contained herein is incomplete and is subject to change. This Application Proof must be read in conjunction with the section headed “Warning” on the cover of this Application Proof. RISK FACTORS objectives are not accomplished, the Group’s business, profitability and financial positions in the future may be materially and adversely affected. Furthermore, the Group’s future business plans may be hindered by other factors beyond its control, such as competition from other retailers and distributors selling similar products. Therefore, there is no assurance that the Group’s future business plans will materialise, or result in the conclusion or execution of any agreement within the planned time frame, or that the Group’s objectives will be fully or partially accomplished. The Group is exposed to risks of obsolete and slow-moving inventory which may adversely impact its cash flow and liquidity The total amount of the Group’s inventories were approximately HK$22.5 million and HK$14.6 million as at 31 December 2014 and 2015 respectively, and accounted for approximately 49.3% and 33.8% of the Group’s total assets respectively. The demand for the Group’s fitness equipment and beauty gadgets or other accessories products is highly dependent on customers’ preferences, which are beyond the Group’s control. For the two years ended 31 December 2015, the Group had not identified material inventory items requiring impairment provision. Any increase in inventory may adversely affect the Group’s working capital. If the Group cannot manage its inventory level efficiently in the future, its liquidity and cash flow may be adversely affected. Further, if the Group fails to source appropriate products to suit consumer preferences in the future, the volume of obsolete and slow-moving inventory may increase and it may need to either sell off such inventory at a lower price or write off such inventory, in the event of which the Group’s financial position and results of operations may be materially and adversely affected. RISKS RELATING TO THE INDUSTRY IN WHICH THE GROUP OPERATES The Group operates in a highly competitive industry The Group faces keen competition in respect of, inter alia, pricing, product quality and brand identification. Some of the Group’s competitors may have greater financial, technological and informational resources than the Group, which may enable them to provide products superior to the Group’s products, or to adapt more quickly than the Group does to evolving industry trends and consumer preferences. Conversely, some of the Group’s competitors may, out of various commercial considerations, adopt low-margin sales strategies and compete against the Group based on lower prices to increase their market shares. The Group may be forced to lower the prices and profit margins of its products or its market share would drop. There is no assurance that the Group will be able to compete successfully with its competitors in the future in view of the changing market environment. Increasing competition within the industry may have an adverse impact on the Group’s sales volume, market share, profit margin and financial result. The Group’s products mainly target Hong Kong market For the two years ended 31 December 2015, the Group generated approximately 75.4% and 76.1% of its sales from the Hong Kong market respectively. The Group anticipates that sales in Hong Kong will continue to represent a substantial proportion of its total sales in the future. – 32 – THIS APPLICATION PROOF IS IN DRAFT FORM. The information contained herein is incomplete and is subject to change. This Application Proof must be read in conjunction with the section headed “Warning” on the cover of this Application Proof. RISK FACTORS However, the profitability of the Group’s business is dependent on, inter alia, a number of factors relating to the Hong Kong market, such as the purchase power of the population, the number of and the spending by tourists and other visitors, and legislation, regulations and government policies in relation to the Group’s business. Furthermore, economic instability and political turmoil has certain effect on the macroeconomics conditions which would affect the consumer ’s desire to spend. Hong Kong is a special administrative region of the PRC. It enjoys a high degree of autonomy under the principle of “one country, two systems” in accordance with the Basic Law of Hong Kong. However, the Group is not in any position to guarantee the “one country, two systems” principle and the level of autonomy would be maintained as currently in place. Since the Group’s primary operations are substantially located in Hong Kong, any change in Hong Kong’s existing political environment may affect the stability of the economy in Hong Kong, thereby affecting the Group’s results of operations and financial positions. In late 2014, thousands of residents of Hong Kong engaged in civil disobedience protests. Activists protested outside key government buildings and occupied several major intersections, causing major disruption to traffic and trade in the affected areas. Any political and social instability in Hong Kong, if significant and prolonged, could have a material adverse effect on the Group’s business, financial condition, results of operations and prospects. As a result, the Group’s business may be materially and adversely affected in the event of any adverse or unforeseeable change in the economic, political and social conditions in Hong Kong. The Group is unable to assure that such changes will not occur in the future. The Group is operating in an industry that is reliant upon labour. Any increase in the cost of labour and the availability of labour may adversely affect the Group’s competitiveness and profitability As a result of its retail operation, the Group’s business is reliant upon labour. As the labour costs in Hong Kong are affected by the demand for and supply of labours and as well as economic factors including the inflation rate and standard of living, should there be a high demand and low supply in labour, the Group may face the risk of losing their current staff if there are more appealing offers in the market. There is no assurance that the Group will be able to identify and recruit replacement staff in a timely manner, which could have an adverse effect on the Group’s operation. In view of the potential increase in labour cost, if the Group is unable to apply effective measures to control the labour cost and increase the price of its products correspondingly, the Group’s competitiveness and profitability could be adversely affected. – 33 – THIS APPLICATION PROOF IS IN DRAFT FORM. The information contained herein is incomplete and is subject to change. This Application Proof must be read in conjunction with the section headed “Warning” on the cover of this Application Proof. RISK FACTORS RISKS RELATING TO THE [REDACTED] The Group’s financial performance would be adversely affected by expenses incurred in connection with the [REDACTED] As set out in the section headed “Reasons for the [REDACTED] and Use of Proceeds” in this document, the estimated expenses to be incurred in connection with the [REDACTED] is approximately HK$[REDACTED] million based on the [REDACTED] of HK$[REDACTED] (being the mid-point of the indicated [REDACTED] range stated in this document), assuming the [REDACTED] is not exercised. Such estimated expenses, which are non-recurrent in nature, are attributable as to (i) approximately HK$[REDACTED] million which was regarded as incremental costs directly attributable to the proposed issue of new Shares under the [REDACTED] and will be deducted from equity upon completion of the [REDACTED]; and (ii) approximately HK$[REDACTED] million which was regarded as costs associated with the [REDACTED] to the extent they are incremental costs not attributable to the equity transaction and to be charged to the Group’s consolidated statements of comprehensive income. Approximately HK$3.9 million of the [REDACTED] expenses was charged to the Group’s consolidated statements of comprehensive income for the year ended 31 December 2015, and as to HK$[REDACTED] million for the year ending 31 December 2016. You should note that the financial performance of the Group for the year ending 31 December 2016 would be materially and adversely affected by the estimated expenses in relation to the [REDACTED], and our net profit may be significantly lower than that for the years ended 31 December 2014 and 2015. There has been no prior public market for the Shares and the liquidity, market price and trading volume of the Share may be volatile Prior to the [REDACTED], there is no public market for the Shares. The [REDACTED] of, and the permission to deal in, the Shares on the Stock Exchange do not guarantee the development of an active public market or the sustainability thereof following completion of the [REDACTED]. Factors such as variations in the Group’s revenues, earnings and cash flows, strategic alliances or acquisitions made by the Group or its competitors, loss of key personnel, litigation or fluctuations in the market prices for the products of the Group, the liquidity of the market for the Shares, the general stock market sentiment could cause the market price and trading volume of the Shares to change substantially. In addition, both the market price and liquidity of the Shares could be adversely affected by factors beyond the Group’s control and unrelated to the performance of the Group’s business, especially if the financial market in Hong Kong experiences a significant price and volume fluctuation. In such cases, investors may not be able to sell their Shares at or above the [REDACTED]. Investors may experience dilution if the Group issues additional Shares in the future The Group may issue additional Shares upon exercise of options to be granted under the Share Option Scheme in the future. The increase in the number of Shares outstanding after the issue would result in the reduction in the percentage of ownership of the Shareholders and may result in a dilution in the earnings per Share and net asset value per Share. – 34 – THIS APPLICATION PROOF IS IN DRAFT FORM. The information contained herein is incomplete and is subject to change. This Application Proof must be read in conjunction with the section headed “Warning” on the cover of this Application Proof. RISK FACTORS In addition, the Group may need to raise additional funds in the future to finance business expansion or new development and acquisitions. If additional funds are raised through the issuance of new equity or equity-linked securities of the Company other than on a pro-rata basis to the existing Shareholders, the shareholding of such Shareholders in the Company may be reduced or such new securities may confer rights and privileges that take priority over those conferred by the [REDACTED]. Any disposal by the Controlling Shareholders of a substantial number of Shares in the public market could materially and adversely affect the market price of the Shares There is no guarantee that the Controlling Shareholders will not dispose of their Shares following the expiration of their respective lock-up periods after the [REDACTED]. The Group cannot predict the effect, if any, of any future sales of the Shares by any of the Controlling Shareholders, or that the availability of the Shares for sale by any of the Controlling Shareholders may have on the market price of the Shares. Sales of a substantial number of Shares by any of the Controlling Shareholders or the market perception that such sales may occur could materially and adversely affect the prevailing market price of the Shares. The Controlling Shareholders may take actions that are not in, or may conflict with, public Shareholders’ best interests The Controlling Shareholders control the exercise of approximately [REDACTED]% voting rights in the general meeting of the Company immediately after the [REDACTED] and the Capitalisation Issue. Therefore, the Controlling Shareholders will continue to be able to exercise controlling influence over the Group’s business through their ability to take actions which do not require the approval of independent Shareholders. As such, the Controlling Shareholders have substantial influence over the Group’s business, including decisions regarding mergers, consolidations and the sale of all or substantially all of the Group’s assets, election of directors, timing and amount of dividends, if any, and other significant corporate actions. In the case where the interest of the Controlling Shareholders conflict with other Shareholders, or if the Controlling Shareholders choose to cause the Group to pursue objectives that would conflict with the interest of other Shareholders, such Shareholders could be left in a disadvantageous position by such actions caused by the Controlling Shareholders and the price of the Shares could be adversely affected. – 35 – THIS APPLICATION PROOF IS IN DRAFT FORM. The information contained herein is incomplete and is subject to change. This Application Proof must be read in conjunction with the section headed “Warning” on the cover of this Application Proof. RISK FACTORS RISKS RELATING TO THIS DOCUMENT Statistics and industry information contained in this document may not be accurate and should not be duly relied upon Certain facts, statistics, and data presented in the section headed “Industry overview” and elsewhere in this document relating to the fitness equipment and beauty gadget markets industries have been derived, in part, from various publications and industry-related sources prepared by government officials or independent third parties. The Company believes that the sources of the information are appropriate sources for such information, and the Sponsor and the Directors have taken reasonable care to extract and reproduce the publications and industry-related sources in this document. In addition, the Company has no reason to believe that such information is false or misleading or that any fact that would render such information false or misleading has been omitted. However, neither the Group, the Directors, the Sponsor, nor any parties involved in the [REDACTED] has independently verified, or make any representation as to, the accuracy of such information and statistics. Accordingly, such information and statistics may not be accurate and should not be unduly relied upon. The Group’s future results could differ materially from those expressed or implied by the forward-looking statements Included in this document are various forward-looking statements that are based on various assumptions. The Group’s future results could differ materially from those expressed or implied by such forward-looking statements. For details of these statements and the associated risks, please refer to the section headed “Forward-looking statements” in this document. – 36 – THIS APPLICATION PROOF IS IN DRAFT FORM. The information contained herein is incomplete and is subject to change. This Application Proof must be read in conjunction with the section headed “Warning” on the cover of this Application Proof. INFORMATION ABOUT THIS DOCUMENT AND THE [REDACTED] [REDACTED] – 37 – THIS APPLICATION PROOF IS IN DRAFT FORM. The information contained herein is incomplete and is subject to change. This Application Proof must be read in conjunction with the section headed “Warning” on the cover of this Application Proof. INFORMATION ABOUT THIS DOCUMENT AND THE [REDACTED] [REDACTED] – 38 – THIS APPLICATION PROOF IS IN DRAFT FORM. The information contained herein is incomplete and is subject to change. This Application Proof must be read in conjunction with the section headed “Warning” on the cover of this Application Proof. INFORMATION ABOUT THIS DOCUMENT AND THE [REDACTED] [REDACTED] – 39 – THIS APPLICATION PROOF IS IN DRAFT FORM. The information contained herein is incomplete and is subject to change. This Application Proof must be read in conjunction with the section headed “Warning” on the cover of this Application Proof. INFORMATION ABOUT THIS DOCUMENT AND THE [REDACTED] [REDACTED] – 40 – THIS APPLICATION PROOF IS IN DRAFT FORM. The information contained herein is incomplete and is subject to change. This Application Proof must be read in conjunction with the section headed “Warning” on the cover of this Application Proof. DIRECTORS AND PARTIES INVOLVED IN THE [REDACTED] Name Address Nationality Chan Yiu Kwong (陳耀廣) 2/F, Block 15 Fortune Garden Chuk Yuen Yuen Long Hong Kong Chinese Li Hong Ming (李漢明) No. 38, Sun Lee Uk Tsuen Tin Ha Road Yuen Long Hong Kong Chinese Lo Wing Sang (勞永生) Room 14C, Block 6 Sceneway Gdn Lam Tin, Kowloon Chinese Executive Directors Independent non-executive Directors So Alan Wai Sing (蘇偉成) Flat C, 23/F, Block 8 Laguna City 25 Laguna Street Kwun Tong, Kowloon Chinese Ho Long Chin Matthew (何浪前) 10/F, New Henry House 10 Ice House Street Central, Hong Kong Chinese Wong King Lung (黃景隆) Room 709, Block C Kwai Chun Court Kwai Hing, New Territories Chinese – 41 – THIS APPLICATION PROOF IS IN DRAFT FORM. The information contained herein is incomplete and is subject to change. This Application Proof must be read in conjunction with the section headed “Warning” on the cover of this Application Proof. DIRECTORS AND PARTIES INVOLVED IN THE [REDACTED] Sponsor Ample Capital Limited Unit A, 14th Floor Two Chinachem Plaza 135 Des Voeux Road Central Central Hong Kong [REDACTED] [REDACTED] [REDACTED] [REDACTED] [REDACTED] Legal advisers to the Company as to Hong Kong law Jun He Law Offices Suite 3701-10 37/F, Jardine House 1 Connaught Place Central Hong Kong as to PRC law Jun He Law Offices Suite 2803-04 28/F, Tower Three Kerry Plaza No.1-1, Zhongxinsi Road Futian District Shenzhen 518048 P.R. China as to Cayman Islands law Conyers Dill & Pearman Cricket Square Hutchins Drive P.O. Box 2681 Grand Cayman KY1-1111 Cayman Islands – 42 – THIS APPLICATION PROOF IS IN DRAFT FORM. The information contained herein is incomplete and is subject to change. This Application Proof must be read in conjunction with the section headed “Warning” on the cover of this Application Proof. DIRECTORS AND PARTIES INVOLVED IN THE [REDACTED] Legal adviser to the Sponsor and the [REDACTED] [REDACTED] Reporting accountants RSM Hong Kong 29/F, Lee Garden Two 28 Yun Ping Road Causeway Bay Hong Kong – 43 – THIS APPLICATION PROOF IS IN DRAFT FORM. The information contained herein is incomplete and is subject to change. This Application Proof must be read in conjunction with the section headed “Warning” on the cover of this Application Proof. CORPORATE INFORMATION Registered office in the Cayman Islands Cricket Square Hutchins Drive P.O. Box 2681 Grand Cayman KY1-1111 Cayman Islands Headquarters and principal place of business in Hong Kong Room 2207, 22/F Park-In Commercial Centre 56 Dundas Street Mong Kok Kowloon Hong Kong Company secretary Mr. Li Shiu Tong Andrew Certified Public Accountants 2/F, 168D Yuen Kong, Pat Heung Yuen Long, New Territories Hong Kong Compliance officer Mr. Lo Wing Sang Members of the audit committee Mr. So Alan Wai Sing (chairman) Mr. Ho Long Chin Matthew Mr. Wong King Lung Members of the remuneration committee Mr. Wong King Lung (chairman) Mr. So Alan Wai Sing Mr. Ho Long Chin Matthew Mr. Ho Long Chin Matthew (chairman) Members of the nomination committee Mr. Chan Mr. So Alan Wai Sing – 44 – THIS APPLICATION PROOF IS IN DRAFT FORM. The information contained herein is incomplete and is subject to change. This Application Proof must be read in conjunction with the section headed “Warning” on the cover of this Application Proof. CORPORATE INFORMATION Mr. Lo Wing Sang Room 14C, Block 6 Sceneway Garden Lam Tin, Kowloon Hong Kong Authorised representatives Mr. Li Shiu Tong Andrew 2/F, 168D Yuen Kong, Pat Heung Yuen Long, New Territories Hong Kong Principal share registrar and transfer office in the Cayman Islands [REDACTED] Hong Kong branch share registrar and transfer office [REDACTED] Principal bankers Bank of China (Hong Kong) 1 Garden Road Hong Kong Compliance Adviser Ample Capital Limited Unit A, 14/F Two Chinachem Plaza 135 Des Voeux Road Central Central Hong Kong Company website (Note) www.fitboxx.com Note: The information on the website of the Company does not form part in this document. – 45 – THIS APPLICATION PROOF IS IN DRAFT FORM. The information contained herein is incomplete and is subject to change. This Application Proof must be read in conjunction with the section headed “Warning” on the cover of this Application Proof. INDUSTRY OVERVIEW The information that appears in this Industry Overview has been prepared by Euromonitor and reflects estimates of market conditions based on publicly available sources and trade opinion surveys, and is prepared primarily as a market research tool. References to Euromonitor Report should not be considered as the opinion of Euromonitor as to the value of any security or the advisability of investing in the Company. The Directors believe that the sources of information contained in this Industry Overview are appropriate sources for such information and have taken reasonable care in reproducing such information. The Directors have no reason to believe that such information is false or misleading or that any material fact has been omitted that would render such information false or misleading. The information prepared by Euromonitor and set out in this Industry Overview has not been independently verified by the Group, the Sponsor, the [REDACTED], the [REDACTED] or any other party involved in the [REDACTED] and none of them gives any representations as to its accuracy and the information should not be relied upon in making, or refraining from making, any investment decision. COMMISSIONED REPORT FROM EUROMONITOR The Company commissioned Euromonitor, an independent market research company, to conduct an analysis of and produce the report on the fitness equipment and beauty gadget market in Hong Kong and the beauty gadget online retailing market in the PRC. A total fee of US$99,750 (equivalent to approximately HK$778,000) was paid to Euromonitor for the preparation of the report. Research Methodology Euromonitor, founded in 1972, is a global research organisation and the private independent provider of business intelligence on industries, countries and consumers. The information contained in the Euromonitor Report was undertaken through both primary and secondary research obtained from various sources. Primary research involved interviews with a sample of leading industry participants and industry experts. Secondary research involved reviewing published sources including, specialised industry literature, government/regulatory sources, third-party reports and surveys, industry reports and analyst reports, industry associations and the database maintained by Euromonitor. Intelligence gathered has been analysed, assessed and validated using Euromonitor ’s in-house analysis models and techniques. The forecasting bases and assumptions for the projections in the Euromonitor Report include the following: • The economy of Hong Kong and the PRC is expected to maintain steady growth over the forecast period; • The social, economic and political environments of Hong Kong and the PRC are expected to remain stable during the forecast period; – 46 – THIS APPLICATION PROOF IS IN DRAFT FORM. The information contained herein is incomplete and is subject to change. This Application Proof must be read in conjunction with the section headed “Warning” on the cover of this Application Proof. INDUSTRY OVERVIEW • There will be no external shock, such as a financial crisis or raw materials shortage, that affects the demand and supply of the beauty gadget and fitness equipment market in Hong Kong or the beauty gadget online retailing market in the PRC during the forecast period. The following definitions were used throughout the Euromonitor Report: • Beauty Gadget: Defined as a gadget meant for beauty care treatment purposes, it includes (i) facial care gadgets (e.g. facial saunas, facial solariums, facial toners, facial cleansers, etc.), (ii) hair removal gadgets (e.g. epilators, IPL (Intense Pulsed Light) hair removal gadgets, etc.) and (iii) other beauty gadgets (e.g. hair care appliances including hair styling appliances and hair dryers, as well as oral care appliances and other personal care appliances). Beauty gadgets for professional usage (i.e. specifically designed for beauty salons, etc.) are excluded from this study. • Fitness Equipment: Defined as equipment meant for personal fitness purposes, this includes treadmills, steppers, exercise bikes, workout benches, etc. Fitness equipment for professional usage (i.e. specifically designed for gyms/fitness clubs, etc.) is excluded from this study. The research results may be affected by the accuracy of these assumptions and the choice of these parameters. Euromonitor ’s forecast data comes from analysis of the historical development of the market, the economic environment and underlying market drivers, and it is cross-checked against established industry data and trade interviews with industry experts. The Sponsor and the Company consider such information to be reliable, accurate and not misleading after taking into account the following factors: (a) Euromonitor is an independent reputable research agency with extensive experience in their profession; and (b) Although the Euromonitor Report includes forecast of the development of the fitness equipment and beauty gadget market in Hong Kong and the beauty gadget online retailing market in the PRC, it does not contain performance forecast of the Company. – 47 – THIS APPLICATION PROOF IS IN DRAFT FORM. The information contained herein is incomplete and is subject to change. This Application Proof must be read in conjunction with the section headed “Warning” on the cover of this Application Proof. INDUSTRY OVERVIEW The Directors confirm that, to the best of their knowledge, after taking reasonable care, there is no material adverse change in the market information since the date of the Euromonitor Report which may qualify, contradict or have an impact on the information in this section. MACROECONOMIC ENVIRONMENT IN HONG KONG Nominal GDP in Hong Kong stood at HK$2,246 billion in 2014, representing a CAGR of 6.0% since 2010. After the economy slipped into recession in 2009 and employment shrank for the first time since 2003, consumption, investment and exports all contributed to the rebound in 2010 and 2011, resulting in real GDP growth of approximately 6.8% and 4.8%, respectively. The pace slowed again in 2012 when exports dropped and retail sales stalled. Investment and construction provided most of the support for the economy. Strong growth in the export of services was one of the main factors contributing towards the improved economic performance in 2013, when real GDP rose by 2.9%. In particular, rising inbound tourism helped boost exports of travel services in the same year, while exports of financial and other business services also performed well. Rising domestic demand also made a strong contribution to positive economic growth in 2013. However, the economy witnessed slower growth in 2014 than the 2.9% recorded in 2013. Hong Kong’s economy came under scrutiny in 2014 when wide-scale democracy protests beginning in September disrupted retail sales and tourism, especially that of mainland Chinese visitors. Although this growth is the second-lowest of the review period, it remained well ahead of the approximately 1.5% growth seen in 2012. Similar trends were observed for annual disposable income per capita, which increased from HK$197,413 in 2010 to HK$249,083 in 2014, exhibiting a CAGR of about 6.0% over the review period of 2010-2014. FITNESS EQUIPMENT MARKET IN HONG KONG Fitness equipment retail market in Hong Kong Fitness equipment retail overview and performance A very concentrated retail market The Hong Kong fitness equipment retail market is very concentrated. There are only a few major players, with the Group and competitor A dominating the market. Competitor A (please refer to “Table 3 – Market Ranking of the Top Five Distributors for Fitness Equipment, Based on Total Equivalent Retail Value Sales, Historical (2014)” for more details) was the largest retailer of home fitness equipment until 2008, displaying a large range of traditional fitness equipment such as treadmills and elliptical machines in its stores. Since 2008-2009, the Group played a pivotal role in developing the market. By offering less space-consuming and smaller-sized equipment (e.g. foldable treadmills, foldable bikes, small-sized steppers), the Group helped boost the Hong Kong market, raising interest in home gyms and enlarging the overall customer base for fitness equipment as space was a major constraint. – 48 – THIS APPLICATION PROOF IS IN DRAFT FORM. The information contained herein is incomplete and is subject to change. This Application Proof must be read in conjunction with the section headed “Warning” on the cover of this Application Proof. INDUSTRY OVERVIEW Healthy growth supported by product innovations and consumer health trends The competition from commercial fitness centres was fierce during the review period of 2010-2014, mostly because they provide more advanced products along with personal training services. However, retail sales of home fitness equipment increased steadily over the review period at a CAGR of 4.9%, reaching HK$58.4 million in 2014. This growth was mostly driven by the innovative range proposed by retailers, especially the smaller-sized and more convenient equipment compared to traditional fitness equipment, which is less adapted to Hong Kong home sizes. In terms of products, the consumers trust the international brands available in Hong Kong (mainly from US or Europe) and consequently, product safety is not seen as a major concern. Retail sales of fitness equipment are expected to continue to grow over the forecast period The fitness equipment category is expected to continue to grow at a CAGR of 4.9% to reach HK$74.1 million in 2019. Convenience and flexibility will remain primary drivers in the growth of home gyms. But this expected growth is also likely to be spurred on by demographic trends, such as the ageing population. Hong Kong is the second-fastest ageing population in Asia behind Japan. By 2041, nearly one in three Hong Kong residents will be aged 65 or older and, with such an epidemiological transition, maintaining health and fitness into old age has become a public health priority. TABLE 1 TOTAL RETAIL VALUE SALES OF FITNESS EQUIPMENT IN HONG KONG, HISTORICAL (2010-2014), FORECAST (2015-2019), HK$ MILLIONS Fitness Equipment Fitness Equipment Sources: 2010 2011 2012 2013 2014 CAGR 2010-14 48.2 50.6 53.0 55.6 58.4 4.9% 2015 2016 2017 2018 2019 CAGR 2015-19 61.2 64.2 67.4 70.7 74.1 4.9% Euromonitor estimates from desk research and trade interviews with relevant industry associations and major fitness equipment manufacturers/distributors/retailers in Hong Kong – 49 – THIS APPLICATION PROOF IS IN DRAFT FORM. The information contained herein is incomplete and is subject to change. This Application Proof must be read in conjunction with the section headed “Warning” on the cover of this Application Proof. INDUSTRY OVERVIEW Fitness equipment retail distribution Sporting goods retailers lead sales of home fitness equipment in Hong Kong Store-based retailers dominate the distribution of fitness equipment in terms of retail value sales, accounting for about HK$55.4 million or 94.9% of the total distribution in 2014. This share was mainly driven by chained players, the Group and Competitor A (please refer to “Table 3 – Market Ranking of the Top Five Distributors for Fitness Equipment, Based on Total Equivalent Retail Value Sales, Historical (2014)” for more details). The Group has seven outlets in Hong Kong (five stores and, one counter in a department store and one sales booth in a shopping mall). Competitor A had seven stores and 22 counters in major sporting goods retailers and in some department stores as at the completion date of the Euromonitor Report. Hence, the single largest distribution channel is sporting goods retailers, accounting for 80.3% of the overall retail distribution in value sales, or HK$46.9 million in 2014. Sporting goods retailers display the widest range of fitness products among all retailers and are located in the major commercial areas in Hong Kong. Department stores represented the next-largest channel within the distribution of fitness equipment in 2014, accounting for about 14.6% of the retail value sales of fitness equipment. The market share of the non-store retailing channel within the distribution of fitness equipment remained low in 2014, at approximately 5.1% or HK$3.0 million. Table 2 Fitness Equipment Retail Distribution in Hong Kong, Based on Retail Value Sales, Historical (2014), HK$ Millions Store-based Retailing Sporting Goods Stores Department Stores 80.3% 14.6% Non-store Retailing (*) 94.9% 5.1% Total 100% (*) Includes Internet retailing for the purpose of this study Sources: Euromonitor estimates from desk research and trade interviews with relevant industry associations and major fitness equipment manufacturers/distributors/retailers in Hong Kong – 50 – THIS APPLICATION PROOF IS IN DRAFT FORM. The information contained herein is incomplete and is subject to change. This Application Proof must be read in conjunction with the section headed “Warning” on the cover of this Application Proof. INDUSTRY OVERVIEW Market drivers, constraints and entry barriers A combination of convenience, flexibility and style are the primary drivers of home gyms With space being the biggest challenge, convenience and flexibility are the major drivers in the fitness equipment industry for consumers. Owing to high rental prices, consumers can seldom dedicate a whole room of their flat for exercise. Hence, portable, foldable, sleek and streamlined workout equipment is ideal for home use. Hong Kong consumers are attentive to the aesthetics and style of the equipment, in addition to ease of use and effectiveness. Growing awareness of the benefits of exercise has impacted the fitness equipment market Hong Kong citizens work some of the longest hours in the world, largely due to a belief that more work hours means higher productivity. However, consumer awareness is increasing with regard to the benefits of exercise, such as reduced risk of disease, increased health and a positive effect on performance and work-related productivity. Therefore, consumers are beginning to make lifestyle choices through new exercise and eating/drinking patterns. This growing awareness for sustaining a healthy lifestyle amongst the general public has impacted the fitness equipment market. The ageing population is a growth driver of the fitness equipment market The large ageing population is another important factor driving the fitness equipment market. Hong Kong’s population has experienced an ageing trend over the past decade. According to the Hong Kong Census and Statistics Department, the proportion of people aged 65 and up increased from 12% in 2001 to about 15% in 2013 and it is expected to reach 32% in 2041. Moreover, people aged 50 and older are the major customers of overall health and wellness products and the demand for fitness equipment for home use is expected to continue to grow among this customer segment. Very limited risk factors for the fitness equipment market in Hong Kong In Hong Kong, owing to no import tax, there are no real risk factors that could have a potential impact on the development of the fitness equipment market. Moreover, there have been very few issues with counterfeit fitness equipment, which are not considered significant enough to be a risk factor. Market concentration is the major barrier for new entrants Retail consolidation is one of the biggest barriers for new entrants in the fitness equipment market for home use. With only two major players, it is challenging for a new entrant, especially a small company, to build awareness and start selling fitness equipment in Hong Kong. It is not easy to step into this market where the Group and Competitor A dominate. Moreover, in terms of media, the Group has a strong and regular presence above and below the line, leaving its competitors with little share. Hence, the investment/capital required to enter the fitness equipment market is significant and can be an entry barrier for small players. – 51 – THIS APPLICATION PROOF IS IN DRAFT FORM. The information contained herein is incomplete and is subject to change. This Application Proof must be read in conjunction with the section headed “Warning” on the cover of this Application Proof. INDUSTRY OVERVIEW Competitive landscape A market characterised by strong consolidation The Hong Kong fitness equipment market is highly concentrated, with the two largest players accounting for approximately 71.8% of total equivalent retail value sales. The Group and Competitor A are large players while international companies/brands focusing more on the professional market also have an offer for the home fitness market. Several international players do not have their own points of sale in Hong Kong and try to reach Hong Kong consumers online. They often have a studio to display their equipment and work with agents/dealers. The Group has a dominant position owing to its innovative offers and strong media presence The Group mainly sells fitness equipment at its own point of sale. The Group has wide coverage with seven retail outlets in Hong Kong. The Group differentiates itself with strong and innovative product offers and extensive marketing campaigns, specifically targeting home fitness equipment market. Moreover, the Group has the advantage of distributing multiple brands. This allows the Group to bring in more innovations than distributing a single brand. Consequently, the Group played a pivotal role since it emerged in this market by introducing flexible and space-saving products, e.g. foldable bikes, foldable treadmills, small-sized steppers etc. Table 3 Market Ranking of the Top Five Distributors for Fitness Equipment, Based on Total Equivalent Retail Value Sales, Historical (2014) Ranking Company Name Share 1 2 Others the Group Competitor A 40.1% 31.6% 28.3% Total Sources: 100.0% Euromonitor estimates after desk research and trade interviews with a sample of distributors and retailers of fitness equipment. The market share data reported above has been determined via a fieldwork program consisting of desk research and trade interviews. While audited data was available for some of the companies, they typically did not break the revenue or sales numbers into the relevant categories covered in this study. For these companies as well as those that were included in the market shares but are not publicly listed, Euromonitor has projected the market shares based on estimates provided by various trade sources (i.e. not just the companies themselves) and sought a consensus on these estimates as much as possible. – 52 – THIS APPLICATION PROOF IS IN DRAFT FORM. The information contained herein is incomplete and is subject to change. This Application Proof must be read in conjunction with the section headed “Warning” on the cover of this Application Proof. INDUSTRY OVERVIEW BEAUTY GADGET MARKET IN HONG KONG Beauty gadget retail market in Hong Kong Beauty gadget retail market overview and performance Beauty gadgets are well established in the Hong Kong personal care market Hong Kong is a mature and sophisticated market when it comes to beauty. Consumers use a large range of personal care or grooming products and show high interest in skincare innovations. Hong Kong consumers have the second-highest level of gadget adoption in Asia. Hence, beauty gadgets have been part of the beauty market for some time, driven by hair removal gadgets. However, only in the past five years has the category expanded into skin care, driven by facial care gadgets. In broader terms, the beauty gadget market is segmented into three major categories: (i) facial care gadgets, (ii) hair removal gadgets and (iii) other beauty gadgets. For the purpose of this study, only the first two categories are covered because the inclusion of all other beauty gadgets would be too broad, encompassing a multitude of market players across various product industries, who would not be directly comparable to the Group in terms of product offering. For information, other beauty gadgets accounted for approximately 24.9% of retail sales of all beauty gadgets. International players dominate the beauty gadget market due to an established presence that earns consumers’ confidence in the quality of the products, which is particularly important as these products often have direct contact with the body, and therefore, consumers want to ensure product safety. Retail sales of beauty gadgets (excluding other beauty gadgets) increased over the review period of 2010-2014 at a CAGR of 10.2% to reach HK$465.2 million in 2014. This growth was mostly driven by facial care gadgets, which accounted for 50.4% of total beauty gadget retail sales in 2014. Hair removal gadgets achieved a similar customer value spend, reaching HK$230.7 million in 2014 and a share of about 49.6% within beauty gadgets, but realised slower growth than facial care gadgets. In Hong Kong, saving time is important to consumers in all respects, and thus consumers looking for convenient and effective solutions that could save them time (especially for hair removal) played a pivotal role in the growth of beauty gadgets. In addition, women’s rising disposable income and sophistication saw them become more receptive to beauty gadgets and innovations, as witnessed in the facial care gadget segment. The market for facial care gadgets flourished in 2011-2012, supported by major launches Increasing demand for more sophisticated offerings in skin care, consumers’ desire for greater efficacy and the high level of gadget adoption helped beauty gadgets garner more attention in skin care in Hong Kong since 2011. Facial care gadgets represented a relatively niche segment in 2010, but the acquisition of Clarisonic by L’Oréal at the end of 2011 boosted this segment. The success of Clarisonic opened doors for other beauty players to move into the industry across both the mass and premium segments. Investment from consumer appliance manufacturers has also been in the form of collaboration with beauty players, e.g. the Panasonic and Shiseido sets of facial gadgets. – 53 – THIS APPLICATION PROOF IS IN DRAFT FORM. The information contained herein is incomplete and is subject to change. This Application Proof must be read in conjunction with the section headed “Warning” on the cover of this Application Proof. INDUSTRY OVERVIEW Retail sales of facial care gadgets grew at a CAGR of 12.5% over the review period to reach HK$234.6 million in 2014, up from HK$146.6 million in 2010. The Group competes closely with some major international manufacturers of personal care. Although the competition from professional hair removal salons became fiercer, hair removal gadget retail sales witnessed healthy growth among the beauty gadget segments, increasing at a CAGR of approximately 8.1% during the review period to reach HK$230.7 million in 2014, up from HK$168.9 million in 2010. Beauty gadget retail sales are expected to continue to grow over the forecast period Several factors influencing consumer trends such as convenience, heightened awareness of the technology used in beauty gadgets, an ageing population and men’s grooming are expected to drive the growth of beauty gadget retail sales at a CAGR of 8.2% over the forecast period of 2015-2019, to reach HK$687.4 million by 2019. Facial care gadgets are forecast to continue growing quickly, at a CAGR of 11.0% over 2015-2019, to reach HK$395.2 million in 2019. Hair removal gadgets are forecast to continue accounting for a large share of beauty gadget retail sales, driven by consumers’ constant search for time- and cost-efficient solutions. This segment is forecast to grow at a CAGR of 4.9% over 2015-2019, to reach HK$292.1 million in 2019. Table 4 Total Retail Value Sales of Beauty Gadgets in Hong Kong, Historical (2010-2014), Forecast (2015-2019), HK$ Millions Beauty Gadgets Facial Care Gadgets Hair Removal Gadgets Beauty Gadgets Facial Care Gadgets Hair Removal Gadgets Sources: 2010 2011 2012 2013 2014 CAGR 2010-14 315.5 330.3 374.5 416.9 465.2 10.2% 146.6 148.4 178.0 204.4 234.6 12.5% 168.9 181.9 196.4 212.5 230.7 8.1% 2015 2016 2017 2018 2019 CAGR 2015-19 501.8 541.8 585.9 634.2 687.4 8.2% 260.4 289.0 320.8 356.1 395.2 11.0% 241.4 252.8 265.1 278.1 292.1 4.9% Euromonitor estimates from desk research and trade interviews with relevant industry associations and major beauty gadget manufacturers/distributors/retailers in Hong Kong – 54 – THIS APPLICATION PROOF IS IN DRAFT FORM. The information contained herein is incomplete and is subject to change. This Application Proof must be read in conjunction with the section headed “Warning” on the cover of this Application Proof. INDUSTRY OVERVIEW Beauty gadget retail distribution Electronics and appliance specialist retailers lead sales of beauty gadgets Store-based retailers dominate the distribution of beauty gadgets in terms of retail value sales, accounting for HK$463.3 million or 99.6% of the total distribution in 2014. Amongst these retailers, electronics and appliance specialist retailers represented the leading distribution channel for beauty gadgets, reaching a share of 65.3% of the total distribution of beauty gadgets in 2014. This share was mainly driven by chained players due largely to their comprehensive product portfolios and ability to offer competitive prices. The next largest channels within the distribution of beauty gadgets are health and beauty specialist retailers, accounting for about 14.1% of retail value sales. The two major pharmacy chains dominate the health and beauty specialist channel, offering a comprehensive range of personal care products and beauty gadgets in addition to supporting a huge retail network. Large beauty specialist chains contribute moderately to beauty gadget retail sales. Other store-based retailers account for 5.6% of the beauty gadget retail value sales. This channel includes sporting goods stores (i.e. retail outlets specialising in the sale of sports and outdoor equipment) that also sell beauty gadgets. The Group, which is classified as a sporting goods store, is included in this channel and drives its share. Table 5 Beauty Gadget Retail Distribution in Hong Kong, Based on Retail Value Sales, Historical (2014), HK$ Millions Store-based Retailing Grocery Retailers Electronics and Appliance Specialist Retailers Health and Beauty Specialist Retailers Department Stores Other Store-based Retailers (*) Non-store Retailing (**) (*) Include Sporting Goods Stores (**) Includes Internet retailing for the purpose of this study Sources: 463.3 47.1 304.0 65.7 20.3 26.3 2.0 Euromonitor estimates from desk research and trade interviews with relevant industry associations and major beauty gadget manufacturers/distributors/retailers in Hong Kong Industry outlook of beauty gadget retail market in Hong Kong An ageing population and rising health consciousness presents opportunity Beauty gadgets that provide anti-ageing benefits are already driving the market, and are expected to further gain ground over the forecast period in Hong Kong. In addition, rising personal care spending, increasing prevalence of skin diseases and awareness of the harmful effects of ultraviolet radiation are adjacent trends that will support the growth of the market. – 55 – THIS APPLICATION PROOF IS IN DRAFT FORM. The information contained herein is incomplete and is subject to change. This Application Proof must be read in conjunction with the section headed “Warning” on the cover of this Application Proof. INDUSTRY OVERVIEW Hong Kong’s healthy economic forecast likely to boost premium and niche brands Hong Kong’s GDP growth is expected to improve over the forecast period, driven by the expected stronger global demand for Hong Kong exports. Also, local consumer spending is likely to increase over the forecast period due to expected better economic conditions, which will continue to boost the performance of beauty gadgets. High retail rents in Hong Kong remain a major challenge despite a recent slowdown in growth According to real estate services firm Jones Lang LaSalle, Hong Kong retail rents were the world’s most expensive for two years until they were topped by New York’s Fifth Avenue in 2014. However, leases are expected to drop by approximately 5% in 2015. Major drivers of the slowdown in retail rent growth are mainland Chinese visitors who spent less due to a slowing domestic economy, official anti-corruption measures and a growing ‘anti-extravagance’ trend. Retailers are cautious and will continue to slow their expansion plans over the forecast period, as many had already reached a saturation point by the end of the review period. Beauty gadget wholesale market in Hong Kong Beauty gadget distribution overview and performance Distributors and agents play a pivotal role in the beauty gadget wholesale market Hong Kong has a sophisticated retail sector for the sale and distribution of beauty products. There are different channels for suppliers to access retail outlets, depending on the type of product and the target consumer sector. When it comes to beauty gadgets, larger-scale retail outlets traditionally rely on distributors and agents to help source and supply the products. Health and beauty specialist retailers (including pharmacies) typically demand high listing fees and a high retail margin when purchasing from wholesalers. A similar margin is demanded by electronics and appliance specialist retailers. Steady growth of the wholesale value sales of beauty gadgets Similarly to retail value sales, wholesale value sales of beauty gadgets in Hong Kong increased at a CAGR of about 10.2% to reach HK$255.9 million in 2014, from HK$173.5 million in 2010. Facial care gadgets flourished and distributors such as Competitor C (please refer to “Table 7 – Market Ranking of Top Five Distributors for Beauty Gadgets, Based on Total Equivalent Retail Value Sales, Historical (2014)” in this section for more details) were present in this segment at an early stage. Facial care gadgets increased at a CAGR of approximately 12.5% to reach HK$129.0 million in 2014, thanks to major innovations and launches by international manufacturers and a strong network of distributors/agents. – 56 – THIS APPLICATION PROOF IS IN DRAFT FORM. The information contained herein is incomplete and is subject to change. This Application Proof must be read in conjunction with the section headed “Warning” on the cover of this Application Proof. INDUSTRY OVERVIEW Beauty gadget wholesale value sales to continue experiencing healthy growth With no major changes expected in the sales and distribution model for beauty gadgets in upcoming years, the wholesale value sales of beauty gadgets are forecast to follow a similar growth rate as retail sales. Over the forecast period of 2015-2019, the wholesale value sales of beauty gadgets are expected to grow at a CAGR of about 8.2%. Facial care gadgets are projected to gain the most and become the single largest segment, accounting for approximately 57.5% of wholesale value sales of beauty gadgets by 2019. Table 6 Total Wholesale Value Sales of Beauty Gadgets in Hong Kong, Historical (2010-2014), Forecast (2015-2019), HK$ Millions Beauty Gadgets Facial Care Gadgets Hair Removal Gadgets Beauty Gadgets Facial Care Gadgets Hair Removal Gadgets Sources: 2010 2011 2012 2013 2014 CAGR 2010-14 173.5 181.7 206.0 229.3 255.9 10.2% 80.6 81.6 97.9 112.4 129.0 12.5% 92.9 100.1 108.0 116.9 126.9 8.1% 2015 2016 2017 2018 2019 CAGR 2015-19 276.0 298.0 322.2 348.8 378.1 8.2% 143.2 158.9 176.4 195.8 217.4 11.0% 132.8 139.1 145.8 153.0 160.7 4.9% Euromonitor estimates from desk research and trade interviews with relevant industry associations and major beauty gadget manufacturers/distributors/retailers in Hong Kong Industry outlook of beauty gadget wholesale market in Hong Kong Electronics and appliance retailers provide growth driver for the distribution of beauty gadgets The wide coverage of chained electronics and appliance specialist retailers allows consumers to have easy access to beauty gadgets. Increasingly comprehensive product and brand portfolios of beauty gadgets will further allow consumers to enjoy one-stop shopping convenience. Hong Kong’s chained electronics and appliance specialist retailers are expected to continue to enjoy higher bargaining power over suppliers, which will allow them to offer more competitive prices and promotions. – 57 – THIS APPLICATION PROOF IS IN DRAFT FORM. The information contained herein is incomplete and is subject to change. This Application Proof must be read in conjunction with the section headed “Warning” on the cover of this Application Proof. INDUSTRY OVERVIEW Changes in operations and rental costs are key challenges faced by distributors and retailers The major challenges faced by the Hong Kong beauty gadget distribution market are changes in operations and ever-rising rental costs. Although a slowdown of retail rental costs was witnessed in 2014, retailers are careful with their expansion plans and will instead focus on store. For distributors, it is also important to partner with international players or niche/premium brands of beauty gadgets. Market drivers, constraints and entry barriers A strong anti-ageing trend and product innovation support beauty gadget growth The ageing local population combined with high adoption of electronic devices and consumers’ rising sophistication driving their image-consciousness are the primary growth drivers for beauty gadgets in Hong Kong. Innovative products such as facial care gadgets with anti-ageing claims, such as facial toner gadgets, facial lifting gadgets or wrinkle treatment gadgets are expected to further encourage the market. The impact of tourism is another key driver of beauty gadget growth in Hong Kong In 2014, 60.8 million visitors came to Hong Kong, of whom 47.2 million were mainland Chinese. Majority of these tourists came to shop in Hong Kong, mainly for cosmetics and skin care items. Owing to high taxes in the PRC, consumers are enticed to shop in tax-free Hong Kong where they can enjoy up to 30% savings, which is a key driver for beauty gadget retail sales. Economic slowdown is the major risk factor for retailers of beauty gadgets in Hong Kong With an economy increasingly linked to the PRC yet a monetary policy still tied to the United States, Hong Kong is set to be squeezed by diverging dynamics in the two nations. Hong Kong’s economy was hurt in 2014 by the moderation in Chinese growth. An economic slowdown is perceived to be the main threat to the beauty gadget market. A highly competitive market where a strong sales model is paramount for new entrants Since 2012, increasingly fierce competition exists between large international consumer appliance manufacturers and players specialised in the beauty and personal care industry. Hence, the high fragmentation and competition in the Hong Kong beauty gadget market is a significant barrier for new entrants. A new entrant in this market would either need to already have an established presence in adjacent product categories or would have to partner with a leading distributor to gain awareness and presence in this market. – 58 – THIS APPLICATION PROOF IS IN DRAFT FORM. The information contained herein is incomplete and is subject to change. This Application Proof must be read in conjunction with the section headed “Warning” on the cover of this Application Proof. INDUSTRY OVERVIEW Competitive landscape A distributor market defined by intense competition between international players With numerous product launches since 2012 and the entry of large international players, the Hong Kong beauty gadget wholesale market is highly competitive, as is the retail market. In terms of total equivalent retail value sales, the top five distributors’ market shares range from 4.1% to 26.8%, while other players share a fragmented 19.0%. Some leading international appliance manufacturers rely primarily on large distributors. Opportunities to grow for the Group as a distributor of beauty gadgets With constant innovations and most leading international players looking to enter the Hong Kong market, there is potential for distributors of beauty gadgets to gain shares. For the Group, the challenge is to compete in a market where major players have the advantage of their brand name. With its specialised facial care gadget portfolio, the Group has the opportunity to capture share by riding the ageing population trend. Moreover, the range offered in the hair removal segment is a plus for the Group. In this segment, consumers look first and foremost for convenient and time-efficient solutions. With gadgets providing permanent hair removal (e.g. Silk’n SensEpil Home Pulse Light Hair Removal System), the Group could compete against large appliance brands that may face new challenges because of their ‘generalist’ image. Table 7 Market Ranking of Top Five Distributors for Beauty Gadgets, Based on Total Equivalent Retail Value Sales, Historical (2014) Ranking Company Name Share 1 2 3 4 5 Others Competitor Competitor Competitor Competitor the Group 26.8% 26.3% 12.1% 11.7% 4.1% 19.0% B C D E Total Sources: 100.0% Euromonitor estimates after desk research and trade interviews with a sample of distributors and retailers of beauty gadgets. The market share data reported above has been determined via a fieldwork programme consisting of desk research and trade interviews. While audited data was available for some of the companies, they typically did not break the revenue or sales numbers into the relevant categories covered in this study. For these companies as well as those included in the market shares but not publicly listed, Euromonitor has projected the market shares based on estimates provided by various trade sources (i.e. not just the companies themselves) and sought a consensus on these estimates as much as possible. – 59 – THIS APPLICATION PROOF IS IN DRAFT FORM. The information contained herein is incomplete and is subject to change. This Application Proof must be read in conjunction with the section headed “Warning” on the cover of this Application Proof. INDUSTRY OVERVIEW BEAUTY GADGET ONLINE RETAILING IN THE PRC Beauty gadget online retailing overview and performance Steady growth and potential encouraged by trends such as appearance and rising income Beauty gadgets as emerging products in the PRC have only recently begun developing rapidly. Due to gradually increasing income and the popularity of self-beautification, the PRC’s beauty gadget market is starting to develop gradually. In 2014, total retail sales value of the online beauty gadget market has achieved HK$333.8 million, an increase of 67.0% from 2013, with a CAGR of 51.9% from 2010 to 2014. Demand for beauty gadgets in online platforms has continued increasing due to consumers’ search for effective ways to keep the body and skin young and energetic, and it also benefits from the booming online retailing. According to China Electronic Commerce Research Centre, at the end of 2014 the total transaction value of China’s online retailing market achieved HK$3,526.4 billion, an increase of 49.7% over 2013. Due to the significant growth of the online retail market, it has become an important channel for manufacturers and a very effective way to distribute products, especially new and emerging items. Online platforms represent popular channel for distribution of beauty gadgets The PRC’s rapid development of telecommunications infrastructure with widely available internet access, the locally booming internet economy, and improving online payment technology and security are significant drivers to the expanding growth of online retailing. Even before beauty gadgets grew popular in the PRC, many consumers had purchased products sold via online platforms where many overseas sellers and individuals are selling their products in online stores. Hence consumers have demonstrated familiarity and comfort with the online channel. Industry outlook of beauty gadget online retail market in the PRC The PRC’s online retailing of beauty gadgets will continue to grow and is expected to reach HK$512.7 million in 2015, reflecting 53.6% growth over 2014. Due to increasing demand for beauty gadgets, this market will reach approximately HK$1,678.2 million in 2019, experiencing a CAGR of 34.5% from 2015 to 2019. The continuously increasing demand from the PRC’s consumers is the important factor stimulating the country’s beauty gadget market growth. The PRC’s consumers consist of not only females but also a growing male group who are increasingly concerned with appearance and the desire to stay energetic and healthy. – 60 – THIS APPLICATION PROOF IS IN DRAFT FORM. The information contained herein is incomplete and is subject to change. This Application Proof must be read in conjunction with the section headed “Warning” on the cover of this Application Proof. INDUSTRY OVERVIEW Table 8 Total Retail Value Sales of Beauty Gadget Online Retailing in the PRC, Historical (2010-2014), Forecast (2015-2019), HK$ Millions Beauty Gadgets Beauty Gadgets Sources: 2010 2011 2012 2013 2014 CAGR 2010-14 62.7 86.5 123.7 199.9 333.8 51.9% 2015 2016 2017 2018 2019 CAGR 2015-19 512.7 728.6 996.3 1,315.2 1,678.2 34.5% Euromonitor estimates from desk research and trade interviews with relevant industry associations and major beauty equipment manufacturers/distributors/retailers in the PRC Market drivers, constraints and entry barriers Growing disposable income and demand for convenient and effective products The per capita disposable income of PRC consumers have seen stellar growth, reaching HK$35,717.1 in 2014, up by 10.3% compared to 2013. As a result, consumers are more willing to spend on products and services that could enhance a healthier lifestyle — including portable beauty gadgets — yet are convenient and effective to use. Online payments and mobile payments to increase the flexibility of purchasing According to Ministry of Industry and Information Technology, the number of mobile subscribers increased to about 1.29 billion in 2014. The number of 4G subscribers increased to approximately 97.3 million and 3G grew to approximately 485.3 million. The penetration rate of 4G and 3G subscribers increased by 7.6% and 37.7%, respectively in 2014. In addition, the development of mobile e-commerce has stimulated growth in demand for mobile payments. According to China Internet Network Information Centre, the population of online shoppers reached 361 million in 2014, an increase of 19.7% over 2013. Logistical services developing quickly to stimulate online retailing in the PRC Benefitting from the explosive growth of internet retailing, China’s express delivery industry has witnessed rapid growth. According to China Electronic Commerce Research Centre’s figures in 2014, the total number of mails and parcels delivered by express methods reached 14.0 billion, an increase of 52% over 2013, while the total revenue of express delivery increased by 42% to total approximately HK$255.0 billion. The fast-developing logistics industry provides the essential condition to deliver products all over the country and the consumers have the opportunity to purchase products overseas. – 61 – THIS APPLICATION PROOF IS IN DRAFT FORM. The information contained herein is incomplete and is subject to change. This Application Proof must be read in conjunction with the section headed “Warning” on the cover of this Application Proof. INDUSTRY OVERVIEW The competition between multinational corporations and local players Due to increasing demand for beauty gadgets in the PRC, many international brands have entered this market. In both online and store-based PRC markets, internationally branded products generally from the US and Japan are still positioned as high-end. The PRC’s local brands mainly offer economical product pricing and focus on the mass product market as their target positioning. The competition between international brands and local brands is intensifying and multinational corporations are also attracted by this market. Local brands with similar product designs and competitive selling prices The PRC’s consumers are familiar with international brands’ beauty gadgets and are interested in their designs and functions. In the online retailing market, it is very common to find many local beauty gadget brands with similar product designs. As PRC’s beauty gadget market is still new, there are limited detailed regulations or standards to guide product design in this market. Some local brands’ products have quality issues that could hurt popular products’ brand image due to similar product designs. Limited barriers exist for online beauty gadgets but in the future the market will be regulated The PRC’s online beauty gadget market focuses on beauty care treatments including facial care, body care, hand and foot care and are portable and targeted for personal rather than professional usage. Currently, the beauty gadget online retailing market is experiencing rapid growth during its initial phase of development. As the competition intensifies, cooperating with foreign or famous brands becomes an important factor for market entry, either online or in stores. – 62 – THIS APPLICATION PROOF IS IN DRAFT FORM. The information contained herein is incomplete and is subject to change. This Application Proof must be read in conjunction with the section headed “Warning” on the cover of this Application Proof. REGULATORY OVERVIEW OVERVIEW This section summarises certain material aspects of Hong Kong and PRC laws and regulations, which are relevant to the Group’s business operations. HONG KONG Competition Ordinance The Competition Ordinance (Chapter 619 of the Laws of Hong Kong) (the “Competition Ordinance”) which came into force on 14 December 2015 has an impact on all businesses in Hong Kong. According to the Competition Ordinance, serious anti-competitive conducts such as price fixing, market allocation and bid rigging/collusion will contravene the Competition Ordinance. The following arrangements might be considered unlawful under the Competition Ordinance: • unprofitable pricing to gain market share and put pressure on competitor ’s ability to compete; • tying (one product can only be bought or used if another product is also bought); • bundling (two or more products offered together at a discount); • exclusive dealing arrangements or imposition of tougher pricing and terms for certain customers; • sharing of pricing, information and agreement of practices/pricing through trade associations; and • joint ventures/tenders by competitors capable of bidding independently. According to an enforcement policy issued by the competition commission which is established under the Competition Ordinance (the “Competition Commission”), the Competition Commission intends to direct its resources to the investigation of unfair competition and enforcement of matters that provide the greatest overall benefit to consumers in Hong Kong and to facilitate fair and healthy competition in the market. Therefore it is anticipated that companies operating in Hong Kong including the Group are likely to be under scrutiny for their operation in Hong Kong. Hence, ensuring anti-competitive conduct does not occur will become a continuous requirement for proper governance of the business of the Group, in particular in the course of working with distributors and suppliers. – 63 – THIS APPLICATION PROOF IS IN DRAFT FORM. The information contained herein is incomplete and is subject to change. This Application Proof must be read in conjunction with the section headed “Warning” on the cover of this Application Proof. REGULATORY OVERVIEW Consumer Goods Safety Ordinance The Consumer Goods Safety Ordinance (Chapter 456 of the Laws of Hong Kong) (the “Consumer Goods Safety Ordinance”) imposes a duty on manufacturers, importers and suppliers of certain consumer goods to ensure that the consumer goods they supply are safe and for incidental purposes. The Group’s products are regulated by the Consumer Goods Safety Ordinance and the Consumer Goods Safety Regulation (Chapter 456A of Laws of Hong Kong) (the “Consumer Goods Safety Regulation”). Section 4(1) of the Consumer Goods Safety Ordinance requires consumer goods to be reasonably safe having regard to all of the circumstances including the manner in which, and the purpose for which the products are presented, promoted or marketed, the use of any mark in relation to the products, instructions and warnings given for the keeping or use of the products, reasonable safety standards published by a standards institute or other similar bodies and the existence of any reasonable means to make the products safer. According to section 2(1) of the Consumer Goods Safety Regulation, where consumer goods on their packages are marked with, or where any labels affixed to or any documents enclosed in their packages contain, any warning or caution regarding the safe keeping, use, consumption or disposal, such warning or caution shall be in both the English and the Chinese languages. Such warnings and cautions, as required by section 2(2) of Consumer Goods Safety Regulation, shall be legible and be placed in a conspicuous position on (a) the consumer goods; (b) any package of the consumer goods; (c) a label security affixed to the package; or (d) a document enclosed in the package. – 64 – THIS APPLICATION PROOF IS IN DRAFT FORM. The information contained herein is incomplete and is subject to change. This Application Proof must be read in conjunction with the section headed “Warning” on the cover of this Application Proof. REGULATORY OVERVIEW Copyright Ordinance The Copyright Ordinance (Chapter 528 of the Laws of Hong Kong) (the “Copyright Ordinance”) currently in force in Hong Kong has come into effect since 27 June 1997. The Copyright Ordinance as reviewed and revised from time to time provides comprehensive protection for recognised categories of literary, dramatic, musical and artistic works, as well as for films, television broadcasts and cable diffusion, and works made available to the public on the internet. Electrical Products (Safety) Regulation It is a requirement under the Electrical Products (Safety) Regulation that electrical products which are designed for household use and supplied in Hong Kong shall comply with certain safety requirements and obtain recognised certificates of safety compliance. Employment Ordinance The Employment Ordinance (Chapter 57 of the Laws of Hong Kong) (the “Employment Ordinance”) provides for the protection of the wages of employees, regulates general conditions of employment and employment agencies, and for matters connected therewith. Under the Employment Ordinance, employees who are employed under a continuous contract are entitled to additional benefits including rest days, paid annual leave, sickness allowance, severance payment and long service payment. Where an employer willfully and without reasonable excuse fails to pay wages to an employee when it becomes due, or fails to pay interest on the outstanding amount of wages to the employee, the employer is liable on conviction to a fine and imprisonment. Where an employer who is no longer able to pay wages due, he should terminate the contract of employment in accordance with its terms. – 65 – THIS APPLICATION PROOF IS IN DRAFT FORM. The information contained herein is incomplete and is subject to change. This Application Proof must be read in conjunction with the section headed “Warning” on the cover of this Application Proof. REGULATORY OVERVIEW Employees’ Compensation Ordinance The Employees’ Compensation Ordinance (Chapter 282 of the Laws of Hong Kong) (the “Employees’ Compensation Ordinance”) regulates the payment of compensation to employees who are injured in the course of their employment. Under the Employees’ Compensation Ordinance, an employer must be in possession of a valid insurance policy to cover his liabilities both under the said ordinance and at common law for the work injuries of his employees, irrespective of the length of employment contract or working hours, full-time or part-time employment. An employer who fails to secure an insurance cover commits an offence and is liable on conviction to a fine and imprisonment. Mandatory Provident Fund Schemes Ordinance The Group provides retirement benefits for the employees under the Mandatory Provident Fund Scheme (the “MPF Scheme”) under the Mandatory Provident Fund Schemes Ordinance. Under the Mandatory Provident Fund Schemes Ordinance, except for exempt persons, employees (full-time and part-time) and self-employed persons who are at least 18 but under 65 years of age are required to join an MPF Scheme. Under the MPF Scheme, both the employer and each of its employees are each required to make contributions to the plan at 5% of the employee’s relevant income, subject to a monthly relevant income cap of HK$30,000 for employers and a minimum and maximum monthly relevant income cap of HK$7,100 and HK$30,000 respectively for employees. Where the employee’s income exceeds HK$30,000, both the employer and employee shall contribute a monthly sum of HK$1,500 to the plan. This contribution amount will immediately be vested in the employee as his/her accrued benefits in the MPF Scheme. Employers found to have evaded payment of MPF contributions, deducted employer contributions from an employee’s pay, or failed to enroll their employees to an MPF Scheme, may be liable to a financial penalty and potential criminal prosecution. Occupational Safety and Health Ordinance The Occupational Safety and Health Ordinance (Chapter 509 of the Laws of Hong Kong) (the “Occupational Safety and Health Ordinance”) aims to ensure the safety and health of employees when they are at work. Under the Occupational Safety and Health Ordinance, an employer must ensure the safety and health of his workplace by (i) providing and maintaining plant and work systems that are safe and without risks to health; (ii) making arrangement for ensuring safety and health in connection with the use, handling, storage or transport of plant or substances; (iii) providing all necessary information, instruction, training and supervision for ensuring safety and health; (iv) providing and maintaining safe access to and egress from the workplace; and (v) providing and maintaining a safe and healthy work environment. An employer who fails to comply with the above may be liable on conviction to a fine and imprisonment, if he did so intentionally, knowingly or recklessly. – 66 – THIS APPLICATION PROOF IS IN DRAFT FORM. The information contained herein is incomplete and is subject to change. This Application Proof must be read in conjunction with the section headed “Warning” on the cover of this Application Proof. REGULATORY OVERVIEW Occupational Safety and Health Regulation The Occupational Safety and Health Regulation (Chapter 509A of the Laws of Hong Kong) further sets out basic requirements for accident prevention, fire precaution, workplace environment control, hygiene at workplaces, first aid, as well as what employers and employees are expected to do in manual handling operations. Personal Data (Privacy) Ordinance The Personal Data (Privacy) Ordinance (Chapter 486 of the Laws of Hong Kong) regulates the collection, retention, use and security of any data relating directly or indirectly to a living individual, from which it is practicable for the identity of the individual to be ascertained and is in a form in which access to or processing of the data is practicable. Tortious Duty Under Common Law Apart from contractual liability, under common law, manufacturers, distributors and retailers of products also owe a duty of care to consumers and may be liable for damage resulting from defects in goods caused by their negligent acts or for any fraudulent misrepresentation made in the distributing and selling of goods. Where a manufacturer, distributor and retailer knows or reasonably believes that the products may be defective, he may have to cease to supply such goods and to give warning and instructions to persons to whom the products are supplied. Any person who undertakes to design, import or supply a product, and who negligently performs his work and causes damage to another person or property, will also attract civil liability. Trade Description Ordinance The Trade Descriptions Ordinance prohibits false trade descriptions, false, misleading or incomplete information, false statements, etc., in respect of goods offered in the course of trade. Therefore, all of the products sold by the Group are required to comply with the relevant provisions therein. Section 2 of the Trade Descriptions Ordinance provides, inter alia, that “trade description” in relation to goods means an indication, direct or indirect, and by whatever means given, of certain matters (including quantity, method of manufacture, composition, fitness for purpose, availability, compliance with a standard specified or recognised by any person, price, their being of the same kind as goods supplied to a person, price, place or date of manufacture, production, processing or reconditioning, person by whom manufactured, produced, processed or reconditioned etc), with respect to any goods or parts of the goods; and in relation to services means an indication, direct or indirect, and by whatever means given, of certain matters (including nature, scope, quantity, fitness for purpose, method and procedures, availability, the person by whom the service is supplied, after-sale service assistance, price etc.). – 67 – THIS APPLICATION PROOF IS IN DRAFT FORM. The information contained herein is incomplete and is subject to change. This Application Proof must be read in conjunction with the section headed “Warning” on the cover of this Application Proof. REGULATORY OVERVIEW Section 7 of the Trade Descriptions Ordinance provides that no person shall in the course of trade or business apply a false trade description to any goods or sell or offer for sale any goods with false trade descriptions applied thereto. Section 7A of the Trade Descriptions Ordinance provides that a trader who applies a false trade description to a service supplied or offered to be supplied to a consumer, or supplies or offers to supply to a consumer a service to which a false trade description is applied, commits an offence. Sections 13E, 13F, 13G, 13H and 13I of the Trade Descriptions Ordinance provide that a trader who engages in relation to a consumer in a commercial practice that (a) is a misleading omission; or (b) is aggressive; (c) constitutes bait advertising; (d) constitutes a bait and switch; or (e) constitutes wrongly accepting payment for a product, commits an offence. A person who commits an offence under sections 7, 7A, 13E, 13F, 13G, 13H or 13I shall be subject, on conviction on indictment, to a fine of HK$500,000 and to imprisonment for 5 years, and on summary conviction, to a fine at HK$100,000 and to imprisonment for 2 years. Trade Marks Ordinance The Trade Marks Ordinance (Chapter 559 of the Laws of Hong Kong) (the “Trade Marks Ordinance”) provides for the registration of trademarks, the use of registered trademarks and connected matters. Hong Kong provides territorial protection for trademarks. Therefore, trademarks registered in other countries or regions are not automatically entitled to protection in Hong Kong. In order to enjoy protection by the laws of Hong Kong, trademarks must be registered with the Trade Marks Registry of the Intellectual Property Department under the Trade Marks Ordinance and the Trade Marks Rules (Chapter 599A of the Laws of Hong Kong) (the “Trade Marks Rules”). According to section 10 of the Trade Marks Ordinance, a registered trademark is a property right acquired through due registration under such ordinance. The owner of a registered trademark is entitled to the rights provided by the ordinance. The Group is the registered owner and proprietor of the trademarks as set out in the paragraph headed “Appendix IV — B. Further information about the business — 2. Intellectual property rights of the Group in this document. By virtue of section 14 of the Trade Marks Ordinance, the owner of a registered trademark is conferred exclusive rights in the trademark. The rights of the owner in respect of the registered trademark come into existence from the date of the registration of the trademark. According to section 48 of such ordinance, the registration date is the filing date of the application for registration. Subject to the exceptions in section 19 to section 21 of the Trade Marks Ordinance, any use of the trademark by third parties without the consent of the owner is an infringement of the trademark. Conducts which amount to infringement of the registered trademark are further specified in section 18 of the same ordinance. – 68 – THIS APPLICATION PROOF IS IN DRAFT FORM. The information contained herein is incomplete and is subject to change. This Application Proof must be read in conjunction with the section headed “Warning” on the cover of this Application Proof. REGULATORY OVERVIEW The owner of the registered trademark is entitled to remedies under the Trade Marks Ordinance once any infringement by third parties occurs, such as infringement proceedings provided for in section 23 and section 25 of the Trade Marks Ordinance. Trademarks which are not registered under the Trade Marks Ordinance and the Trade Marks Rules may still obtain protection by the common law action of passing off, which requires proof of the owner ’s reputation in the unregistered trademark and that use of the trademark by third parties will cause the owner damage. Sale of Goods Ordinance The Sale of Goods Ordinance (Chapter 26 of the Laws of Hong Kong) (the “Sale of Goods Ordinance”) provides, inter alia, that where a seller sells goods in the course of a business, there is an implied condition that (a) where the goods are purchased by description, the goods must correspond with the description; (b) the goods supplied are of merchantable quality; and (c) the goods must be fit for the purpose for which they are purchased. Otherwise, a buyer has the right to reject defective goods unless he or she has a reasonable opportunity to examine the goods. PRC The Law of the PRC on Protection of Consumer Rights and Interests (中華人民共和國消 費者權益保護法) Pursuant to the Law of the PRC on Protection of Consumer Rights and Interests (中 華人民共和國消費者權益保護法) implemented on 1 January 1994 and amended on 25 October 2013 by the Standing Committee of the National People’s Congress (全國人民代表 大會), both manufacturers and distributors will be held jointly liable for losses and damage suffered by consumers caused by the defective products they manufacture and distribute. The Law of the PRC on Protection of Consumer Rights and Interests sets out standards of behaviour which business operators must observe in their dealings with consumers, including the following: (1) Goods and services provided by the business operators to consumers must comply with the Law of the PRC on products quality and requirements regarding personal safety and protection of property; (2) Business operators shall provide consumers with authentic information and give truthful and definite replies to inquiries from consumers concerning their commodities or services, and may not make any false and misleading propaganda. Business operators shall mark in their stores clearly the prices of the commodities they supply; (3) Business operators shall make out for consumers invoices for purchases or documents of services in accordance with relevant regulations or commercial practices; (4) Business operators shall carry out the obligations of repair or caveat venditor in accordance with relevant regulations or agreements with consumers; – 69 – THIS APPLICATION PROOF IS IN DRAFT FORM. The information contained herein is incomplete and is subject to change. This Application Proof must be read in conjunction with the section headed “Warning” on the cover of this Application Proof. REGULATORY OVERVIEW (5) Business operators shall indicate their real names and marks; (6) Business operators may not, through format contracts, notices, announcements, entrance hall bulletins and so on, impose unfair or unreasonable rules on consumers or reduce or escape their civil liability for their infringement of the legitimate rights and interests of consumers. Format contracts, notices, announcements, entrance hall bulletins and so on with such contents shall be invalid. Violations of the above may result in the imposition of fines. In addition, the business operator will be ordered to suspend its operations and its business license will be revoked. Criminal liability may be incurred in serious cases; and (7) Consumers whose legitimate rights and interests are infringed upon may demand compensation from the sellers or service providers concerned. In case the liability is on the manufacturers or other sellers who supply the commodities to the said sellers, the said sellers shall, after paying the compensations, have the right to recover the compensations from the manufacturers or the other sellers. Consumers or other victims suffering personal injuries or property damage resulting from defects of commodities may demand compensations either from the sellers or from the manufacturers. If the liability is on the manufacturers, the sellers shall, after paying the compensations, have the right to recover the compensations from the manufacturers; if the liability is on the sellers, the manufacturers shall, after paying the compensations, have the right to recover the compensations from the sellers. Product Quality Law of the PRC (中華人民共和國產品質量法) According to Product Quality Law of the PRC (中華人民共和國產品質量法) promulgated by the Standing Committee of the National People’s Congress on 22 February 1993 and amended on 27 August 2009, consumers who sustain losses or damages from defective products are entitled to be indemnified by either manufacturers or distributors. Nevertheless, if manufacturers are responsible for the defective products and the losses or damage caused thereby, the distributors which have indemnified consumers for their losses may seek claims on the indemnities against the manufacturers. Pursuant to the Product Quality Law of the PRC, a seller shall have the following obligations: (1) Sellers shall adopt measures to maintain the quality of products for sale and may not sell any product the sale of which has been prohibited or those that have lost effect or have deteriorated; (2) Sellers are not allowed to fake the marks on the products or the packaging of the products including without limitation the place of origin, quality marks such as certification marks and fine quality marks or fake or use the names and addresses of other producers; and – 70 – THIS APPLICATION PROOF IS IN DRAFT FORM. The information contained herein is incomplete and is subject to change. This Application Proof must be read in conjunction with the section headed “Warning” on the cover of this Application Proof. REGULATORY OVERVIEW (3) Sellers are not allowed to adulterate the products for sale or pose fake ones as genuine or shoddy ones as good or sub-standard ones as standard. Labor Laws Effective as at 1 January 2008 and amended on 28 December 2012, labor contracts shall be concluded in writing if labor relationships are to be or have been established between enterprises or institutions and the laborers under the Labor Contract Law of the PRC (中華人民共和國勞動合同法). Enterprises and institutions are forbidden to force the laborers to work beyond the time limit and employers shall pay laborers for overtime work in accordance with national regulations. In addition, the labor wages shall not be lower than local standards on minimum wages and shall be paid to the laborers timely. According to the Labor Law of the PRC (中華人民共和國勞動法) promulgated on 5 July 1994 and amended on 27 August 2009, enterprises and institutions shall establish and perfect their system of work place safety and sanitation, strictly abide by State rules and standards on work place safety, educate laborers in labor safety and sanitation in the PRC. Labor safety and sanitation facilities shall comply with State-fixed standards. The enterprises and institutions shall provide laborers with work place safety and sanitation conditions which are in compliance with State stipulations and relevant articles of labor protection. Social Insurance Regulations Pursuant to the Social Insurance Law of the PRC (中華人民共和國社會保險法) promulgated on 28 October 2010 and implemented on 1 July 2011 by the Standing Committee of the National People’s Congress, the Interim Measures Concerning the Maternity Insurance of Enterprise Employees (企業職工生育保險試行辦法) promulgated on 14 December 1994 and implemented on 1 January 1995 by former Ministry of Labor, the Regulation Concerning the Administration of Housing Fund (住房公積金管理條例) promulgated and implemented on 3 April 1999 and amended on 24 March 2002 by the State Council of the PRC (the “State Council”), the Regulation on Occupational Injury Insurance (工傷保險條例) promulgated on 27 April 2003 and amended on 20 December 2010 by the State Council, the employer shall pay the pension insurance fund, basic medical insurance fund, unemployment insurance fund, occupational injury insurance fund, maternity insurance fund and housing fund for the employees. – 71 – THIS APPLICATION PROOF IS IN DRAFT FORM. The information contained herein is incomplete and is subject to change. This Application Proof must be read in conjunction with the section headed “Warning” on the cover of this Application Proof. REGULATORY OVERVIEW Income Tax Law According to the Enterprise Income Tax Law of the PRC (中華人民共和國企業所得稅 法) enacted on 16 March 2007 and the Implementation Regulations of Enterprise Income Tax Law of the PRC (中華人民共和國企業所得稅法實施條例) enacted on 6 December 2007 (collectively the “Income Tax Law”), which both took effect on 1 January 2008, the enterprise income tax for both domestic and foreign-invested enterprises are unified at 25%. According to the Income Tax Law, income such as dividends, rental, interest and royalty from the PRC derived by a non-resident enterprise which has no establishment in the PRC or has establishment but the income has no relationship with such establishment is subject to a 10% withholding tax, which may be reduced if the foreign jurisdiction of incorporation has a tax treaty with the PRC that provides for a different withholding arrangement, unless the relevant income is specifically exempted from tax under the applicable income tax laws, regulations, notices and decisions which relate to foreign invested enterprises and their investors. According to the Arrangement between the Mainland and Hong Kong Special Administrative Region for the Avoidance of Double Taxation and the Prevention of Fiscal Evasion with respect to Taxes on Income effective on 1 January 2007 (內地和香港特別行政 區關於對所得避免雙重徵稅和防止偷漏稅的安排), the withholding tax rate for dividends paid by a PRC resident enterprise to a Hong Kong resident enterprise is 5%, if the Hong Kong enterprise owns at least 25% of the PRC enterprise. According to the Notice of the State Administration of Taxation on Issues Relating to the Administration of the Dividend Provision in Tax Treaties promulgated on 20 February 2009 (國家稅務總局關於執行稅收協 定股息條款有關問題的通知), the corporate recipients of dividends distributed by PRC enterprises must satisfy the direct ownership thresholds at all times during the 12 consecutive months preceding the receipt of the dividends. Regulations Relating to Foreign Currency Exchange Under the Foreign Currency Administration Rules (中華人民共和國外匯管理條例) promulgated by the State Council on 29 January 1996 and amended on 14 January 1997 and 1 August 2008 and various regulations issued by State Administration of Foreign Exchange, and other relevant PRC government authorities, Renminbi is convertible into other currencies for the purpose of current account items, such as trade related receipts and payments, interest and dividend. The conversion of Renminbi into other currencies and remittance of the converted foreign currency outside China for the purpose of capital account items, such as direct equity investments, loans and repatriation of investment, requires prior approval from the State Administration of Foreign Exchange or its local office. Domestic entities are permitted to free retain their current exchange earnings according to their needs of operation. – 72 – THIS APPLICATION PROOF IS IN DRAFT FORM. The information contained herein is incomplete and is subject to change. This Application Proof must be read in conjunction with the section headed “Warning” on the cover of this Application Proof. REGULATORY OVERVIEW Regulation on Foreign Investors Investing in Commercial Sectors In order to fulfill the undertaking in respect of the opening up of commercial sector for PRC’s entry to World Trade Organisation, the Ministry of Commerce issued the Measures for Administration on Foreign Investment in Commercial Fields (the “Measures of Administration”) (外商投資商業領域管理辦法) on 16 April 2004 which took effect on 1 June 2004. The Measures of Administration abolished the original higher standard of requirements for foreign investors, allowed Sino-foreign equity joint venture, Sino-foreign cooperation and wholly foreign-funded commercial enterprises (collectively the “Foreign-invested Commercial Enterprises”) to engage in commission agency, wholesale, retail and franchise businesses. The incorporation of Foreign-invested Commercial Enterprises is subject to review and approval of the Ministry of Commence of the PRC (“MOC“) and its authorised provincial ministry of commerce and should nevertheless meet the following conditions: (1) registered capital in compliance with the requirement of Company Law of the PRC; (2) compliance with the standard total investment and registered capital requirements for foreign-invested enterprises; and (3) in general, Foreign-invested Commercial Enterprises’ term of operation not exceeding 30 years and Foreign-invested Commercial Enterprises’ term of operation in the middle and western regions of the PRC not exceeding 40 years. According to the Notice of Ministry of Commerce on Delegation of Approval Power for Foreign-Funded Commercial Enterprises (商務部關於下放外商投資商業企業審批事項的 通知) issued by the MOC on 12 September 2008 and taking effect on the same day, all the establishments of foreign-funded commercial enterprises and all the alterations of established foreign-funded commercial enterprises shall be subject to review and approval by competent provincial Ministries of Commerce (省級商務主管部門), and report to the MOC; however, the MOC retains the approval power upon the enterprises which are doing business not by opening stores but via television, telephone, mail, internet, vending machine and the enterprises which are engaged in the wholesale of audio-visual products or the sales of books, newspapers and magazines. – 73 – THIS APPLICATION PROOF IS IN DRAFT FORM. The information contained herein is incomplete and is subject to change. This Application Proof must be read in conjunction with the section headed “Warning” on the cover of this Application Proof. REGULATORY OVERVIEW According to The Measures for the Administration of Sales Promotion Activities of Retailers (零售商促銷行為管理辦法) (the “Measures for Promotion”) issued by the MOC on 13 July 2006 and taking effect on 15 October 2006, a retailer, when undertaking sales promotion activities, should follow the principles of lawfulness, fairness and good faith and may not impair the lawful rights and interests of consumers and other business operators. Furthermore, when undertaking sales promotion activities, a retailer should show the promotion contents at an eye-catching place in its business site and clearly mark the prices on the price tags; a retailer may not cheat or induce the consumers to buy commodities by taking a misleading price method or reduce the quality of the promotion commodities. No retailer may undertake any sales promotion activity by making up a reason such as rummage sale or shifting to another business. Where any retailer ’s act is in violation of the Measures for Promotion and such act is also in violation of any other laws or regulations, such other laws or regulations shall govern. Otherwise, the Measures for Promotion apply and the retailer may be ordered to make corrections and imposed a fine of not exceeding RMB30,000. Regulations on Importation of Goods According to Customs Law of the PRC (中華人民共和國海關法) promulgated by the standing committee of National People’s Congress as revised on 28 December 2013, the consignee of import goods or the consignor of export goods shall make an accurate declaration to the Customs office for examination. The consignee of import goods shall be the obligatory customs duty payer. The acts of evasion of Customs control or Customs duties stipulated by relevant laws and regulations may constitute an act of smuggling and incur criminal charges, and the Customs shall confiscate any smuggled goods and illegal income and impose a fine. According to Law of the PRC on Imported and Exported Commodities Inspection (中華人民共和國進出口商品檢驗法) promulgated by Standing Committee of the National People’s Congress as revised on 29 June 2013, the inspection of the import commodities which are listed in the Catalogue of Import and Export Commodities Subject to Compulsory Inspection shall be conducted by the commodity inspection authorities, otherwise such import commodities may not be sold or used. The consignee or agent shall apply for inspection to the inspection authorities. Violation of the above rules may result in the unlawful gains derived therefrom being confiscated by the commodity inspection authorities and imposition of a fine and criminal responsibility in serious cases. – 74 – THIS APPLICATION PROOF IS IN DRAFT FORM. The information contained herein is incomplete and is subject to change. This Application Proof must be read in conjunction with the section headed “Warning” on the cover of this Application Proof. REGULATORY OVERVIEW Regulations on Cross-border E-commerce Retail Imports The Group deliver its products sold from its Tmall storefronts to its individual customers in the PRC by post. According to Customs Law of the PRC, the transit of mail bags into the PRC shall be subject to customs control. According to Announcement of the General Administration of Customs (2010) No. 43 — Relevant Issues Concerning Amending the Administrative Measures for the Entry and Exit of Personal Postal Items (海 關總署公告2010年第43號-關於調整進出境個人郵遞物品管理措施有關事宜) promulgated by General Administration of Customs and came into effect on 1 September 2010, personal postal items from Hong Kong no more than RMB800 each time are exempted from import tax. Where personal postal items from Hong Kong exceed RMB800 each time, the consignee shall go through a customs clearance procedure in line with relevant regulations concerning import goods, except that there is only one single item in the parcel and the customs confirms that the item is for personal use. According to Measures of the Customs of the PRC for the Supervision and Administration of Inward and Outward Express Consignments (中華人民共和國海關對進 出境快件監管辦法), inward and outward express consignments refers to inward and outward goods and articles undertaken or carried by the operator of inward and outward express consignments by means of the rapid commercial operations they promise to their customers. The inward and outward express consignments are divided into three categories, namely, the documents, the individual articles and the goods. The individual articles refer to those inward or outward luggage articles for self-use, of reasonable quantities and transported separately from the passenger as prescribed by customs regulations, those articles as gift presented between relatives or friends and other individual articles. The consignments falling into the goods category refer to the express consignments other than documents and individual articles. As for the consignments falling into the goods category other than samples of goods and advertisement articles, the operator shall make declaration in accordance with the regulations of the customs on the clearance of the imported goods. According to Implementing Regulations of the Customs of the PRC on Administrative Penalties (中華人民共和國海關行政處罰實施條例), where an individual transports, carries or posts articles to enter or exit the territory but makes false declaration, a warning shall be given and a fine of 20% the value of goods may be imposed upon, and the illegal gains may be confiscated. – 75 – THIS APPLICATION PROOF IS IN DRAFT FORM. The information contained herein is incomplete and is subject to change. This Application Proof must be read in conjunction with the section headed “Warning” on the cover of this Application Proof. REGULATORY OVERVIEW According to Announcement of the Ministry of Finance, the General Administration of Customs and State Tax Bureau on Tax Policies for Cross-border E-commerce Retail Imports (財政部、海關總署、國家稅務總局關於跨境電子商務零售進口稅收政策的通知) promulgated on 24 March 2016 and came into effect on 8 April 2016, customs duty and value-added tax and consumption tax for importation will be levied on commodities imported through cross-border e-commerce retail as goods, and the individual purchasing such commodities as the tax payer shall pay such duty and taxes on the basis of the actual trading price (including the retail price, freight and insurance premiums), and the e-commerce operator, e-commerce trading platform operator or logistics service provider may act as the withholding agent to withhold and pay such duty and taxes on behalf of the tax payer. The policy shall be applicable to the following commodities imported from foreign countries or regions which are included in the List of Commodities Imported Through Cross-border E-commerce Retail (which is going to be published by the Ministry of Finance separately): (1) all commodities imported through cross-border e-commerce retail which are traded via e-commerce trading platform interconnected with the customs and for which the electronic data on trading, payment and logistics may be checked against one another; and (2) commodities imported through cross-border e-commerce retail which are not traded via e-commerce trading platform interconnected with the customs, but for which the courier service provider or post office may provide the electronic data on trading, payment and logistics and undertakes to bear the relevant legal liabilities for importation. Commodities imported through cross-border retail for which no electronic data on trading, payment and logistics can be provided shall be governed by the regulations currently in effect. The upper limit of the value of commodities imported through cross-border e-commerce retail in a single deal is RMB2,000, and the aggregate upper limit of the value of all deals of an individual in one year is RMB20,000. For commodities imported through cross-border e-commerce retail of which the value is less than the upper limit, the customs duty is levied at the rate of 0% temporarily, the exemption of value-added tax and consumption tax for importation is eliminated and such taxes will be levied temporarily at 70% of the statutory tax amount payable. For a single deal of which the value exceeds the upper limit for a single deal or of which the value, together with the value of other deals in a year, exceeds the aggregate upper limit for an individual’s deals in one year, and an individual non-dividable commodity of which the duty-paid price exceeds RMB2,000, such deal will be deemed as general trade and taxes will be levied on a full-amount basis. – 76 – THIS APPLICATION PROOF IS IN DRAFT FORM. The information contained herein is incomplete and is subject to change. This Application Proof must be read in conjunction with the section headed “Warning” on the cover of this Application Proof. REGULATORY OVERVIEW Regulation on Online Trading According to the Administrative Measures for Online Trading (網路交易管理辦法) promulgated by State Administration for Industry and Commerce on 26 January 2014 and taking effect on 15 March 2014, where a company engages in online commodity trading and related services, it shall disclose the information indicated in the business license or electronic linkage identifier of its business license at a notable position of the homepage of its website or the web-page where it conduct its business activities. When selling commodities or providing services to consumers, online commodity operators shall: (1) state such information as the business address, contact information, quantity and quality, price or expense, performance period and means, payment mode and return or placement mode of commodities or services and safety precautions and risk warning, after sales service and civil liabilities, take safety guarantee measures to ensure the safety of transaction and shall provide such commodities or services as promised; (2) ensure the integrity of such commodities or services and neither irrationally split up them for sale, nor set up any minimum consumption standard or otherwise charge any irrational fee; (3) issue such purchase vouchers or service bills as invoices to consumers in accordance with relevant national provisions or business practices; such vouchers or bills may be issued in electronic form if agreed by the consumers; (4) allow consumers to return the commodities within seven days from receiving the commodities without giving a reason, except for commodities specified in Article 16 of the Administrative Measures for Online Trading and refund the prices paid by consumers within seven days upon receipt of the returned commodities; (5) employ bold manners to remind consumers of clauses of significant interests to consumers and shall interpret such clauses as required by the consumers where standard contract terms are adopted; (6) not set out the provisions that are not fair or rational to consumers such as those that exclude or restrain consumers’ rights, relieve or exempt operators’ responsibilities, and increase the consumers’ responsibilities by using contract terms or by other manners; (7) not reach transactions in a forcible manner by using contract terms and by technical means; (8) explicitly state the purposes, manners and scopes of collecting and using information about consumers in business activities, obtain the consent of those from whom information is collected, make public their collection and use rules, strictly keep confidential and may not divulge, sell, or illegally provide others with, the data and information about personal information of consumers; – 77 – THIS APPLICATION PROOF IS IN DRAFT FORM. The information contained herein is incomplete and is subject to change. This Application Proof must be read in conjunction with the section headed “Warning” on the cover of this Application Proof. REGULATORY OVERVIEW (9) not send consumers commercial electronic information without the consent of or the request from the consumers or with an explicit refusal from the consumers. In addition, online commodity operators may not, by using online technical means or carriers, engage in the following unfair competition acts: (1) to use without authorisation the same or similar domain name, name or logo to the peculiar domain name, name or logo of a well-known website, which may cause mis-recognition by consumers; (2) to use or forge without authorisation the electronic logos of governmental departments or social organisations to conduct misleading and false propaganda; (3) to make lottery sales with virtual items as the prizes and the agreed amount of virtual items in online market exceeds the limit as allowed by the laws and regulations; (4) to harm competitors’ business reputation by malicious evaluation contrary to the facts after transaction; and (5) other unfair competition acts as provided by the laws and regulations. Violations of the Administrative Measures for Online Trading may result in the imposition of warning and the order to make corrections. Fines may be imposed if the violator refuses to do so. Foreign Investment Industrial Guidance According to applicable PRC regulations on Foreign-invested enterprise, capital contributions from a foreign holding company to its PRC subsidiaries, which are considered foreign-invested enterprises (or foreign-funded enterprises), may only be made when the approval by the MOC or its local counterpart is obtained. In approving such capital contributions, the MOC or its local counterpart examines the business scope of each foreign-invested enterprise (or foreign-funded enterprise) under review to ensure it complies with the Foreign Investment Industrial Guidance Catalogue, which classifies industries in China into three categories: “encouraged foreign investment industries”, “restricted foreign investment industries” and “prohibited foreign investment industries”. According to the “Guideline Catalogue of Foreign Investment Industries” promulgated on 10 March 2015 and enforced on 10 April 2015 by the State Development and Reform Commission and MOC, Fit Boxx Shenzhen is not engaged in any of the “restricted foreign investment industries” or “prohibited foreign investment industries”. – 78 – THIS APPLICATION PROOF IS IN DRAFT FORM. The information contained herein is incomplete and is subject to change. This Application Proof must be read in conjunction with the section headed “Warning” on the cover of this Application Proof. REGULATORY OVERVIEW Regulations Relating to Dividends Distribution The principal regulations governing dividend distributions by wholly foreign owned enterprises includes: The PRC Company Law (中華人民共和國公司法), as amended; The Wholly Foreign Owned Enterprise Law, as amended (中華人民共和國外資企業法); and The Wholly Foreign Owned Enterprise Law Implementing Rules, as amended (中華人民共 和國外資企業法實施細則). Under these law and regulations, wholly foreign owned enterprises in the PRC may pay dividends only out of their retained earnings, if any, determined in accordance with the PRC accounting standards and regulations. Additionally, a wholly foreign-owned enterprise is required, as other enterprises subject to PRC laws, to set aside at least 10% of its after tax profits each year, if any, to fund statutory reserve funds until the cumulative amount of such funds reaches 50% of its registered capital. These reserves are not distributable as cash dividends. Under the relevant PRC law, no net assets other than the accumulated after-tax profits can be distributed in the form of dividends. Trademark Law The period of validity of a registered trademark shall be ten years, to be counted from the date of approval of the registration under the Trademark Law of the PRC (中華人 民共和國商標法) promulgated on 23 August 1982, amended as at 22 February 1993, 27 October 2001 and 30 August 2013. The administrative authority for industry and commerce has the power to investigate and handle any act of infringement of the exclusive right to use a registered trademark according to the Trademark Law and relevant regulations Where the case is so serious that it constitutes a crime, in addition to compensating for the losses suffered by the infringed, shall be investigated into for the criminal responsibilities according to law. Any of the following acts shall be an infringement upon the right to exclusive use of a registered trademark: (1) using a trademark which is identical with the registered trademark on the same kind of commodities without a license from the registrant of that trademark; (2) using a trademark which is similar to the registered trademark on similar commodities which may cause confusion without a license from the registrant of that trademark; (3) selling the commodities that infringe upon the right to exclusive use of a registered trademark; (4) forging, manufacturing without authorisation the marks of a registered trademark of others, or selling the marks of a registered trademark forged or manufactured without authorisation; (5) changing a registered trademark and putting the commodities with the changed trademark into the market without the consent of the registrant of that trademark; – 79 – THIS APPLICATION PROOF IS IN DRAFT FORM. The information contained herein is incomplete and is subject to change. This Application Proof must be read in conjunction with the section headed “Warning” on the cover of this Application Proof. REGULATORY OVERVIEW (6) causing other damage to the right to exclusive use of a registered trademark of another person; and (7) deliberately facilitating or helping with infringement of the right to exclusive use of a registered trademark of another person. In the event of any above mentioned acts which infringe upon the right to the exclusive use of a registered trademark, the infringer would be imposed a fine, ordered to stop the infringement acts immediately, and give the infringed party compensation. Value-Added Tax Pursuant to the Provisional Regulations of the PRC Concerning Value-Added Tax promulgated by the State Council which was subsequently amended and came into effect on 1 January 2009 and its Implementation Rules, value added tax is imposed on goods sold in or imported into the PRC and on processing, repair and replacement services provided within the PRC. A company, if it is not qualified as a small-scale value added tax payer, is subject to value added tax at the rate of 17% on the sale and import of goods as well as on processing, repair and replacement services. A company importing goods will pay value added tax on the total value of the goods. The Group’s applicable value-added tax rate is 17%. Competition Law Pursuant to the Anti-unfair Competition Law of the PRC (the “Competition Law”), which was promulgated on 2 September 1993 and came into effect on 1 December 1993 by the Standing Committee of the National People’s Congress. The Competition Law provides that business operators shall not undermine their competitors by engaging in the following improper market activities: (1) infringement of trademark rights or confidential business information; (2) false publicity through advertising or other means, or forgery and dissemination of false information that infringes upon the goodwill of competitors or the reputation of their products; and (3) other improper practices, including commercial bribery, cartels, dumping sales at below-cost prices, and offering prizes as sales rebates illegally. Violations of the Competition Law may result in the imposition of fines and, in serious cases, revocation of its business license as well as incurrence of criminal liability. – 80 – THIS APPLICATION PROOF IS IN DRAFT FORM. The information contained herein is incomplete and is subject to change. This Application Proof must be read in conjunction with the section headed “Warning” on the cover of this Application Proof. HISTORY, REORGANISATION AND GROUP STRUCTURE BUSINESS DEVELOPMENT OF THE GROUP The business was first started in 2006 as a virtual online shop managed jointly by Mr. Chan and Mr. Li, both being the executive Directors and Controlling Shareholders, on a part-time basis on an online auction platform maintained with a local internet portal in Hong Kong. In the infant stage of the Group’s business, the Group primarily sold steppers sourced directly from PRC manufacturers. In 2007, seeing the huge potential demand for fitness equipment as demonstrated by the growth of the online business of the Group, Mr. Chan and Mr. Li decided to expand the business of the Group by forming a partnership with the establishment of Fit Boxx Trading in March 2007, and the opening of the first retail shop in Yuen Long in March 2007. Two years later in June 2009, to streamline the continued expansion of the Group’s business, Fit Boxx HK was incorporated to take over the business operated under Fit Boxx Trading. Since then, Fit Boxx HK has been the primary operating subsidiary of the Group. In 2009, leveraging on the experience in trading and the established sales network, Fit Boxx HK became a distributor for a brand of foldable treadmill under the brand name “Horizon”, which became the Group’s then major products. Since then, the Group continued to be engaged by a number of brand proprietors and manufacturers mainly from Japan and Isreal for the sales and distribution in Hong Kong and the PRC of their fitness equipment and beauty gadgets targeting general consumer market. In 2010, the Group extended its product portfolio to beauty gadgets and launched its first beauty gadget — hair removal device under the “Silk’n” brandname. In less than ten years since the start of the Group’s business, the Group has developed to become one of the major market players in the home-use fitness equipment and beauty gadgets industry with extensive distribution channels. As at the Latest Practicable Date, the Group’s sales network comprised its own retail outlets (retail shops, a shopping mall booth and a department store counter), points of sales established in the chain retailers, third party e-commerce platforms, online group buying platforms, other distributors and retailers, as well as the retail websites operated by the Group. For more details, please refer to the sub-section headed “Business — Sales and distribution channels”. As at the Latest Practicable Date, the Group has obtained exclusive distributorship of eight brands of products from seven brand owners of fitness equipment and beauty gadgets and the Group also developed and managed two brands of its own products which were mainly fitness equipment and other health care products. For details of the brands developed and managed by the Group, please refer to the paragraph headed “Business — Operating flow – (I) Sourcing of branded products” in this document. – 81 – THIS APPLICATION PROOF IS IN DRAFT FORM. The information contained herein is incomplete and is subject to change. This Application Proof must be read in conjunction with the section headed “Warning” on the cover of this Application Proof. HISTORY, REORGANISATION AND GROUP STRUCTURE Below are some of the key milestones of the business development of the Group. March 2007 Fit Boxx HK was incorporated and the first retail shop in Yuen Long was set up. March 2009 The Group launched the first foldable treadmill under the “Horizon” brand name. August 2010 The Group launched its first beauty gadget – hair removal device, under the “Silk’n” brand name. January 2012 The Group began to distribute its beauty gadgets to chain retailers in Hong Kong. February 2012 The Group obtained the exclusive distributorship to launch the radio frequency beauty devices under the “Tripollar” brand name. April 2012 The Group obtained the exclusive distributorship to launch laser hair rejuvenation helmet under the “iGrow” brand name. June 2012 The Group commenced the sales of beauty gadgets under the “Cosmoboxx” tradename. September 2012 The Group had a total of 9 retail stores. March 2013 The Group launched its first online storefront on Tmall. August 2013 The Group launched the “iRunner” treadmill under its proprietary brand “EnerGym”. December 2013 The Group obtained the exclusive distributorship to launch the Japanese brand “Bijouna” and “PEC” which offers a variety of beauty gadgets and accessories. May 2015 The Company was established in the Cayman Islands. September 2015 The Group obtained the distributorship to launch the “Reebok (fitness equipment)” brand which offers a variety of fitness equipment and accessories. – 82 – THIS APPLICATION PROOF IS IN DRAFT FORM. The information contained herein is incomplete and is subject to change. This Application Proof must be read in conjunction with the section headed “Warning” on the cover of this Application Proof. HISTORY, REORGANISATION AND GROUP STRUCTURE February 2016 The Group obtained the exclusive distributorship to launch the “Hoii” brand which offers a variety of anti-ultraviolet clothing products. CORPORATE HISTORY OF THE GROUP Set out below the corporate history and shareholding changes of the major operating subsidiaries of the Group. Fit Boxx HK Fit Boxx HK (formerly known as Fix Boxx Trading Company Limited and was renamed to its current name on 6 July 2009) is a limited liability company incorporated in Hong Kong on 18 June 2009. As at the date of its incorporation, its authorised share capital was HK$10,000 divided into 10,000 shares of HK$1 each, all of which were issued and allotted as to 5,000 shares to Mr. Chan and 5,000 shares to Mr. Li, representing 50% and 50% of the then entire issued share capital respectively. Pursuant to the 1st Round Subscription Agreements, National Pride and Prime View respectively subscribed for 733 shares and 509 shares of Fit Boxx HK at the consideration of HK$2,750,000 and HK$2,750,000, which was determined with reference to the estimated net profit of Fit Boxx HK in the financial year of 2014, representing 6.52% and 4.53% of the then entire issued share capital of Fit Boxx HK. The subscription was duly completed and the consideration was settled on 19 December 2014. Please refer to the sub-section headed “Pre-IPO Investors” of this section for further details. – 83 – THIS APPLICATION PROOF IS IN DRAFT FORM. The information contained herein is incomplete and is subject to change. This Application Proof must be read in conjunction with the section headed “Warning” on the cover of this Application Proof. HISTORY, REORGANISATION AND GROUP STRUCTURE As at the Latest Practicable Date, Fit Boxx HK was a major operating subsidiary of the Group and owned a substantial number of the Group’s trademarks as detailed under the paragraph headed “Appendix IV — B. Further information about the business — 2. Intellectual property rights of the Group” in this document. Fit Boxx HK is principally engaged in the sourcing, marketing, selling and distribution of a variety of fitness equipment and accessories, beauty gadgets and accessories, as well as other health care products, which are mainly for home use as detailed in the section headed “Business” in this document. Fit Boxx Shenzhen Fit Boxx Shenzhen was established in the PRC on 31 October 2012 as a wholly foreign owned enterprise of Mr. Li, the chief executive officer, an executive Director and the Controlling Shareholder of the Company. The establishment of Fit Boxx Shenzhen was pursuant to a mutual agreement among Mr. Li, Mr. Chan and Fit Boxx HK that, since Mr. Li had been responsible for the daily operation of the Company’s sales and businesses, it would be desirable for Mr. Li to take charge in setting up Fit Boxx Shenzhen and it was further agreed that, to facilitate the better operation of Fit Boxx Shenzhen and to simplify the establishment process, Mr. Li should be the registered shareholder of Fit Boxx Shenzhen to hold the entire equity interest in Fit Boxx Shenzhen on trust for and on behalf of the Company (the “Trust Arrangement”). Since the inception of Fit Boxx Shenzhen, Fit Boxx Shenzhen has been operating under the management of Fit Boxx HK. As part of the Reorganisation, it was agreed among Mr. Li, Mr. Chan and the Company that the Trust Arrangement should be terminated. On 13 February 2015, Mr. Li and Fit Boxx HK entered into a deed of confirmation whereby the parties confirmed the existence of the Trust Arrangement and also agreed to terminate the Trust Arrangement on or before 30 April 2015. Acting on this agreement and to legalise the proper transfer of the entire equity interest in Fit Boxx Shenzhen to Fit Boxx HK as required by Shenzhen Futian District Economy Promotion Bureau (“Shenzhen EPB”), Mr. Li and Fit Boxx HK entered into a share transfer agreement on 4 May 2015 pursuant to which Mr. Li transferred 100% of his equity interest in Fit Boxx Shenzhen to Fit Boxx HK at a consideration of RMB1,330,000, which was determined based on the value of the then shareholder ’s equity in accordance with the instruction from Shenzhen EPB. As at the Latest Practicable Date, the principal business activities of Fit Boxx Shenzhen was the sale of the Group’s products in the PRC. – 84 – THIS APPLICATION PROOF IS IN DRAFT FORM. The information contained herein is incomplete and is subject to change. This Application Proof must be read in conjunction with the section headed “Warning” on the cover of this Application Proof. HISTORY, REORGANISATION AND GROUP STRUCTURE REORGANISATION In preparation for the [REDACTED], the Group carried out a series of restructuring steps to streamline the corporate structure of the Group and to facilitate the Group’s growth and expansion strategy. The shareholding and corporate structure of the Group immediately before the Reorganisation is set out as follows: Mr. Chan Mr. Li 50% 50% Fit Boxx HK (HK) 100% Fit Boxx Shenzhen (Note 1) (PRC) Notes: 1. According to a deed of confirmation dated 13 February 2015, the entire equity interest in Fit Boxx Shenzhen had been held by Mr. Li as a trustee for and on behalf of Fit Boxx HK since the establishment of Fit Boxx Shenzhen. The Trust Arrangement was terminated with the transfer by Mr. Li to Fit Boxx HK the entire equity interest in Fit Boxx Shenzhen pursuant to a share transfer agreement dated 4 May 2015 entered into between Mr. Li and Fit Boxx HK. The transfer was legally and properly completed and settled on 27 May 2015. Investment by National Pride and Prime View Pursuant to the 1st Round Subscription Agreements, National Pride and Prime View respectively agreed to subscribe for 733 shares and 509 shares in Fit Boxx HK, representing 6.52% and 4.53% of the entire issued share capital of Fit Boxx HK. It was agreed in the 1st Round Subscription Agreements that after the Reorganisation, National Pride and Prime View would have shareholdings in the Company reflecting their respective investment in Fit Boxx HK and the shareholdings of National Pride and Prime View in the Company would at all time prior to the completion of the [REDACTED] be maintained at 6.52% and 4.53% respectively (the “Anti-dilution Arrangement”). – 85 – THIS APPLICATION PROOF IS IN DRAFT FORM. The information contained herein is incomplete and is subject to change. This Application Proof must be read in conjunction with the section headed “Warning” on the cover of this Application Proof. HISTORY, REORGANISATION AND GROUP STRUCTURE Transfer of equity interest in Fit Boxx Shenzhen to Fit Boxx HK As part of the Reorganisation, it was agreed between Mr. Li, Mr. Chan and the Company that the Trust Arrangement should be terminated and Mr. Li should transfer his shareholding in Fit Boxx Shenzhen to Fit Boxx HK. Further details of such transfer are set out in the section headed “Corporate History of the Group” of this section. Incorporation of overseas holding companies and restructuring of the Group Incorporation of Faith Elite as the offshore shareholding company On 8 July 2014, Faith Elite was incorporated with limited liability in Anguilla with an authorised share capital of US$1,000,000 divided into 1,000,000 shares with par value of US$1.00 each. On 18 December 2014, 1 share and 1 share with par value of US$1.00 each, representing 50% and 50% of the entire issued share capital of Faith Elite, were allotted and issued fully paid to Mr. Chan and Mr. Li respectively. The directors of Faith Elite are Mr. Chan and Mr. Li. Incorporation of the Company On 14 May 2015, the Company was incorporated as an exempted company with limited liability in the Cayman Islands with an authorised share capital of HK$390,000 divided into 390,000 shares of HK$1.00 each. Upon its incorporation, one share of HK$1.00 was allotted and issued to the initial subscriber for cash at par and the same was transferred to Faith Elite on the same day. On 12 June 2015, every issued and unissued share of HK$1.00 was subdivided into 100 Shares of HK$0.01 each. – 86 – THIS APPLICATION PROOF IS IN DRAFT FORM. The information contained herein is incomplete and is subject to change. This Application Proof must be read in conjunction with the section headed “Warning” on the cover of this Application Proof. HISTORY, REORGANISATION AND GROUP STRUCTURE Incorporation of Fit Boxx BVI as intermediate holding company On 20 May 2015, Fit Boxx BVI was incorporated with limited liability in the BVI with the power to issue a maximum of 50,000 shares of HK$1.00 each. On the same date, one share with par value of HK$1.00, representing 100% of the entire issued share capital of Fit Boxx BVI was allotted and issued fully paid to the Company. Upon completion, Fit Boxx BVI became a wholly-owned subsidiary of the Company with Mr. Chan and Mr. Li as its directors. Transfer of the entire issued share capital of Fit Boxx HK from the existing shareholders to Fit Boxx BVI and allotment of Shares by the Company to Faith Elite, Prime View and National Pride and acquisition of Fit Boxx HK by Fit Boxx BVI Pursuant to a share sale and purchase agreement dated 10 December 2015 (the “Share Purchase Agreement”) entered into among (i) Mr. Chan, Mr. Li, Prime View and National Pride as the vendors (collectively the “Vendors”); (ii) Fit Boxx BVI as the purchaser; and (iii) the Company, the Vendors agreed to sell, and Fit Boxx BVI agreed to purchase the entire issued share capital of Fit Boxx HK in consideration for the issue of 9,900 Shares to Faith Elite, 733 Shares to National Pride and 509 Shares to Prime View, all credited as fully paid in return for which Fit Boxx BVI issued one new share of HK$1.00 in its share capital, credited as fully paid, to the Company. The share transfer was properly and legally settled and completed on 6 Janaury 2016. Upon completion of the aforesaid share transfer, Fit Boxx HK became a directly and wholly owned subsidiary of Fit Boxx BVI. On 6 January 2016, pursuant to the Share Purchase Agreement, the Company allotted 9,900 Shares to Faith Elite credited as fully paid which together with 100 Shares already owned by Faith Elite, in aggregate, representing 88.95% of the then entire issued share capital of the Company. On the same date, pursuant to the Share Purchase Agreement, the Company allotted to National Pride and Prime View 733 Shares and 509 Shares respectively, credited as fully paid, representing 6.52% and 4.53% of the entire issued share capital of the Company. In consideration of the aforesaid allotments, Fit Boxx BVI issued one new share of HK$1.00 in its share capital, credited as fully paid, to the Company on 6 January 2016. Following the completion of the transfers, the Company remained the sole shareholder of Fit Boxx BVI holding two shares in Fit Boxx BVI. – 87 – THIS APPLICATION PROOF IS IN DRAFT FORM. The information contained herein is incomplete and is subject to change. This Application Proof must be read in conjunction with the section headed “Warning” on the cover of this Application Proof. HISTORY, REORGANISATION AND GROUP STRUCTURE Investment by Global Excellent and Hang Kong Pursuant to the 2nd Round Subscription Agreements, each of Global Excellent and Hang Kong agreed to subscribe for 1,292 Shares at the consideration of HK$3,387,500, representing 6.46% of the then total issued shares of the Company respectively. Pursuant to the Anti-dilution Arrangement, an additional of 5,206 Shares, 571 Shares and 397 Shares were issued and allotted to Faith Elite, National Pride and Prime View respectively at par value on 6 January 2016. On 6 January 2016, the Company allotted 1,292 Shares, representing 6.46% of the issued share capital of the Company, to each of Global Excellent and Hang Kong. Upon completion of the aforesaid allotments, the Company was held as to 76.03% by Faith Elite, 6.52% by National Pride, 4.53% by Prime View, 6.46% by Global Excellent and 6.46% by Hang Kong. – 88 – THIS APPLICATION PROOF IS IN DRAFT FORM. The information contained herein is incomplete and is subject to change. This Application Proof must be read in conjunction with the section headed “Warning” on the cover of this Application Proof. HISTORY, REORGANISATION AND GROUP STRUCTURE SHAREHOLDER AND CORPORATE STRUCTURE Shareholding and Corporate Structure after Completion of the Reorganisation but before [REDACTED] The shareholding and corporate structure of the Group immediately after completion of the Reorganisation is set out as follows: Mr. Chan Mr. Li Kwan Hoi Wang Ip Wai Lung Cheng Oi Yin Wong Kwok Wai Faith Elite National Pride Prime View Global Excellent Hang Kong (Auguilla) (Auguilla) (Seychelles) (Hong Kong) (BVI) 50% 50% 76.03% 6.52% 4.53% 6.46% 6.46% The Company (Cayman Islands) 100% Fit Boxx BVI (BVI) 100% Fit Boxx HK (HK) 100% Fit Boxx Shenzhen (PRC) Capitalisation Issue and [REDACTED] Conditional upon the creating of the Company’s share premium account as a result of the issue of the [REDACTED] pursuant to the [REDACTED], an amount of HK$[REDACTED] standing to the credit of the share premium account of the Company would be capitalised by applying such sum towards the paying up in full at par a total of [REDACTED] Shares for allotment and issue to the then shareholders of the Company on a pro rata basis. – 89 – THIS APPLICATION PROOF IS IN DRAFT FORM. The information contained herein is incomplete and is subject to change. This Application Proof must be read in conjunction with the section headed “Warning” on the cover of this Application Proof. HISTORY, REORGANISATION AND GROUP STRUCTURE Shareholding and Corporate Structure after Completion of the [REDACTED] and the Capitalisation Issue The following chart sets out the shareholding and corporate structure of the Group immediately after completion of the Capitalisation Issue and completion of the [REDACTED], assuming the [REDACTED] is not exercised and there is no exercise of any options which may be granted under the Share Option Scheme: Mr. Chan Mr. Li 50% Kwan Hoi Wang Ip Wai Lung Cheng Oi Yin Wong Kwok Wai 50% Faith Elite National Pride Prime View Global Excellent Hang Kong (Auguilla) (Auguilla) (The Republic of Seychelles) (Hong Kong) (BVI) [REDACTED]% [REDACTED]% [REDACTED]% [REDACTED]% [REDACTED]% Public Shareholders [REDACTED]% The Company (Cayman Islands) 100% Fit Boxx BVI (BVI) 100% Fit Boxx HK (HK) 100% Fit Boxx Shenzhen (PRC) PRE-IPO INVESTMENTS Investment of National Pride and Prime View Pursuant to the 1st Round Subscription Agreements, National Pride and Prime View respectively subscribed for 733 shares and 509 shares in Fit Boxx HK, representing 6.52% and 4.53% of the then entire issued share capital of Fit Boxx HK, both at a consideration of HK$2,750,000, which was determined after an arm’s length negotiation with regard to the estimated net profit of Fit Box HK in the financial year of 2014 and the price-to-earnings ratio of five times. It was agreed that after the Reorganisation, National Pride and Prime View would have shareholdings in the Company reflecting their investments in Fit Boxx HK. To implement the 1st Round Subscription Agreements, on 6 January 2016, the Company allotted and issued 733 Shares and 509 Shares, representing 6.52% and 4.53% of the entire issued share capital of the Company to National Pride and Prime View respectively in consideration for the transfer to Fit Boxx BVI of each of National Pride and Prime View’s entire shareholding, being 733 shares and 509 shares, in Fit Boxx HK. Following the 2nd Round Subscription Agreements and in accordance with the Anti-Dilution Arrangement, an additional of 571 Shares and 397 Shares were issued and allotted to National Pride and Prime View respectively at par value of HK$1.00 on 6 January 2016. – 90 – THIS APPLICATION PROOF IS IN DRAFT FORM. The information contained herein is incomplete and is subject to change. This Application Proof must be read in conjunction with the section headed “Warning” on the cover of this Application Proof. HISTORY, REORGANISATION AND GROUP STRUCTURE The consideration under the 1st Round Subscription Agreements had been fully settled on 19 December 2014. Saved for the Anti-dilution Arrangement, National Pride and Prime View were not given any special rights with respect to their respective investments. Since they are not required to be subject to any lock-up arrangement after the [REDACTED], the Shares held by each of National Pride and Prime View are not counted towards the public float after the [REDACTED] for the purpose of Rule 11.23 of the GEM Listing Rules. The following table summarises the details of the investments of National Pride and Prime View: Investment of National Pride and Prime View Name of investors Information of investors (a) National Pride (b) Prime View (a) National Pride is an investment holding company and is wholly owned by Mr. Kwan Hoi Wang, a merchant who is a Hong Kong permanent resident and an Independent Third Party (b) Prime View is an investment holding company and is wholly owned by Mr. Ip Wai Lung, a merchant who is a Hong Kong permanent resident and an Independent Third Party Completion date and date of payment of consideration of investments 19 December 2014 Amount of consideration Each of National Pride and Prime View paid HK$2,750,000 for their respective investments and the amount was credited to the share capital of Fit Boxx HK. Number of equity interest/ shares acquired (a) National Pride: 1,304 Shares (representing approximately 6.52% and [REDACTED]% of the entire issued share capital of the Company upon the completion of the Capitalisation Issue and the completion of the [REDACTED] respectively) – 91 – THIS APPLICATION PROOF IS IN DRAFT FORM. The information contained herein is incomplete and is subject to change. This Application Proof must be read in conjunction with the section headed “Warning” on the cover of this Application Proof. HISTORY, REORGANISATION AND GROUP STRUCTURE (b) Prime View: 906 Shares (representing approximately 4.53% and [REDACTED]% of the entire issued share capital of the Company upon the Capitalisation Issue and the completion of the [REDACTED] respectively) (assuming the [REDACTED] is not exercised and taking into no account of the exercise of any options which may be granted under the Share Option Scheme) Cost per Share paid by the Investors (taking into account the Capitalisation Issue) (a) For National Pride: HK$[REDACTED] (representing a discount of approximately [REDACTED]% to the mid-point of the indicative [REDACTED] range of HK$[REDACTED] to HK$[REDACTED]) (b) For Prime View: HK$[REDACTED] (representing a discount of [REDACTED]% to the mid-point of the indicative [REDACTED] range of HK$[REDACTED] to HK$[REDACTED] Special Rights National Pride and Prime View were not given any special rights with respect to their respective investments except for the Anti-dilution Arrangement Use of Proceeds The Company utilised the investment proceeds from National Pride and Prime View for business development, working capital and other corporate purposes. The investments from National Pride and Prime View enable the Group to expand its business Investment of Global Excellent and Hang Kong Pursuant to the 2nd Round Subscription Agreements, each of Global Excellent and Hang Kong agreed to subscribe for 1,292 Shares at the consideration of HK$3,387,500, which was determined based on the estimated valuation of the assets and business of the Group being not less than HK$90 million as at [REDACTED] or as at the [REDACTED], whichever is earlier. On 6 January 2016, the Company allotted and issued 1,292 Shares and 1,292 Shares, representing 6.46% and 6.46% of the entire issued share capital of the Company to each of Global Excellent and Hang Kong. The consideration under the 2nd Round Subscription Agreements had been fully settled on 14 December 2015. Saved for the Anti-dilution Arrangement, Global Excellent and Hang Kong were not given to any special rights with respect to their respective investment. Since Global Excellent and Hong Kong are not required to be subject to any lock-up arrangement after the [REDACTED], the Shares held by each of them are not counted towards the public float after the [REDACTED] for the purpose of Rule 11.23 of the GEM Listing Rules. After the completion of the 2nd Round Subscription Agreement – 92 – THIS APPLICATION PROOF IS IN DRAFT FORM. The information contained herein is incomplete and is subject to change. This Application Proof must be read in conjunction with the section headed “Warning” on the cover of this Application Proof. HISTORY, REORGANISATION AND GROUP STRUCTURE and the issue and allotment of additional Shares to National Pride and Prime View on 6 January 2016 pursuant to the Anti-dilution Arrangement, the Company was held as to 76.03% by Faith Elite, 6.52% by National Pride, 4.53% by Prime View, 6.46% by Global Excellent and 6.46% by Hang Kong. The following table summarises the details of the investment of Global Excellent and Hang Kong: Name of investors Information of investors (a) Global Excellent (b) Hang Kong (a) Global Excellent is an investment holding company and is wholly owned by Ms. Cheng Oi Yin, a merchant who is a Hong Kong permanent resident and an Independent Third Party (b) Hang Kong is an investment holding company and is wholly owned by Mr. Wong Kwok Wai, a merchant who is a Hong Kong permanent resident and an Independent Third Party Completion date and date of payment of consideration of investments 14 December 2015 Among of consideration Each of Global Excellent and Hang Kong paid HK$3,387,500 for their respective investments Number of equity interest/ shares acquired (a) Global Excellent: 1,292 Shares (representing approximately 6.46% and [REDACTED]% of the entire issued share capital of the Company upon the Capitalisation Issue and completion of the [REDACTED] respectively) (b) Hang Kong: 1,292 Shares (representing approximately 6.46% and [REDACTED]% of the entire issued share capital of the Company upon the Capitalisation Issue and completion of the [REDACTED] respectively) (assuming the [REDACTED] is not exercised and taking into no account of the exercise of any options which may be granted under the Share Option Scheme – 93 – THIS APPLICATION PROOF IS IN DRAFT FORM. The information contained herein is incomplete and is subject to change. This Application Proof must be read in conjunction with the section headed “Warning” on the cover of this Application Proof. HISTORY, REORGANISATION AND GROUP STRUCTURE Cost per Share paid by the investors (taking into account the Capitalisation Issue) [REDACTED] (representing a discount of approximately [REDACTED]% to the mid-point of the indicative [REDACTED] range of HK$[REDACTED] to HK$[REDACTED] Special Rights Pursuant to an anti-dilution arrangement, the Company promises that prior to the completion of the [REDACTED], the shareholdings of Global Excellent and Hang Kong in the Group would at all time be maintained at 6.46% and 6.46% respectively. Use of Proceeds The Company utilised the investment proceeds from Global Excellent and Hang Kong for business development, working capital and other corporate purposes. The investments from Global Excellent and Hang Kong enable the Group to expand its business. Sponsor’s confirmation The Sponsor is of the view that the terms of the investments of National Pride, Prime View, Global Excellent and Hang Kong are in compliance with the Interim Guidance on Pre-IPO Investment issued the Stock Exchange on 13 October 2010 (as amended) and Guidance Letters HKEx-GL43-12 (issued in October 2012 and updated in July 2013), based on the review of the relevant documentation. – 94 – THIS APPLICATION PROOF IS IN DRAFT FORM. The information contained herein is incomplete and is subject to change. This Application Proof must be read in conjunction with the section headed “Warning” on the cover of this Application Proof. BUSINESS OVERVIEW The Group was founded in 2007 and is principally engaged in the sourcing, marketing, selling and distribution of a variety of fitness equipment and accessories, beauty gadgets and accessories, as well as other health care products, which are mainly for home use, under various brands through its sales and distribution network in Hong Kong and the PRC. The Group’s turnover is principally derived from the sales of fitness equipment, beauty gadgets and other accessory products. The fitness equipment product segment mainly consists of treadmills, exercise bikes, elliptical trainers, steppers and other fitness accessories such as trampolines, yoga gears, dumbbells, boxing gears, heart rate monitors and diagnostic scales. The beauty gadgets product segment mainly consists of beauty devices for hair removal, wrinkle reduction, skin lifting, anti-acne treatment, rejuvenation of the skin’s appearance and body sliming and other healthy accessories. Other health care products include massage devices, inflated bath tubs and limb-support compression wears. The table below sets out the breakdown of the Group’s turnover by product segment during the Track Record Period. Year ended 31 December 2014 HK$’000 Fitness equipment and accessories Beauty gadgets and accessories Other health care products Total % Year ended 31 December 2015 HK$’000 % 23,919 35.5 22,463 26.5 41,373 61.3 60,706 71.6 2,173 3.2 1,575 1.9 67,465 100.0 84,744 100.0 These products are either (i) branded products purchased from independent brand owners and are sold to customers under the brand owners’ brands; or (ii) proprietary products sourced from independent external manufacturers or suppliers and are sold to customers under the Group’s proprietary brands. As at the Latest Practicable Date, the Group entered into exclusive distribution agreements with seven brand owners for the marketing, sales and distribution of their products on an exclusive basis in Hong Kong. Some of these brand owners have also granted exclusivity to the Group for the distribution of their products in the PRC (for online sales on specified e-commerce platforms only) and/or Macau; and two of them also have granted to the Group distribution rights in the PRC on a non-exclusive basis. The popular brands under the Group’s fitness equipment segment include “Reebok (fitness equipment)”, “La-fit” and “Horizon”. For the beauty gadgets segment, the – 95 – THIS APPLICATION PROOF IS IN DRAFT FORM. The information contained herein is incomplete and is subject to change. This Application Proof must be read in conjunction with the section headed “Warning” on the cover of this Application Proof. BUSINESS popular brands include “Silk’n”, “TriPollar”, “Bijouna”, “P.E.C”, “Aduro”, “Hoii” and “iGrow”. For products sold under the Group’s own proprietary brands, namely, “EnerGym” and “元氣達人”, they are fitness equipment and other health care products sourced from independent external manufacturers or suppliers located in Hong Kong and the PRC and are delivered to the Group as finished products for distribution under the Group’s proprietary brands. The Group’s products target the general consumer market in Hong Kong and the PRC. In respect of the fitness equipment segment, the Group’s products mainly target general consumers of both genders aged between 25 to 50 who are health conscious and appearance conscious. In respect of the beauty gadgets segment, the Group’s products mainly target female consumers aged between 25 to 50 who are appearance conscious, eager to try novel and trendy products, and are willing to pay premium price in return for quality products. In order to reach the Group’s target customers for different types of products, the Group believes that it is essential to establish an extensive sales and distribution channel. Within less than ten years of operation, the Group has managed to develop various sales and distribution channels, including the Group’s own retail outlets (including retail shops, shopping mall booth and department store counter) and retail websites, points of sales established by the chain retailers, third party e-commerce platforms, online group buying platforms, other distributors and retailers. As at the Latest Practicable Date, the Group had seven retail outlets (five retail shops, one shopping mall booth and one department store counter) and a showroom located in Hong Kong which were all directly operated by the Group. Since 2012, the Group started to co-operate with some chain retailers in Hong Kong and as at the Latest Practicable Date, the Group had established over 150 points of sales through their retail networks in Hong Kong. The Group also operates two retail websites, namely, www.fitboxx.com and www.cosmoboxx.com in Hong Kong, which allow the customers to view and/or purchase the Group’s products online. Besides, the Group co-operates with two third party e-commerce platform operators to provide online shopping channels in Hong Kong. Leveraging on the Group’s growth in Hong Kong, the Group started to explore the PRC market in 2011. The Group principally distributes its products in the PRC through online channels. As at the Latest Practicable Date, the Group launched three storefronts on an e-commerce platform in the PRC, namely, Tmall, for the sales of beauty gadgets and accessory products. The Directors consider that these online storefronts would allow the Group to gain access to the fast-growing consumer market of the PRC without significant capital investment. The Group’s fitness equipment and accessories are not sold on the e-commerce platform in the PRC as the Directors consider that, apart from the inconvenience of logistics, the competition in respect of the fitness equipment market is keen in the PRC with a considerable number of established brands and distributors competing in the market over product design and price. – 96 – THIS APPLICATION PROOF IS IN DRAFT FORM. The information contained herein is incomplete and is subject to change. This Application Proof must be read in conjunction with the section headed “Warning” on the cover of this Application Proof. BUSINESS COMPETITIVE STRENGTHS The Group believes that its growth during the Track Record Period and future prospects are based on the following competitive strengths: Diversified portfolio of fitness equipment and beauty gadgets offered by the Group The Group offers a variety of proprietary and branded fitness equipment and beauty gadgets, which are mainly for home use, to consumers with varying needs and preferences. The Group’s sales and marketing team regularly attends key tradeshow events and conducts market studies to keep abreast of the latest market information and industry trends. As they communicate frequently with various brand owners around the world, they are able to grasp updated market information and benefit from the experience in other geographical markets. With the market updates and consumer data, the Group strives to bring new products to the market and upgrade its product portfolio on a continuous basis in response to changing consumer preferences, new innovations and market opportunities. During the Track Record Period, the Group was approached by certain brand owners for the purpose of business cooperation. The Directors consider that the approaches of various suppliers to the Group during the Track Record Period were as a result of the Group’s growth and reputation built in the industry. The Group would shortlist suitable products based on its assessment of the market acceptance and may include such products into its product portfolio in order to maintain competitive edge. During the Track Record Period and up to the Latest Practicable Date, the Group brought in the following brands for distribution on an exclusive basis:• “Reebok” for fitness equipment and accessories; and • “Aduro”, “Bijouna”, “P.E.C.” and “Hoii” for beauty gadgets and accessories The Directors believe this diversified portfolio of products will help reduce the Group’s reliance on any particular kind of product or brand, and demonstrate the Group’s ability to identify and introduce new products to meet customers’ expectations and demands. Multiple sales and distribution channels The Group’s products target the general consumer market in Hong Kong and the PRC. The Directors believe that an established sales and distribution network would enhance brand awareness and enable the Group’s products to penetrate into the target market. The Group’s sales network is made of its own retail outlets (including retail shops, shopping mall booth, and department store counter) and retail websites, points of sales established by the chain retailers, third party e-commerce platforms, online group buying platforms, other distributors and retailers, as well as the retail websites operated by the – 97 – THIS APPLICATION PROOF IS IN DRAFT FORM. The information contained herein is incomplete and is subject to change. This Application Proof must be read in conjunction with the section headed “Warning” on the cover of this Application Proof. BUSINESS Group. The Directors beleive physical retail stores, combined with the online retail platforms, would provide an integrated shopping experience to the consumers for the sales and promotion of the Group’s products. The Group has expanded its sales network to the PRC by operating three storefronts on a e-commerce platform, namely, Tmall, for the sales of beauty gadgets and accessories. The Directors consider that these online storefronts allow the Group to gain access to the fast-growing consumer market of the PRC without significant capital investment. The Directors believe that the multiple sales and distribution channels would provide the Group with the solid foundation to further increase its sales and market share. In addition, the established sales network would also attract potential brand owners supplying fitness equipment or beauty gadgets to appoint the Group as distributors in order to penetrate into the Hong Kong and the PRC markets. Multi-faceted marketing strategy The Group believes that strong brand awareness, recognition, and reputation are essential to the Group’s success. Accordingly, the Group places great emphasis and efforts in marketing and promoting both the Group’s proprietary brands and branded products traded by the Group. During the two years ended 31 December 2015, marketing and promotion expenses accounted for approximately 15.1% and 14.5% respectively of the Group’s cost of sales. The Group implements a multi-faceted marketing strategy to promote its products. It tailors marketing and promotion plans for major products based on their respective brand positioning, price range and target customers. The Group advertises and promotes its major products through various media channels, such as television commercials, printed media, internet, outdoor advertising, road shows, billboards and in-store promotion. In addition, the Group selects celebrities as brand ambassadors to promote and enhance the public image of its brands and products. The Directors believe that this advertising and promotion strategy has a positive and long lasting effect on the public and is able to further reinforce the Group’s image and recognition of its products among the general consumers, which in turn will boost the sales of the Group’s existing and new products in the future. Experienced and dedicated management team The Directors believes that the Group’s management team’s experience, knowledge and vision in the fitness equipment and beauty gadgets markets have enabled the Group to achieve growth during the Track Record Period. Most of the Group’s key executives and senior management have over six years of experience in the fitness equipment and beauty gadgets markets and possess relevant management experience and industry knowledge. Benefiting from the experience and knowledge of the Group’s management team, the Directors believes that the Group is able to adopt appropriate marketing and sales strategies to accommodate the changing market environment, possess the vision required to anticipate changes in consumer preference, market trends and introduce new products or upgrade existing products to ensure the Group’s future growth. – 98 – THIS APPLICATION PROOF IS IN DRAFT FORM. The information contained herein is incomplete and is subject to change. This Application Proof must be read in conjunction with the section headed “Warning” on the cover of this Application Proof. BUSINESS BUSINESS STRATEGIES The Group’s mission statement is to improve the quality of people’s lifestyle at home and become one of the leading wellness solutions retailers in Hong Kong. The Group plans to implement the following strategies to pursue further development and expansion of its business: Further development of the Group’s business in the PRC online market by opening of display stores The Directors believe the online market in the PRC has promising potential. However, the Directors consider that certain customers may be hesitated to purchase the products online without test using or looking at the physical products. In order to provide online customer traffic with physical experience of the Group’s products in the PRC, and to enhance the Group’s interactivity with potential customers, the Group plans to open a few display stores in major cities of the PRC, including Shenzhen, Shanghai and Beijing. These display stores allow customers to gain confidence of their purchases by test using the products before placing their orders at the Group’s online storefronts. In this regard, the Group plans to incur an aggregate of approximately HK$[REDACTED] million for the payment of rental deposits and renovation expenditures for five display stores, which is expected to open progressively in 2017 to 2018. The relevant expenditures will be funded by the net proceeds from the [REDACTED]. Expansion of retail network in Hong Kong In order to attract customer traffic with higher purchasing power, the Group plans to open a new flagship shop in Shatin district and two new shops in Central and Kowloon Bay respectively. The Group plans to open the flagship shop in Shatin in the first quarter of 2017 and the two new shops in Central and Kowloon Bay in the second and third quarter of 2017 respectively. The Directors believe that the new shops allow the Group to gain market presence in prime locations with busy customer traffic of working group, while the flagship shop to be opened in Shatin district is intended to display most of the Group’s products in a well-decorated shop environment so as to gain favourable impression from customers. The Directors also believe that the flagship store serves, to a certain extent, to promote the brand name of the Group. In this regards, the Group plans to incur approximately HK$[REDACTED] million (which mainly comprises the estimated expenses for renovation and rental deposits of the shops) for the opening of the three shops, which will be funded by the net proceeds from the [REDACTED]. Enhancing marketing and promotional activities In view that the products sold by the Group are general consumer products, the Directors believe that marketing and promotion of its products and brand names are important to increase the general public’s awareness of the Group and its products. In order to increase customer traffic of both physical and online stores and to cope with the Group’s expansion plan in relation to various types of physical stores, the Group plans to – 99 – THIS APPLICATION PROOF IS IN DRAFT FORM. The information contained herein is incomplete and is subject to change. This Application Proof must be read in conjunction with the section headed “Warning” on the cover of this Application Proof. BUSINESS strengthen its effort to promote its brand name of “Fit Boxx” in Hong Kong and the PRC by launching various marketing and promotional activities. In this regards, apart from its existing budget in advertising and promotion (which was around HK$4.9 million for the year ended 31 December 2015), the Group plans to increase its annual budget using the net proceeds from the [REDACTED]. HK$[REDACTED] million will be allocated for this purpose up to 31 December 2018. Increasing market presence in Hong Kong by opening of pop-up stores Taking into consideration the Group’s positive results in sales through trade fairs and exhibitions, the Directors consider sales of its products through short-term leased area is profitable. The Group plans to incur approximately HK$[REDACTED] million (which mainly comprises the estimated expenses for renovation and rental deposits of the short-term leased area), which will be funded by the net proceeds from the [REDACTED], to open four pop-up stores in Hong Kong in 2018 to further enhance its market presence. The pop-up stores are temporary stores open for around two to three month and are intended to allow the Group to create an unique environment that engages potential customers and generates interactivity between the Group and its customers, and to promote seasonal product items such as hair removal devices. These pop-up stores also allow the Group to test the popularity of its products and suitability of future shop locations, which the Directors believe is a low-cost way to capture foot traffic without committing to leases with tenure of two to three years. Enhancing the Group’s brand recognition and image by renovation of existing shops In addition to the increase in the variety of brands and products offered to customers, the Directors believe that ambience of the retail shops is also important to customers’ shopping experience. In this regard, the Group plans to refurbish its existing retail shops with an estimated aggregate renovation costs of approximately HK$[REDACTED] million to be incurred in 2018, which will be funded by the net proceeds from the [REDACTED]. The Group will continue to refurbish its existing retail shops as and when necessary with the aim to provide its customers with a comfortable shopping environment. BUSINESS MODEL The Group is principally engaged in the sourcing, marketing, selling and distribution of a variety of fitness equipment and accessories, beauty gadgets and accessories, as well as other health care products, which are mainly for home use, under various brands through its sales and distribution network in Hong Kong and the PRC. These products are either (i) branded products purchased from independent brand owners and are sold to customers under the brand owners’ brands; or (ii) proprietary products sourced from independent external manufacturers or suppliers and are sold to customers under the Group’s proprietary brands. – 100 – THIS APPLICATION PROOF IS IN DRAFT FORM. The information contained herein is incomplete and is subject to change. This Application Proof must be read in conjunction with the section headed “Warning” on the cover of this Application Proof. BUSINESS OPERATION FLOW The following diagram illustrates the Group’s general operation flow in respect of the branded products and proprietary products: Branded products Proprietary products Select brand and product Select product Evaluate product and manufacturer (i) Enter into exclusive distribution agreement; or (ii) procure products on a non-exclusive basis Negotiate with product manufacturer Determine market position, price range and target customers and formulate marketing plan Place order, receive delivery and product inspection Sell and distribute the products through various sales and distribution channels in Hong Kong and the PRC The Group’s own retail outlets in Hong Kong Chain retailers, other distributors and retailers in Hong Kong and the PRC Online sales through (i) own retail websites in Hong Kong; (ii) third party storefronts on e-commerce platform in the PRC (for branded products only); and (iii) group buying platforms in Hong Kong Launch promotional and marketing activities Review/maintain brand image and keep track of consumer’s response to the products and brand image After sales support and customer services through the Group’s offices in Hong Kong and the PRC (I) Sourcing of Branded Products The Group normally sources and identifies popular fitness equipment and beauty gadgets from independent brand owners around the world. Once a brand is identified, the Group approaches the brand owners directly and negotiates for the distribution rights of the products of a particular brand principally in Hong Kong and in some occasions covering Macau and online sales in the PRC. The brand owners who wish to expand their business into the Hong Kong and/or the PRC market may also approach the Group directly for business co-operation. In either event, if the products are assessed by the Group as popular, the Group will strive to negotiate for the exclusive distribution right of the products in the agreed territories. – 101 – THIS APPLICATION PROOF IS IN DRAFT FORM. The information contained herein is incomplete and is subject to change. This Application Proof must be read in conjunction with the section headed “Warning” on the cover of this Application Proof. BUSINESS Brand selection and cooperation with the brand owners The Directors understand that product features and the reputation of brand owners (who are mainly manufacturers) are essential to the Group’s long-term development. Hence, the Group adopts a stringent approach in the selection of brands and the sourcing of products which are as follows: (i) The Group normally sources new products and brand owners based on the market intelligence collected from industry exhibitions, tradeshows, feedbacks from the frontline salespeople, referrals from existing and new suppliers, and from foreign websites. The Group will conduct a preliminary check on the brand owners’ credentials to ascertain their background and goodwill and estimate the projected sale of a particular product manufactured and/or supplied by such owners. The selection criteria for brands and products are based on factors such as: (a) whether the new products complement the current product portfolio offered by the Group; (b) the quality and safety of the products; (c) the expected sales and profitability of the new products; (d) the brand owners’ reputation in the industry; (e) the prospect of expanding the market share of the Group in the target market; and (f) the popularity of a particular product in the overseas market. (ii) After the preliminary evaluation, the Group normally orders small quantities of new products from the brand owners. These new products will be put on a trial sale for one to six months. Based on the level of market reception and the trial sale results, the Group will further consider whether to co-operate with the brand owners in the long term and whether to negotiate for exclusive distribution rights from the brand owners. Entering into the exclusive distribution agreement with brand owners Having selected the brand owners, the relevant brand and the product(s) to be distributed, as well as having decided to strive for exclusive distribution rights, the Group will negotiate with the brand owners and seek to enter into exclusive distribution agreements with them. As at the Latest Practicable Date, the Group entered into exclusive distribution agreements with a total of seven brand owners for the marketing, sales and distribution of their products on an exclusive basis predominantly in Hong Kong, Macau and/or online sales in the PRC. Set out below are the salient terms under the exclusive distribution agreements: • Term of the agreement: generally ranges from one to three years and one of the distribution agreements without specified term; some with automatic renewal clause of one year; – 102 – THIS APPLICATION PROOF IS IN DRAFT FORM. The information contained herein is incomplete and is subject to change. This Application Proof must be read in conjunction with the section headed “Warning” on the cover of this Application Proof. BUSINESS • Termination of agreement: in general, the distribution agreement would be terminated with immediate effect with or without notice if there is material breach of the terms of the agreement or in the event of bankruptcy, cessation of business, etc.; in some distribution agreements, either party can terminate the agreement by giving advance notice of three to six months; • Distribution territories and channels: Hong Kong and in some agreements, the distribution territories also cover Macau and online sales in the PRC; • Products: the agreements specify the respective brand(s) and kinds of product(s) to be distributed and managed by the Group; • Minimum purchase requirement: all except one brand owner imposed a minimum purchase requirement in the exclusive distribution agreements. If the Group fails to fulfil the minimum requirement, the brand owner is entitled to terminate the agreement or revoke the exclusivity rights. However, except for one agreement which requires the Group to pay 20% of the deficiency in guaranteed purchase amount, the Group is not liable to pay any compensation or damages to the brand owners under the agreement for non-fulfilment of the minimum purchase requirement. The Directors confirm that the Group was not aware of the situation that it had not met any of the minimum purchase requirements set by the brand owners during the Track Record Period and up to the Latest Practicable Date, which would otherwise lead to possible termination of the agreements or recovation of the exclusivity rights by the brand owners. • Recommended retail prices: a majority of the brand owners set recommended retail prices for the Group to follow. • Non-compete clause: most of the distribution agreements include a non-compete clause which prohibits the Group from selling products that are identical to, or performs same or similar functions to the products supplied by the brand owner. Once the exclusive distribution right is granted to the Group, the Group will devise marketing and promotion plan including the corresponding sales and distribution channel, arrange logistics and delivery services for these branded products. – 103 – THIS APPLICATION PROOF IS IN DRAFT FORM. The information contained herein is incomplete and is subject to change. This Application Proof must be read in conjunction with the section headed “Warning” on the cover of this Application Proof. BUSINESS Exclusively distributed brands and products As at the Latest Practicable Date, the Group has entered into exclusive distribution agreements with seven brand owners. The table below is a summary of the brands and products distributed by the Group on an exclusive basis: Brand Key products/ Key product series Silk’n Pulsed light hair removal device and beauty devices for anti-acne treatment, cleaning and rejuvenation of skin TriPollar Radio frequency (“RF”) treatment devices Bijouna Sonic brush, ion device, sonic device, mist spray device iGrow Laser hair rejuvenation helmet P.E.C Sonic Brush, nail polisher, dead skin removal, hair shaver Aduro LED silicon mask Hoii Anti-ultraviolet clothing products Reebok (fitness equipment) Treadmills, exercise bikes, elliptical trainers, fitness accessories Non-exclusively distribution brands and products The table below is a summary of the major brands and products distributed by the Group on a non-exclusive basis: Brand Key products/ Key product series Horizon Treadmills, exercise bikes, elliptical trainers La-fit Exercise bikes – 104 – THIS APPLICATION PROOF IS IN DRAFT FORM. The information contained herein is incomplete and is subject to change. This Application Proof must be read in conjunction with the section headed “Warning” on the cover of this Application Proof. BUSINESS (II) Sourcing of the Group’s Proprietary Products Apart from the distribution and sale of branded products, starting from 2007, the Group began to source fitness equipment and other health care products and develop its own proprietary brands, including “EnerGym” and “元氣達人”. The “EnerGym” collection offers small-sized or compact fitness equipment which is relatively convenient to store and requires less storage space. Major products under the “EnerGym” brand consist of foldable treadmills, exercise bikes and steppers. Products under the “元氣達人” brand include inflated bath tubs. Products under a previous brand which is owned by the Group, namely, “部屋達人”, included similar household products as the “元氣達人” brand and such brand was no longer in use as at the Latest Practicable Date. The Group does not have its own manufacturing facilities or production lines. These products are manufactured by external manufacturers located in the PRC or sourced from third party suppliers in Hong Kong or the PRC, and are delivered to the Group as finished products for distribution under the Group’s proprietary brands. For details of these external manufacturers, please refer to the sub-section headed “Suppliers” in this section. Product selection The sales and marketing team is responsible for sourcing products from the market based on their market research. The products identified should suit the market trend and consumer preference. Before selecting a product, the Group will evaluate the features and quality of the product, and identify if any improvement is required. The Group will also evaluate the major product manufacturer based on factors such as its operating history, reputation, scale of operation, production facilities and production capacity. The Group may visit the factory site to understand its production procedures, including the raw materials used and third party intellectual property rights involved. Cooperation with product manufacturer If the Group is satisfied with its preliminary check, the management team will negotiate with the product manufacturer on the terms of cooperation, such as unit price, quantity, quality requirements, packaging arrangement and delivery schedule. The Group normally places a smaller order with the product manufacturer first to test the initial market response. If the market response proves to be positive, the Group would consider placing a larger order with the product manufacturer. If the performance of the manufacturer is satisfactory to the Group and the relevant products are assessed to be popular, the Group may negotiate with the relevant manufacturer to enter into a framework agreement. This is intended to assure constant and steady supply of products from the product manufacturer, prevent infringement of the Group's proprietary products by the manufacturers, and exercise better control of product quality over the manufacturers. – 105 – THIS APPLICATION PROOF IS IN DRAFT FORM. The information contained herein is incomplete and is subject to change. This Application Proof must be read in conjunction with the section headed “Warning” on the cover of this Application Proof. BUSINESS As at the Latest Practicable Date, the Group and three external manufacturers entered into manufacturing framework agreements. Pursuant to these framework agreements, the parties will negotiate and agree in advance in respect of the manufacturing schedule for each order placed by the Group depending on the market conditions, including product specification, quantity, unit price, quality requirements, delivery time and place. Such terms will then be incorporated into an order form for the manufacturer to follow. Other salient terms of these manufacturing framework agreements include the following: • Unless with the Group’s prior written consent, the manufacturer shall not in any circumstance sub-contract the manufacturing process to any third party contractor(s), or supply to or manufacture the subject products(s) for any party (whether retailor or wholesaler) located in Hong Kong; • With prior notice, the Group has the right to visit the factory and production facilities, inspect the manufacturing standards and product quality, provide recommendations and confirm receipt of goods after quality inspection; • The intellectual property rights in respect of the subject product brand, including name, pattern and design of the brand, belong to the Group, and the manufacturer is prohibited from utilising such intellectual property rights without the prior consent of the Group or providing products bearing the same or similar brand features and trademarks to other parties; • If the manufacturer anticipates that it would terminate the production of the subject product(s) or that it would not be able to deliver the subject product(s) to the Group according to normal practice (including quantity and delivery time), it shall notify the Group as soon as possible in order to allow the Group to react promptly to adjust its business arrangements; – 106 – THIS APPLICATION PROOF IS IN DRAFT FORM. The information contained herein is incomplete and is subject to change. This Application Proof must be read in conjunction with the section headed “Warning” on the cover of this Application Proof. BUSINESS Quality control of the proprietary products All products will be delivered to the Group as finished products. Depending on the nature of the product, the Group may send its own quality control personnel to conduct quality control during the manufacturing process. Please refer to the paragraph headed “Quality control” in this section for more information. The table below is a summary of the Group’s proprietary products as at the Latest Practicable Date: Brand Key products/ Key product series Product features EnerGym Treadmill, exercise bike, stepper Foldable treadmill and space saving exercise bike and stepper 元氣達人 Inflated bathtub Space saving bathtub Retail price range HK$688HK$4,888 HK$338 Sales and after-sales activities As shown in the operation flowchart above, both branded products and proprietary products share the similar procedures from devising marketing and promotion plan to customer sales and after-sales services. Devising marketing and promotion plan For both branded and proprietary products, the Group generally tailors a marketing and promotion plan for each of the brand and product: • based on the product features and market acceptance in other territories, determine the market position of the product and the ultimate target consumers; • based on the perceived value of ultimate target consumers and with reference to the suggested selling price of brand owners (if for a branded product), set the price range; – 107 – THIS APPLICATION PROOF IS IN DRAFT FORM. The information contained herein is incomplete and is subject to change. This Application Proof must be read in conjunction with the section headed “Warning” on the cover of this Application Proof. BUSINESS • devise marketing and promotion campaign for the brand and the relevant product, such as designing and producing the advertising materials and promotion packages, placing advertisements in different media channels such as magazines, newspapers, public transportation displays and the internet; identifying appropriate events to provide sponsorship; identifying suitable celebrities as product/brand ambassador; and arranging other marketing and promotional activities; • continue monitoring the effectiveness of the marketing and promotional campaign, and making adjustment to marketing strategies if necessary, so as to achieve the intended brand/product image and market acceptance; The promotion and marketing activities for the branded products may be assisted by the brand owners through their provision of free samples and marketing materials for the Group’s marketing and promotion campaigns. The Group also implements a loyalty program pursuant to which consumers can join the Group’s membership scheme and enjoy certain discounts on future purchase when they have an accumulated spending over certain amounts as specified under the membership scheme. Protecting the intellectual property rights of the brand owners • The Group monitors the market to determine whether the intellectual property rights of the brand owners are being infringed by way of pirated or parallel imported good or any unauthorised usage of the brand logos; • necessary and appropriate actions will be taken against the infringers; and • the Group will keep the brand owners informed of the infringements. Expanding sales channels of the products • The Group will continue to develop and expand the sales networks of the products in both chain retailers and other distributors and retailers; • the Group will continue to gain more retail shelf spaces in various chain retailers; and • the Group will explore and expand into more e-commerce platforms and group buying channels. – 108 – THIS APPLICATION PROOF IS IN DRAFT FORM. The information contained herein is incomplete and is subject to change. This Application Proof must be read in conjunction with the section headed “Warning” on the cover of this Application Proof. BUSINESS Product delivery • Apart from its own logistics team, the Group also engages third party logistics providers to deliver its products to individual consumers or corporate customers such as retail chain stores, department stores or other distributors and retailers. After-sales services • The Group provides after-sales services such as responding to customer enquiries; and • for products which are sold by the Group on an exclusive basis, the Group generally offers its customers a one-year product warranty period, and the Group provides free maintenance services during the product warranty period. PRODUCTS Product segments The Group’s products can be classified into three segments, namely, fitness equipment and accessories, beauty gadgets and accessories, and other health care products. The table below sets out the breakdown of the Group’s turnover by product segment during the Track Record Period: For the year ended 31 December 2014 HK$’000 % Fitness equipment and accessories Beauty gadgets and accessories Other health care products Total For the year ended 31 December 2015 HK$’000 % 23,919 35.5 22,463 26.5 41,373 2,173 61.3 3.2 60,706 1,575 71.6 1.9 67,465 100.0 84,744 100.0 – 109 – THIS APPLICATION PROOF IS IN DRAFT FORM. The information contained herein is incomplete and is subject to change. This Application Proof must be read in conjunction with the section headed “Warning” on the cover of this Application Proof. BUSINESS Branded and proprietary products The table below sets out the relevant breakdown of the Group’s turnover during the Track Record Period attributable to products sold under brand owners’ brands and products sold under the Group’s proprietary brands. For the year ended 31 December 2014 HK$’000 % For the year ended 31 December 2015 HK$’000 % Branded products Proprietary products 60,888 6,577 90.3 9.7 79,777 4,967 94.1 5.9 Total 67,465 100.0 84,744 100.0 Fitness equipment and accessories The fitness equipment product segment mainly consists of treadmills, exercise bikes, elliptical trainers, steppers and other fitness accessories including trampolines, yoga gears, dumbbells, boxing gears, heart rate monitors and diagnostic scales. The following is a list of major fitness equipment products sold by the Group during the Track Record Period: Brand Year of launch by the Group Horizon 2008 Treadmills, exercise bikes, elliptical trainers HK$4,388HK$16,888 Reebok (fitness equipment) 2014 Treadmills, exercise bikes, elliptical trainers, fitness accessories HK$68HK$9,388 Key products/ Key products series Retail price range – 110 – Sample product pictures THIS APPLICATION PROOF IS IN DRAFT FORM. The information contained herein is incomplete and is subject to change. This Application Proof must be read in conjunction with the section headed “Warning” on the cover of this Application Proof. BUSINESS Brand Year of launch by the Group Key products/ Key products series Retail price range La-fit 2007 Exercise bikes HK$2,288HK$2,388 EnerGym 2007 Treadmills, steppers HK$688HK$4,888 Sample product pictures Beauty gadgets and accessories The beauty gadgets product segment mainly consists of beauty devices for hair removal, wrinkle reduction, skin lifting, anti-acne treatment, rejuvenation of skin’s appearance and body sliming. It also includes other beauty accessories such as hair care products and anti-ultraviolet clothings. The following is a list of major beauty gadgets products sold by the Group during the Track Record Period: Brand Year of launch by the Group TriPollar 2012 Key products/ Key products series Radio frequency (“RF”) treatment devices Purpose Retail price range RF skin tightening HK$2,988and cellulite reduction HK$3,988 – 111 – Sample product pictures THIS APPLICATION PROOF IS IN DRAFT FORM. The information contained herein is incomplete and is subject to change. This Application Proof must be read in conjunction with the section headed “Warning” on the cover of this Application Proof. BUSINESS Brand Year of launch by the Group Silk’n 2010 Pulsed light hair removal device and beauty devices for anti-acne treatment, cleaning and rejuvenation of skin Pulse light hair HK$988removal, sonic HK$3,888 cleansing, pulse light anti-acne, skin rejuvenation and skin tightening Bijouna 2014 Sonic brush, ion device, sonic device, mist spray device Sonic hair brushing, HK$288cleansing, facial HK$1,288 massage, sonic and ion skin rejuvenation P.E.C 2014 Sonic Brush, nail polisher, dead skin removal, hair shaver Sonic hair brushing, nail polishing, dead skin removing, hair shaving HK$198HK$299 iGrow 2012 Laser hair rejuvenation helmet Low-level light therapy for hair rejuvenation HK$5,988 Aduro 2015 LED silicone mask Skin rejuvenation and HK$1,288wrinkle reduction HK$1,988 Hoii 2014 Anti-ultraviolet clothing products Transforming harmful HK$588ultraviolet light to HK$1,688 beneficial light for skin Key products/ Key products series Purpose – 112 – Retail price range Sample product pictures THIS APPLICATION PROOF IS IN DRAFT FORM. The information contained herein is incomplete and is subject to change. This Application Proof must be read in conjunction with the section headed “Warning” on the cover of this Application Proof. BUSINESS Other health care products The other health care products mainly consist of massage devices, inflated bath tubs and limb-support compression wears. SALES AND DISTRIBUTION CHANNELS The Group distributes and sells all products through various sales and distribution channels, including the Group’s own retail outlets (retail shops, shopping mall booth and department store counter) and retail websites, chain retailers, e-commerce platforms, group buying channels and other distributors and retailers. Set out below is a breakdown of the Group’s turnover by distribution channels during the Track Record Period: Year ended 31 December 2014 HK$’000 % Direct sales Physical stores: Own retail shops (note 1) Department store counter and shopping mall booth Franchised stores (note 2) Online stores: Own websites (note 3) Third party e-commerce platforms Group buying platforms Indirect sales Chain retailers Other distributors and retailers (note 4) Total Year ended 31 December 2015 HK$’000 % 24,215 35.9 31,544 37.2 3,048 7,051 4.5 10.5 3,128 842 3.7 1.0 1,316 1.9 1,539 1.8 7,692 1,353 11.4 2.0 16,174 3,605 19.1 4.2 7,365 10.9 7,676 9.1 15,425 22.9 20,236 23.9 67,465 100.0 84,744 100.0 Notes: 1. The figures under this category also included (i) the Group’s hotline sales through its hotline staff; and (ii) sales in trade fairs and exhibitions. Hotline sales also included customer orders made online with settlement by cash on delivery. 2. The franchised stores were all located in Hong Kong and operated by staff of the Group assigned to work in the stores. 3. The figures only comprised those online sales with settlement made through online payment system. 4. The figures included sales to related parties who in turn sold the Group’s products on their own online storefronts of an e-commerce platform. For details, please refer to the sub-paragraph headed “Sales and distribution channels – Sales to other distributors and retailers — Sales to related parties” in this section. – 113 – THIS APPLICATION PROOF IS IN DRAFT FORM. The information contained herein is incomplete and is subject to change. This Application Proof must be read in conjunction with the section headed “Warning” on the cover of this Application Proof. BUSINESS Set out below is a breakdown of the Group’s turnover by geographical region during the Track Record Period, based on location of customers: Year ended 31 December 2014 HK$’000 (I) % Year ended 31 December 2015 HK$’000 % Hong Kong The PRC 50,843 16,622 75.4 24.6 64,527 20,217 76.1 23.9 Total 67,465 100.0 84,744 100.0 Direct Sales Own retail outlets network As at the Latest Practicable Date, the Group had seven retail outlets (five retail shops, one shopping mall booth and one department store counter) located in Hong Kong directly operated by the Group. All retail outlets directly operated by the Group are presently located on leased premises. For details of the rental arrangements, please refer to the sub-section headed “Properties” in this section. The Group had eight, seven and seven retail outlets (including franchised stores) as of 31 December 2014 and 2015 and the Latest Practicable Date respectively. All of the retail outlets are operated under the “Fitboxx 元氣館” trade name. The following table sets forth the respective locations, types of the outlets, estimated gross floor areas, and types of premises of the retail outlets currently in operation as at the Latest Practicable Date. Location Hong Kong Island: Causeway Bay Quarry Bay Type of the outlet Approximate gross floor area (sq.m.) Type of the premises Own shop Shopping mall booth 111 59 Store on street-level Shopping mall 53 25 Shopping mall Shopping mall Mongkok Own shop Department store counter Own shop 93 Commercial building New Territories: Tsuen Wan Yuen Long Own shop Own shop 112 41 Shopping mall Store on street-level Kowloon: Diamond Hill Kowloon Bay – 114 – THIS APPLICATION PROOF IS IN DRAFT FORM. The information contained herein is incomplete and is subject to change. This Application Proof must be read in conjunction with the section headed “Warning” on the cover of this Application Proof. BUSINESS The Directors considers identifying a suitable location for the retail outlets to be crucial to the Group’s success and to maximising the Group’s revenue. Most of the Group’s existing retail outlets are situated at or close to high-traffic or populated locations such as shopping malls, department stores and residential areas. Factors that the Group takes into account in selecting a new retail outlet site would include the accessibility of the potential site to the target customers, spending patterns of the target customers, geographic coverage of the site compared to that of the existing stores, size of the premises, nature of surrounding shops and rental expenses. In contrast with the Group’s self-operated retail shops and the shopping mall booth, the Group does not retain direct control over the sales proceeds received in connection with the sales transacted at the self-operated department store counter located in a department store in Kowloon Bay. Instead, all proceeds are collected by the grantor (being the department store) of a license arrangement for the use of the department store counter by the Group, subject to deduction of a license fee before being disbursed to the Group on a monthly basis generally within 30 days of the issuance of a monthly statement. In respect of the self-operated shopping mall booth, it is a specified area granted to be used by the Group under a license agreement with the landlord of the shopping mall. The Directors confirm that during the Track Record Period, there were no instances of material disputes with any of the grantors of the Group’s licensing arrangements in relation to the terms of the respective licensing agreements and the amount of sales proceeds, nor did the Group experience any material default in collecting the net sales proceeds from the said Kowloon Bay department store. The Group also receives hotline sales orders from customers who place orders via the Group’s sales hotline. Such orders also include those made online but with settlement by cash on delivery. Franchised stores During the Track Record Period, the Group had three franchised stores located in Kowloon Bay, Diamond Hill and Yuen Long respectively. The purposes of adopting the franchise model was to enhance the Group’s market presence and to increase sales volume, at the same time to incur less set-up and operating costs at the initial stage of the Group’s business development. Under the franchise arrangements, the rental and other operating costs were borne by the franchisees. However the franchised stores were under full control of the Group whereby the sales staff were employed by the Group to work in the franchised stores with their salaries reimbursed by the franchisees together with other operation costs paid by the Group on behalf of the franchised stores, on a monthly basis. Moreover, all sales proceeds of the shops were received by the Group which it then paid the pre-agreed percentages of the sales proceeds of different products to the franchisees as agency fees. – 115 – THIS APPLICATION PROOF IS IN DRAFT FORM. The information contained herein is incomplete and is subject to change. This Application Proof must be read in conjunction with the section headed “Warning” on the cover of this Application Proof. BUSINESS Therefore, the franchised stores were regarded as self-operated stores and all sales proceeds by the franchised stores were treated as turnover of the Group. In November 2013, the Group opened its own retail outlet at a department store counter in a shopping mall in Kowloon Bay. Upon the business of the said retail outlet had been gradually on the track, the Group mutually agreed with the relevant franchisee to terminate the franchised store operation in Kowloon Bay in May 2014. In September 2014, the franchise arrangement in respect of the franchised store in Diamond Hill was terminated upon mutual agreement between the Group and the relevant franchisee. The Group continued to use the same shop premises as its own retail store. In March 2015, the franchise arrangement in respect of the franchised store in Yuen Long was terminated upon mutual agreement between the Group and the relevant franchisee. In May 2015, the Group continued to use the same shop premises as its own retail store. The Directors confirm that there was no disagreement nor dispute between the Group and the relevant franchisees due to the termination of the franchise agreements. As at the Latest Practicable Date, the Group did not have any subsisting franchise agreement. Own websites — online sales in Hong Kong The Group currently operates two retail websites, namely, www.fitboxx.com & www.cosmoboxx.com in Hong Kong, which allow the customers to view and/or purchase the Group’s products online. The Group’s retail websites contain the following information and features: • Comprehensive product information: each product webpage contains pictures of the product, the price and a detailed introduction of the product’s specifications and functions. In order to promote the products in an attractive way, the product webpage may also contains showcases presented by way of television commercials, advertisements on printed media, demonstration videos and customer review videos. • Online question and answer section: customers can submit their questions or queries through the retail websites. Then the customer services staff of the Group will reply to their questions by emails. Frequently asked questions and answers are also listed out on the websites for the customers’ easy reference. – 116 – THIS APPLICATION PROOF IS IN DRAFT FORM. The information contained herein is incomplete and is subject to change. This Application Proof must be read in conjunction with the section headed “Warning” on the cover of this Application Proof. BUSINESS • Online order system: customers can place orders for the products online. They can choose to pay by credit cards online or by cash upon delivery. For purchases of more than HK$300, the Group provides free delivery. After receipt of the orders, the customer services staff of the Group will contact the customers to arrange for delivery. The Directors believe these user-friendly retail websites address customer ’s desire to view and understand the products before purchasing. The Directors also believe that the retail websites would help stimulating viewers’ interest and attract customers to visit the Group’s retail stores. The physical retail stores, combined with online retail websites, are aimed to provide an integrated shopping experience to the consumers for the sales and promotion of the Group’s products. Third party e-commerce platforms Online sales in Hong Kong In 2010, The Group entered into a cooperation agreement with a credit card company which provides an online shopping platform for its credit card holders in Hong Kong. According to the agreement, the credit card company is mainly responsible for the production and printing of the promotional materials, approving credit card payment transactions and handling online orders from its credit card members; while the Group is mainly responsible for the supply and direct delivery of the ordered products, and provision of after-sales service to those online buyers. The online storefront is named “Fitboxx 元氣館” and sells various kinds of fitness equipment and accessories, beauty gadgets and accessories, and other health care products. The sales proceeds, after deduction of the agreed percentage of commission and other charges payable, will be reimbursed to the Group from the credit card company within one month in general. In 2015, the Group entered into another cooperation agreement with an online shopping platform operator which provides an online marketplace facilitating the sale, purchase, and promotion of multifarious goods and services between merchants and online buyers in Hong Kong. According to the agreement, the platform operator is mainly responsible for maintaining the design, layout and features of the online shopping platform, running regular marketing and promotional campaigns on the platform, and handling the delivery (depending on product types) of the online customer orders; while the Group is mainly responsible for the supply and delivery (depending on product types) of the ordered products, and provision of after-sales service to those online buyers. The online storefront is named “Fitboxx 元氣館” and sells various kinds of fitness equipment and accessories, beauty gadgets and accessories, and other health care products. The online buyers are required to settle payments by credit cards and the sales proceeds are held by the platform operator through the relevant escrow agents of the credit card companies. The sales proceeds, after deduction of the agreed percentage of – 117 – THIS APPLICATION PROOF IS IN DRAFT FORM. The information contained herein is incomplete and is subject to change. This Application Proof must be read in conjunction with the section headed “Warning” on the cover of this Application Proof. BUSINESS commission and other charges payable, will be reimbursed to the Group from the platform operator within one month in general. Online sales in the PRC Since 2011, the Group started to sell beauty gadgets and accessories by way of distribution arrangements through online storefronts set up by certain related parties on an e-commerce platform namely, Taobao, in the PRC. As advised by the Directors, competition in respect of the fitness equipment market is keen in the PRC, with a considerable number of established brands and distributors competing in the market over product design and price. Moreover, the Directors consider that the delivery logistics of fitness equipment is inconvenient. Therefore, the Group’s fitness equipment are not sold through e-commerce platforms in the PRC. Upon familiarising with the operation of online marketplace and the market potential in the PRC through the related parties, the Group set up its own storefronts on an e-commence platform, namely, Tmall, since 2013, while continued to maintain the distribution arrangements with the related parties in order to gain more market presence of its products. In April 2015, the Group ceased the distribution arrangements with the related parties in order to enhance its corporate image and consolidate its market presence. As at the Latest Practicable Date, the Group maintained three storefronts on Tmall. The Group also sells beauty gadgets to other distributors which operate e-commerce platforms in the PRC. The following table sets forth the respective name of the storefront on Tmall, year of launch and major products sold of the storefronts which were operated by the Group as at the Latest Practicable Date: Name of storefront Year of launch Major products sold Cosmosboxx 海外旗艦店 Hoii旗艦店 2013 Silk’n偉博專賣店 2013 Beauty gadgets and accessories of various brands Beauty gadgets and accessories of various brands Beauty gadgets under the “Silk’n” brand, which mainly consist of hair removal device and beauty devices for anti-acne treatment, cleaning and rejuvenation of skin 2015 As provided under the framework agreement with Tmall, the Group is required to pay a commission, at a rate depending on the product category, out of the total sales amounts settled through the payment system of the marketplace. An additional commission based on the total sales amounts would also be charged if the Group joins the specific product promotional activities launched by Tmall. The Group also subscribes online marketing services to direct viewer traffic to certain of its storefronts. – 118 – THIS APPLICATION PROOF IS IN DRAFT FORM. The information contained herein is incomplete and is subject to change. This Application Proof must be read in conjunction with the section headed “Warning” on the cover of this Application Proof. BUSINESS In a typical sales transaction, the consumer may pay the purchase price by credit cards or through Tmall marketplace’s online payment system known as “Alipay” (“支付寶”). All transactions are ultimately settled through Alipay. The marketplace releases the payments from Alipay to the Group only when the consumer has confirmed receipt of goods and is in satisfactory condition or when the consumer does not object to the releases of the payments with a specified time period. After the customer ’s order is confirmed, the Group will engage third-party logistics company to execute the delivery of products ordered. The logistics company picks up the package from the Group and delivers the package directly to the buyer ’s door or to pick-up stations selected by the consumer. The sales activities of the Group on Tmall are regulated by its marketplace rules, including consumer protection programmes, return and exchange policy and dispute reporting procedures. Consumers on Tmall may return the purchased goods within seven days if there are quality issues. The freight costs of the returned goods and exchange goods will be borne by the Group. In case of disputes, both the buyer and the seller can report to Tmall and ask their customer service staff to intervene and assist to resolve the disputes. The Group is also required to contribute to and maintain a consumer protection fund in the amount ranges from approximately HK$180,000 to HK$480,000, depending on the features of the storefronts, for the benefits of the individual customers. If the Group fails to perform its obligations against the consumer, Tmall may use this fund to compensate the consumer. Group buying platforms The Group also engaged three, three and three online group buying platforms in Hong Kong during the two years ended 31 December 2015 and as at the Latest Practicable Date respectively to provide group buying services which offer the Group’s certain products to online customer traffic for boosting sales and achieving promotional effect. Under the group buying arrangements, the Group offers different products at discounted prices and at limited quantities for specified period, usually a few weeks, by selling redemption vouchers on such online platforms, which are exchangeable into goods by presentation of the vouchers at designated shops of the Group. (II) Indirect Sales Sales through chain retailers The Group provides its products to chain retailers, which display the products of the Group in their stores for sales to the general public. As at the Latest Practicable Date, the Group co-operated with four chain retailers and established over 150 points of sales through their extensive sales network in Hong Kong. These chain retailers include two chain retailers of electronic products, a chain retailer of cosmetic products and a chain retailer of pharmaceutical, health and beauty products. – 119 – THIS APPLICATION PROOF IS IN DRAFT FORM. The information contained herein is incomplete and is subject to change. This Application Proof must be read in conjunction with the section headed “Warning” on the cover of this Application Proof. BUSINESS The chain retailers place purchase orders generally on a replenishment basis and the Group supply products to them accordingly by delivering the products to the warehouses or stores designated by the chain retailers from time to time. The retail prices of the Group’s products are recommended by the Group and finally determined by the chain retailers. The Group provides products to the chain retailers under two kinds of arrangements: consignment arrangement or non-consignment arrangement. (1) Under the consignment arrangement, the Group provides its products for sale on a consignment basis where the ownership of the goods delivered to the chain retailers belongs to the Group before they are sold by the chain retailers. After the consigned goods are sold, the relevant chain retailers will provide the Group with details of the goods sold on a monthly basis. The consignment fees charged by the chain retailers are generally represented by the difference between the pre-determined retail prices and the pre-agreed discounted prices for the goods purchased from the Group for resale to customers of the chain retailers, and the pre-agreed discounted prices are determined based on a fixed percentage of or discounted amount on the retail prices of consigned goods. After deducting the payable consignment fees (i.e. the profit margin charged by the chain retailers) and other commissions and charges, if any, the chain retailers will pay the balance of the sales proceeds to the Group. (2) Under the non-consignment arrangement, the Group directly sells its products to the chain retailers. The Group invoices the chain retailers at wholesale prices, which is recognised as revenue of the Group when the products are accepted by the chain retailers after delivery of the products to their respective warehouses or stores. Thus, when the products are sold to the general public at the chain retailers, the proceeds of sales belong to them. However, the chain retailers are entitled to return unsold goods purchased from the Group according to the relevant terms of the distribution agreements. As at the Latest Practicable Date, the Group had distribution arrangements with two chain retailers under the consignment arrangements and two chain retailers under the non-consignment arrangement. The Group generally enters into master supply agreements with the chain retailers using the standard agreements and/or forms prescribed by them on an annual basis. One of these master supply agreements specifies annual target purchase amounts whereby, if the annual target purchase amounts are met, the relevant chain retailer will be entitled to certain rebates specified in the master supply agreement. Some master supply agreements also specify certain terms such as delivery, payment, discounts and/or rebates payable to the chain retailers, promotion and return policy. The Group generally does not set any initial purchase requirements or minimum purchase requirements for the chain retailers. – 120 – THIS APPLICATION PROOF IS IN DRAFT FORM. The information contained herein is incomplete and is subject to change. This Application Proof must be read in conjunction with the section headed “Warning” on the cover of this Application Proof. BUSINESS Rebates and allowances to the chain retailers The Group offers rebates and allowances (other than discount on retail price for the purchase cost of goods supplied by the Group on consignment basis) to the chain retailers. The Group will give certain rebates to the chain retailers based on the amount of goods purchased by the chain retailers. Such rebates will then be paid by the chain retailers at their own discretion to their salespersons as incentive. This arrangement is intended to boost the sales volume when the Group promotes a particular kind of product or intends to clear the stock of that product. Occasionally, the Group will offer promotional campaigns to the chain retailers and offer extra discounts on its products during the promotion period. The amounts of the discount, rebate or allowance are determined on case by case basis after taking into account of (i) the negotiation between the chain retailers and the Group; and (ii) the market sentiment in the relevant period. Sales to other distributors and retailers To benefit from local market knowledge and expertise and to expand the Group’s network of product coverage at minimal costs into areas where the Group does not have presence, the Group also sells its products directly to other distributors and retailers in Hong Kong and the PRC. For the two years ended 31 December 2015, the Group sold goods to over 20 and 25 other distributors and retailers in Hong Kong and the PRC, which also included sales to certain corporate customers such as fitness centre, beauty salon and healthcare clinic. The Group selects the distributors and retailers based on, among others, their business scale, distribution network, payment terms and reputation. Relationship with other distributors and retailers The sales of the Group’s products are generally made on a wholesale basis to the other distributors and retailers, who then resell the products (i) to consumers mainly through various channels including online storefronts of e-commerce platforms which they operate, or (ii) to their wholesale customers, who then resell the products to consumers through their respective retail channels. Except for a distributor which operates its own online storefronts on an e-commerce platform and has entered into a distribution agreement with the Group, the Group’s sales to its other distributors and retailers are conducted on an order-by-order basis without entering into any distribution agreement with them. The Group does not have any contractual relationships with the wholesale customers of its distributors and have no direct control over their respective distribution channels. Except as disclosed under the sub-paragraphs headed “Sales partner traded under the Group’s trade name” and “Sales to related parties” below, all of the Group’s other distributors and retailers during the Track Record Period are Independent Third Parties. – 121 – THIS APPLICATION PROOF IS IN DRAFT FORM. The information contained herein is incomplete and is subject to change. This Application Proof must be read in conjunction with the section headed “Warning” on the cover of this Application Proof. BUSINESS The Group’s relationship with a distributor which operates its own online storefronts is governed by a distribution agreement with the following key terms: Term: one year Retail price: determined by the distributor with reference to the Group’s own retail prices Operational control: except for determined the Group activities of Termination: terminable by either party by giving three months’ prior notice to the other sales period of the products to be after consultation between both parties, does not have control over the sales the distributor Irrespective of whether there is distribution or other cooperation agreement with such other distributors and retailers, products are purchased from the Group and paid in full by the distributors and retailers as buyer on an order-by-order basis. Generally, except for defective goods, there is no product return policy. As it is a policy of the Group to prevent stock accumulation, it will assess the sales and inventory levels of the distributors and retailers by reviewing the amount of orders placed by them and communication with them for any unusualness. Sales partner traded under the Group’s trade name Since September 2011, the Group had authorised its marketing manager to open a shop in Macau and sell the Group’s products in the shop under the trade name of “Fit Boxx 元氣館” in order to open up a new distribution channel in Macau, under which the Macau shop was operated by the marketing manager who purchased products from the Group as a distributor. The relationship between the Macau shop and the Group is one of buyer and seller, while the marketing manager continued to be a staff of the Group during the period of operation of his own business of running the Macau shop. In April 2015, as the marketing manager considered the Macau business was not satisfactory and intended to concentrate on the Group’s marketing activities in Hong Kong, the parties mutually agreed to terminate the buyer and seller relationship and the Macau shop had closed down. Having taken into consideration of the fact that (i) the Group has no prior experience in running retail store in Macau; (ii) opening the Group’s own retail store in Macau involves capital investment; and (iii) the sales to the store in Macau only contributed approximately 1.1% and 0.2% to the turnover of the Group during the Track Record Period, the Directors considered that establishing its own retail location in Macau might not be of imminent need for the Group’s business development at this stage. The Group currently has no plan to open a retail store in Macau after the termination of the physical distribution channel in Macau. – 122 – THIS APPLICATION PROOF IS IN DRAFT FORM. The information contained herein is incomplete and is subject to change. This Application Proof must be read in conjunction with the section headed “Warning” on the cover of this Application Proof. BUSINESS Sales to related parties During the Track Record Period, the Group sold its products to the following related parties who in turn, to the best knowledge of the Directors, sold such products at online storefronts on an e-commerce platform, namely, Taobao, which were registered in the related parties’ own names, on an indent basis: Related parties Relationship with the Group Ms. Cao Xiaowei Mr. Li Wife of Mr. Chan Director and a controlling Shareholder Mother-in-law of Mr. Chan Ms. Zhu Zhengfang Sales for the year ended 31 December 2014 2015 HK$’000 HK$’000 6,032 250 1,278 14 1,114 123 The reason for the online sales through the above related parties was due to the fact that the Group was yet to familiarise with the operation of online marketplace and market potential in the PRC before it formally stepped into the PRC market in 2013 by setting up its first online storefront on Tmall. Therefore, in order to increase the online market presence of its products in the PRC, the Group commenced the sales of its products to the related parties since 2011, who in turn sold the products through their own Taobao storefronts, and the prices of the products sold by the Group to the related parties were generally the same as the online retail prices which the related parties sold to their online customers during the Track Record Period. Upon familiarizing with the operation of online marketplace and market potential in the PRC through the related parties, the Group set up its first own online storefront on Tmall in 2013. Moreover, since the Group considered that direct online sales by the Group was gradually on track, the Group ceased the distribution relationship with the related parties in April 2015 in order to enhance its corporate image and consolidate its market presence. – 123 – THIS APPLICATION PROOF IS IN DRAFT FORM. The information contained herein is incomplete and is subject to change. This Application Proof must be read in conjunction with the section headed “Warning” on the cover of this Application Proof. BUSINESS Management of distribution network The following table illustrates the number of distributors with which the Group had entered into distribution or other cooperation agreements, during the Track Record Period and up to the Latest Practicable Date: For the year ended 31 December 2014 2015 Chain retailers Other distributors and retailers 4 nil 4 1 Up to the Latest Practicable Date 4 1 To the best knowledge of the Directors, there were no instances of material disputes with the distributors and retailers, or material non-compliance with the terms of the distribution or cooperation agreements (if any) by the Group or any of the distributors or retailers during the Track Record Period. The table below set forth the amount of goods unsold and returned (other than defective goods) from the above distributors during the Track Record Period: Year end 31 December 2014 2015 HK$’000 HK$’000 Goods returned from chain retailers nil 34 The Group has no ownership or managerial control over any of the distribution networks of its distributors, irrespective of whether the Group has entered into distribution agreements or other cooperation agreements with them. Distribution networks of the Group’s products are owned and managed by its distributors and the wholesale customers of the Group’s distributors (which include third-party retailers and sub-distributors). The Group also does not have direct day-to-day access to the sales and inventory levels of its distributors and points of sales operated by them as well as the third-party retailers with whom they contract. The Group does not have contractual relationships with the wholesale customers of the Group’s distributors, such as third-party retailers and sub-distributors, of its distributors. The Group relies on its distributors to monitor the business behaviour of their own wholesale customers. Excluding the sales to related parties, the Group’s sales to other distributors and retailers accounted for only 11.5% and 22.2% of its turnover for the two years ended 31 December 2015, the majority amount of which, to the best knowledge of the Directors, comprised sales to distributors which were engaged in online retail business. As such, except for understanding the business nature of such distributors and retailer, generally reviewing of orders and communication with them for any unusualness, the Group did not implement any other means to monitor and evaluate the sales performance or inventory levels of the distribution networks of such distributors and retailers. – 124 – THIS APPLICATION PROOF IS IN DRAFT FORM. The information contained herein is incomplete and is subject to change. This Application Proof must be read in conjunction with the section headed “Warning” on the cover of this Application Proof. BUSINESS During the Track Record Period, save as disclosed above, the Group had not received any request for and had no material sales returns (other than defective goods) from those distributors with distribution or other cooperation agreements, and continually received orders from them. In addition, through regular contact with such distributors by the Group’s sales and marketing team, nothing has caused the Directors to believe that the increase, if any, in the Group’s sales to those distributors during the Track Record Period was due to the accumulation of inventories at the distributors. The Directors consider that the Group’s chain retailer customers are well-known retailers in Hong Kong with extensive retail shop networks selling a wide variety of consumer goods with similar products from various brand owners and as such, the possibility of cannibalisation among themselves in respect of the Group’s products is remote. However, the Directors believe certain chain retailer customers would, for the sake of avoiding potential cannibalisation, request for exclusivity for designated brands or categories of product supplied to them, to the exclusion of other chain retailer competitors. In such case, the Group may agree to such request depending on the number of retail shops designated by the chain retailer to promote the subject brands or products. As to those distributors which operate online storefronts on e-commerce platforms in the PRC or distribute the products in the PRC through other channels, the possibility of cannibalisation with the Group’s chain retailer customers, which are all located in Hong Kong, or among themselves in respect of the Group’s products is also considered by the Directors to be remote due to their different operating location with different customer groups and the fact that the PRC market is too huge to consider the effect of cannibalisation. Furthermore, the Group would, if possible, enquire its distributors (other than chain retailers and operators of online retail platforms) the geographical locations of the ultimate points of sales, both of the distributors themselves and their wholesale customers. Through taking awareness of the locations in which the Group’s distributors and their wholesale customers establish the points of sales, the Group would minimise possible cannibalisation and competition among its distributors. The Group’s distributors are managed by its sales and marketing team which manages the relationships with the distributors in accordance with the distribution or other cooperation agreements (if any) and internal sales and marketing policy. The Group will monitor and evaluate the performance of its distributors from time to time. Such monitoring and evaluation form the basis of whether it would continue the business relationships with its distributors or to adjust the business scales with them. – 125 – THIS APPLICATION PROOF IS IN DRAFT FORM. The information contained herein is incomplete and is subject to change. This Application Proof must be read in conjunction with the section headed “Warning” on the cover of this Application Proof. BUSINESS SUPPLIERS Relationship with suppliers Suppliers of the Group include (i) brand owners for branded products; and (ii) manufacturers for its major proprietary products. For each of the two years ended 31 December 2015, the Group engaged over ten and ten major brand owners respectively for its branded products, and three and four manufacturers respectively for its major proprietary products. As at the Latest Practicable Date, the Group entered into exclusive distribution agreements with seven brand owners for branded products generally for a term of one to three years, and the purchase price for the products is generally negotiated between individual brand owners and the Group on an annual basis subject to adjustments by the brand owners with at least 30-90 days’ notice. For details of the exclusive distribution agreement entered into with the brand owners, please refer to the paragraph headed “Operating flow – Sourcing of branded products” in this section. The Directors confirm that the Group had not experienced any termination of distribution agreements by brand owners up to the Latest Practicable Date. Manufacturers for proprietary products are mainly third party manufacturers in the PRC to which the Group outsources the production of its proprietary products. The Group had not entered into any contractual arrangements with the manufacturers for the production of the proprietary products during the Track Record Period. The Group generally places purchase orders for a particular kind of product when needed. In February 2016, the Group entered into cooperation framework agreements with three major manufacturers, in order to ensure quality control, stable supply and prevention of possible infringement of intellectual property rights of the major proprietary products. According to the terms of the cooperation framework agreements, the manufacturers are required to ensure, among others, product quality, delivery terms, and exclusivity of products supplied to the Group. The Group’s five largest suppliers during the Track Record Period are all Independent Third Parties. The purchases from the top five suppliers amounted to approximately HK$20.5 million and HK$17.4 million respectively, representing approximately 71.3% and 69.9% of total purchases for the two years ended 31 December 2015. The purchases from the largest supplier amounted to approximately HK$9.6 million and HK$7.9 million respectively, representing approximately 33.4% and 31.8% of total purchases for the two years ended 31 December 2015 respectively. – 126 – THIS APPLICATION PROOF IS IN DRAFT FORM. The information contained herein is incomplete and is subject to change. This Application Proof must be read in conjunction with the section headed “Warning” on the cover of this Application Proof. BUSINESS During the Track Record Period, the Group’s business is considerably relied on the sales of a few series of branded beauty gadget products supplied by two brand owners in Israel. The aggregate amount of purchases from these two suppliers accounted for approximately 51.7% and 49.8% of the Group’s total purchases for the two years ended 31 December 2015. In order to mitigate the effect of concentration risk of reliance on a few major suppliers, a particular product segment or territory of the suppliers, it is the Group’s policy to continuously explore the opportunity to introduce new branded products for all of the Group’s product segments from worldwide suppliers, irrespective of whether the supplies are on an exclusive or non-exclusive basis. Please also refer to the paragraph headed “Risk Factors — Risk relating to the Group and its business — The Group is relied on the supply of products by major suppliers” in this document for details. The following tables set forth certain information about the Group’s top five suppliers during the Track Record Period: For the year ended 31 December 2014 Supplier Principal business Location Supplier A Manufacturing of beauty devices Israel Supplier B Manufacturing of beauty devices Manufacturing of electrical appliances and beauty devices Manufacturing of fitness equipment and accessories Manufacturing of beauty devices Israel Supplier C Supplier D Supplier E Japan Type of products sold to the Group Typical credit terms Hair removal Within 60 days and skin care after delivery devices Skin care Full payment in devices advance Hair and skin Within 14 days care devices after delivery Business relationship Amount of since purchase (%) 2010 33.4 2012 18.3 2014 6.8 Taiwan Exercise bikes Full payment upon 2007 delivery 6.7 United States Full payment upon 2012 Hair delivery rejuvenation device 6.1 – 127 – THIS APPLICATION PROOF IS IN DRAFT FORM. The information contained herein is incomplete and is subject to change. This Application Proof must be read in conjunction with the section headed “Warning” on the cover of this Application Proof. BUSINESS For the year ended 31 December 2015 Supplier Principal business Location Supplier A Manufacturing of beauty devices Israel Supplier B Supplier F Supplier G Supplier D Type of products sold to the Group Typical credit terms Hair removal Within 60 days and skin care after delivery devices Manufacturing of Israel Skin care 50% payment in beauty devices devices advance; 50% payment within 60 days after shipment Distribution of fitness Hong Kong Treadmills, Within 15 days equipment exercise after shipment bikes and elliptical trainers Distribution of fitness Hong Kong Treadmills and Within 30 days after delivery equipment elliptical trainers Taiwan Exercise bikes Full payment upon Manufacturing of fitness equipment delivery and accessories Business relationship Amount of since purchase (%) 2010 31.8 2012 18.1 2014 7.2 2008 6.7 2007 6.2 Background of the top five suppliers Supplier A (brand owner of “Silk’n”) is a developer and manufacturer of various types of beauty devices under the same brand of “Silk’n”, with distribution networks located worldwide. The major products include pulsed light hair removal device and beauty devices for anti-ance treatment, cleaning and rejuvenation of skin. Supplier B (brand owner of “Tripollar”) is a developer and manufacturer of various types of beauty devices under a few brands, with distribution networks located worldwide. It is specialised in the development of beauty devices using the technology of radio frequency for skin tightening and cellulite reduction. Supplier C (brand owner of “Bijouna” and “P.E.C”) is an appliances manufacturer and original equipment manufacturer supplier for well-known brands of electrical appliances. It designs, manufactures and wholesales electrical and household appliances. Its products include televisions, radios, kitchen appliances, audio equipment, air conditioners, lighting products, and beauty devices for hair and skin care. Supplier D (brand owner of “La-fit”) is a manufacturer of fitness equipment and accessories. Its export markets are mainly Asian countries. – 128 – THIS APPLICATION PROOF IS IN DRAFT FORM. The information contained herein is incomplete and is subject to change. This Application Proof must be read in conjunction with the section headed “Warning” on the cover of this Application Proof. BUSINESS Supplier E (brand owner of “iGrow ”) is a developer and manufacturer of beauty devices for skin treatment and hair rejuvenation, using low-level light therapy technology. Supplier F (brand owner of “Reebok” (fitness equipment)) is a distributor of fitness equipment for famous sports brands. Supplier G (brand owner of “Horizon”) is a distributor of fitness equipment for its parent company which is a manufacuturer of fitness equipment based in Taiwan with sales market worldwide. None of the Directors, their associates, or any Shareholders who owned more than 5% of the share capital of the Company as at the Latest Practicable Date had any interest in any of the five largest suppliers during the Track Record Period. Payments to suppliers are generally made within 60 days upon delivery of goods from suppliers, and are generally settled either by telegraphic transfers or cheque payments. During the two years ended 31 December 2015, approximately 82.7% and 81.1%, respectively of the purchases from the Group’s suppliers were denominated and settled in US dollars, approximately 14.1% and 16.0%, respectively were denominated and settled in Hong Kong dollars, and the remaining purchases were denominated and settled in Renminbi and other currencies. CUSTOMERS Customers of the Group The Group’s products target the general consumer market in Hong Kong and the PRC. In respect of the fitness equipment segment, the Group’s products mainly target general consumers of both genders aged between 25 to 50 who are health conscious and appearance conscious. In respect of the beauty gadgets segment, the Group’s products mainly target the female consumers aged between 25 to 50 who are appearance conscious, eager to try novel and trendy products, and are willing to pay for premium price in return for quality products. The Group’s customers can generally be classified as follows: (i) ultimate-consumers who purchase products through the Group’s own retail outlets, own retail websites and third party storefronts on the e-commerce platforms (including group buying platforms); (ii) chain retailers which sell the Group’s products directly to ultimate consumers in Hong Kong through their points of sales networks; and – 129 – THIS APPLICATION PROOF IS IN DRAFT FORM. The information contained herein is incomplete and is subject to change. This Application Proof must be read in conjunction with the section headed “Warning” on the cover of this Application Proof. BUSINESS (iii) other distributors and retailers which sell the Group’s products directly or through sub-distributors to ultimate consumers. The Group has not entered into any long-term or short-term supply agreements with distributors and retailers save for (i) master supply agreements with the chain retailers in Hong Kong containing those terms related to the rebates, discounts or promotion offers offered by the Group to them so that the Group’s products are allowed to be put on sale on their shelf spaces in Hong Kong; and (ii) a distribution agreement entered into with a distributor which operates its own online storefronts on an e-commerce platform in the PRC, to govern the terms of supply and delivery. Please refer to the sub-paragraphs headed “Sales and distribution channels — (II) Indirect sales — Sales through chain retailers” and “Sales and distribution channels — (II) Indirect sales — Sales to other distributors and retailers — Relationship with other distributors and retailers” in this section for the key terms of the distribution or cooperation agreements. Top five customers Except for the sales to Ms. Cao Xiao Wei, the wife of Mr. Chan, the Group’s five largest customers during the Track Record Period are all Independent Third Parties. Details of the Group’s sales to Ms. Cao Xiao Wei are set out in the sub-paragraph headed “Sale and distribution channels — (II) Indirect sales — Sales to other distributors and retailers — Sales to related parties” in this section. The sales to the top five customers amounted to approximately HK$15.6 million and HK$17.9 million respectively, representing approximately 23.1% and 21.0% of the Group’s total revenue for the two years ended 31 December 2015 respectively. The sales to the largest customer amounted to approximately HK$6.0 million and HK$5.9 million respectively, representing approximately 8.9% and 6.9% of total revenue of the Group for the two years ended 31 December 2015 respectively. The following tables set forth certain information about the Group’s top five customers during the Track Record Period: For the year ended 31 December 2014 Customer Principal business (Note) Location Ms. Cao Xiao Wei Operation of an online the PRC storefront on Taobao Type of products purchased from the Group Business Typical relationship credit terms since beauty gadgets Within 60 2011 days after delivery – 130 – Amount of sales (%) 8.9 THIS APPLICATION PROOF IS IN DRAFT FORM. The information contained herein is incomplete and is subject to change. This Application Proof must be read in conjunction with the section headed “Warning” on the cover of this Application Proof. BUSINESS Customer Principal business (Note) Customer B Chain retailer of Hong Kong beauty gadgets cosmetic products, with over 200 retail stores in Hong Kong Customer C General trading Customer D Operation of online the PRC beauty gadgets storefronts on e-commerce platforms Hong Kong beauty gadgets Chain retailer of electronic products, with over 30 retail stores in Hong Kong Customer E Location Type of products purchased from the Group Hong Kong beauty gadgets Business Typical relationship credit terms since Amount of sales (%) Within 60 2012 days upon sale of consigned goods Within 120 2014 days after delivery Full 2013 payment is advance 6.4 Within 60 2014 days after delivery 2.4 2.7 2.7 For the year ended 31 December 2015 Type of products purchased from the Group Customer Principal business (Note) Location Customer C General trading Hong Kong beauty gadgets Customer B Chain retailer of Hong Kong beauty gadgets cosmetic products, with over 200 retail stores in Hong Kong Customer F Operation of online storefronts on e-commerce platforms Hong Kong beauty gadgets – 131 – Business Typical relationship credit terms since Within 120 2014 days after delivery Within 60 2012 days upon sale of consigned goods 2014 Within 60 days after delivery Amount of sales (%) 6.9 5.3 4.0 THIS APPLICATION PROOF IS IN DRAFT FORM. The information contained herein is incomplete and is subject to change. This Application Proof must be read in conjunction with the section headed “Warning” on the cover of this Application Proof. BUSINESS Customer Principal business (Note) Customer G Operation of online Hong Kong beauty gadgets storefronts on e-commerce platforms Chain retailer of Hong Kong beauty gadgets electronic products, with over 30 retail stores in Hong Kong Customer E Note: Location Type of products purchased from the Group Business Typical relationship credit terms since Full 2015 payment upon delivery Within 60 2014 days after delivery Amount of sales (%) 2.5 2.3 The relevant information is per the best knowledge of the Directors. Except for Ms. Cao Xiao Wei, none of the Directors, their associates, or any Shareholders who owned more than 5% of the share capital of the Company as at the Latest Practicable Date had any interest in any of the five largest customers during the Track Record Period. PRICING POLICY, PROFIT MARGIN, SEASONALITY AND PAYMENT TERMS Pricing Policy The Group adopts a market driven pricing policy. The Group would consider various factors including the pricing of similar products of the Group’s competitors uniqueness and market positioning of the Group’s products, macroeconomic conditions and the Group’s operation costs, in arriving at the retail and wholesale prices of its products. The retail prices of branded products being distributed and sold by the Group are generally set with reference to the recommended prices of the brand owners and are usually higher than such recommended prices, depending on the perceived market acceptance. If there is no recommended price from the brand owners, the Group will determine the retail price of the products with reference to a number of factors, including the selling price guideline and discount range provided by the brand owners to the Group (if any), the prices of other competitive products available in the same market, the perceived market value and the Group’s pricing strategy as ultimately determined by the Group’s management. – 132 – THIS APPLICATION PROOF IS IN DRAFT FORM. The information contained herein is incomplete and is subject to change. This Application Proof must be read in conjunction with the section headed “Warning” on the cover of this Application Proof. BUSINESS The pricing of the Group’s proprietary products are determined by the Group based on its market research and the perceived general market acceptance. The Group has taken into account factors including the costs related to manufacturing, packaging, marketing and logistics. The Group decides on an initial price range for a new product. Once the product is launched in the market, the Group will evaluate market response to the product and will compare the retail price and demand with similar products already available (if any) in the market in order to ascertain whether the Group needs to adjust the initial price of the product. The Group holds periodic meetings with its chain retailer customers to discuss market strategies of its products in order to maintain brand image and make recommendation to their retail pricing policies. The Directors believe that, alongside with the Group’s expansion, the Group will be able to purchase larger quantities of products at a more favourable price from different suppliers and will therefore be able to maintain competitiveness of the prices of the Group’s products offered to its chain retailer customers and other distributors. Gross profit margin Set out below are the average gross profit margins (Note) for each product segment during the Track Record Period: Year ended 31 December 2014 Year ended 31 December 2015 63.0% 64.4% 46.5% 61.8% 61.1% 65.0% Fitness equipment and accessories Beauty gadgets and accessories Other health care products Set out below are the average gross profit margins (Note) in respect of each category of distribution channel during the Track Record Period: Year ended 31 December 2014 Year ended 31 December 2015 66.5% 57.0% 65.1% 53.7% Direct sales Indirect sales For the analysis of the Group’s gross profit margins (Note) , please refer to the sub-section headed “Financial Information — Discussion and analysis of financial condition and operations of the Group” in this document. Note: The cost of goods sold used for calculating gross profit margin does not take into account other direct costs which mainly comprised transportation charges. – 133 – THIS APPLICATION PROOF IS IN DRAFT FORM. The information contained herein is incomplete and is subject to change. This Application Proof must be read in conjunction with the section headed “Warning” on the cover of this Application Proof. BUSINESS Seasonality The Group’s sales is subject to certain degree of seasonal fluctuations. Generally, demand for the Group’s beauty gadgets is relatively higher during spring season in March and April. The Directors consider this is due to the higher appearance consciousness of target customers in preparation for summer when they wear short wears, leading to their purchase behaviour before summer. The Group also experienced higher sales during Christmas holidays in 2014, and in November 2015 when Tmall launched special promotional activities to boost online shopping. Payment terms and credit control The Group generally offers a credit period of 30 days after the end of the month of sales to its chain retailer customers to settle payments, whereas other distributors and retailers are usually requested to settle payments within 30 to 60 days upon delivery of products depending on the distributors or retailer ’s credit record, historical sales performance, annual purchase and accounts settlement patterns. For certain distributors or retailer customers with shorter business relationships, all sales are generally made on “cash on delivery” basis. For online sales, customers will settle payment through online payment systems and the Group will receive sales proceeds from escrow agents within a short period of time. Customers who make purchases at the retail outlets or through sales hotline are required to settle payment before delivery or by “cash on delivery”. In order to minimise the Group’s credit risk, the management team determines credit limits and credit periods and is responsible for credit approvals. The Group’s accounting department is delegated with the responsibility for other monitoring procedures to ensure that proper and timely follow-up action is taken to recover overdue debts. In addition, the management team reviews the recoverable amount of each individual trade debt at the end of each year to ensure that adequate impairment losses were made for irrecoverable amounts, if any. In this regard, the Directors believe that the Group’s credit risk is significantly reduced. – 134 – THIS APPLICATION PROOF IS IN DRAFT FORM. The information contained herein is incomplete and is subject to change. This Application Proof must be read in conjunction with the section headed “Warning” on the cover of this Application Proof. BUSINESS Before accepting orders from new customers, the Group determines the credit terms by assessing various factors, including reputation and business scale of the customer, if appropriate. The Group’s accounting department carries out regular reconciliations of outstanding receivables balances and the Group’s management regularly reviews whether bad debts, if any, are to be written off. For the two years ended 31 December 2015, the Group had made no provision for impairment loss on its trade receivables as at the respective year ends. Nevertheless, the Group had written off bad debts amounting to an aggregate of approximately HK$226,000 for the year ended 31 December 2015. Sales return policy The Group generally permits its customers to return products to the Group due to quality defects. Save as disclosed in the sub-paragraph headed “Sales and distribution channels — (II) Indirect sales — Sales to other distributors and retailers — Management of distribution network” in this section, the Directors confirm that, except for (i) the purchase of certain display items of the franchised stores at discounted prices with immaterial purchase amounts from the franchisees when they terminated the business; and (ii) the repurchase of old models of certain products upon launch of new models by the Group from certain distributor customers with immaterial amounts, the Group did not repurchase any unsold products from retailer or distributor customers during the Track Record Period. According to the agreements with certain chain retailer customers, their purchases are conducted on a returnable basis. Nevertheless, the Group did not experience any material products return from such chain retailer customers during the Track Record Period. During the Track Record Period, the Group did not experience any material product returns or make any material product recalls due to any quality defects, perceived product side effects or harmful chemicals or substances. No inventory impairments were made for the two years ended 31 December 2015. SALES AND MARKETING As the Group’s products target the general consumer market, the Group has put considerable resources in devising various marketing campaigns to further increase public awareness of the Group’s brand recognition and its products. During the Track Record Period, the Group advertised mainly through magazines, pamphlets, banners, billboards, television advertisements, internet advertisements, and media advertisements on public transit vehicles such as buses. Trade exhibitions are also conducted in order to gain awareness of the Group’s products. The Group also contracts with celebrities to be the brand/product ambassadors. For the Group’s sales and marketing function in relation to a new product, please refer to the paragraph headed “Operating flow — Devising marketing and promotion plan” in this section above. – 135 – THIS APPLICATION PROOF IS IN DRAFT FORM. The information contained herein is incomplete and is subject to change. This Application Proof must be read in conjunction with the section headed “Warning” on the cover of this Application Proof. BUSINESS Marketing materials and design were carried out by the Group’s in-house staff. However, the Group’s advertising activities are subject to the relevant laws and regulations of the jurisdictions where the Group operates. For instance, the Trade Description Ordinance provides that no person(s) shall publish any advertisements that contain misleading information and/or a false trade description of the goods. If the Group’s marketing materials or advertisements contain anything contrary to the relevant laws and regulations, the Group would be liable for those breaches. During the Track Record Period and as at the Latest Practicable Date, the Directors confirm that there was no breach of the said ordinance by the Group, and the Group did not experience any non-compliance with the applicable laws and regulations relevant to the advertising issue. QUALITY CONTROL Before the Group orders a particular product from the suppliers, if the Directors consider there would be higher risk of product defective rate due to product quality, the Group would ensure that each batch of products supplied should be accompanied with a Quality Control Report (the “Q.C. Report”) which is issued by the product manufacturer. The Q.C. Report is issued if it is in compliance with the quality and safety standards set by the manufacturer. For beauty gadgets, the Group will obtain copies of clinical studies certificates and/or reports issued to the manufacturer to prove that the beauty gadgets perform their advertised functions and are not hazardous for humans to use. Moreover, a certificate of safety compliance would be provided by the supplier if the subject product is subject to safety compliance under the Electrical Products (Safety) Regulations. When the products are delivered to the Group’s warehouses, the warehouse staff will inspect the condition (including physical appearance, packaging and labelling) of the products to ensure that their condition has not been changed or impaired and that there is no damage to the products. The designated quality control staff will then perform sampling inspections on the products. They follow the quality control guidelines of each product when conducting quality control tests. Quality inspection on the fitness equipment normally include the equipment’s condition, structure, functions and safety, whilst the quality inspection on the beauty gadgets normally include the condition, structure and safety. If the quantity of products does not match or where defects are found, the staff will notify the management. The Group will then take records and photos of the damaged products and communicate with the relevant suppliers and request for refund or exchange of products from the relevant suppliers. As at the Latest Practicable Date, the Group had four designated staff responsible for the quality control of the products of the Group. The Group selects and assembles its branding profile with due regard to the quality exhibited by products of the underlying branded suppliers. The Directors believe that the fitness equipment and beauty gadgets products which the Group sells generally comply with international safety standards, and is subject to the Group’s quality control procedures including sample inspection upon deliveries to its warehouse. The Directors – 136 – THIS APPLICATION PROOF IS IN DRAFT FORM. The information contained herein is incomplete and is subject to change. This Application Proof must be read in conjunction with the section headed “Warning” on the cover of this Application Proof. BUSINESS consider the chance of significant defects occurring in its product portfolio is generally low and the exposure to significant potential compensation claims from its customers is unlikely. During the Track Record Period, the Group did not encounter any incidence of customer complaints or product liability claims of materiality. During the Track Record Period, the Group had not made any material claim against the suppliers. In view of the above, the Group has not taken out any product liability insurance policy in relation to the products it offers. To the best of knowledge and understanding of the Directors, it is not the industry practice for retailers or distributors to take out such product liability insurance policy. Please refer to the paragraph headed ‘‘Risk Factors — Risks relating to the Group and its business — The Group’s products may cause unexpected or undesirable side effects unknown to the Group that may result in costly product returns or recalls, or even legal actions against the Group” in this document for further details. In order to gain customer confidence in the Group’s products and enhance the Group’s corporate image, the Group has participated in the “No Fakes Pledge” Scheme since 2012. It is a scheme launched by the Hong Kong Government and aims to promote a sense of pride among traders who do not deal in counterfeit and pirated goods; it also aims to enhance awareness of intellectual property protection among retailers and consumers alike. The “No Fakes Pledge” Scheme campaign encourages participating retail merchants to set a good example by pledging not to sell or distribute counterfeit or pirated products, thus establishing and upholding honest and trustworthy trading practices. WARRANTY For products which are sold by the Group on an exclusive basis, the Group generally offers its customers a one-year product warranty period. Warranty for the products is usually given directly by the Group to customers if a warranty is also given to the Group from the supplier. Products that are found to be defective and are entitled for a replacement will be subject to a replacement either for the defective parts or for the whole equipment or gadget. For products which are sold by the Group on a non-exclusive basis, warranty is generally provided directly by the relevant sole distributors to the ultimate customers. For the Group’s proprietary products, the Group generally offers its customers a one-year product warranty period. Generally, certain brand owners would offer the Group a certain amount of spare parts per shipment so that replacements can be made by the Group to their customers. Certain brand owners would also undertake to take up returned defective products (if any) and will replace them with new products under the warranty policy given to the Group. The Directors confirm that the Group had not received any material complaints about the quality of the products during the Track Record Period. The Group did not make any return of products to the suppliers during the Track Record Period. – 137 – THIS APPLICATION PROOF IS IN DRAFT FORM. The information contained herein is incomplete and is subject to change. This Application Proof must be read in conjunction with the section headed “Warning” on the cover of this Application Proof. BUSINESS CUSTOMER SERVICE The Group has maintained a service hotline in Hong Kong. The customers can contact the service hotline to ask questions or leave a complaint. In relation to product repairs, the current maintenance policy provided by the Group is to offer free on-site maintenance of one year upon purchase of fitness equipments worth more than HK$2,400. For fitness equipments worth less than HK$2,400, the Group also offers free maintenance period of one year, but the on-site maintenance service is for one month upon purchase only; and customers are then required to bring the products back to the stores for repair after the one month period has lapsed. For beauty gadgets, the Group generally offers free maintenance of one year, but customers are required to bring the products to the stores for repair. For maintenance of beauty gadgets sold in the PRC, customers can return their purchased products to the Group’s Shenzhen office for repair. Simple repair works will be conducted by the staff situated at the office. If the staff is unable to repair the product, the product will be delivered to Hong Kong for further repair works and will be returned to the customer by mail. In addition, the customers may also leave a complaint in writing through the retail websites operated by the Group or emails to the Group. INVENTORY CONTROL Inventories held by the Group are mainly fitness equipment and beauty gadgets products provided by the suppliers. The Group had inventories of HK$22.5 million and HK$14.6 million as of 31 December 2014 and 2015, respectively. The majority of the Group’s inventories are kept in its retail outlets and warehouses in Hong Kong and Shenzhen, while some beauty gadgets and accessories are kept in the point-on-sales of certain chain retailers as consignment stocks. The Directors understand that maintaining a sufficient but non-excessive inventory is crucial to the success of the Group’s business. The Group normally maintains the inventory level at an average of approximately two to six months depending on the product nature, marketing plan and delivery lead time. The Group place orders with suppliers regularly to replenish the inventory stock to a predetermined level which in turn allows it to avoid additional warehouse costs. The general lead time for the delivery of products to the warehouses ranges from 30 to 60 days for orders placed with overseas suppliers. For orders placed with PRC suppliers, which are usually fitness equipments, the lead time for delivery is approximately 60-90 days. The Group adopts the first-in-first-out inventory management policy in order to minimise stock-ageing problems. The inventory turnover days for each of the two years ended 31 December 2015 was approximately 302 days and 207 days respectively. The relatively higher inventory turnover day for the year ended 31 December 2014 was mainly due to the stock up of certain flagship products i.e. hair removal devices and facial care devices near the end of 2014 for launch in 2015. Moreover, the Directors consider that it is necessary to maintain a relatively higher inventory near the end of a year as manufacturers in the PRC generally suspend production during the Chinese New Year holidays. – 138 – THIS APPLICATION PROOF IS IN DRAFT FORM. The information contained herein is incomplete and is subject to change. This Application Proof must be read in conjunction with the section headed “Warning” on the cover of this Application Proof. BUSINESS Since two of the Group’s top five suppliers are situated in Israel, the Group has implemented a special inventory control policy for these suppliers in order to ensure stable delivery of products should there be a delay of product supply due to events arising from political turmoil. Depending on product types, an inventory level of three to six months is usually maintained for these two suppliers. Aside from maintaining a higher inventory level with these suppliers, the Group also focuses on diversifying its product categories in order to sustain retail activities and to prevent from overreliance on these two suppliers. The Directors consider that the beauty gadgets industry is characterised by rapid changes of trends and technology. The suppliers frequently launch new products or upgrade their existing products to cater for evolving industry trends and consumer preferences. As such, the Directors believe that the beauty gadgets products have a relative short product life cycle as compared with other products. Based on their experience and observation, the Directors believe the product life cycle of beauty gadgets products ranges from three to five years while fitness equipment products have longer life cycle of four to seven years. Nevertheless, the product brand owners will usually launch new product models to replace old models before the expiry of the expected product life cycles of those old models. The Group has a policy of making provisions against slow moving and obsolete inventories when such items are identified. During the Track Record Period, the Group had not made any allowances for impairment of obsolete and slow-moving inventories. This is because the Group closely monitors the stock ageing and usually offers the products prone to obsolescence to the customers at a discount. The Group has established a computerised inventory management system and other inventory control procedures to track in-coming and out-going inventory. The warehouse staff also maintain an inventory list for stock kept at the warehouse and update the list regularly. They also carry out a full inventory check at the end of each financial year and monthly inventory checks on selected products. LOGISTICS The Group has its own logistics team which aims at ensuring the cost-effectiveness and timely delivery of the products to the customers and for better control. The logistics team consisted of three staff as at the Latest Practicable Date. The logistics team coordinates closely with customer services staff for the purposes of arranging the delivery of the products to the customers according to the purchase orders received. The Group owned and operated a truck and two cargo vans as at the Latest Practicable Date. The Group delivered the products from its warehouse to its own retail stores and designated places of the customers in Hong Kong. The costs of delivery to the chain store customers were borne by the Group. For individual consumers in Hong Kong, the Group provides free delivery for purchases of more than HK$300. The Group also engages two third-party logistics providers in Hong Kong for delivery of heavy fitness equipments and to cover delivery during busy hours. – 139 – THIS APPLICATION PROOF IS IN DRAFT FORM. The information contained herein is incomplete and is subject to change. This Application Proof must be read in conjunction with the section headed “Warning” on the cover of this Application Proof. BUSINESS The Group also rented a warehouse in Shenzhen to support its online sales operation in the PRC. The Group engages third party logistics companies to regularly transfer goods from the Hong Kong warehouse to the Shenzhen warehouse. After the customers place orders through the online storefronts in the PRC, the staff in the Shenzhen warehouse is responsible for packaging of the goods and engages third party logistics companies to deliver the order. The logistic company picks up the package from the Shenzhen warehouse and delivers the packages directly to the customers’ door or to pick-up stations selected by the customers. The cost of the delivery will be borne by the Group. For other distributors and retailer customers in the PRC, the Group will either deliver the products to the customers’ designated places in Hong Kong or engage third party logistics company to provide delivery services at the cost of the Group. During the Track Record Period, the Group did not face any material disruption in the delivery of the products and it did not suffer any loss or pay any compensation as a result of delays in delivery or poor services of the logistics companies. COMPETITION The Group faces keen competition in respect of, inter alia, pricing, product quality and brand identification. Some of the Group’s competitors may have greater financial, technological and informational resources than the Group, which may enable them to provide products superior to the Group’s products, or to adapt more quickly than the Group does to evolving industry trends and consumer preferences. Conversely, some of the Group’s competitors may, out of various commercial considerations, adopt low-margin sales strategies and compete against the Group based on lower prices to increase their market shares. Details of the competition that the Group currently faces and will continue to face are set out under the section headed “Industry overview” in this document. The Directors consider that the [REDACTED] will promote the Group’s corporate image and enhance public awareness towards the Group’s brands and products. This in turn will enable the Group to attract new customers and retain existing customers. – 140 – THIS APPLICATION PROOF IS IN DRAFT FORM. The information contained herein is incomplete and is subject to change. This Application Proof must be read in conjunction with the section headed “Warning” on the cover of this Application Proof. BUSINESS INTELLECTUAL PROPERTY RIGHTS Trademarks As at the Latest Practicable Date, the Group owned a number of trademarks registered in Hong Kong and the PRC. The following is the trademarks owned by the Group:Hong Kong trademark Use of the trademark Holder of trademark The “FITBOXX.com” trademark is limited to the use of the Group’s advertising, business management, business administration and office functions under Class 35 of the Hong Kong Trademark Registry classifications. Fit Boxx HK The “FITBOXX 元氣館” trademark is limited to the use of the Group’s advertising, business management, business administration and office functions under Class 35 of the Hong Kong Trademark Registry classifications. Fit Boxx HK The “CosmoBoxx” trademark is limited to the use of the Group’s advertising, business management, business administration and office functions under Class 35 of the Hong Kong Trademark Registry classifications. Fit Boxx HK The “ENERGYM” trademark is limited to the use of labelling the Group’s gymnastic and sporting articles (not included in other classes) under Class 28 of the Hong Kong Trademark Registry classifications. Fit Boxx HK – 141 – THIS APPLICATION PROOF IS IN DRAFT FORM. The information contained herein is incomplete and is subject to change. This Application Proof must be read in conjunction with the section headed “Warning” on the cover of this Application Proof. BUSINESS Hong Kong trademark PRC trademark Use of the trademark Holder of trademark The “部屋達人” trademark is limited to the use of labelling the Group’s furniture under Class 20 of the Hong Kong Trademark Registry classifications. Fit Boxx HK The “元氣達人” trademark limited to the use of the Group’s advertising, business management, business administration and office functions under Class 35 of the Hong Kong Trademark Registry classifications. Fit Boxx HK Use of the trademark Holder of trademark The “FITBOXX 元氣館” trademark is limited to the use of labeling fitness equipment under Class 28 of the PRC Trademarks classifications. The permitted items include dumbbells, muscle training machineries, boxing gloves, etc. Fix Boxx Shenzhen The “COSMO BOXX ” trademark is limited to the use of labeling beauty equipment under Class 8 and Class 10 of the PRC Trademarks classifications. The permitted items include hair removal devices, acne removal apparatuses and beauty devices. Fix Boxx Shenzhen – 142 – THIS APPLICATION PROOF IS IN DRAFT FORM. The information contained herein is incomplete and is subject to change. This Application Proof must be read in conjunction with the section headed “Warning” on the cover of this Application Proof. BUSINESS The following trademarks are registered and held by the Group on behalf of a brand owner at its request for the purpose of business efficacy and management efficiency. Hong Kong trademark held on behalf of a brand owner Use of the trademark The “Silk’n” trademark is a trademark used by the Group’s supplier. The Group registered the supplier ’s trademark in Hong Kong for better protection and for the execution of exclusive distribution rights of the Silk’n products in Hong Kong. This trademark is limited to the use of labelling the Group’s beauty equipment under Class 10 of the Hong Kong Trademark Registry classifications. PRC trademarks held on behalf of a brand owner Use of the trademark The “HomeSkinovations” trademark is a trademark used by the Group’s supplier. The Group registered the supplier ’s trademark in the PRC for better protection and for the operation of the Silk’n store in T-Mall. The trademark is limited to the use of beauty equipment under Class 10 of the PRC Trademarks classifications. The permitted items include acne removal apparatuses and beauty devices. – 143 – Holder of trademark Fit Boxx HK Holder of trademark Fit Boxx Shenzhen THIS APPLICATION PROOF IS IN DRAFT FORM. The information contained herein is incomplete and is subject to change. This Application Proof must be read in conjunction with the section headed “Warning” on the cover of this Application Proof. BUSINESS PRC trademarks held on behalf of a brand owner Use of the trademark Holder of trademark The “SensEpil” trademark is a trademark used by the Group’s supplier. The Group registered the supplier ’s trademark in the PRC for better protection and for the operation of the Silk’n store in T-Mall. This trademark is limited to the use of beauty equipment under Class 8 of the PRC Trademarks classifications. The permitted items include hair removal devices. Fit Boxx Shenzhen The “Silk’n” trademark is a trademark used by the Group’s supplier. The Group registered the supplier ’s trademark in the PRC for better protection and for the operation of the Silk’n store in T-Mall. This trademark is limited to the use of beauty equipment under Class 10 of the PRC Trademarks classifications. The permitted items include acne removal apparatuses and beauty devices. Fit Boxx Shenzhen The Group has made applications for the registration of eight trademarks in the PRC under classes 8, 21 and 35 to the Trademark Office of the State Administration for Industry and Commerce of the PRC. All such applications were still being processed as at the Latest Practicable Date. Domain names As at the Latest Practicable Date, the Group registered five domain names. Details in relation to the domain names are set out in the paragraph headed “Appendix IV – B. Further information about the business – 2. Intellectual property rights of the Group” in this document. The Group recognises the importance of protecting and enforcing the Group’s intellectual property rights. The Group relies on various intellectual property laws, especially trademark laws, to protect its proprietary rights. If any attempted or actual infringement of the Group’s trademarks comes to the Group’s attention, the Group will take appropriate actions (including legal actions) to protect its trademarks to the full extent allowable by law. – 144 – THIS APPLICATION PROOF IS IN DRAFT FORM. The information contained herein is incomplete and is subject to change. This Application Proof must be read in conjunction with the section headed “Warning” on the cover of this Application Proof. BUSINESS EMPLOYEES Number of employees by function and geographical location As at the Latest Practicable Date, the Group had a total of 71 full-time employees. Set out below is the number of employees of the Group by function and geographical location as at the Latest Practicable Date: Hong Kong Function Number of Employees Senior management Finance and accounting Sales and marketing Human resources and administration Warehousing Quality control and maintenance Logistics Customer services Retail stores operations 7 2 5 1 6 4 3 3 29 PRC Function Number of Employees Senior management Finance and accounting Human resources and administration Warehousing Online stores operations and customer services 1 1 1 3 5 Relationship with staff The Directors consider that the Group has maintained good relationship with its employees. The Directors confirm that the Group has not experienced any significant problems with its employees or disruption to its operations due to labour disputes nor has it experienced any difficulties in the recruitment and retention of experienced staff or skilled personnel during the Track Record Period. During the Track Record Period and up to the Latest Practicable Date, there were no labour union established by the Group’s employees. – 145 – THIS APPLICATION PROOF IS IN DRAFT FORM. The information contained herein is incomplete and is subject to change. This Application Proof must be read in conjunction with the section headed “Warning” on the cover of this Application Proof. BUSINESS Training and recruitment policies The Group intends to use its best effort to attract and retain appropriate and suitable personnel to serve the Group. The Group assesses the available human resources on a continuous basis and will determine whether additional personnel are required to cope with the business development of the Group. The Group provides various types of trainings to its employees. The Group provides trainings to new employees to explain the Group’s internal rules and to enhance employees’ safety awareness. Apart from the ongoing on-the-job training, the Group also identifies training programmes and seminars arranged by external institutions such as the Hong Kong Retail Management Association and the Occupational Safety & Health Council, and encourages employees to attend. The training fees (if any) are reimbursed by the Group. These training programmes and seminars are usually relevant to the Group’s business and operation, such as customer servicing techniques and introduction of new products and their functions. Through these trainings, the Group intends to cultivate a sense of work safety among its employees and to enhance the technical skills relevant to employees’ responsibilities. Remuneration policies The Group entered into separate labour contracts with each of its employees in accordance with the applicable labour laws in Hong Kong and the PRC. The remuneration package the Group offers to its employees includes salary, bonuses and commission for sales persons. The Group determines employee salaries based on each employee’s qualifications, position and seniority. For sales persons, they are entitled to guaranteed commission based on retail sales amount, and will also be entitled to further commissions subject to whether they can meet the sales target laid out by the Group. The Group has designed an annual review system to assess the performance of its employees, which forms the basis of its decisions with respect to salary raises, bonuses and promotions. INSURANCE The Group maintains insurance policies against loss or damage to its office and retail shops, business interruption, and for employees’ compensation for its staff in Hong Kong. In relation to the insurance policy maintained for the Group’s inventories, the insurance policy insures the fitness equipment and beauty equipment stored in the Group’s warehouse in Hong Kong. The Group also maintains a general property insurance for its business in the PRC. The insurance premium paid by the Group for the two years ended 31 December 2015 amounted to approximately HK$81,000 and HK$214,000 respectively. As the major aspects of the Group’s operation have been covered by insurance, the Directors consider that the Group has taken out sufficient insurance policies over its assets and employees. During the Track Record Period, there have not been any material insurance claims. – 146 – THIS APPLICATION PROOF IS IN DRAFT FORM. The information contained herein is incomplete and is subject to change. This Application Proof must be read in conjunction with the section headed “Warning” on the cover of this Application Proof. BUSINESS The Group’s branded products are generally covered by the product liability insurance maintained by relevant brand owners. The Group is exposed to potential product liability claim in respect of injuries alleged to be caused by the Group’s proprietary product that a consumer purchases. For further details of the potential product liability to which the Group may be exposed, please refer to the sub-section headed “Quality control” above in this section. Please also refer to the paragraph headed “Risk Factors — Risks relation to the Group and its business — The Group’s products may cause unexpected or undesirable side effects unknown to the Group that may result in costly product returns or recalls, or even legal actions against the Group” in this document for the relevant risk. HEALTH, WORK SAFETY, SOCIAL AND ENVIRONMENTAL MATTERS The Group has established procedures to provide its workers with a safe and healthy working environment by providing work safety rules in the staff manual for the operation and warehousing staff to follow. In addition, the Group provides its employees with occupational safety education and training to enhance their awareness of safety issues. In order to protect the rights of workers to receive medical cure and monetary compensation after suffering from work injuries, the Group has procedures in place to handle work-related accidents. During the Track Record Period and up to the Latest Practicable Date, there was no material breach of work safety rules by the Group’s operation and warehousing staff, and the Group did not experience any significant incidents or accidents in relation to workers’ safety or any non-compliance with the applicable laws and regulations relevant to the work safety and health issues. The Group does not have formal protocols over social responsibility and environmental protection matters. The Directors believe the nature of the Group’s business operations would not impose any serious threats to these concerns. PROPERTIES As at the Latest Practicable Date, the Group does not own any property. Properties leased by the Group in Hong Kong As at the Latest Practicable Date, the Group had leased 12 properties in Hong Kong, the uses of which are for retail outlets, showroom, repair centre, office and warehouse purposes respectively. Except for the lease in relation to a retail store in Yuen Long district, details of which are set out in the section headed “Connected transactions” in this document, all properties leased by the Group in Hong Kong were from Independent Third Parties. – 147 – THIS APPLICATION PROOF IS IN DRAFT FORM. The information contained herein is incomplete and is subject to change. This Application Proof must be read in conjunction with the section headed “Warning” on the cover of this Application Proof. BUSINESS The following table sets out a summary of the properties leased by the Group in Hong Kong as at the Latest Practicable Date: Location Shop No. 1, G/F, and Flat J, 1/F, Phoenix Apartments, No. 70 Lee Garden Road, Causeway Bay, Hong Kong Use of Approximate property by gross floor the Group area Tenant (sq.m.) Term of current lease Rental payment basis Retail store 111 Fit Boxx HK 7 July 2014 to 6 July 2016 Fixed monthly rental payment Shop No. 411, Level 4, Retail store Tsuen Wan Plaza, New Territories, Hong Kong 112 Fit Boxx HK 1 October 2015 to 30 September 2017 Fixed monthly rental payment; plus additional turnover rent of a certain percentage of the monthly gross receipts of the retail outlet exceeding the fixed monthly rent Whole Floor, 7/F, Retail store Mongkok Metro, 594-596 Nathan Road, Kowloon, Hong Kong 93 Fit Boxx HK 16 August 2015 to Fixed monthly rental 15 August 2017 payment Booth S1FA and Storeroom, 1/F, Kornhill Plaza, Kornhill Road, Hong Kong (labelled as licence agreement) Retail store 59 Fit Boxx HK 9 April 2016 to 8 October 2016 Department store Retail store counter at 5/F Telford Plaza, Kowloon Bay, Kowloon, Hong Kong 25 Fit Boxx HK 1 December 2015 Monthly fee based on a to 30 November certain percentage of gross 2016 sales of the retail outlet, subject to a minimum sales amount per month G/F & M/F Shop 13, Wing Fu Mansion, 2‐6 Fung Yau Street North, Yuen Long, New Territories, Hong Kong 41 Fit Boxx HK 1 April 2015 to 31 March 2017 Retail store – 148 – Fixed monthly fee payment; plus additional turnover fee of a certain percentage of the monthly gross receipts of the retail outlet exceeding the fixed monthly fee Fixed monthly rental payment THIS APPLICATION PROOF IS IN DRAFT FORM. The information contained herein is incomplete and is subject to change. This Application Proof must be read in conjunction with the section headed “Warning” on the cover of this Application Proof. BUSINESS Location Shop No. 338, Level 1, Plaza Hollywood, Diamond Hill, Kowloon, Hong Kong Use of Approximate property by gross floor the Group area Tenant (sq.m.) Retail Store Workshop No. E1, Showroom 6/F, Camelpaint and repair Building, Block 3, centre No. 60 Hoi Yuen Road, Kowloon, Hong Kong 53 Fit Boxx HK Term of current lease 3 October 2015 to 31 August 2017 49 Fix Boxx HK 5 November 2015 to 4 November 2017 Rental payment basis Fixed monthly rental payment; plus additional turnover rent of a certain percentage of the monthly gross receipts of the retail outlet exceeding the fixed monthly rent Fixed monthly rental payment Room A-E, 9/F, Hung Wai Industrial Building, No. 3 Hi Yip Street, Yuen Long, New Territories, Hong Kong Warehouse 724 Fit Boxx HK 3 October 2015 to 2 October 2017 Fixed monthly rental payment Room G, H& I, 9/F, Hung Wai Industrial Building, No. 3 Hi Yip Street, Yuen Long, New Territories, Hong Kong Warehouse 384 Fit Boxx HK 17 March 2016 to 16 March 2018 Fixed monthly rental payment Unit F, 3/F, Hung Wai Industrial Building, No. 3 Hi Yip Street, Yuen Long, New Territories, Hong Kong Warehouse 213 Fix Boxx HK 21 May 2015 to 20 May 2017 Fixed monthly rental payment Room 2207, 22/F, Park‐In Commercial Centre 56 Dundas Street, Mong Kok, Kowloon, Hong Kong Office 50 Fix Boxx HK 17 June 2015 to 30 November 2017 Fixed monthly rental payment – 149 – THIS APPLICATION PROOF IS IN DRAFT FORM. The information contained herein is incomplete and is subject to change. This Application Proof must be read in conjunction with the section headed “Warning” on the cover of this Application Proof. BUSINESS Properties leased by the Group in the PRC As at the Latest Practicable date, the Group had leased two properties in Shenzhen, the PRC from an Independent Third Party for use as office and warehouse. The following table sets out a summary of the properties leased by the Group in the PRC as at the Latest Practicable Date: Location Units 1304 and 1305, Shenrong Building, No. 1045 Fuqiang Road, Futian District, Shenzhen, Guangdong, China Use of Approximate property by gross floor the Group area Tenant (sq.m.) Office Unit 713, Shenrong Warehouse Building, No. 1045 Fuqiang Road, Futian District, Shenzhen, Guangdong, China Term of current lease Rental payment basis 85 Fit Boxx Shenzhen 31 March 2015 to 30 March 2017 Fixed monthly rental payment 59 Fit Boxx Shenzhen 5 May 2015 to 4 May 2017 Fixed monthly rental payment According to the inspection conducted by a surveyor appointed by the Group, there are suspected unauthorised building works (the “UBWs”) in two leased retail stores of the Group, located in Causeway Bay (the “Causeway Bay Shop”) and Yuen Long (the “Yuen Long Shop”), respectively. No notice or order has been imposed by the relevant government authority to remove the UBWs as at the Latest Practicable Date. In the event that an order is imposed by the relevant government authority in relation to the UBWs, the Group and the relevant landlords will be required to remove and/or rectify the UBWs under the relevant Hong Kong laws. According to the Hong Kong Legal Counsel, notwithstanding the existence of the UBWs, the tenancy agreement for each of the Causeway Bay Shop and Yuen Long Shop is valid and subsisting and in full force and effect in favour of the Group. Except for certain minor additions constructed by the Group such as signage board (the “Group’s UBWs”), the Directors confirm that the UBWs situated at the Causeway Bay Shop and Yuen Long Shop (the “Landlord’s UBWs”) were not built by the Group and these Landlord’s UBWs existed prior to the commencement of the relevant tenancy agreements. Accordingly, the costs of removing the Landlord’s UBWs shall be borne by the respective landlords. As certain UBWs were erected or built within the two retail stores, the removal and/or rectification works by the respective landlords, may have influence on the operation of the respective shops the Group. The Group has informed the respective landlords about the UBWs and also recommended them to take appropriate action to remove the Landlord’s UBWs. As at the Latest Practicable Date, no feedback had – 150 – THIS APPLICATION PROOF IS IN DRAFT FORM. The information contained herein is incomplete and is subject to change. This Application Proof must be read in conjunction with the section headed “Warning” on the cover of this Application Proof. BUSINESS been provided by both the landlords. In addition, the Group has removed the Group’s UBWs of the Yuen Long Shop to the extent practicable. No action has been taken for the Group’s UBWs of the Causeway Bay Shop in view that the tenancy agreement will be expired soon (i.e. in July 2016). The Directors confirm that to the best of their knowledge, none of the UBWs had resulted in any injuries to its employees and the public during the Track Record Period and up to the Latest Practicable Date. The Group plans to relocate the Causeway Bay Shop and the Yuen Long Shop upon the expiry of the term of the respective tenancies, which will be 7 July 2016 and 31 March 2017, respectively. Since the tenancy agreement for the Causeway Bay Shop will expire soon, the Group is currently identifying suitable premises for relocation. The estimated relocation cost which may be incurred by the Group would be approximately HK$0.5 million and HK$0.4 million for the relocation of the Causeway Bay Shop and the Yuen Long Shop, respectively. The Directors are of the view that no material disruption to the Group’s business is expected to arise from the proposed relocations as the Group will ensure smooth transition. The Controlling Shareholders have executed the Deed of Indemnity in favour of the Group to indemnify the Group against, among others, losses, liabilities, damages, costs, charges, fees, claims, expenses and fines of whatever nature suffered by or incurred by the Group as a result of directly or indirectly or in connection with the UBWs. The aggregate revenue contribution of this two retail stores for the two years ended 31 December 2015 represented approximately 14.3% and 10.5% of the Group’s revenue respectively. In addition, under the relevant occupation permit of the premises which the Causeway Bay Shop is located, the permitted use of the first floor of the Causeway Bay Shop (which consists of ground floor and first floor) is restricted for domestic use while the relevant floor has been used by the Group for retail purposes. Accordingly, there is a breach of section 40(2) of the Buildings Ordinance for not requesting permission for a material change in use under section 25(1) of the Building Ordinance by the Group. In view that the tenancy agreement of the Causeway Bay Shop will expire soon and the Group will relocate the Causeway Bay Shop to other premises, the Group considers that it is not sensible to take action to rectify such breach. Despite such breach, the Hong Kong Legal Counsel is of the view that (i) the tenancy agreement for the Causeway Bay Shop is valid and subsisting and in full force and effect in favour of the Group, and (ii) for the breach of section 40(2) of the Buildings Ordinance by the Group, the fines (if any) that the Group is likely to receive if found guilty of such offence should be greatly reduced from the maximum default fine of HK$100,000 and the chance of imprisonment (if any) for any director of the Group is extremely remote. The Controlling Shareholders have executed the Deed of Indemnity in favour of the Group to indemnify the Group against, among others, losses, liabilities, damages, costs, claim and expenses incurred by the Group in relation to the unauthorised use of the first floor of the Causeway Bay Shop. – 151 – THIS APPLICATION PROOF IS IN DRAFT FORM. The information contained herein is incomplete and is subject to change. This Application Proof must be read in conjunction with the section headed “Warning” on the cover of this Application Proof. BUSINESS INTERNAL CONTROL The Group’s internal control system and procedures are designed to meet its specific business needs and to minimise its risk exposure. The Group has adopted different internal guidelines, along with written policies and procedures to monitor and lessen the impact of risks which are relevant to the Group’s business and control the Group’s daily business operations. In order to ensure sound implementation of the Group’s risk management and internal control policies, the Group has also adopted various on-going measures as set out below: • the Group has engaged an internal control consultant to perform internal controls review in connection with its internal control policies; • the Group has improved the existing internal control framework by adopting a set of internal control manual and policies, which cover corporate governance, risk management, operations and legal matters; • the Group will assess and monitor the implementation of its internal control manual and policies by the relevant departments and companies in the Group through regular audits and inspections; and • provide internal training to staff as appropriate in order to enable them to follow the internal control and corporate governance procedures. The Group will continuously monitor and improve the Group’s management procedures to ensure that effective operation of those internal controls are in line with the growth of the Group’s business and good corporate governance practice. LITIGATION During the Track Record Period and up to the Latest Practicable Date, the Directors confirm that, neither the Company, any of the subsidiaries nor the Directors and senior management is engaged in any litigation, arbitration or claim of material importance, and no litigation, arbitration or claim of material importance is known to the Directors to be pending or threatened by or against the Company or any of the subsidiaries or the Directors and senior management, that would have a material adverse effect on the results of operations or financial condition of the Group. LICENSES AND PERMITS To the best knowledge, information and belief of the Directors, and as advised by the Company’s legal adviser as to Hong Kong law and legal adviser as to PRC law, the Group has obtained all material licenses, permits and certificates which are necessary for the conduct of its principal businesses as stipulated in this section. – 152 – THIS APPLICATION PROOF IS IN DRAFT FORM. The information contained herein is incomplete and is subject to change. This Application Proof must be read in conjunction with the section headed “Warning” on the cover of this Application Proof. CONNECTED TRANSACTIONS CONTINUING CONNECTED TRANSACTION EXEMPTED FROM REPORTING, ANNUAL REVIEW, ANNOUNCEMENT AND INDEPENDENT SHAREHOLDERS’ APPROVAL Ms. Poon Suet Fan is the mother of Mr. Chan, the chairman of the Company, executive Director and one of the Controlling Shareholders, and Mr. Chan Yiu Chung is the brother of Mr. Chan. Therefore, Ms. Poon Suet Fan and Mr. Chan Yiu Chung will become connected persons of the Company upon [REDACTED] by virtue of Chapter 20 of the GEM Listing Rules. Lease Agreement On 31 March 2015, the Group entered into a lease agreement (the “Lease Agreement”) with Ms. Poon Suet Fan, pursuant to which Ms. Poon Suet Fan as a landlord agreed to lease a property located on the ground floor and the loft of Wing Fu Mansion, No. 2-6 of Fung Yau Street North, Yuen Long, New Territories, with a gross area of approximately 41 sq.m (the “Premises”) to the Group as tenant at a monthly rental of HK$35,000 for a period of two years commencing from 1 April 2015. The Premises is occupied by the Group to operate as a shop for the sale of the Group’s products. Given that Ms. Poon Suet Fan is a connected person of the Group, the Lease Agreement constitutes a continuing connected transaction of the Group under Chapter 20 of the GEM Listing Rules. The Directors confirm that the rental payable under the Lease Agreement is on normal commercial terms based on arm’s length negotiation and was determined with reference to the prevailing market rate for the lease of properties of similar standard in neighbouring areas of the premises. IT Maintenance Agreement On 1 February 2013, the Group entered into an IT maintenance agreement (the “IT Maintenance Agreement”) with Exodus Technology Ltd (“Exodus Technology”), a company directly and wholly owned by Mr. Chan Yiu Chung, pursuant to which Exodus Technology agreed to provide maintenance service for the computer system of the Group on a monthly basis at the monthly service charge of HK$3,500 until termination by either party. On 1 May 2015, the Group entered into another IT Service Agreement (the “IT Service Agreement”) with Exodus Technology for a period of 24 months to replace the IT Maintenance Agreement. Pursuant to the IT Service Agreement, Exodus Technology agreed to provide maintenance and security service for the computer system of the Group on a monthly basis at the monthly service charge of HK$16,500. The increase in the service charge is due to the expansion of the Group and the upgrading of the computer system of the Group. Given that Mr. Chan Yiu Chung is a connected person of the Group, the IT Service Agreement constitutes a continuing connected transaction of the Group under Chapter 20 of the GEM Listing Rules. – 153 – THIS APPLICATION PROOF IS IN DRAFT FORM. The information contained herein is incomplete and is subject to change. This Application Proof must be read in conjunction with the section headed “Warning” on the cover of this Application Proof. CONNECTED TRANSACTIONS The Directors confirm that the service charges payable under the IT Service Agreement is on normal commercial terms based on arm’s length negotiation and was determined with reference to the prevailing market rate for similar services. GEM Listing Rules implications As the applicable percentage ratios for both transactions are less than 5% and the annual consideration for the Lease Agreement is less than HK$3,000,000 while the annual consideration for the IT Service Agreement is less than HK$3,000,000, the transactions under the Lease Agreement and the IT Service Agreement are fully exempted from all requirements under Chapter 20 of the GEM Listing Rules. For the three years ended 31 December 2018, the proposed annual cap amount for the aggregate consideration payable by the Group will be HK$420,000, HK$420,000 and HK$420,000 respectively under the Lease Agreement and HK$198,000, HK$198,000 and HK$198,000 respectively under the IT Service Agreement. Such annual cap amounts are estimated based on the rental payable to Ms. Poon Suet Fan and the service charges payable to Mr. Chan Yiu Chung. CONFIRMATION FROM THE DIRECTORS The Directors (including the independent non-executive Directors) consider that it is in the interest of the Company to continue with the continuing connected transactions after the [REDACTED]. They also consider that all the continuing connected transactions as set out above are in the interests of the Company and the Shareholders as a whole and are in the ordinary and usual course of the business. The Directors are also of the view that the continuing connected transaction above was entered into on normal commercial terms and the annual caps are fair and reasonable and in the interest of the Company and the Shareholders as a whole. – 154 – THIS APPLICATION PROOF IS IN DRAFT FORM. The information contained herein is incomplete and is subject to change. This Application Proof must be read in conjunction with the section headed “Warning” on the cover of this Application Proof. FUTURE PLANS AND USE OF PROCEEDS BUSINESS OBJECTIVES AND STRATEGIES Please refer to the sub-section headed “Business — Business strategies” in this document for the Group’s business objectives and strategies. IMPLEMENTATION PLAN The Group’s implementation plans are set forth below for each of the six-month periods until 31 December 2018. Investors should note that the implementation plans and their scheduled times for attainment are formulated on the bases and assumptions referred to in the sub-section headed “Bases and assumptions” below. These bases and assumptions are inherently subject to many uncertainties, variables and unpredictable factors, in particular the risk factors set out in the section headed “Risk factors” in this document. The Group’s actual course of business may vary from the business objective set out in this document. There can be no assurance that the plans of the Group will materialise in accordance with the expected time frame or that the objective of the Group will be accomplished at all. Based on the Group’s business objective, the Directors intend to carry out the following implementation plans: Business strategy Implementation plan Amount to be applied from the net proceeds of the [REDACTED] HK$’000 From the Latest Practicable Date to 31 December 2016 Expansion of retail network in Hong Kong Enhancing marketing and promotional activities • Opening of a flagship shop in Shatin district: – Identify suitable flagship shop location – Negotiation of the terms of the lease – Design and renovation of the flagship shop [REDACTED] • Launch various marketing and promotional activities with additional budget [REDACTED] [REDACTED] – 155 – THIS APPLICATION PROOF IS IN DRAFT FORM. The information contained herein is incomplete and is subject to change. This Application Proof must be read in conjunction with the section headed “Warning” on the cover of this Application Proof. FUTURE PLANS AND USE OF PROCEEDS Business strategy Implementation plan Amount to be applied from the net proceeds of the [REDACTED] HK$’000 For the six months ending 30 June 2017 Further development of the PRC online market Expansion of retail network in Hong Kong Enhancing of marketing and promotional activities • Opening of a display store in Shenzhen, the PRC: – Identify suitable display store location – Negotiation of the terms of the lease – Design and renovation of the display store – Opening by the end of June 2017 [REDACTED] • Opening of a flagship shop in Shatin district: – Opening in early 2017 [REDACTED] • Opening of a new shop in Central: – Identify suitable shop location – Negotiation of the terms of the lease – Design and renovation of the new shop – Opening in second quarter of 2017 [REDACTED] • Opening of a new shop in Kowloon Bay: – Identify suitable shop location – Negotiation of the terms of the lease – Design and renovation of the new shop [REDACTED] • Launch various marketing and promotional activities with additional budget [REDACTED] [REDACTED] – 156 – THIS APPLICATION PROOF IS IN DRAFT FORM. The information contained herein is incomplete and is subject to change. This Application Proof must be read in conjunction with the section headed “Warning” on the cover of this Application Proof. FUTURE PLANS AND USE OF PROCEEDS Business strategy Implementation plan Amount to be applied from the net proceeds of the [REDACTED] HK$’000 For the six months ending 31 December 2017 Further development of the PRC online market • Opening of a display store in Shanghai, the PRC: – Identify suitable display store location – Negotiation of the terms of the lease – Design and renovation of the display store – Opening by the end of December 2017 [REDACTED] Expansion of retail network in Hong Kong • Opening of a new shop in Kowloon Bay: – Opening in third quarter of 2017 [REDACTED] Enhancing of marketing and promotional activities • Launch various marketing and promotional activities with additional budget [REDACTED] [REDACTED] For the six months ending 30 June 2018 Further development of the PRC online market • Opening of a display store in Beijing, the PRC: – Identify suitable display store location – Negotiation of the terms of the lease – Design and renovation of the display store – Opening by the end of June 2018 [REDACTED] Enhancing marketing and promotional activities • Launch various marketing and promotional activities with additional budget [REDACTED] Increasing market presence in Hong Kong • Opening of two pop-up stores in Hong Kong: – Identify suitable pop-up store locations – Negotiation of the terms of the leases – Design and renovation of the pop-up stores – Opening by the end of June 2018 [REDACTED] Enhancing the Group’s brand recognition and image • Refurbishment of existing retail shops [REDACTED] [REDACTED] – 157 – THIS APPLICATION PROOF IS IN DRAFT FORM. The information contained herein is incomplete and is subject to change. This Application Proof must be read in conjunction with the section headed “Warning” on the cover of this Application Proof. FUTURE PLANS AND USE OF PROCEEDS Business strategy Implementation plan Amount to be applied from the net proceeds of the [REDACTED] HK$’000 For the six months ending 31 December 2018 Further development of the PRC online market • Opening of a display store in Chongqing, the PRC: – Identify suitable display store location – Negotiation of the terms of the lease – Design and renovation of the display store – Opening by the end of December 2018 [REDACTED] • Opening of a display store in Guangzhou, the PRC: – Identify suitable display store location – Negotiation of the terms of the lease – Design and renovation of the display store – Opening by the end of December 2018 [REDACTED] Enhancing marketing and promotional activities • Launch various marketing and promotional activities with additional budget [REDACTED] Increasing market presence in Hong Kong • Opening of two pop-up stores in Hong Kong: – Identify suitable pop-up store locations – Negotiation of the terms of the leases – Design and renovation of the pop-up stores – Opening by the end of December 2018 [REDACTED] Enhancing the Group’s brand recognition and image • Refurbishment of existing retail shops [REDACTED] [REDACTED] – 158 – THIS APPLICATION PROOF IS IN DRAFT FORM. The information contained herein is incomplete and is subject to change. This Application Proof must be read in conjunction with the section headed “Warning” on the cover of this Application Proof. FUTURE PLANS AND USE OF PROCEEDS BASES AND ASSUMPTIONS The business objectives set out by the Directors are based on the following bases and assumptions: • the Group will have sufficient financial resources to meet the planned capital expenditure and business development requirements during the period to which the Group’s future plans relate; • there will be no change in the funding requirement for each of the Group’s future plans described in this document from the amount as estimated by the Directors; • there will be no material changes in existing laws and regulations, or other governmental policies relating to the Group, or in the political, economic or market conditions in which the Group operates; • there will be no material changes in the bases or rates of taxation applicable to the activities of the Group; • the [REDACTED] will be completed in accordance with and as described in the section headed “Structure and conditions of the [REDACTED]” in this document; • the Group is able to maintain its customers; • there will be no material changes in the industries or businesses of the Group’s major suppliers; • the Group can maintain the relationship with its suppliers; • the Group will be able to retain key staff in the management and the main operational departments; • the Group will be able to continue its operation in substantially the same manner as the Group has been operating during the Track Record Period and the Group will also be able to carry out its development plans without disruptions adversely affecting its operations or business objectives in any way; • there will be no disasters, natural, political or otherwise, which would materially disrupt the businesses or operations of the Group; and • the Group will not be materially affected by the risk factors as set out under the section headed “Risk factors” in this document. – 159 – THIS APPLICATION PROOF IS IN DRAFT FORM. The information contained herein is incomplete and is subject to change. This Application Proof must be read in conjunction with the section headed “Warning” on the cover of this Application Proof. FUTURE PLANS AND USE OF PROCEEDS REASONS FOR THE [REDACTED] The [REDACTED] will enhance the Group’s reputation and capital base and provide the Group with additional working capital to implement the future plans set out in the sub-section headed “Implementation plan” above. USE OF PROCEEDS The net proceeds from the [REDACTED], after deducting related expenses, are estimated to be approximately HK$[REDACTED] million (assuming the [REDACTED] is not exercised) and based on a [REDACTED] of HK$[REDACTED] (being the mid-point of the [REDACTED] range between HK$[REDACTED] and HK$[REDACTED]. The Directors presently intend that the net proceeds will be applied as follows: From the For the For the For the For the Latest six months six months six months six months Practicable ending ending ending ending Date to 31 30 31 30 31 December June December June December 2016 2017 2017 2018 2018 Total HK$ million HK$ million HK$ million HK$ million HK$ million HK$ million Further development of the Group’s business in the PRC online market by opening of display stores Expansion of retail network in Hong Kong Enhancing marketing and promotional activities Increasing the market presence in Hong Kong by opening pop-up stores Enhancing the Group’s brand recognition and image by renovation of existing shops [REDACTED] [REDACTED] [REDACTED] [REDACTED] [REDACTED] [REDACTED] [REDACTED] [REDACTED] [REDACTED] [REDACTED] [REDACTED] [REDACTED] [REDACTED] [REDACTED] [REDACTED] [REDACTED] [REDACTED] [REDACTED] [REDACTED] [REDACTED] [REDACTED] [REDACTED] [REDACTED] [REDACTED] [REDACTED] [REDACTED] [REDACTED] [REDACTED] [REDACTED] [REDACTED] [REDACTED] [REDACTED] [REDACTED] [REDACTED] [REDACTED] [REDACTED] The balance of the net proceeds from the [REDACTED] of approximately HK$[REDACTED] million will be used as to HK$[REDACTED] million (approximately [REDACTED]% of the net proceeds) as working capital for stock up of products newly launched in 2016 and approximately HK$[REDACTED] million (approximately [REDACTED]% of the net proceeds) will be used as general working capital of the Group. The Directors consider that the net proceeds from the issue of the [REDACTED] of about HK$[REDACTED] million and the Group’s internal resources will be sufficient to finance the business plans of the Group as scheduled up to 31 December 2018. – 160 – THIS APPLICATION PROOF IS IN DRAFT FORM. The information contained herein is incomplete and is subject to change. This Application Proof must be read in conjunction with the section headed “Warning” on the cover of this Application Proof. FUTURE PLANS AND USE OF PROCEEDS If the [REDACTED] is exercised in full, the net proceeds from the [REDACTED] will increase to approximately HK$[REDACTED] million, assuming the [REDACTED] is set at the mid-point of the indicative [REDACTED] range at HK$[REDACTED] per Share. If the [REDACTED] is set at the high-end of the indicative [REDACTED] range at HK$[REDACTED] per Share, the net proceeds from the [REDACTED] (including the proceeds from the exercise of the [REDACTED]) will increase to approximately HK$[REDACTED] million. If the [REDACTED] is set at the low-end of the indicative [REDACTED] range, at HK$[REDACTED] per Share, the net proceeds from the [REDACTED] (including the proceeds from the exercise of the [REDACTED]) will decrease to approximately HK$[REDACTED] million. The Directors intend to apply the additional net proceeds from the exercise of the [REDACTED] to the above purposes on a pro-rata basis. If the [REDACTED] is finally determined to be less than HK$[REDACTED] (being the mid-point of the indicative range of the [REDACTED]), the Group will finance the shortfall in relation to the funding required for its implementation plans by internal cash resources, working capital and/or other financing, as and when appropriate. If the [REDACTED] is finally determined to be more than HK$[REDACTED], the Group will apply the additional net proceeds as working capital. To the extent that the net proceeds from the [REDACTED] are not immediately required for the above purposes, it is the present intention of the Directors that such net proceeds will be placed as short-term deposits with authorised banks and/or financial institutions in Hong Kong. Investors should be aware that any part of the Group’s business plans may or may not proceed according to the timeframe as described under the sub-section headed “Implementation Plans” of this section due to various factors such as changes in customers’ demand and changes in market conditions. Under such circumstances, the Directors will evaluate carefully the situations and will hold the funds as short-term deposits in authorised banks and/or financial institutions in Hong Kong until the relevant business plan materialises. – 161 – THIS APPLICATION PROOF IS IN DRAFT FORM. The information contained herein is incomplete and is subject to change. This Application Proof must be read in conjunction with the section headed “Warning” on the cover of this Application Proof. DIRECTORS AND SENIOR MANAGEMENT SUMMARY OF DIRECTORS AND SENIOR MANAGEMENT Directors Name Age Position Roles and Responsibilities Date of Joining the Group Date of Relationship with Appointment other Directors and as Director senior management Chan Yiu Kwong (陳耀廣) 38 Chairman and executive Director Responsible for overall 27 March strategic planning and 2007 business development of the Group 14 May 2015 Cousin of Ms. Lam Tsui Ying and husband of Ms. Cao Xiaowei Li Hon Ming (李漢明) 38 Chief executive officer and executive Director Responsible for 27 March management of the 2007 day-to-day operations of the Group 14 May 2015 None Lo Wing Sang (勞永生) 50 Executive Director Responsible for 11 March 2016 overseeing the strategic planning and corporate development of the Group 11 March 2016 None So Alan Wai Shing (蘇偉成) [●] 49 Independent Responsible for supervising and non-executive providing Director, the chairman independent of Audit judgment to the Board Committee [●] None Ho Long Chin Matthew (何浪前) 35 Independent Responsible for [●] non-executive supervising and Director, providing the chairman independent of Nomination judgment to the Board Committee [●] None Wong King Lung (黃景隆) [●] Responsible for 44 Independent supervising and non-executive providing Director, the independent chairman of judgment to the Board Remuneration Committee [●] None – 162 – THIS APPLICATION PROOF IS IN DRAFT FORM. The information contained herein is incomplete and is subject to change. This Application Proof must be read in conjunction with the section headed “Warning” on the cover of this Application Proof. DIRECTORS AND SENIOR MANAGEMENT Senior Management Name Age Position Roles and Responsibilities Date of Joining the Group Relationship with Date of other Directors Appointment and other senior to Position management Ms. Lam Tsui Ying (林翠瑩) 35 General manager of Fit Boxx HK Supervising daily operation and management of Fit Boxx HK 1 April 2009 1 December 2012 Cousin of Mr. Chan Ms. Cao Xiaowei (曹小偉) 34 General manager of Fit Boxx Shenzhen Supervising daily operation and management of Fit Boxx Shenzhen 1 December 2012 1 December 2012 Wife of Mr. Chan Mr. Mak Chin Wah (麥展華) 35 Marketing manager Developing and communicating marketing strategies and coordinating marketing functions of the Group 19 May 2010 19 May 2010 N/A Ms. Lam Kit Man (林潔文) 30 Financial controller Supervising financial reporting, corporate finance, treasury, tax and other financial related matters 1 January 2015 Mr. Li Shiu Tong Andrew (李紹棠) Financial planning, 11 January 53 Company management and 2016 secretary and corporate governance chief financial officer 1 January 2016 N/A 11 January 2016 N/A BOARD OF DIRECTORS The Board currently consists of six Directors comprising three executive Directors and three independent non-executive Directors. The functions and duties of the Board includes, but are not limited to, convening the general meetings, reporting on the performance of the Board at the general meeting, implementing the resolutions passed at the general meetings, formulating business plans and investment plans, preparing the annual budget and final accounts, preparing proposals on profit distribution and increasing or decreasing the registered capital, as well as performing the other authorities, functions and responsibilities in accordance with the Articles of Association. – 163 – THIS APPLICATION PROOF IS IN DRAFT FORM. The information contained herein is incomplete and is subject to change. This Application Proof must be read in conjunction with the section headed “Warning” on the cover of this Application Proof. DIRECTORS AND SENIOR MANAGEMENT Executive Directors Mr. Chan Yiu Kwong (陳耀廣), aged 38, is the chairman and one of the co-founders of the Group and was appointed as an executive Director on 11 March 2016. Mr. Chan is primarily responsible for the overall strategic planning and business development of the Group, overseeing the day-to-day management, research and development and formulation of overall corporate policies of the Group. Mr. Chan has more than ten years of experience in the industry of hospitality, distribution and sales and marketing business. He joined Renaissance Zurich Hotel, Switzerland as service trainee in February 1997 and worked as front desk clerk at JW Marriott Hotel Hong Kong from August 1998 to October 1999. He was then employed by Shanghai Paka Premium Products Ltd. as a marketing supervisor from January 2003 to November 2004 stationed in Shanghai. Since January 2005, Mr. Chan joined Edward Wong & Company Limited and was promoted to sales manager and was mainly responsible for managing the sales team to sell raw leather materials factories in the PRC. Mr. Chan founded the business of the Group in March 2007 and has been devoted himself to the sales and marketing business of fitness equipment and beauty gadgets since then. Mr. Li Hon Ming (李漢明), aged 38, is one of the co-founders of the Group. He is the chief executive officer of the Group and was appointed as an executive Director on 11 March 2016. Mr. Li is primarily responsible for overall strategic planning, formulation of the corporate policies and the day-to-day management of the Group. Prior to the establishment of the Group in March 2007, Mr. Li had over ten years of experience in the industry of surveying since 1997. He was an assistant surveyor of Sun Fook Kong Construction Management Ltd. during the period from April 1997 to March 2003 and worked as a works supervisor in MWH Hong Kong Limited from April 2003 to January 2006. Mr. Li then established his career with the Group and involved in the distribution, marketing and sale of fitness equipment and beauty gadgets. Mr. Lo Wing Sang (勞永生), aged 50, was appointed as an executive Director on 11 March 2016, is responsible for overseeing the strategic planning and corporate development of the Group. Mr. Lo obtained a bachelor ’s degree of arts majoring in accountancy from the City University of Hong Kong in December 1994. He is a practicing member of The Hong Kong Institute of Chartered Public Accountant, an associate of The Institute of Chartered Accountants in England and Wales and a fellow member of The Association of Chartered Certified Accountants. He has worked in a large international accounting firm and has over ten years of experience in auditing and accounting. He has also been involved in various senior management positions over the years. Mr. Lo worked as a vice president-finance, the company secretary and qualified accountant of Pico Far East Holdings Limited (stock code: 752), a company listed on the main board of the Stock Exchange, from December 1995 to August 2004. From September 2004 to June 2005, Mr. Lo was the company secretary of AMS Public Transport Holdings Limited (stock code: 77), a company listed on the main board of the Stock Exchange. From 2011 to 2014, he joined as the chief operating officer and later promoted to be the deputy chief executive officer and executive Director of Time Watch Investments Limited (stock code: 2033), a company listed on the main board of the Stock Exchange. From August to November in 2014, Mr. Lo was an independent non-executive director of PPS International (Holdings) Limited (stock code: 8201), a company listed on GEM. Prior to joining the Group, Mr. Lo was also – 164 – THIS APPLICATION PROOF IS IN DRAFT FORM. The information contained herein is incomplete and is subject to change. This Application Proof must be read in conjunction with the section headed “Warning” on the cover of this Application Proof. DIRECTORS AND SENIOR MANAGEMENT the executive Director and the chief executive officer of China New Energy Power Group Limited (stock code: 1041), a company listed on the main board of the Stock Exchange, from March 2014 to July 2015. Independent Non-executive Directors Mr. So Alan Wai Shing (蘇偉成), aged 49, was appointed as an independent non-executive Director on [●] and is the chairman of the Audit Committee. Mr. So obtained a bachelor ’s degree in business majoring in accounting from the Edith Cowan University, Western Australia, Australia, in February 1993, and a master ’s degree in business administration from the Open University of Hong Kong in December 2003. Mr. So has approximately 22 years of experience in audit work and has been an associate of the Hong Kong Society of Accountants since May 1999, as well as a registered practicing member of the Hong Kong Institute of Certified Public Accountants since January 2012. He had been practising in his own name as a certified public accountant from October 2006 to June 2014 and under Alan So & Co, Certified Public Accountants from June 2014 to present to provide auditing, accounting and tax services. Prior to joining the Group, Mr. So worked at various institutions, including accounting firms, and held the position of audit assistant manager at RSM Nelson Wheeler from January 1999 to February 2001. Mr. So was also the chief financial officer and company secretary of Huazhang Technology Holdings Limited (stock code: 8276), a company which was listed on GEM, (a company now listed on the main board of the Stock Exchange with stock code 1673) for the period from May 2012 to February 2014. Mr. Ho Long Chin Matthew (何浪前), aged 35, has been appointed as an independent non-executive Director of the Company on [●] and is the chairman of the Nomination Committee. Mr. Ho has obtained a bachelor ’s degree of laws from the University of Hong Kong in 2003. Mr. Ho has been a practicing barrister in Hong Kong since 2005. He was appointed as a member of the Panel of Advisers under the Film Censorship Ordinance (Cap. 392 of the Laws of Hong Kong) from October 2012 to September 2013. He is also currently an adjudicator of the Immigration Tribunal under the Immigration Ordinance (Cap. 115 of the Laws of Hong Kong) and a headnote writer of the Board of Review of the Inland Revenue Department. From June to July in 2015, Mr. Ho was an independent non-executive director of China New Energy Power Group Limited (stock code: 1041), a company listed on the main board of the Stock Exchange. Mr. Wong King Lung (黃景隆), aged 44, was appointed as an independent non-executive Director on [●] and is the chairman of the Remuneration Committee. He obtained a bachelor ’s degree in managerial statistics from the City University of Hong Kong in November 1998. Prior to joining the Group, Mr. Wong has over 15 years of working experience in business development and project management in the industry of manufacturing, retail and services. He has been working as a consultant in the Hong Kong Productivity Council from June 2004 to July 2014 and is also currently a council member of the Kowloon Chamber of Commerce in the year of 2015-2016. Mr. Wong also obtained professional qualifications as an affiliate of the Association of Chartered Certified Accountants in February 2000 and Certified Information Systems Auditor of the Information Systems Audit and Control Association in September 2003. – 165 – THIS APPLICATION PROOF IS IN DRAFT FORM. The information contained herein is incomplete and is subject to change. This Application Proof must be read in conjunction with the section headed “Warning” on the cover of this Application Proof. DIRECTORS AND SENIOR MANAGEMENT Please refer to the sub-section headed “Appendix IV — C. Further information about the Directors and Substantial Shareholders” in this document for information regarding particulars of the Directors’ service agreements and emoluments and information regarding their respective interests (if any) in the Shares of the Company within the meaning of Part XV of the SFO. Save as disclosed in this document, each of the Directors confirms that (i) each of them has not held any directorships in the last three years in any public companies the securities of which are listed on any securities market in Hong Kong or overseas; (ii) each of them does not have any relationship with any other Directors, senior management or substantial or Controlling Shareholders of the Company; (iii) each of them does not have any interests in the Shares within the meaning of Part XV of the SFO; (iv) there are no other matters concerning all the Directors’ appointment that need to be brought to the attention of the Shareholders and the Stock Exchange; and (v) there are no other matters which shall be disclosed pursuant to Rule 17.50(2)(h) to 17.50(2)(v) of the GEM Listing Rules. SENIOR MANAGEMENT Ms. Lam Tsui Ying (林翠瑩), aged 35, was appointed as the general manager of Fit Boxx HK in December 2012. She is responsible for the administrative and human resources matters of the Group and has been involved in the management of the Group for over six years. Ms. Lam received a certificate in business law, business communication, office practice, fundamental computer concepts and written English for commerce from the School of Continuing Education of Hong Kong Baptist University in 2001. Prior to joining the Group, Ms. Lam had over eight years’ experience in the industry of shipping and logistics, including working as a shipping clerk for Universe (Far East) Co. Ltd. from June 2000 to January 2003 and for Pai Cheng Bags Co. Ltd. from July 2004 to June 2005. She then joined U-Right International Limited as a senior trading officer from June 2005 to October 2008 and was responsible for managing the trading department and overseeing shipment schedule. Ms. Lam is the cousin of Mr. Chan. Ms. Cao Xiaowei (曹小偉), aged 34, was appointed as the general manager of Fit Boxx Shenzhen in December 2012 and is responsible for customer communication, management of customer information, preservation of continuous customer relationship and customer service planning of the Group’s operation in the PRC. Ms. Cao obtained tertiary education qualification in electronic technology from Shanghai Xinqiao Polytechnic College (上海新僑職業技術學院) in July 2003. Ms. Cao is the wife of Mr. Chan. – 166 – THIS APPLICATION PROOF IS IN DRAFT FORM. The information contained herein is incomplete and is subject to change. This Application Proof must be read in conjunction with the section headed “Warning” on the cover of this Application Proof. DIRECTORS AND SENIOR MANAGEMENT Mr. Mak Chin Wah (麥展華), aged 35, is the marketing manager of the Group and is responsible for developing and communicating marketing strategies, overseeing marketing budget, leading the marketing team to develop business models and coordinating marketing functions of the Group. Mr. Mak joined the Group in May 2010 and has been working as the marketing manager of the Group since then. Prior to joining the Group, Mr. Mak was a manager of the logistics department of Asia Credit Monitors (Holdings) Ltd from February 2004 to April 2009, in which he was responsible for providing staff training, managing logistics activities of the company and develop strategy for debt collection. Ms. Lam Kit Man (林潔文), aged 30, was appointed as the financial controller of the Company in January 2016, prior to which Ms. Lam worked for the Group during her secondment to the Group from January 2015 to December 2015. She is in charge of the accounting department of the Group and responsible for the accounting, finance and taxation matters of the Group. Ms. Lam obtained a bachelor ’s degree of commerce majoring in accounting from Curtin University of Technology, Australia in February 2009. Ms. Lam has been admitted to full membership as a certified public accountant of CPA Australia in August 2013 and she has also become a certified public accountant of the Hong Kong Institute of Certified Public Accountants in March 2014. Prior to joining the Group, Ms. Lam was a supervisor at KTC Partners CPA Limited, primarily responsible for auditing, financial reporting, taxation and secretarial matters, during which she has obtained extensive experience in corporate listing work, financial due diligence and acquisition transactions. Ms. Lam worked as an audit assistant and then audit senior at KTC Partners CPA Limited from February 2010 to December 2015 and she underwent audit training at Hoosang, Lyn, Li & Co. from April 2009 to January 2010. Mr. Li Shiu Tong Andrew (李紹棠), aged 53, was appointed as the company secretary of the Company on 11 January 2016. He obtained his honours diploma of social science from Lingnan College of Hong Kong in November 1986 and master in business administration from the University of Wales in December 1988. Mr. Li Shiu Tong Andrew became an associate of the Hong Kong Society of Accountants in 1993 and a fellow of the Chartered Association of Certified Accountants in 1997. He joined PriceWaterhouse as a staff accountant in corporate advisory services department in February 1989 and was promoted to the position of audit senior in July 1991 and later as an senior accountant II in December 1992. From December 1992 to August 1999, he served in various financial roles in FPD Guardforce Holdings Limited, a subsidiary of First Pacific Company (stock code: 142), a company listed on the main board of the Stock Exchange. He started as an internal auditor and was later promoted to General Manager Group Finance (Overseas Companies) in 1995 responsible for the management and all company secretarial matters. In 1997, he was appointed as the Group Chief Financial Officer and was responsible for the all financial operations and reporting of the enterprises. He then involved in various senior financial and management positions and overseas project development in eForce Holdings Limited (stock code: 943), a company listed on the main board of the Stock Exchange from 2000 to 2014. Currently, he is also the chief financial officer of the Company. There are no directorships held by the senior management of the Group in any listed company whose securities are listed on any stock exchanges in Hong Kong or overseas within the three years immediately preceding the date in this document. – 167 – THIS APPLICATION PROOF IS IN DRAFT FORM. The information contained herein is incomplete and is subject to change. This Application Proof must be read in conjunction with the section headed “Warning” on the cover of this Application Proof. DIRECTORS AND SENIOR MANAGEMENT COMPLIANCE OFFICER Mr. Lo Wing Sang (勞永生), an executive Director of the Company, is the compliance officer of the Company. Details of the qualification and experience of Mr. Lo Wing Sang have been disclosed in the paragraph headed “Executive Directors” of this section. BOARD COMMITTEES Audit Committee The Company established an audit committee pursuant to a resolution of the Directors passed on [●] in compliance with Rule 5.28 of the GEM Listing Rules. Written terms of reference in compliance with paragraph C3.3 of the Corporate Governance Code as set out in Appendix 15 to the GEM Listing Rules has been adopted. The primary duties of the Audit Committee are mainly to make recommendations to the Board on the appointment and removal of external auditor; review the financial statements and material advice in respect of financial reporting; and oversee internal control procedures of the Company. At present, the audit committee of the Company consists of three members who are Mr. So Alan Wai Shing (蘇偉成), Mr. Ho Long Chin Matthew (何浪前) and Mr. Wong King Lung (黃景隆). Mr. So Alan Wai Shing (蘇偉成) is the chairman of the Audit Committee. Remuneration committee The Company established a remuneration committee on [●] with written terms of reference in compliance with paragraph B1.2 of the Corporate Governance Code as set out in Appendix 15 to the GEM Listing Rules. The primary duties of the Remuneration Committee are to make recommendation to the Board on the overall remuneration policy and structure relating to all Directors and senior management of the Group; review performance based remuneration; and ensure none of the Directors determine their own remuneration. The remuneration committee consists of three members who are Mr. So Alan Wai Shing (蘇偉成), Mr. Ho Long Chin Matthew (何浪前) and Mr. Wong King Lung (黃景隆). Mr. Wong King Lung (黃景隆) is the chairman of the Remuneration Committee. Nomination committee The Company established a nomination committee on [●] with written terms of reference in compliance with paragraph A5.2 of the Corporate Governance Code as set out in Appendix 15 to the GEM Listing Rules. The primary duties of the Nomination Committee are to review the structure, size and composition of the Board on regular basis; identify individuals suitably qualified to become Board members; assess the independence of independent non-executive Directors; and make recommendations to the Board on relevant matters relating to the appointment or re-appointment of Directors. The Nomination Committee consists of three members who are Mr. Chan, Mr. So Alan Wai Shing (蘇偉成) and Mr. Ho Long Chin Matthew (何浪前). Mr. Ho Long Chin Matthew (何浪 前) is the chairman of the Nomination Committee. – 168 – THIS APPLICATION PROOF IS IN DRAFT FORM. The information contained herein is incomplete and is subject to change. This Application Proof must be read in conjunction with the section headed “Warning” on the cover of this Application Proof. DIRECTORS AND SENIOR MANAGEMENT COMPENSATION OF THE DIRECTORS AND SENIOR MANAGEMENT The Directors and senior management receive compensation in the form of fixed monthly salaries in accordance with their respective employment contracts with the Group. The Group also reimburses them for expenses which are necessarily and reasonably incurred for the provision of services to the Group or executing their functions in relation to the business operation. The Board regularly reviews and determines the remuneration and compensation packages of its Directors and senior management, by making reference to, among other things, market level of salaries paid by comparable companies, the respective responsibilities of the Directors and the performance of the Group. After [REDACTED], the Remuneration Committee will review and determine the remuneration and compensation packages of the Directors with reference to their responsibilities, workload, the time devoted to the Group and the performance of the Group. The Directors may also receive options to be granted under the Share Option Scheme. The aggregate amounts of remuneration including fees, salaries, contributions to pension schemes, housing allowances and other allowances and benefits in kind and discretionary bonuses which were paid or payable to the Directors for the two years ended 31 December 2015 was approximately HK$0.9 million and HK$1.1 million respectively. Under the arrangement currently in force, the aggregate remuneration (excluding discretionary bonus) of the Directors for the year ending 31 December 2016 is estimated to be approximately HK$1.4 million. The five highest paid individuals included two directors for the two years ended 31 December 2015. The aggregate amounts of remuneration including fees, salaries, contributions to pension schemes, housing allowances and other allowances and benefits in kind and discretionary bonuses which were paid by the Group to the remaining three highest paid individuals for the two years ended 31 December 2015 was approximately HK$1.1 million and HK$1.2 million respectively. During the Track Record Period, no remuneration was paid by the Group to, or received by, the Directors or the five highest paid individuals as an inducement to join or upon joining the Group or as compensation for loss of office. There was no arrangement under which a director waived or agreed to waive any remuneration during the Track Record Period. For additional information on Directors’ remuneration during the Track Record Period as well as information on the highest paid individuals, please refer to notes 12 and 13 to the Accountant’s Report set out in Appendix I to this document. SHARE OPTION SCHEME The Company has adopted conditionally the Share Option Scheme. For details of the Share Option Scheme, please refer to the section entitled “Appendix IV — Share Option Scheme” in this document. – 169 – THIS APPLICATION PROOF IS IN DRAFT FORM. The information contained herein is incomplete and is subject to change. This Application Proof must be read in conjunction with the section headed “Warning” on the cover of this Application Proof. DIRECTORS AND SENIOR MANAGEMENT COMPLIANCE ADVISOR Pursuant to Rule 6A.19 of the GEM Listing Rules, the Company has appointed Ample Capital Limited as the compliance adviser. The compliance adviser will advise the Company on the following matters pursuant to Rule 6A.23 of the GEM Listing Rules: (i) before the publication of any regulatory announcement, circular or financial report; (ii) where a transaction, which might be a notifiable or connected transaction, is contemplated including share issues and share repurchases; (iii) where the Company proposes to use the proceeds of the [REDACTED] in a manner different from that detailed in this document or where the business activities, developments or results deviate from any forecast, estimate or other information in this document; and (iv) where the Stock Exchange makes an inquiry of the Company regarding unusual movements in the price or trading volume of the Shares the possible development of a false market in its securities, or any other matters. The term of this appointment will commence on the [REDACTED] and is expected to end on the date on which the Company complies with Rule 18.03 of the GEM Listing Rules on the distribution of the annual report in respect of the financial results of the second full financial year commencing after the [REDACTED]. – 170 – THIS APPLICATION PROOF IS IN DRAFT FORM. The information contained herein is incomplete and is subject to change. This Application Proof must be read in conjunction with the section headed “Warning” on the cover of this Application Proof. SUBSTANTIAL SHAREHOLDERS So far as the Directors are aware, immediately following completion of the [REDACTED] and the Capitalisation Issue (without taking into account any Shares which may be issued under the [REDACTED] or the exercise of any options granted under the Share Option Scheme), the following persons will have or be deemed or taken to have beneficial interests and/or short position in the Shares or the underlying Shares which would be required to be disclosed to the Company under the provisions of Divisions 2 and 3 of Part XV of the SFO or be directly or indirectly interested in 10% or more of the nominal value of any class of share capital carrying rights to vote in all circumstances at general meetings of any of the Group: Name Nature of Interest Faith Elite Mr. Chan(Note) Beneficial Owner Interest in controlled corporation Interest in controlled corporation Mr. Li(Note) Note: Approximate percentage of interest in the Company immediately after the [REDACTED] and the Number of Capitalisation Shares Issue Number of Shares as at the Latest Practicable Date Approximate percentage of interest in the Company as at the Latest Practicable Date 15,206 15,206 76.03% 76.03% [REDACTED] [REDACTED] [REDACTED] [REDACTED] 15,206 76.03% [REDACTED] [REDACTED] As at the Latest Practicable Date, Faith Elite was directly held as to 50% and 50% by each of Mr. Chan and Mr. Li, therefore, each of Mr. Chan and Mr. Li is deemed to be interested in 50% shareholding of the Company held by Faith Elite. Save as disclosed above, the Directors are not aware of any other person who will, immediately following the completion of the [REDACTED] and the Capitalisation Issue (without taking into account any Shares that may be issued under the [REDACTED] or the exercise of any options granted under the Share Option Scheme), have beneficial interests or short positions in any of the Shares or underlying Shares, which would be required to be disclosed to the Company under the provisions of Divisions 2 and 3 of Part XV of the SFO, or who is, directly or indirectly interested in 10% or more of the nominal value of any class of share capital carrying rights to vote in the circumstances at general meetings of any member of the Group. The Directors are not aware of any arrangement which may at a subsequent date result in a change of control of the Company. – 171 – THIS APPLICATION PROOF IS IN DRAFT FORM. The information contained herein is incomplete and is subject to change. This Application Proof must be read in conjunction with the section headed “Warning” on the cover of this Application Proof. RELATIONSHIP WITH THE CONTROLLING SHAREHOLDERS CONTROLLING SHAREHOLDERS Immediately after completion of the Capitalisation Issue and the [REDACTED], Faith Elite will legally and beneficially own approximately [REDACTED]% of the entire issued share capital of the Company (without taking into account any Shares which may be issued under [REDACTED] or the exercise of any options which may be granted under the Share Option Scheme). Faith Elite is jointly owned by Mr. Chan, an executive Director and chairman of the Group, and Mr. Li, an executive Director and the chief executive officer of the Group, as to 50% and 50% respectively. Accordingly, Faith Elite, Mr. Chan and Mr. Li are the Controlling Shareholders of the Company. COMPETING INTEREST None of the Controlling Shareholders is interested in any business which is, whether directly or indirectly, in competition with the Group’s business. To ensure that competition will not exist in the future, each of the Controlling Shareholders has entered into the Deed of Non-Competition in favour of the Company to the effect that each of them will not, and will procure each of their respective close associates not to, directly or indirectly participate in, or hold any right or interest, or otherwise be involved in any business which may be in competition with the Group’s businesses. INDEPENDENCE FROM CONTROLLING SHAREHOLDERS The Directors believe that the Group is capable of carrying on its business independently from the Controlling Shareholders and/or their respective close associates after the [REDACTED], having taken into consideration the following factors: Management independence The Company aims at establishing and maintaining a strong and independent Board to oversee the Group’s business. The Board’s main function includes the approval of the overall business plans and strategies of the Group, monitoring the implementation of these policies and strategies and the management of the Company. The Company has an independent management team which is led by a team of senior management with experience and expertise in the Group’s business to implement its policies and strategies. – 172 – THIS APPLICATION PROOF IS IN DRAFT FORM. The information contained herein is incomplete and is subject to change. This Application Proof must be read in conjunction with the section headed “Warning” on the cover of this Application Proof. RELATIONSHIP WITH THE CONTROLLING SHAREHOLDERS The Board consists of six Directors, comprising three executive Directors, and three independent non-executive Directors. For a summary of the positions held by the Directors at the Company and its subsidiaries as of the Latest Practicable Date, please refer to the section headed “Directors and Senior Management” in this document. Except for Mr. Chan and Mr. Li, who act as directors of Faith Elite, being the Controlling Shareholder, none of other Directors hold(s) any directorships or positions in the Controlling Shareholders. Each of the Directors is aware of his/her fiduciary duties as a Director which requires, among other things, that he/she acts for the benefit and in the best interests of the Company and does not allow any conflict between his/her duties as a Director and his/her personal interest. In the event that there is a potential conflict of interest arising out of any transaction to be entered into between the Group and the Directors or their respective associates, the interested Director(s) shall abstain from voting at the relevant board meetings of the Company in respect of such transactions and shall not be counted in the quorum. The provisions of the Articles also ensure that matters involving a conflict of interests which may arise from time to time will be managed in line with accepted corporate governance practice. The Company has also appointed three independent non-executive Directors to ensure that there is a strong independent element on the Board and with a view to promoting the best interests of the Company and Shareholders taken as a whole. The independent non-executive Directors have diversified skills and experience in their respective fields of expertise and the Directors believe that the Board will benefit from their independent advice. In light of the above, the Directors are satisfied that they are able to perform their roles in the Company independently, and the Directors are of the view that the Company is capable of managing its business independently from the Controlling Shareholders after the [REDACTED]. Operational independence The Group has established its own organisational structure comprising individual departments, each with specific areas of responsibilities. Save as set out in this document, no services, premises and facilities will be provided by the Controlling Shareholders and/or their respective associates to the Group. The Group is able to operate independently from the Controlling Shareholders after the [REDACTED]. – 173 – THIS APPLICATION PROOF IS IN DRAFT FORM. The information contained herein is incomplete and is subject to change. This Application Proof must be read in conjunction with the section headed “Warning” on the cover of this Application Proof. RELATIONSHIP WITH THE CONTROLLING SHAREHOLDERS Financial independence The Group has an independent accounting, financial and internal control system and makes financial decisions according to its own business needs. During the Track Record Period, Mr. Chan and Mr. Li provided guarantees to the Group’s several bank loans and finance lease. [Mr. Chan and Mr. Li would be released from the guarantees prior to the [REDACTED].] Upon [REDACTED], the Group is capable of relying principally on cash from operations to carry on its business and financing from Independent Third Parties without relying on guarantee or security provided by the Controlling Shareholders. Having considered the above factors, the Directors consider that there is no financial dependence on the Controlling Shareholders. Therefore, in view of the above fact, the Group is considered independent in all material aspects including finance, management and operations of the Controlling Shareholders. UNDERTAKINGS Each of the Controlling Shareholders has given certain undertakings in respect of the Shares to the Company, the Sponsor and the [REDACTED], details of which are set out under the sub-section headed “Underwriting — Non-disposal Undertakings” in this document. NON-COMPETITION UNDERTAKINGS For the purpose of the [REDACTED], the Controlling Shareholders (the “Covenantors”) have entered into the Deed of Non-Competition with the Company, pursuant to which each of the Covenantors has unconditionally and irrevocably undertaken to the Company (for itself and for the benefits of members of the Group) that it/he/she would not, and would procure that its/his/her close associates (other than any members of the Group) would not, directly or indirectly, either on its/his/her own account or in conjunction with or on behalf of any person, firm or company, among other things, carry on, participate or be interested or engaged in or acquire or hold (in each case whether as a shareholder, director, partner, agent, employee, or otherwise, and whether for profit, reward or otherwise) any activity or business which is or may be in competition, directly or indirectly, with the business carried on or contemplated to be carried on by any member of the Group from time to time (“Restricted Activity”). Further, each of the Covenantors has unconditionally and irrevocably undertaken to the Company that in the event that it/he/she or its/his/her close associate(s) is given/identifies any opportunities which directly or indirectly competes, or may lead to competition with the Restricted Activity, it/he/she will and will procure it/his/her close associate(s) to, as soon as practicable inform the Group of such opportunity in writing, provide such information as is available to it/him/her in respect of such opportunity to the Group, refer such opportunity to the Group, and use all reasonable endeavours to procure the person who communicated the opportunity to the Covenantors or their respective close associates to contact the Group directly regarding the opportunity upon becoming aware of it. – 174 – THIS APPLICATION PROOF IS IN DRAFT FORM. The information contained herein is incomplete and is subject to change. This Application Proof must be read in conjunction with the section headed “Warning” on the cover of this Application Proof. RELATIONSHIP WITH THE CONTROLLING SHAREHOLDERS Each of the Covenantors has represented and warranted that, as of the date of the Deed of Non-Competition, neither it/he/she nor any of its/his/her close associates was interested, involved or engaged, directly or indirectly, in (whether as a shareholder, partner, agent or otherwise and whether for profit, reward or otherwise) the Restricted Activity otherwise than through the Group or was otherwise engaged in any business which is in competition or potential competition to those of the Group. Each of the Covenantors has also undertaken to the Company the following: (a) to provide all information requested by the Company which is necessary for the annual review by the independent non-executive Directors of its/his/her compliance with the terms of the Deed of Non-Competition and the enforcement of the Deed of Non-Competition; (b) to procure the Company to disclose decisions on matters reviewed by the independent non-executive Directors relating to the compliance and enforcement of its/his/her non-competition undertakings under the Deed of Non-Competition either through the annual report, or by way of announcements to the public; and (c) to make an annual declaration on compliance with his/her/its undertaking under the Deed of Non-Competition in the annual reports of the Company as the independent non-executive Directors think fit and ensure that the disclosure of details of its/his/her compliance with and the enforcement of the non-competition undertakings under the Deed of Non-Competition is consistent with the relevant requirements under the GEM Listing Rules. The Deed of Non-Competition does not apply to: (a) the holding of or interests in the shares of any member of the Group; or (b) the holding of or interests in shares or other securities in any company other than the Group which conducts or is engaged in any Restricted Activity, provided that, in the case of such shares, they are listed on a recognised stock exchange and either: (i) the relevant Restricted Activity (and assets relating thereto) accounts for less than 5% of that relevant company’s consolidated turnover or consolidated assets, as shown in that company’s latest audited accounts; or – 175 – THIS APPLICATION PROOF IS IN DRAFT FORM. The information contained herein is incomplete and is subject to change. This Application Proof must be read in conjunction with the section headed “Warning” on the cover of this Application Proof. RELATIONSHIP WITH THE CONTROLLING SHAREHOLDERS (ii) the total number of the shares held by the Covenantors and/or their respective close associates or in which they are together interested does not amount to more than 5% of the issued shares of that class of the company in question, provided that the Covenantors and/or their respective close associates, whether acting singly or jointly, are not entitled to appoint a majority of the directors of that company or otherwise participate in or be involved in the management of that company and that at all times there should exist at least another shareholder of that company (together, where appropriate, with its close associates) whose shareholdings in that company should be more than the total number of shares held by the Covenantors and/or their respective close associates together hold. The obligation of the Covenantors under the Deed of Non-Competition will cease to have any effect whatsoever on: (a) the date on which the Shares cease to be listed on the Stock Exchange; or (b) in respect of a Covenantor, the date on which that Covenantor and/or its/his/her close associates, jointly and severally, ceases to be entitled to exercise or control the exercise of not less than 30% in aggregate of the voting power at general meetings of the Company, whichever occurs first. CORPORATE GOVERNANCE MEASURES The Company will further adopt the following measures to manage the conflict of interest arising from the possible competing business of the Controlling Shareholders and to safeguard the interests of the independent Shareholders: (i) in preparation for the [REDACTED], the Company has amended the Articles to comply with the GEM Listing Rules. In particular, the Articles provide that, except for certain exceptions permitted under the GEM Listing Rules or the Stock Exchange, a Director shall not vote on any board resolution approving any contract in relation to which he has a material interest, nor shall such Director be counted in the quorum present at the meeting; (ii) the Company has appointed Ample Capital Limited as the Company’s compliance adviser, which will provide advice and guidance to the Company with respect to compliance with the applicable laws and the GEM Listing Rules, including various requirements relating to Directors’ duties and internal controls; (iii) the Company’s independent non-executive Directors will review, at least on an annual basis, the compliance with the Deed of Non-Competition by the Controlling Shareholders; – 176 – THIS APPLICATION PROOF IS IN DRAFT FORM. The information contained herein is incomplete and is subject to change. This Application Proof must be read in conjunction with the section headed “Warning” on the cover of this Application Proof. RELATIONSHIP WITH THE CONTROLLING SHAREHOLDERS (iv) each of the Controlling Shareholders has undertaken to provide all information necessary for the annual review by the independent non-executive Directors of its/his/her compliance with the terms of the Deed of Non-Competition and the enforcement of the Deed of Non-Competition; (v) the Company will disclose decisions on matters reviewed by the independent non-executive Directors relating to compliance and enforcement of the Deed of Non-Competition either through the annual report, or by way of announcements to the public; (vi) each of the Controlling Shareholders will make an annual declaration of compliance with the Deed of Non-Competition in the annual reports of the Company; (vii) the management structure of the Group includes an audit committee, a remuneration committee, and a nomination committee, the terms of reference of each of which will require them to be alert to prospective conflict of interest and to formulate their proposals accordingly; and (viii) pursuant to the Corporate Governance Code in Appendix 15 to the GEM Listing Rules, the Directors, including the independent non-executive Directors, will be able to seek independent professional advice from external parties in appropriate circumstances at the Company’s costs. The Directors consider that the above corporate governance measure are sufficient to manage any potential conflict of interests between the Controlling Shareholders and their respective close associates and the Group and to protect the interests of the Shareholders, in particular, the minority Shareholders. – 177 – THIS APPLICATION PROOF IS IN DRAFT FORM. The information contained herein is incomplete and is subject to change. This Application Proof must be read in conjunction with the section headed “Warning” on the cover of this Application Proof. SHARE CAPITAL SHARE CAPITAL OF THE COMPANY The following is a description of the authorised and issued share capital of the Company immediately before and following the completion of the [REDACTED] and upon [REDACTED]: Authorised share capital [REDACTED] HK$ Shares of par value of HK$0.01 each Shares issued and fully paid or credited as fully paid [REDACTED] HK$ Assuming that the [REDACTED] is not exercised, the share capital of the Company immediately following the [REDACTED] and Capitalisation Issue will be as follows: 20,000 [REDACTED] [REDACTED] Total: [REDACTED] Shares in issue as at the date in this document Shares to be issued under the [REDACTED] Shares to be issued under the Capitalisation Issue Shares 200 [REDACTED] [REDACTED] [REDACTED] Assuming the [REDACTED] is exercised in full, the share capital of the Company immediately following the [REDACTED] and the Capitalisation Issue will be as follows: 20,000 [REDACTED] [REDACTED] [REDACTED] Total: [REDACTED] Shares in issue as at the date in this document Shares to be issued under the [REDACTED] Shares to be issued under the Capitalisation Issue Shares to be issued upon exercise of the [REDACTED] Shares 200 [REDACTED] [REDACTED] [REDACTED] [REDACTED] ASSUMPTIONS The above table assumes that the [REDACTED] has become unconditional and the Shares are issued pursuant to the [REDACTED]. It takes no account of any Shares, which may be allotted and issued pursuant to the exercise of the options which may be granted under the Share Option Scheme or which may be allotted and issued or repurchased by the Company under the general mandates of any Shares referred to below. – 178 – THIS APPLICATION PROOF IS IN DRAFT FORM. The information contained herein is incomplete and is subject to change. This Application Proof must be read in conjunction with the section headed “Warning” on the cover of this Application Proof. SHARE CAPITAL RANKING The [REDACTED] are ordinary shares and will rank pari passu in all respects with all the Shares now in issue or to be issued as mentioned herein, and, in particular, will qualify in full for all dividends or other distributions declared, made or paid on the Shares in respect of a record date which falls after the date in this document save for entitlement to the Capitalisation Issue. MINIMUM PUBLIC FLOAT Pursuant to Rule 11.23(7) of the GEM Listing Rules, at the time of the [REDACTED] and at all times thereafter, the Company must maintain the minimum prescribed percentage of 25% of the issued share capital of in the hands of the public (as defined in the GEM Listing Rules). THE SHARE OPTION SCHEME The Company conditionally adopted the Share Option Scheme. Summaries of the principal terms of the Share Option Scheme are set out in the sub-section entitled “Appendix IV – D. Share Option Scheme” in this document. GENERAL MANDATE TO ISSUE NEW SHARES Conditional on the fulfilment or waiver (as applicable) of the conditions set out in the sub-section headed “Structure and Conditions of the [REDACTED] — Conditions of the [REDACTED]” in this document, the Directors have been granted a general unconditional mandate to allot, issue and deal with Shares with an aggregate nominal value of not more than the sum of: (a) 20% of the aggregate nominal amount of share capital of the Company in issue immediately following completion of the [REDACTED] and upon [REDACTED]; and (b) the aggregate nominal amount of the share capital of the Company repurchased by the Company, if any, under the general mandate to repurchase Shares referred to below. The allotment and issue of Shares under a rights issue, script dividend scheme or similar arrangement in accordance with the Articles do not generally require the approval of the Shareholders in general meeting and the aggregate nominal value of the Shares which the Directors are authorised to allot and issue under this mandate will not be reduced by the allotment and issue of such Shares. This general mandate will expire at the earliest of: (a) the conclusion of the Company’s next annual general meeting; (b) the expiration of the period within which the Company is required applicable laws or its Articles to hold its next annual general meeting; and – 179 – THIS APPLICATION PROOF IS IN DRAFT FORM. The information contained herein is incomplete and is subject to change. This Application Proof must be read in conjunction with the section headed “Warning” on the cover of this Application Proof. SHARE CAPITAL (c) when varied or revoked by an ordinary resolution of the Shareholders in general meeting. For further details of this general mandate, please refer to the paragraph headed “Appendix IV — A. Further Information About The Company And Its Subsidiaries — 3. Written Resolutions of the Shareholders passed on [●]” in this document. GENERAL MANDATE TO REPURCHASE SHARES Conditional on the fulfilment or waiver (as applicable) of the conditions set out in the paragraph headed “Conditions of the [REDACTED]” under the section headed “Structure and conditions of the [REDACTED]” in this document, the Directors have been granted a general unconditional mandate to exercise all the powers of the Company to repurchase Shares with an aggregate nominal value of not more than 10% of the aggregate nominal amount of the share capital of the Company in issue following completion of the [REDACTED] and upon [REDACTED]. This mandate only relates to repurchases made on the Stock Exchange, or on any other stock exchange on which the Shares are listed (and which are recognised by the SFC and the Stock Exchange for this purpose), and which are in accordance with all applicable laws and requirements of the GEM Listing Rules. Further information required by the Stock Exchange to be included in this document regarding the repurchase of Shares is set out in the paragraph headed “Appendix IV – A. Further Information About the Company and its Subsidiaries – 7. Repurchase of the Securities” in this document. This mandate will expire at the earliest of: (a) the conclusion of the Company’s next annual general meeting; (b) the expiration of the period within which the Company is required applicable laws or its Articles to hold its next annual general meeting; and (c) when varied or revoked by an ordinary resolution of the Shareholders in general meeting. For further details of this general mandate, please refer to the paragraph headed “Appendix IV — Written Resolutions of the Shareholders passed on [●]”in this document. CIRCUMSTANCES UNDER WHICH GENERAL MEETING AND CLASS MEETING ARE REQUIRED The circumstances under which general meeting and class meeting are required are provided in the Articles. For details, please refer to the Summary of the constitution of the Company and Cayman Islands company law set out in Appendix III to this document. – 180 – THIS APPLICATION PROOF IS IN DRAFT FORM. The information contained herein is incomplete and is subject to change. This Application Proof must be read in conjunction with the section headed “Warning” on the cover of this Application Proof. FINANCIAL INFORMATION You should read the following discussion and analysis of the Group’s financial condition and results of operations together with its consolidated financial statements as at the closing date of and for the years ended 31 December 2014 and 2015 and the accompanying notes included in the Accountants’ Report set out in Appendix I to this document. The Accountants’ Report has been prepared in accordance with HKFRS. Potential investors should read the whole of the Accountants’ Report set out in Appendix I to this document and not rely merely on the information contained in this section. The following discussion and analysis contains forward-looking statements that involve risks and uncertainties (including those discussed below or elsewhere in this document). For additional information regarding these risks and uncertainties, please refer to the section headed “Risk Factors” in this document. OVERVIEW The Group is principally engaged in the sourcing, marketing, selling and distribution of a variety of fitness equipment and accessories, beauty gadgets and accessories, as well as other health care products under various brands through its sales and distribution network in Hong Kong and the PRC. The fitness equipment product segment mainly consists of treadmills, exercise bikes, elliptical trainers, steppers and other fitness accessories such as trampolines, yoga gears, dumbbells, boxing gears, heart rate monitors and diagnostic scales. The beauty gadget product segment mainly consists of beauty devices for hair removal, wrinkle reduction, skin lifting, anti-acne treatment, rejuvenation of the skin’s appearance and body sliming and other healthy accessories. Other health care products include massage devices, inflated bath tubs, electric blankets and limb-support compression wears. For the two years ended 31 December 2015, the Group generated revenue of approximately HK$67.5 million and HK$84.7 million respectively. The profit attributable to owners of the Company was approximately HK$11.4 million and HK$9.5 million for the respective years. The increase in revenue for the year ended 31 December 2015 by 25.6% as compared to that of the year ended 31 December 2014 was mainly attributable to increase in sale of beauty gadgets and accessories resulted from the increase in sales of the Group’s flagship hair removal devices via the Group’s own online sales channels as well as sales to other distributors which in turn sold such products through various channels including their online storefronts. For the year ended 31 December 2015, the decrease in profit attributable to owners of the Company by approximately 17.1% as compared to that of the year ended 31 December 2014 was mainly attributable to increase in administrative expenses, in particular, [REDACTED] expenses of approximately HK$3.9 million incurred during the year ended 31 December 2015. Excluding the effect of [REDACTED] expenses, the profit attributable to owners of the Company for year ended 31 December 2015 would be approximately HK$13.3 million, representing an increase of approximately 16.7%, which was mainly due to the increase in gross profit as driven by increase in revenue during the year. – 181 – THIS APPLICATION PROOF IS IN DRAFT FORM. The information contained herein is incomplete and is subject to change. This Application Proof must be read in conjunction with the section headed “Warning” on the cover of this Application Proof. FINANCIAL INFORMATION BASIS OF PRESENTATION The Company was incorporated as a limited liability company in the Cayman Islands on 14 May 2015. In preparation of the [REDACTED], the Group underwent the Reorganisation, as detailed in the sub-section headed “History, Reorganisation and Group Structure — Reorganisation” in this document. As a result of the Reorganisation, the Company became a holding company of the subsidiaries comprising the Group. The financial information includes the consolidated statements of profit and loss and other comprehensive income, consolidated statements of changes in equity, consolidated statements of cash flows and consolidated statements of financial position of the companies now comprising the Group. The financial information has been prepared as if the current group structure had been in existence throughout the Track Record Period. The consolidated statements of financial position of the Group as at 31 December 2014 and 2015 have been prepared to present the assets and liabilities of the Group as at the respective dates as if the current group structure had been in existence at those dates. Transactions, balances and unrealised gain or losses on transactions between companies within the Group are eliminated on consolidation. KEY FACTORS AFFECTING THE RESULTS OF OPERATIONS The results of operations and financial condition of the Group have been and will continue to be affected by a number of factors, many of which may be beyond control of the Group, including those factors set out in the section headed “Risk Factors” in this document and those set out below. Market recognition of the branded products and proprietary products and the trade name The growth of the historical sales was mainly driven by the increasing market recognition of the branded products managed by the Group in Hong Kong and the PRC. The Directors expect the future sales growth to receive continuous benefits from the expansion of public awareness of the fitness equipment and beauty gadget products in Hong Kong and the PRC. The growth of these markets is affected by a number of factors, including the growth of GDP and disposable income level of households as well as consumer preferences. For the Group’s fitness equipment and beauty gadget products, the Group faces challenges from Hong Kong, the PRC and foreign manufacturers, distributors as well as other brand owners. – 182 – THIS APPLICATION PROOF IS IN DRAFT FORM. The information contained herein is incomplete and is subject to change. This Application Proof must be read in conjunction with the section headed “Warning” on the cover of this Application Proof. FINANCIAL INFORMATION Through distributing and marketing under the direct and indirect sales and distribution network, the Group offers a variety of fitness equipment and beauty gadget products sourced from third party brand owners. The Group also offers certain products under its own proprietary brands. The Directors believe the Group’s success depends substantially on the popularity of the branded products and its proprietary products, as well as the reputation of its trade name of “Fitboxx 元氣館”. As at the Latest Practicable Date, all the Group’s retails outlets are operated under the trade name of “Fitboxx 元氣館” to offer branded products and proprietary products. The Directors believe that brand and trade name recognition plays an important role in influencing consumers’ decisions in purchasing the products. The Group has been investing significant effort to establish brand and trade name recognition through various media channels. The Directors believe that the continued success will depend largely on the ability to enhance the recognition of the branded and proprietary products offered by the Group, and the reputation and public awareness of its trade name. Furthermore, as the Group continues to expand its sales network, the ability to market and promote the branded and proprietary products as well as its trade name will remain critical to the success of the business. Coverage of the Group’s sales and distribution network The revenue and profit growth of the Group will depend to a significant extent on the ability to successfully expand and manage the sales and distribution network. The Group may face challenges with finding suitable distribution channels in Hong Kong and the PRC. The Group will rely continuously on the ability of the self-operated retail outlets, sales to chain retailers and other distributors and retailers, and online sales through its own websites and third party e-commerce platforms to successfully promote its products to end consumers. In the event that any of the major sales channels is found to be unsustainable, which may be due to the deteriortation of the business of the distributor customers of the Group and hence out of control of the Group, the sales and results of operations of the Group may be adversely affected. – 183 – THIS APPLICATION PROOF IS IN DRAFT FORM. The information contained herein is incomplete and is subject to change. This Application Proof must be read in conjunction with the section headed “Warning” on the cover of this Application Proof. FINANCIAL INFORMATION The product portfolio The Group’s ability to introduce new products to the market that meet consumer preferences will have a significant influence on the future sales volume and financial performance. The success of the Group’s branded and proprietary products depends on a number of factors, including (i) the Group’s ability to accurately anticipate changes in market demand and consumer preferences; (ii) the Group’s ability to differentiate its products from those of the competitors; (iii) the Group’s ability to obtain exclusive distribution rights of branded products from brand owners; and (iv) intellectual property rights of competitors that may cause limitation in the Group’s product offerings. CRITICAL ACCOUNTING POLICIES AND ESTIMATES Critical accounting policies and estimates are those accounting policies and estimates that involve significant judgments and uncertainties and potentially yield materially different results under different assumptions and conditions. The consolidated financial statements have been prepared in accordance with HKFRSs, which requires that the Group adopts accounting policies and makes estimates that it believes are the most appropriate in the circumstances for the purposes of giving a true and fair view of the results of operations and financial condition. Estimates and judgments are based on historical experience, prevailing market conditions and rules and regulations, and are reviewed on a continual basis taking into account of the changing environment and circumstances. For more details, see notes 4 and 5 to the Accountants’ Report set forth in Appendix I to this document. Revenue recognition Revenue is measured at the fair value of the consideration received or receivable and is recognised when it is probable that the economic benefits will flow to the Group and the amount of revenue can be measured reliably. (i) Sales of goods Revenue from the sales of goods is recognised on the transfer of significant risks and rewards of ownership, which generally coincides with the time when the goods are delivered and the title has passed to the customers. (ii) Interest income Interest income is recognised on a time-proportion basis using the effective interest method. – 184 – THIS APPLICATION PROOF IS IN DRAFT FORM. The information contained herein is incomplete and is subject to change. This Application Proof must be read in conjunction with the section headed “Warning” on the cover of this Application Proof. FINANCIAL INFORMATION Inventories Inventories are stated at the lower of cost and net realisable value. Cost is determined using the first-in, first-out basis. Net realisable value is the estimated selling price in the ordinary course of business, less the estimated costs of completion and the estimated costs necessary to make the sale. Trade and other receivables Trade receivables are amounts due from customers for merchandise sold or services performed in the ordinary course of business. If collection of trade and other receivables is expected in one year or less (or in the normal operating cycle of the business if longer), they are classified as current assets. If not, they are presented as non-current assets. Trade and other receivables are recognised initially at fair value and subsequently measured at amortised cost using the effective interest method, less allowance for impairment. Plant and equipment Plant and equipment, held for use in the production or supply of goods or services, or for administrative purposes are stated in the consolidated statement of financial position at cost, less subsequent accumulated depreciation and subsequent accumulated impairment losses if any. Subsequent costs are included in the asset’s carrying amount or recognised as a separate asset, as appropriate, only when it is probable that future economic benefits associated with the item will flow to the Group and the cost of the item can be measured reliably. All other repairs and maintenance are recognised in profit or loss during the period in which they are incurred. Depreciation of plant and equipment is calculated at rates sufficient to write off their cost over the estimated useful lives on a straight-line basis. The principal annual rates are as follows: Furniture and Fixtures Office equipment Motor vehicles Leasehold improvements 20% 20% 30% 20% The useful lives and depreciation method are reviewed and adjusted, if appropriate, at the end of each reporting period. The gain or loss on disposal of plant and equipment is the difference between the net sales proceeds and the carrying amount of the relevant asset, and is recognised in profit or loss. – 185 – THIS APPLICATION PROOF IS IN DRAFT FORM. The information contained herein is incomplete and is subject to change. This Application Proof must be read in conjunction with the section headed “Warning” on the cover of this Application Proof. FINANCIAL INFORMATION Useful lives of plant and equipment The Group determines the estimated useful lives, residual values and related depreciation charges for the Group’s plant and equipment. This estimate is based on the historical experience of the actual useful lives and residual values of plant and equipment of similar nature and functions. The Group will revise the depreciation charge where useful lives and residual values are different to those previously estimated, or it will write-off or write-down technically obsolete or non-strategic assets that have been abandoned. Impairment loss for bad and doubtful debts The Group makes impairment loss for bad and doubtful debts based on assessments of the recoverability of the trade and other receivables, including the current creditworthiness and the past collection history of each debtor. Impairments arise where events or changes in circumstances indicate that the balances may not be collectible. The identification of bad and doubtful debts, in particular of a loss event, requires the use of judgment and estimates. Where the actual result is different from the original estimate, such difference will impact the carrying value of the trade and other receivables and doubtful debt expenses in the year in which such estimate has been changed. Allowance for slow-moving inventories Allowance for slow-moving inventories is made based on the aging and estimated net realisable value of inventories. The assessment of the allowance amount involves judgment and estimates. Where the actual outcome in future is different from the original estimate, such difference will impact the carrying value of inventories and allowance charge/write-back in the period in which such estimate has been changed. – 186 – THIS APPLICATION PROOF IS IN DRAFT FORM. The information contained herein is incomplete and is subject to change. This Application Proof must be read in conjunction with the section headed “Warning” on the cover of this Application Proof. FINANCIAL INFORMATION SUMMARY OF FINANCIAL INFORMATION The following table presented the selected financial data from the consolidated income statements for the two years ended 31 December 2015 which have been extracted from, and should be read in conjunction with the Accountants’ Report set forth in Appendix I to this document. Consolidated statement of profit or loss and other comprehensive income Year ended 31 December 2014 2015 HK$’000 HK$’000 Revenue Cost of goods sold 67,465 (25,450) 84,744 (33,540) Gross profit Other income Selling and distribution expenses Administrative expenses 42,015 5 (22,693) (6,184) 51,204 98 (25,296) (12,998) Profit from operations Finance costs 13,143 (99) 13,008 (334) Profit before tax Income tax expense 13,044 (1,626) 12,674 (3,205) Profit for the year attributable to owners of the Company 11,418 9,469 Other comprehensive income after tax: Item that may be reclassified to profit or loss: – Exchange differences on translating foreign operations 4 (204) Other comprehensive income for the year, net of tax 4 (204) Total comprehensive income for the year attributable to owners of the Company – 187 – 11,422 9,265 THIS APPLICATION PROOF IS IN DRAFT FORM. The information contained herein is incomplete and is subject to change. This Application Proof must be read in conjunction with the section headed “Warning” on the cover of this Application Proof. FINANCIAL INFORMATION Consolidated statement of financial position As at 31 December 2014 2015 HK$’000 HK$’000 Non-current assets Plant and equipment Long-term rental deposits 1,679 694 979 1,446 2,373 2,425 22,483 5,084 6,005 2,889 6,782 14,624 3,142 5,224 3,985 13,908 43,243 40,883 8,278 7,835 250 161 4,302 3,392 4,292 1,224 163 3,019 20,826 12,090 Net current assets 22,417 28,793 Total assets less current liabilities 24,790 31,218 472 242 2,523 79 714 2,602 NET ASSETS 24,076 28,616 Capital and reserves Share capital Reserves 10 24,066 1 28,615 TOTAL EQUITY 24,076 28,616 Current assets Inventories Trade receivables Prepayments, deposits and other receivables Due from directors Bank and cash balances Current liabilities Trade payables Accruals and other payables Bank loans Finance lease payables Current tax liabilities Non-current liabilities Bank loans Finance lease payables – 188 – THIS APPLICATION PROOF IS IN DRAFT FORM. The information contained herein is incomplete and is subject to change. This Application Proof must be read in conjunction with the section headed “Warning” on the cover of this Application Proof. FINANCIAL INFORMATION DISCUSSION AND ANALYSIS OF FINANCIAL CONDITION AND OPERATIONS OF THE GROUP Revenue by products The revenue represents the net invoiced value of goods sold after deduction of allowances for returns (if any) and trade discounts provided to the Group’s consumers. During the Track Record Period, the revenue was derived from the sales of the Group’s fitness, beauty and other health care products, which are broadly classified into three major types of products including: (i) fitness equipment and accessories; (ii) beauty gadgets and accessories; and (iii) other health care products. The following table sets forth the breakdown of the Group of revenue by types of product: For the year ended 31 December 2014 2015 HK$’000 % HK$’000 Fitness equipment and accessories Beauty gadgets and accessories Other health care products Total % 23,919 35.5 22,463 26.5 41,373 61.3 60,706 71.6 2,173 3.2 1,575 1.9 67,465 100.0 84,744 100.0 The overall revenue of the Group increased by approximately 25.6% from approximately HK$67.5 million for the year ended 31 December 2014 to approximately HK$84.7 million for the year ended 31 December 2015, driven by the increase in sales of the beauty gadgets and accessories sector. The sales derived from fitness equipment and accessories slightly decreased by approximately 6.1% from approximately HK$23.9 million in 2014 to approximately HK$22.5 million in 2015. The sales of the beauty gadgets and accessories significantly increased by approximately 46.7% from approximately HK$41.4 million in 2014 to approximately HK$60.7 million in 2015. Most of the Group’s products are branded products sourced from various brand owners located worldwide, including Hong Kong. The Group’s proprietary products are mainly fitness equipment supplied by manufacturers in the PRC and Taiwan. – 189 – THIS APPLICATION PROOF IS IN DRAFT FORM. The information contained herein is incomplete and is subject to change. This Application Proof must be read in conjunction with the section headed “Warning” on the cover of this Application Proof. FINANCIAL INFORMATION The following table sets forth the breakdown of the Group of revenue by products sold under brand owners’ brands and products sold under the Group’s proprietary brands: For the year ended 31 December 2014 2015 HK$’000 % HK$’000 % Branded products Proprietary products 60,888 6,577 90.3 9.7 79,777 4,967 94.1 5.9 Total 67,465 100.0 84,744 100.0 As the Group’s products are mainly for home-use, its fitness equipment and beauty gadgets product market is considered as a consumer market. The various types of products sold by the Group are subject to different levels of demand and consumer ’s preference, which also depends on a series of factors, including the pricing of the products, the product differentiation, the brand images, the marketing and promotion activities, the customer loyalty, the accessibility of the distribution channels of the products and the overall market trend. Fitness equipment and accessories The fitness equipment and accessories sector included both branded and proprietary products. These products include treadmills, exercise bikes, elliptical trainers, steppers and other fitness accessories such as trampolines, yoga gears, dumbbells, boxing gears, heart rate monitors and diagnostic scales. For the two years ended 31 December 2015, the fitness equipment and accessories represented approximately 35.5%, and 26.5% of the Group’s revenue respectively. The overall decrease in percentage of the Group’s revenue derived from the fitness equipment and accessories sector during the Track Record Period was mainly due to the significant increase in sales of beauty gadgets and accessories sector in 2015. The slight decrease in revenue from the fitness equipment and accessories sector for the year ended 31 December 2015 was mainly attributable to the decrease in sales of treadmill during the year, though mitigated by the increase in sales of exercise bikes and fitness accessories. The Directors consider that such change was mainly due to the launch of certain new treadmill models in 2014 which resulted in increase in sales of treadmills in 2014 as compared to that of 2015; and that the Group launched more new models of exercise bikes and fitness accessories in 2015. – 190 – THIS APPLICATION PROOF IS IN DRAFT FORM. The information contained herein is incomplete and is subject to change. This Application Proof must be read in conjunction with the section headed “Warning” on the cover of this Application Proof. FINANCIAL INFORMATION Beauty gadgets and accessories The beauty gadgets and accessories sector mainly consists of branded beauty devices for hair removal and facial care (e.g. wrinkle reduction, skin tightening and skin rejuvenation), which in aggregate accounted for over 70% and 80% of the revenue from such sector during the year ended 31 December 2014 and 2015 respectively. Other beauty gadgets include devices for cellulite reduction and hair rejuvenation. Beauty accessories mainly include hair care products and anti-ultraviolet clothing products. For the two years ended 31 December 2015, the beauty gadgets and accessories represented approximately 61.3% and 71.6% of the Group’s revenue respectively. The overall increase in percentage of the Group’s revenue derived from the beauty gadgets and accessories sector during the Track Record Period was mainly due to the increase in sales of the Group’s flagship hair removal devices via the Group’s own online sales channels as well as sales to other distributors which in turn sold such products on their online storefronts. Other health care products The Group also sells a wide variety of other health care products such as massage devices, inflated bath tubs, electric blankets and limb-support compression wears, as auxiliary products to cater for customer needs, which accounted for approximately 3.2% and 1.9% of the Group’s revenue for the two years ended 31 December 2015 respectively. – 191 – THIS APPLICATION PROOF IS IN DRAFT FORM. The information contained herein is incomplete and is subject to change. This Application Proof must be read in conjunction with the section headed “Warning” on the cover of this Application Proof. FINANCIAL INFORMATION Revenue by distribution channels The Group’s diversified distribution channels contributed to its success in growth of revenue and gaining market share during the Track Record Period. The following table sets forth a breakdown of the Group’s revenue by distribution channels for the Track Record Period: For the year ended 31 December 2014 2015 HK$’000 % HK$’000 Direct sales Physical stores: Own retail shops Department store counter and shopping mall booth Franchised stores Online stores: Own websites Third party e-commerce platforms Group buying platforms Indirect sales Chain retailers Other distributors and retailers Total % 24,215 35.9 31,544 37.2 3,048 7,051 4.5 10.5 3,128 842 3.7 1.0 1,316 1.9 1,539 1.8 7,692 11.4 16,174 19.1 1,353 2.0 3,605 4.2 7,365 10.9 7,676 9.1 15,425 22.9 20,236 23.9 67,465 100.0 84,744 100.0 The Group has established a multi-channel sales and distribution network which is broadly classified into eight major distribution channels as follows: (i) own retail shops, (ii) department store counter and shopping mall booth, (iii) franchised stores, (iv) own websites, (v) third party e-commerce platforms, (vi) group buying platforms, (vii) chain retailers and (viii) other distributors and retailers. In light of the increasing marketing and promotion activities and the expansion of the sales and distribution network developed over the years, the Group has achieved remarkable growth in overall revenue during the year ended 31 December 2015 as compared to that of 2014, mainly contributed from sales derived from online storefronts set up at third party e-commerce platforms such as Tmall, as well as sales to other distributors which operate their own online storefronts at e-commerce platforms. – 192 – THIS APPLICATION PROOF IS IN DRAFT FORM. The information contained herein is incomplete and is subject to change. This Application Proof must be read in conjunction with the section headed “Warning” on the cover of this Application Proof. FINANCIAL INFORMATION Direct sales During the Track Record Period, the Group’s direct sales were conducted through physical retail outlets, including own retail shops, a department store counter, a shopping mall booth and franchised stores; as well as online channels including its own website, storefronts at third party e-commerce platforms and group buying platforms. Own retail shops and franchised stores During the year ended 31 December 2014, except for the relocation of a shop in Causeway Bay district, the Group operated eight retail shops (being five own retail shops and three franchised stores) in Hong Kong. Upon the termination of the franchise arrangement with the two franchisees in Kowloon Bay and Diamond Hill districts, the Group continued to lease the premises of the franchised store at Diamond Hill as its own retail shop and did not renew the rental of another own retail shop located in the same shopping mall in Diamond Hill district upon the expiry of the lease, and maintained six retail shops (being five own retail shops and one franchised store) as at 31 December 2014. In order to consolidate its market presence, the Group did not renew the rental of the relevant retail shop upon the expiry of the lease during the year ended 31 December 2015. Upon the termination of the franchise arrangement with the franchisee in Yuen Long district, the Group continued to lease the premises of the franchise store as its own retail shop, and maintained five retail shops, all being own retail shops in Hong Kong as at 31 December 2015 and up to the Latest Practicable Date. Except that the rental and other operation costs of the franchised stores were born by the franchisees, the operations of the franchised stores were basically the same as the Group’s own retail shops. In particular, the franchised stores were under the full control of the Group where all sales proceeds of the shops were received by the Group which then paid the pre-agreed percentages of the sales proceeds of different products to the franchisees as agency fees on a monthly basis. Therefore, the franchised stores were regarded as self-operated stores and all sales proceeds of the franchised stores were treated as revenue of the Group. For the two years ended 31 December 2015, despite the reduction in number of retail shops, the aggregate revenue of all the Group’s self-operated physical stores amounted to approximately HK$31.3 million and HK$32.4 million respectively, represented a steady growth of approximately 3.5%. The revenue in this category also included those revenue generated from the Group’s hotline sales through its hotline staff; and sales in trade fairs and exhibitions. Department store counter and shopping mall booth During the Track Record Period and up to the Latest Practicable Date, the Group operated a department store counter in Kowloon Bay district and a shopping mall booth in Quarry Bay district for the sale of its products, where the Group was required to conduct its sales activities within the specified areas stipulated under the respective license agreements. – 193 – THIS APPLICATION PROOF IS IN DRAFT FORM. The information contained herein is incomplete and is subject to change. This Application Proof must be read in conjunction with the section headed “Warning” on the cover of this Application Proof. FINANCIAL INFORMATION For the two years ended 31 December 2015, the aggregate revenue generated from the department store counter and the shopping mall booth amounted to approximately HK$3.0 million and HK$3.1 million respectively, represented a steady growth of approximately 2.6%. Own websites The revenue generated from the Group’s own website, namely, www.fitboxx.com, amounted to approximately HK$1.3 million and HK$1.5 million respectively during the two years ended 31 December 2015, represented an increase of approximately 16.9%, which the Directors believe to be mainly due to the increasingly popularity of online shopping by internet viewer traffic. The Group will keep regular update of the design and layout of the storefront on its own website in order to maintain the informative and attractive features, which the Directors believe would achieve efficacy for the Group’s sales in physical stores. Third party e-commerce platforms The Group’s revenue from online sales at third party e-commerce platforms mainly included sales generated from the Group’s storefronts set up at an e-commerce platform, namely, Tmall in the PRC. The revenue generated from the Group’s Tmall storefronts accounted for approximately 89.2% and 92.9% respectively of the revenue generated from third party e-commerce platforms. For the two years ended 31 December 2015, revenue from this category amounted to approximately HK$7.7 million and HK$16.2 million respectively, represented an increase of approximately 110.3%. Such significant increase was mainly due to the change of the operation mode of the indirect online sales via certain related parties who, to the best knowledge of the Directors, operated Taobao storefronts for selling the Group’s products generally at level off prices on an indent basis (where the Group’s sales to those related parties were classified as indirect sales under the category of “other distributors and retailers”), to direct online sales at the Group’s own Tmall storefronts since March to April 2015. The Group’s sales to those related parties amounted to approximately HK$7.4 million and HK$1.4 million respectively during the two years ended 31 December 2015. If the revenue from such transactional arrangement of indirect online sales through related parties were aggregated with the revenue from direct online sales at third party e-commerce platforms, the combined revenue would be approximately HK$15.1 million and HK$17.6 million respectively, represented a growth of approximately 16.6% which was in line with the growth rate of the Group’s online sales on its own website. Group buying platforms The Group’s revenue from group buying platforms represents the online sales of goods redemption vouchers launched at periodic promotion time slots at those e-commerce platforms, all based in Hong Kong. The Group’s sales of goods redemption vouchers at such group buying platforms are carried out at considerable discounted prices and at limited quantity, mainly for the purposes of product promotion and inventory clearance. – 194 – THIS APPLICATION PROOF IS IN DRAFT FORM. The information contained herein is incomplete and is subject to change. This Application Proof must be read in conjunction with the section headed “Warning” on the cover of this Application Proof. FINANCIAL INFORMATION For the two years ended 31 December 2015, revenue from this category amounted to approximately HK$1.4 million and HK$3.6 million respectively, represented an increase of approximately 166.4%, though accounted for only approximately 2.0% and 4.2% of the Group’s revenues during the respective years. Indirect sales Chain retailers The Group’s sales to chain retailer customers under this category are all governed by contractual arrangements, including both on a consignment basis and non-consignment basis. These chain retailers are all Hong Kong based reputable operators of chain stores and comprised extensive retail networks of cosmetic products, pharmaceutical and health care products, as well as electronics products and home appliances. The Group’s products sold to these chain retailers are mainly beauty gadgets. For the two years ended 31 December 2015, revenue from this category amounted to approximately HK$7.4 million and HK$7.7 million respectively, represented a steady increase of approximately 4.2%. Other distributors and retailers During the Track Record Period, the Group’s sales to other distributors and retailers mainly comprised sales to certain related parties as detailed in the above category headed “Third party e-commerce platforms” and sales to a few other distributors which operate its own online storefronts in the PRC. For the two years ended 31 December 2015, revenue from this category amounted to approximately HK$15.4 million and HK$20.2 million respectively. Excluding the sales to those related parties who operated online storefronts at Taobao, the revenue from sales to other distributors and retailers would amounted to approximately HK$8.0 million and HK$18.8 million respectively, represented a significant increase of approximately HK$10.8 million or growth of 134.4% in 2015 as compared to 2014. Such increase was mainly attributable to the overall increase in sales to those customers, including new customers gained in 2015, which sold the products through various channels including online retail shops in the PRC. The Directors consider such increase was mainly due to the continuous growth of the online retail market in the PRC and the increase in demand for beauty gadget products of the PRC’s consumers, which boosted the Group’s sales to those distributors and retailers. Direct sales vs. indirect sales For the year ended 31 December 2014, the Group’s revenue from direct sales and indirect sales amounted to approximately HK$44.7 million and HK$22.8 million respectively, and accounted for approximately 66.2% and 33.8% respectively of the Group’s revenue for the year. For the year ended 31 December 2015, the Group’s revenue from direct sales and indirect sales amounted to approximately HK$56.8 million and HK$27.9 million respectively, and accounted for approximately 67.0% and 33.0% – 195 – THIS APPLICATION PROOF IS IN DRAFT FORM. The information contained herein is incomplete and is subject to change. This Application Proof must be read in conjunction with the section headed “Warning” on the cover of this Application Proof. FINANCIAL INFORMATION respectively of the Group’s revenue for the year. Hence, the Group’s revenue share derived from direct sales channels and indirect sales channels were relatively stable during the Track Record Period. Revenue by geographic locations The following table sets forth a breakdown of the Group’s revenue by geographical region during the Track Record Period, based on location of the Group’s customers: For the year ended 31 December 2014 2015 HK$’000 % HK$’000 % Hong Kong The PRC 50,843 16,622 75.4 24.6 64,527 20,217 76.1 23.9 Total 67,465 100.0 84,744 100.0 During the Track Record Period, the revenue from Hong Kong mainly included (i) sales in self-operated physical stores in Hong Kong; (ii) sales through the Group’s own website and group buying platforms; (iii) sales to chain retailers which were all located in Hong Kong; (iv) and sales to certain other distributors which received goods in Hong Kong for their resale in the PRC. On the other hand, the revenue from the PRC mainly included direct online sales through the Group’s online storefronts on Tmall of the PRC and sales to certain PRC distributors which operated their own online storefronts on e-commerce platforms in the PRC. For the two years ended 31 December 2015, the revenue from Hong Kong accounted for approximately 75.4% and 76.1% respectively of the Group’s revenue, while the revenue from the PRC accounted for approximately 24.6% and 23.9% of the Group’s revenue; demonstrating a relatively stable share of the Group’s revenue between the two geographical locations during the Track Record Period. Cost of sales The Group’s cost of sales were approximately HK$25.5 million and HK$33.5 million for the two years ended 31 December 2015, which mainly represented the cost of merchandise purchased from brand owners of branded products or manufacturers of the Group’s proprietary products. It also included other direct costs which mainly comprised transportation charges. – 196 – THIS APPLICATION PROOF IS IN DRAFT FORM. The information contained herein is incomplete and is subject to change. This Application Proof must be read in conjunction with the section headed “Warning” on the cover of this Application Proof. FINANCIAL INFORMATION The following table sets forth a breakdown of the major component of cost of sales during the Track Record Period: For the year ended 31 December 2014 2015 HK$’000 % HK$’000 % Cost of merchandise Other direct costs 24,759 691 97.3 2.7 32,760 780 97.7 2.3 Total 25,450 100.0 33,540 100.0 The cost of merchandise included in the Group’s cost of goods sold increased from approximately HK$24.8 million for the year ended 31 December 2014 to approximately HK$32.8 million for the year ended 31 December 2015, representing an increase of approximately 32.3% which was in line with the increase in the Group’s revenue over the years. Other direct costs mainly represented transportation charges incurred in the respective years. The increase in other direct costs by approximately 12.9% during the year ended 31 December 2015 as compared to that of 2014 was mainly due to increase in transportation charges which accounted for over 95% of other direct costs for both years, and was in line with the increase in cost of sales. Gross profit and gross profit margin Gross profit represents the excess of revenue over cost of goods sold. The following table sets forth the overall gross profit margin of the Group for the two years ended 31 December 2015: For the year ended 31 December 2014 2015 HK$’000 HK$’000 Revenue Cost of goods sold 67,465 25,450 84,744 33,540 Gross profit 42,015 51,204 Gross profit margin 62.3% 60.4% – 197 – THIS APPLICATION PROOF IS IN DRAFT FORM. The information contained herein is incomplete and is subject to change. This Application Proof must be read in conjunction with the section headed “Warning” on the cover of this Application Proof. FINANCIAL INFORMATION The overall gross profit margin slightly decreased from approximately 62.3% for the year ended 31 December 2014 to approximately 60.4% for the year ended 31 December 2015, which was mainly due to the increase in sales of beauty gadget products to other distributors at wholesale prices during the year ended 31 December 2015. Nevertheless, as the cost of goods sold included other direct costs which were incurred during the relevant years but were not allocated to specific product types or sales channels. For the purpose of facilitating the further analysis of the Group’s profit margin by product types and by sales channels, which only included the cost of merchandise purchased as the relevant cost of goods sold, the following table sets forth the overall gross profit and gross profit margin as adjusted to include only the cost of merchandise purchased as the cost of goods sold: For the year ended 31 December 2014 2015 HK$’000 HK$’000 Revenue Cost of goods sold (include cost of merchandise only) 67,465 84,744 24,759 32,760 Gross profit (before other direct costs) 42,706 51,984 Gross profit margin (before other direct costs) 63.3% 61.3% The gross profit margin (before other direct costs) decreased slightly from approximately 63.3% for the year ended 31 December 2014 to approximately 61.3% for the year ended 31 December 2015. The following table sets forth a summary of (i) gross profit and gross profit margin (before other direct costs) by product types; and (ii) gross profit and gross profit margin (before other direct costs) by sales channels, respectively: (i) Gross profit and gross profit margin (before other direct costs) – by product types For the year ended 31 December 2014 2015 Gross profit Gross profit HK$’000 margin (%) HK$’000 margin (%) Fitness equipment and accessories Beauty gadgets and accessories Other health care products Total gross profit (before other direct costs) 15,061 63.0 13,872 61.8 26,635 64.4 37,088 61.1 1,010 46.5 1,024 65.0 42,706 – 198 – 51,984 THIS APPLICATION PROOF IS IN DRAFT FORM. The information contained herein is incomplete and is subject to change. This Application Proof must be read in conjunction with the section headed “Warning” on the cover of this Application Proof. FINANCIAL INFORMATION The gross profit margin (before other direct costs) of fitness equipment and accessories for the two years ended 31 December 2015 was relatively stable, being approximately 63.0% and 61.8% respectively. The gross profit margin (before other direct costs) of beauty gadgets and accessories decreased slightly from approximately 64.4% for the year ended 31 December 2014 to approximately 61.1% for the year ended 31 December 2015, mainly due to the increase in sales of beauty gadget products to other distributors at wholesale prices during the year ended 31 December 2015. The gross profit margin (before other direct costs) of other health care products increased from approximately 46.5% for the year ended 31 December 2014 to approximately 65.0% for the year ended 31 December 2015, mainly due to the decrease in sales of products with relatively thin product margins. (ii) Gross profit and gross profit margin (before other direct costs) – by sales channels For the year ended 31 December 2014 2015 Gross profit Gross profit HK$’000 margin (%) HK$’000 margin (%) Direct sales Indirect sales 29,704 13,002 Total gross profit (before other direct costs) 42,706 66.5 57.0 37,004 14,980 65.1 53.7 51,984 The gross profit margin (before other direct costs) of direct sales for the two years ended 31 December 2015 was relatively stable, being approximately 66.5% and 65.1% respectively. The gross profit margin (before other direct costs) of indirect sales decreased from approximately 57.0% for the year ended 31 December 2014 to approximately 53.7% for the year ended 31 December 2015. This was mainly due to the fact that the indirect sales for the year ended 31 December 2014 included sales to certain related parties, who operated online storefronts at Taobao, where the prices of the Group’s products sold to them were generally approximated to online retail prices. Although such sales to related parties were also included in the indirect sales for the year ended 31 December 2015, they were all terminated in April 2015. Please also refer to the sub-paragraph headed “Business — Sales and distribution channels — (II) Indirect sales — Sales to other distributors and retailers — Sales to related parties” in this document for details. – 199 – THIS APPLICATION PROOF IS IN DRAFT FORM. The information contained herein is incomplete and is subject to change. This Application Proof must be read in conjunction with the section headed “Warning” on the cover of this Application Proof. FINANCIAL INFORMATION Other income Other income mainly consists of (i) bank interest income on bank deposits; and (ii) advertising subsidies provided by certain suppliers, which remained immaterial to the Group during the Track Record Period. Selling and distribution expenses The selling and distribution expenses mainly consists of (i) advertising and promotional expenses; (ii) agency fees; (iii) commission and other online charges paid to an e-commerce platform; (iv) rent, rate and management fees of the Group’s retail stores and warehouses; (v) salaries and allowances of sales staff; and (vi) transportation expenses. The following table sets forth a breakdown of the selling and distribution expenses for the two years ended 31 December 2015. For the year ended 31 December 2014 2015 HK$’000 HK$’000 Advertising and promotional expenses Agency fees Bank charges Commission and other online charges Depreciation charge Retirement benefit scheme contributions Rent, rate and management fees Salaries and allowances Sundry Transportation expense 3,833 840 766 839 504 354 7,500 7,449 68 540 4,851 48 759 1,319 422 353 8,062 8,286 193 1,003 22,693 25,296 The Group’s selling and distribution expenses increased by approximately HK$2.6 million, representing an increase of approximately 11.5% from approximately HK$22.7 million for the year ended 31 December 2014 to approximately HK$25.3 million for the year ended 31 December 2015. Such increase was mainly attributable to the combined effect of: (i) increase in advertising and promotion expenses by approximately HK$1.0 million, from approximately HK$3.8 million for the year ended 31 December 2014 to approximately HK$4.9 million for the year ended 31 December 2015, which was in line with the increase in revenue of the Group and represented approximately 5.7% of the Group’ revenue for both of the years ended 31 December 2015; – 200 – THIS APPLICATION PROOF IS IN DRAFT FORM. The information contained herein is incomplete and is subject to change. This Application Proof must be read in conjunction with the section headed “Warning” on the cover of this Application Proof. FINANCIAL INFORMATION (ii) decrease in agency fees by approximately HK$0.8 million, which mainly represented payment of pre-agreed share of revenue of franchised stores (after deducted of operation costs borne by franchisees) to franchisees, where upon the progressive termination of the three franchise arrangements, being in May 2014, September 2014 and March 2015 respectively, the agency fees decreased significantly; (iii) increase in commission and other online charges by approximately HK$0.5 million, which was mainly due to the increase in such charges paid to an e-commerce platform operator for the Group’s online sales and was in line with the increase in revenue from sales via the third party e-commerce platform; (iv) increase in rent, rate and management fees of the Group’s retail stores and warehouses by approximately HK$0.6 million, from approximately HK$7.5 million for the year ended 31 December 2014 to approximately HK$8.1 million for the year end 31 December 2015, mainly as a result of the increase in rental expenses of warehouses in Hong Kong and renting of the retail store in Diamond Hill district since October 2014 upon the termination of franchise arrangement in the district; (v) increase in salaries and allowances for sales staff by approximately HK$0.8 million, which was in line with the increase in revenue generated from the Group’s retail outlets over the years; and (vi) increase in transportation expenses for delivery of goods to customers by approximately HK$0.5 million, which was in line with the increase in revenue over the years. Administrative expenses The Group’s administrative expenses mainly consist of (i) depreciation charge; (ii) [REDACTED] expenses; (iii) repair and maintenance expenses; (iv) rent, rate and management fees of the Group’s offices in Hong Kong and the PRC; and (v) salaries and allowances (including directors’ remuneration). – 201 – THIS APPLICATION PROOF IS IN DRAFT FORM. The information contained herein is incomplete and is subject to change. This Application Proof must be read in conjunction with the section headed “Warning” on the cover of this Application Proof. FINANCIAL INFORMATION The following table sets forth a breakdown of the administrative expenses for the two years ended 31 December 2015: For the year ended 31 December 2014 2015 HK$’000 HK$’000 Accounting fee Auditors’ remuneration Bad debts written off Bank charges Courier and postage Depreciation charge Electricity and water charges Entertainment Insurance expenses Legal and professional fees [REDACTED] expenses Retirement benefit scheme contributions Motor vehicle expenses Office supplies Printing and stationery Repair and maintenance Rent, rate and management fee Salaries and allowances (including directors’ remuneration) Telecommunication Travelling Written off of plant and equipment Others 60 30 – 67 74 474 153 80 77 107 – 174 179 164 275 385 284 114 43 226 168 132 349 185 133 210 130 3,851 246 188 159 256 401 609 2,748 108 101 327 317 4,389 99 65 222 823 6,184 12,998 Excluding the effect of [REDACTED] expense of approximately HK$3.9 million incurred during the year ended 31 December 2015 for the preparation of the [REDACTED], the Group’s administrative expenses increased by approximately HK$3.0 million, representing an increase of approximately 47.9% from approximately HK$6.2 million for the year ended 31 December 2014 to approximately HK$9.1 million for the year ended 31 December 2015. Such increase was mainly due to (i) increase in rent, rate and management fee by approximately HK$0.3 million as a result of renting of office for the Company and increase in rental expense of the Group’s office in the PRC during the year ended 31 December 2015; and (ii) increase in salaries and allowances by approximately HK$1.6 million as a result of general increase in labour costs and increase in headcount during the year ended 31 December 2015. – 202 – THIS APPLICATION PROOF IS IN DRAFT FORM. The information contained herein is incomplete and is subject to change. This Application Proof must be read in conjunction with the section headed “Warning” on the cover of this Application Proof. FINANCIAL INFORMATION Finance costs Finance costs mainly represent finance lease charges and interest expenses on bank loans. The following table sets forth a breakdown of the finance costs for the two years ended 31 December 2015. For the year ended 31 December 2014 2015 HK$’000 HK$’000 Finance charges Interest on bank loans Others 35 58 6 23 306 5 99 334 The increase in finance costs for the year ended 31 December 2015 as compared to that for the year ended 31 December 2014 was mainly due to the addition of a new bank loan of HK$4.0 million for financing the working capital requirement of the Group during the year. Income tax expense During the Track Record Period, the Group’s assessable profits in respect of its Hong Kong operations were subject to Hong Kong profits tax at the applicable income tax rate of 16.5%. The Group’s assessable profits in respect of its the PRC operations were subject to the PRC enterprise income tax at the applicable income tax rate of 25%. Excluding the over-provision of profits tax in prior years credited against income tax expense for the year ended 31 December 2014 and the [REDACTED] expenses incurred by the Company for the year ended 31 December 2015, the effective tax rate for the two years ended 31 December 2015 was approximately 18.2% and 19.4% respectively. – 203 – THIS APPLICATION PROOF IS IN DRAFT FORM. The information contained herein is incomplete and is subject to change. This Application Proof must be read in conjunction with the section headed “Warning” on the cover of this Application Proof. FINANCIAL INFORMATION The following table sets forth a breakdown of the income tax expense for the two years ended 31 December 2015. For the year ended 31 December 2014 2015 HK$’000 HK$’000 Current tax – Hong Kong profits tax Provision for the year Over-provision in prior years Current tax – PRC Provision for the year 1,966 (751) 2,435 – 1,215 2,435 411 770 1,626 3,205 The Group’s income tax expense increased by approximately HK$1.6 million from approximately HK$1.6 million for the year ended 31 December 2014 to approximately HK$3.2 million for the year ended 31 December 2015, mainly due to (i) the increase in profit before tax (excluding [REDACTED] expenses) by approximately HK$3.5 million during the year; and (ii) the tax provision for the year ended 31 December 2014 was partly offset by the over-provision of profits tax in prior years of approximately HK$0.8 million. Profit attributable to owners of the Company and net profit margin The Group’s profit attributable to owners of the Company decreased by approximately HK$1.9 million, representing a decrease of approximately 17.1% from approximately HK$11.4 million for the year ended 31 December 2014 to approximately HK$9.5 million for the year ended 31 December 2015. Excluding the [REDACTED] expenses of approximately HK$3.9 million incurred by the Company during the year ended 31 December 2015, the profit attributable to owners of the Company would be increased by approximately HK$1.9 million, representing a growth of approximately 16.7%, which was in line with the growth of the Group’s revenue during the year; and the Group’s net profit margin would be approximately 16.9% and 15.7% respectively for the two years ended 31 December 2015, representing a relatively stable net profit margin over the years. – 204 – THIS APPLICATION PROOF IS IN DRAFT FORM. The information contained herein is incomplete and is subject to change. This Application Proof must be read in conjunction with the section headed “Warning” on the cover of this Application Proof. FINANCIAL INFORMATION LIQUIDITY AND CAPITAL RESOURCES Cash flow The Group’s primary uses of cash are to satisfy its working capital needs. During the Track Record Period, the Group’s uses of cash have mainly been financed through a combination of cash inflows from its operating activities and bank borrowings. As at 31 December 2015, the Group had cash and cash equivalents of approximately HK$13.9 million. The Group’s working capital requirements mainly comprise cost of purchase of merchandises, operating lease payments and employee benefits expense. The Directors expect that the Group’s capital requirements will be met by cash generated from its retail and distribution operations, bank borrowings and the net proceeds from the [REDACTED]. The following table is a condensed summary statements of cash flows for the two years ended 31 December 2015: For the year ended 31 December 2014 2015 HK$’000 HK$’000 Cash and cash equivalents at beginning of year Net cash generated from operating activities Net cash used in investing activities Net cash (used in)/generated from financing activities 2,311 8,147 (526) 6,782 4,193 (291) (3,154) 3,439 Net increase in cash and cash equivalents Effect of foreign exchange rate changes 4,467 4 7,341 (215) Cash and cash equivalents end of year 6,782 13,908 Net cash generated from operating activities During the Track Record Period, the Group mainly derived its cash inflow from operating activities from the receipt of payment from the sales of products. The Group’s cash outflow from operating activities was principally the payment for purchase of inventories. The Group’s net cash generated from operating activities mainly represented its profit before taxation, being adjusted for impairment loss on trade receivables, depreciation, finance costs, interest income, loss on disposal of plant and equipment, the effects of change in working capital and income taxes paid. For the year ended 31 December 2014, the Group had net cash generated from operating activities of approximately HK$8.1 million, primarily as a result of operating profit of approximately HK$14.4 million before net negative change in working capital of approximately HK$5.9 million and income taxes paid of approximately HK$0.4 – 205 – THIS APPLICATION PROOF IS IN DRAFT FORM. The information contained herein is incomplete and is subject to change. This Application Proof must be read in conjunction with the section headed “Warning” on the cover of this Application Proof. FINANCIAL INFORMATION million. Net negative change in working capital primarily consisted of the combined effects of (i) increase in inventories of approximately HK$4.0 million; (ii) increase in trade receivables of approximately HK$2.9 million; (iii) increase in amounts due from directors of approximately HK$2.9 million; (iv) increase in prepayments, deposits and other receivables of approximately HK$3.8 million; (v) increase in trade payables of approximately HK$2.9 million; and (vi) increase in accruals and other payables of approximately HK$5.0 million. For the year ended 31 December 2015, the Group had net cash generated from operating activities of approximately HK$4.2 million, primarily as a result of operating profit of approximately HK$14.2 million before net negative change in working capital of approximately HK$5.2 million and income taxes paid of approximately HK$4.5 million. Net negative change in working capital primarily consisted of the combined effects of (i) decrease in inventories of approximately HK$7.9 million; (ii) decrease in trade receivables of approximately HK$1.7 million; (iii) increase in amounts due from directors of approximately HK$11.9 million; (iv) decrease in trade payables of approximately HK$4.9 million; and (v) increase in accruals and other payables of approximately HK$2.0 million. Explanations of fluctuations of the aforesaid items from the consolidated statement of financial position are set out in the sub-section headed “Analysis of various items from the consolidated statement of financial position” in this section. Net cash used in investing activities For the two years ended 31 December 2015, the Group had net cash used in investing activities of approximately HK$0.5 million and HK$0.3 million respectively, which were mainly attributable to the payment for purchase of plant and equipment. Net cash used in financing activities For the year ended 31 December 2014, the Group had net cash used in financing activities of approximately HK$3.2 million, which was mainly attributable to decrease in amounts due to directors of approximately HK$3.0 million. For the year ended 31 December 2015, the Group had net cash generated from financing activities of approximately HK$3.4 million, which was mainly attributable to the combined effects of (i) proceeds from issue of shares of HK$6.8 million which represented investments by certain Pre-IPO investors; (ii) proceeds from a new bank loan raised of HK$4.0 million; (iii) repayment of bank loans of approximately HK$1.0 million; and (iv) dividends payment of HK$6.2 million. – 206 – THIS APPLICATION PROOF IS IN DRAFT FORM. The information contained herein is incomplete and is subject to change. This Application Proof must be read in conjunction with the section headed “Warning” on the cover of this Application Proof. FINANCIAL INFORMATION NET CURRENT ASSETS As at 31 December 2014 2015 HK$’000 HK$’000 Current assets Inventories Trade receivables Prepayments, deposits and other receivables Due from directors Bank and cash balances Current liabilities Trade payables Accruals and other payables Bank borrowings Finance lease payables Current tax liabilities Net current assets As at [31 March] 2016 HK$’000 22,483 5,084 14,624 3,142 [17,501] [7,135] 6,005 2,889 6,782 5,224 3,985 13,908 [6,589] [4,401] [8,506] 43,243 40,883 [44,132] 8,278 7,835 250 161 4,302 3,392 4,292 1,224 163 3,019 [6,487] [2,781] [1,246] [150] [3,212] 20,826 12,090 [13,876] 22,417 28,793 [30,256] The Group’s net current assets increased by approximately HK$6.4 million from approximately HK$22.4 million as at 31 December 2014 to approximately HK$28.8 million as at 31 December 2015, which was mainly due to the combined effects of (i) the profitable operation the Group during the year ended 31 December 2015, generating net profit attributable to owners of the Company of approximately HK$9.5 million; (ii) reclassification of the amount of share subscription money paid by certain Pre-IPO investors of HK$5.5 million included in the balance of accruals and other payables as at 31 December 2014 to other reserves as at 31 December 2015 upon completion of the share subscription in February 2015 and the Reorganisation; (iii) declaration of dividend of HK$17.0 million; (iv) the financing from net increase in non-current portion of bank loans of approximately HK$2.1 million during the year ended 31 December 2015; and (v) the financing from issue of shares of approximately HK$6.8 million during the year ended 31 December 2015. – 207 – THIS APPLICATION PROOF IS IN DRAFT FORM. The information contained herein is incomplete and is subject to change. This Application Proof must be read in conjunction with the section headed “Warning” on the cover of this Application Proof. FINANCIAL INFORMATION The increase in net current assets as at 31 December 2015 as compared to that of 2014 was mainly represented by the net effects of (i) decrease in inventories by approximately HK$7.9 million; (ii) decrease in trade receivables by approximately HK$1.9 million; (iii) decrease in prepayments, deposits and other receivables by approximately HK$0.8 million; (iv) increase in amounts due from directors of approximately HK$1.1 million; (v) increase in cash and cash equivalents by approximately HK$7.1 million; (vi) decrease in trade payables by approximately HK$4.9 million; (vii) decrease in accruals and other payables by approximately HK$3.5 million; (viii) increase in bank borrowings by approximately HK$1.0 million; and (ix) decrease in current tax liabilities by approximately HK$1.3 million. As at [31 March 2016], the Group had net current assets of approximately HK$[30.3] million, representing an increase of approximately HK$[1.5] million from approximately HK$[28.8] million as at 31 December 2015, which was mainly due to the profitable operation of the Group during the three months ended [31 March 2016]. ANALYSIS OF VARIOUS ITEMS FROM THE CONSOLIDATED STATEMENT OF FINANCIAL POSITION Plant and equipment During the Track Record Period, the Group’s plant and equipment comprised furniture and fixtures, office equipment, motor vehicles and leasehold improvements. The carrying amount of plant and equipment decreased by approximately HK$0.7 million from approximately HK$1.7 million as at 31 December 2014 to approximately HK$1.0 million as at 31 December 2015, mainly due to the combined effect of (i) additions to furniture and fixtures, office equipment and leasehold improvements aggregated to approximately HK$0.3 million for retail stores and warehouses; (ii) disposal of office equipment and leasehold improvements with aggregate net carrying amount of approximately HK$0.2 million; and (iii) depreciation charge for the year ended 31 December 2015 of approximately HK$0.8 million. Long-term rental deposits Long-term rental deposits as at 31 December 2014 and 2015 represented the Group’s rental deposits for retail outlets, offices and warehouses where the expiry dates of the leases were due more than one year from the respective year-end dates. The increase in long-term rental deposits as at 31 December 2015 was due to the fact that the majority of the Group’s existing leases were renewed during the year ended 31 December 2015 and the relevant rental deposits were classified as long-term rental deposits. – 208 – THIS APPLICATION PROOF IS IN DRAFT FORM. The information contained herein is incomplete and is subject to change. This Application Proof must be read in conjunction with the section headed “Warning” on the cover of this Application Proof. FINANCIAL INFORMATION Inventories The inventories of the Group comprise merchandises of fitness equipment and accessories, beauty gadgets and accessories, as well as other health care products. The following table sets forth a breakdown of inventories balances by product types as at 31 December 2014 and 2015: As at 31 December 2014 2015 HK$’000 HK$’000 Fitness equipment and accessories Beauty gadgets and accessories Other health care products 3,968 18,063 452 4,391 9,943 290 22,483 14,624 The Group’s inventories balance significantly decreased by approximately 35.0% from approximately HK$22.5 million as at 31 December 2014 to approximately HK$14.6 million as at 31 December 2015, which was mainly due to the fact that the Group increased the purchase of certain flagship branded beauty gadget products near the end of the year ended 31 December 2014 for sale in 2015, which boosted the sales to other distributors and retailers for the year ended 31 December 2015. The following table sets forth the inventories turnover days for the years below: For the year ended 31 December 2014 Inventories turnover days (Note) Note: 302 2015 207 The inventories turnover days were calculated using the average of the beginning and ending inventories balances of the year, divided by cost of sales (excluding other direct costs) for the year and multiplied by number of days in the year. It is the Group’s inventories policy to keep adequate inventories level to cope with customers’ demand and adjust according to the timing of planned marketing and promotion activities and the delivery lead time of goods ordered from overseas suppliers of its products. The inventories turnover days decreased from an average of approximately 302 days for the year ended 31 December 2014 to approximately 207 days for the year ended 31 December 2015, mainly due to the sale of beauty gadget products stocked up at as 31 December 2014, as it was the Group’s marketing plan to boost the sales of flagship beauty gadget products during the year ended 31 December 2015 in order to strength its beauty gadget market presence. – 209 – THIS APPLICATION PROOF IS IN DRAFT FORM. The information contained herein is incomplete and is subject to change. This Application Proof must be read in conjunction with the section headed “Warning” on the cover of this Application Proof. FINANCIAL INFORMATION The ageing analysis of the Group’s inventories as at 31 December 2014 and 2015 is as follows: As at 31 December 2014 2015 HK$’000 HK$’000 Up to 30 days 31 to 60 days 61 to 90 days 91 to 180 days 181 to 365 days Over 365 days 6,329 5,334 466 3,313 4,453 2,588 2,669 2,573 708 3,581 2,342 2,751 22,483 14,624 As at 29 February 2016, approximately 25.3% of the inventories as at 31 December 2015 were subsequently sold. Based on the experience and observation of the Directors, the Directors believe the product life cycle of beauty gadget products ranges from three to five years while fitness equipment products have longer life cycle of four to seven years. Nevertheless, the product brand owners will usually launch new product models to replace old models before the expiry of the expected product life cycles of those old models. The Group has a policy of making provisions against slow moving and obsolete inventories as and when such items are identified. During the Track Record Period, the Group had not made any allowances for impairment of obsolete and slow-moving inventories. This is because the Group closely monitors the stock ageing and usually offers the products prone to obsolescence to the customers at a discount. Trade receivables The Group’s trade receivables mainly consist of receivables from chain retailer customers and certain of its other distributor and retailer customers. The Group generally offers credit period of 30 days after the end of the month of sales to its chain retailer customers to settle payments, whereas other distributors and retailers are usually requested to settle payments within 30 to 60 days upon delivery of products depending on, among others, the distributors or retailer ’s credit record, historical sales performance, annual purchase and accounts settlement patterns. The Group seeks to maintain strict control over its outstanding receivables. Overdue balances are reviewed regularly by the management. The Group’s trade receivables decreased by approximately 38.2%, from approximately HK$5.1 million as at 31 December 2014 to approximately HK$3.1 million as at 31 December 2015, which was mainly due to the balance as at 31 December 2014 included a relatively significant amount of sales amounted to approximately HK$1.9 million to a customer near the end of 2014, which was subsequently settled in 2015. – 210 – THIS APPLICATION PROOF IS IN DRAFT FORM. The information contained herein is incomplete and is subject to change. This Application Proof must be read in conjunction with the section headed “Warning” on the cover of this Application Proof. FINANCIAL INFORMATION The following table sets forth the trade receivables turnover days for the years below: For the year ended 31 December 2014 Trade receivables turnover days (Note) Note: 20 2015 18 The trade receivables turnover days were calculated using the average of the beginning and ending trade receivables balances of the year, divided by revenue for the year and multiplied by number of days in the year. The Group’s trade receivables turnover days were maintained stable at approximately 20 days and 18 days for the two years ended 31 December 2015 respectively, which were within the credit period offered to customers. The following table sets forth the ageing analysis of the Group’s trade receivables based on the delivery of goods and net of allowances, as at 31 December 2014 and 2015: As at 31 December 2014 2015 HK$’000 HK$’000 Up to 30 days 31 to 60 days 61 to 90 days 91 to 180 days Over 180 days 3,663 959 177 61 224 2,142 659 112 228 1 5,084 3,142 As at 31 December 2014 and 2015, trade receivables of approximately HK$426,000 and HK$404,000 respectively were past due but not impaired. They relate to a number of independent customers for whom there is no recent history of default. Based on past experience, the management believes that no impairment allowance is necessary in respect of these balances as there has not been a significant change in credit quality and the balances are still considered fully recoverable. – 211 – THIS APPLICATION PROOF IS IN DRAFT FORM. The information contained herein is incomplete and is subject to change. This Application Proof must be read in conjunction with the section headed “Warning” on the cover of this Application Proof. FINANCIAL INFORMATION The ageing analysis of these trade receivables is as follows: As at 31 December 2014 2015 HK$’000 HK$’000 Up to 30 days 31 to 60 days 61 to 90 days 91 to 180 days Over 180 days 137 61 4 3 221 210 149 35 10 – 426 404 Impairment losses in respect of trade receivables are recorded using an allowance account unless the Group is satisfied that recovery of the amount is remote, in which case the impairment loss is written off against trade receivables directly. For the year ended 31 December 2015, the Group has written off bad debts amounting to approximately HK$226,000. At 31 December 2014 and 2015, none of the trade receivables was individually determined to be impaired. As at 29 February 2016, approximately 79.0% of the trade receivables as at 31 December 2015 were subsequently settled. Prepayments, deposits and other receivables Prepayments, deposits and other receivables mainly consisted of prepaid [REDACTED] expenses, trade deposits, rental and utility deposits and trade discounts receivable from suppliers. The following table sets forth the details of the Group’s deposits, prepayments and other receivables as at 31 December 2014 and 2015: As at 31 December 2014 2015 HK$’000 HK$’000 Prepaid operating expenses Prepaid [REDACTED] expenses Trade deposits Rental and utility deposits Other deposits Other receivables – 212 – 168 – – 1,331 874 3,632 488 1,284 1,073 788 934 657 6,005 5,224 THIS APPLICATION PROOF IS IN DRAFT FORM. The information contained herein is incomplete and is subject to change. This Application Proof must be read in conjunction with the section headed “Warning” on the cover of this Application Proof. FINANCIAL INFORMATION The balance of prepayments, deposits and other receivables decreased by approximately HK$0.8 million from approximately HK$6.0 million as at 31 December 2014 to approximately HK$5.2 million as at 31 December 2015, which was mainly due to the combined effects of (i) recognition of prepaid [REDACTED] expenses of approximately HK$1.3 million as at 31 December 2015; (ii) trade deposits of approximately HK$1.1 million paid to certain suppliers but the goods were yet to be received by the Group as at 31 December 2015 while there was no such trade deposits paid as at 31 December 2014; (iii) the decrease in rental and utility deposits by approximately HK$0.5 million, as the majority of the Group’s existing leases were renewed during the year ended 31 December 2015 and the relevant rental deposits were classified as long-term rental deposits; and (iv) trade discounts receivable from certain major suppliers of approximately HK$2.4 million as at 31 December 2014, while there was no such discounts receivable as at 31 December 2015. Trade payables Trade payables were related to the Group’s purchase of merchandises from suppliers. Payments to suppliers are generally made within 60 days after shipment of goods from suppliers. The Group’s trade payables of approximately HK$8.3 million as at 31 December 2014 was approximately HK$4.9 million higher than that of approximately HK$3.4 million as at 31 December 2015, which was mainly due to increase in purchase of beauty gadgets near the end of the year ended 31 December 2014, and was in line with the higher inventories balance as at 31 December 2014 as compared to that as at 31 December 2015. The following table sets forth the trade payables turnover days for the years below: For the year ended 31 December 2014 Trade payables turnover days (Note) Note: 87 2015 86 The trade payables turnover days were calculated using the average of the beginning and ending trade payable balances of the year, divided by the total amount of purchase of goods for the year and multiplied by number of days in the year. The Group’s trade payables turnover days were maintained stable at approximately 87 days and 86 days for the two years ended 31 December 2015 respectively. – 213 – THIS APPLICATION PROOF IS IN DRAFT FORM. The information contained herein is incomplete and is subject to change. This Application Proof must be read in conjunction with the section headed “Warning” on the cover of this Application Proof. FINANCIAL INFORMATION The following table sets forth the ageing analysis of the Group’s trade payables based on date of receipt of goods, as at 31 December 2014 and 2015: As at 31 December 2014 2015 HK$’000 HK$’000 Up to 30 days 31 to 60 days 61 to 90 days 91 to 180 days 1,535 5,872 151 720 1,486 1,803 103 – 8,278 3,392 As at 29 February 2016, all of the trade payables as at 31 December 2015 were subsequently settled. Accruals and other payables Accruals and other payables mainly consisted of accrued operating expenses, accrued [REDACTED] expenses, amount due to Pre-IPO investors and dividends payable. The following table sets forth the details of the Group’s accruals and other payables as at 31 December 2014 and 2015: As at 31 December 2014 2015 HK$’000 HK$’000 Accrued operating expenses Accrued [REDACTED] expenses Trade deposits received Other payables Due to Pre-IPO investors 1,919 – 192 224 5,500 1,755 2,305 141 91 – 7,835 4,292 Accrued operating expenses mainly represented accrued employees benefit expenses, being approximately HK$1.0 million and HK$1.1 million as at 31 December 2014 and 2015 respectively. The Group’s accruals and other payables decreased by approximately HK$3.5 million, from approximately HK$7.8 million as at 31 December 2014 to approximately HK$4.3 million as at 31 December 2015, which was mainly due to the combined effects of (i) the accrual of [REDACTED] expenses of approximately HK$2.3 million incurred during the year ended 31 December 2015; and (ii) the reclassification of the amount due to certain Pre-IPO investors of HK$5.5 million as at 31 December 2014 to other reserves upon the completion of the relevant share subscription in February 2015 – 214 – THIS APPLICATION PROOF IS IN DRAFT FORM. The information contained herein is incomplete and is subject to change. This Application Proof must be read in conjunction with the section headed “Warning” on the cover of this Application Proof. FINANCIAL INFORMATION and the Reorganisation. Such amount was classified as amount due to Pre-IPO investors as at 31 December 2014 since the relevant funds had been injected into the Group while the issuance of shares was pending. Bank loans As at 31 December 2014 and 2015, the Group’s bank loans were borrowed from banks in Hong Kong. The following table sets forth the Group’s bank loans as at 31 December 2014 and 2015: As at 31 December 2014 2015 HK$’000 HK$’000 Bank loans 722 3,747 The Group’s bank loans are repayable as follows: As at 31 December 2014 2015 HK$’000 HK$’000 Within one year More than one year but not exceeding two years More than two years, but not more than five years Less: Amount due for settlement within one year Amount due for settlement after one year 250 1,224 274 1,223 198 1,300 722 3,747 (250) (1,224) 472 2,523 The Group’s bank loans are arranged at the following average interest rates: As at 31 December 2014 Bank loans 9.4% – 215 – 2015 8.6% THIS APPLICATION PROOF IS IN DRAFT FORM. The information contained herein is incomplete and is subject to change. This Application Proof must be read in conjunction with the section headed “Warning” on the cover of this Application Proof. FINANCIAL INFORMATION As at 31 December 2014 and 2015, bank loans of approximately HK$722,000 and HK$3,747,000 respectively are arranged at the above fixed interest rates and exposed the Group to fair value interests rate risk. As at 31 December 2014 and 2015, the Group’s bank loans were secured by personal guarantees provided by the Directors. The Group’s bank borrowings increased by approximately HK$3.0 million from approximately HK$0.7 million as at 31 December 2014 to approximately HK$3.7 million as at 31 December 2015, which was mainly due to the combined effects of (i) the raise of a new bank loan of HK$4.0 million; and (ii) repayment of bank loans of approximately HK$1.0 million during the year ended 31 December 2015. [The personal guarantees provided by the Directors will be released upon the [REDACTED].] Finance lease payables The motor vehicles under finance leases were contracted for an average lease term of 5 years. At 31 December 2014 and 2015, the average effective interest rates were 7.2% and 7.2% respectively. Interest rates are fixed at the contract dates and thus expose the Group to fair value interest rate risk. All leases are on a fixed repayment basis and no arrangements have been entered into for contingent rental payments. At the end of each lease term, the Group has the option to purchase the motor vehicles at nominal prices. At 31 December 2014 and 2015, the Group’s finance lease payables were secured by the lessor ’s title to the leased asset and personal guarantee provided by a Director. [The personal guarantee provided by a Director will be released upon the [REDACTED].] Due from directors The following table sets forth the amounts due from directors as at 31 December 2014 and 2015: As at 31 December 2014 2015 HK$’000 HK$’000 Amount due from directors – Mr. Chan – Mr. Li 2,403 486 1,035 2,950 The amounts due from directors mainly represented advances to the Directors. The amounts due from directors are unsecured, interest-free and repayable on demand. [The amounts due from directors as at 31 December 2015 will be fully settled before the [REDACTED]]. – 216 – THIS APPLICATION PROOF IS IN DRAFT FORM. The information contained herein is incomplete and is subject to change. This Application Proof must be read in conjunction with the section headed “Warning” on the cover of this Application Proof. FINANCIAL INFORMATION Current tax liabilities Current tax liabilities as at 31 December 2014 and 2015 comprised income tax payable charged at the taxable income of the Group derived in Hong Kong and the PRC at the applicable tax rates of 16.5% and 25% respectively. The current tax liabilities as at 31 December 2014 and 2015 included provision for income tax of approximately HK$1.3 million and provision for tax penalty of approximately HK$0.4 million in relation to years of assessment before the Track Record Period. During the course of conducting the annual audit for the year ended 31 December 2015, the auditors of Fit Boxx HK considered certain items should have been accounted for in the accounts of Fit Boxx HK for financial years before the Track Record Period based on latest estimates and information. As a result of the restatement of these relevant financial figures, tax provision in aggregate of approximately HK$1.3 million had been provided for in the respective financial years in which the tax liabilities arose, which are before the Track Record Period. In addition to the tax provision of approximately HK$1.3 million, a provision for tax penalty in aggregate of approximately HK$0.4 million had also been provided for respectively. The provision for tax penalty represented 30% of the tax involved and had been made in accordance with the penalty policy of the Inland Revenue Department. As at the Latest Practicable Date, Fit Boxx HK, assisted by its auditors and its tax representative, will report the revised taxable income in the Hong Kong Profits Tax Returns and tax computations for the relevant years of assessment. Pursuant to the Deed of Indemnity, save for any amount which have been provided for in the audited consolidated accounts of the Group as set out in Appendix I to this document and subject to the terms and conditions contained therein, the Controlling Shareholders have jointly and severally undertaken to indemnify the Group in respect of any taxation arising from which might be payable by any member of the Group in respect of any income, profits or gains earned, accrued or received or alleged to have been earned, accrued or received on or before the date on which the [REDACTED] becomes unconditional. RELATED PARTY TRANSACTIONS During the Track Record Period, the Group had entered into certain related party transactions including the sales of goods to a Director and certain related parties which amounted to an aggregate of approximately HK$7.6 million and HK$1.4 million for the two years ended 31 December 2015 respectively, details of which are set out in the sub-paragraph headed “Business — Sales and distribution channels — (II) Indirect sales — Sales to other distributors and retailers — Sales to related parties” in this document and note 31 to the Accountants’ Report set out in Appendix I to this document. The Directors confirm that these related party transactions were conducted on normal commercial terms and/or on terms not less favourable than terms available from independent third parties, which are considered fair, reasonable and in the interests of the Shareholders as a whole. – 217 – THIS APPLICATION PROOF IS IN DRAFT FORM. The information contained herein is incomplete and is subject to change. This Application Proof must be read in conjunction with the section headed “Warning” on the cover of this Application Proof. FINANCIAL INFORMATION KEY FINANCIAL RATIOS ANALYSIS The following table sets forth certain key financial ratios of the Group as at the dates or for the years indicated: As at/ For the year ended 31 December 2014 2015 Current ratio 1 (times) Quick ratio 2 (times) Debt to equity ratio 3 (%) Gearing ratio 4 (%) Interest coverage ratio 5 (times) Return on assets 6 (%) Return on equity 7 (%) Net profit margin 8 (%) 2.1 1.0 N/A 4.7 132.8 25.0 47.4 16.9 3.4 2.2 N/A 13.9 38.9 21.9 33.1 11.2 Notes: 1. Current ratio is calculated based on the total current assets divided by the total current liabilities as at the respective year end. 2. Quick ratio is calculated based on the total current assets less inventories and divided by total current liabilities as at the respective year end. 3. Debt to equity ratio is calculated by the net debt (all borrowings net of cash and cash equivalents) divided by the total equity attributable to owners of the Company as at the respective year end and multiplied by 100%. 4. Gearing ratio is calculated based on the interest-bearing liabilities divided by the total equity attributable to owners of the Company as at the respective year end and multiplied by 100%. 5. Interest coverage ratio is calculated by the profit before interest and tax divided by the interest for the respective year. 6. Return on assets is calculated by the profit attributable to owners of the Company for the year divided by the total assets as at the respective year end and multiplied by 100%. 7. Return on equity is calculated by the profit attributable to owners of the Company for the year divided by the total equity attributable to owners of the Company as at the respective year end and multiplied by 100%. 8. Net profit margin is calculated by the profit attributable to owners of the Company for the year divided by the revenue for the respective year and multiplied by 100%. – 218 – THIS APPLICATION PROOF IS IN DRAFT FORM. The information contained herein is incomplete and is subject to change. This Application Proof must be read in conjunction with the section headed “Warning” on the cover of this Application Proof. FINANCIAL INFORMATION Current ratio The current ratio increased from approximately 2.1 times as at 31 December 2014 to approximately 3.4 times as at 31 December 2015. This was mainly due to the decrease in total amount of current liabilities arising from (i) decrease in trade payables as at 31 December 2015 as compared to that of 31 December 2014, where the trade payables balance as at 31 December 2014 was relatively higher due to the increase in purchase of certain flagship products near the end of 2014 for sale in 2015; and (ii) the balance of other payables as at 31 December 2014 included an amount of HK$5.5 million due to certain Pre-IPO investors, which was subsequently reclassified to other reserves upon the completion of the relevant share subscription in February 2015 and the Reorganisation. Quick ratio The quick ratio increased from approximately 1.0 times as at 31 December 2014 to approximately 2.2 times as at 31 December 2015. This was mainly due (i) the increase in bank and cash balances as at 31 December 2015 arising from the share subscription money of approximately HK$6.8 million received from certain Pre-IPO investors in December 2015; and (ii) the decrease in total amount of current liabilities as at 31 December 2015 as explained in the paragraph headed “Current ratio” above. Debt to equity ratio As the bank and cash balances exceeded the aggregate balances of interest-bearing debts, the debt to equity ratio was not applicable as at 31 December 2014 and 2015. Gearing Ratio The gearing ratio increased from approximately 4.7% as at 31 December 2014 to approximately 13.9% as at 31 December 2015. This was mainly due to the borrowing of a new bank loan of HK$4.0 million during the year ended 31 December 2015. Interest coverage ratio The interest coverage ratio decreased from approximately 132.8 times for the year ended 31 December 2014 to approximately 38.9 times for the year ended 31 December 2015. This was mainly due to the increase in interest expenses for the year end 31 December 2015 by approximately 2.4 times as a result of the borrowing of a new bank loan of HK$4.0 million during the year. Return on assets The return on assets decreased from approximately 25.0% for the year ended 31 December 2014 to approximately 21.9% for the year ended 31 December 2015. This was mainly due to the decrease in profit attributable to owners of the Company for the year ended 31 December 2015, mainly resulting from the incurring of [REDACTED] expenses of approximately HK$3.9 million during the year. – 219 – THIS APPLICATION PROOF IS IN DRAFT FORM. The information contained herein is incomplete and is subject to change. This Application Proof must be read in conjunction with the section headed “Warning” on the cover of this Application Proof. FINANCIAL INFORMATION Return on equity The return on equity decreased from approximately 47.4% for the year ended 31 December 2014 to approximately 33.1% for the year ended 31 December 2015. This was mainly due to (i) the decrease in profit attributable to owners of the Company for the year ended 31 December 2015, mainly resulting from the incurring of [REDACTED] expenses of approximately HK$3.9 million during the year; and (ii) the increase in total equity attributable to owners of the Company as a result of the recording of share premium and other reserves arising from the share subscriptions of the Pre-IPO investors in an aggregate amount of approximately HK$12.3 million during the year ended 31 December 2015 and the total comprehensive income of approximately HK$9.3 million for the year, as deducted by the dividends of HK$17.0 million declared for the year. Net profit margin The net profit margin decreased from approximately 16.9% for the year ended 31 December 2014 to approximately 11.2% for the year ended 31 December 2015. This was mainly due to the decrease in profit attributable to owners of the Company for the year ended 31 December 2015, mainly resulting from the incurring of [REDACTED] expenses of approximately HK$3.9 million during the year. Excluding the effect of [REDACTED] expenses, the profit attributable to owners of the Company for the year ended 31 December 2015 would be approximately HK$13.3 million, and the net profit margin would be approximately 15.7%, representing a relatively stable net profit margin over the Track Record Period. SENSITIVITY ANALYSIS The Group’s results of operations are vulnerable to the economy in Hong Kong which would affect the rental costs of the Group’s rented premises including retail outlets and the labour costs of the Group’s employees. Moreover, the cost of merchandises purchased from suppliers located worldwide would also affect the results of operations of the Group to a material extent. The table below sets forth a sensitivity analysis for the Group’s major cost components, i.e. (i) costs of goods sold (excluding other direct costs); (ii) employee benefits expense (including directors’ remuneration); and (iii) operating lease charges of rented premises, illustrating their respective impact on the Group’s profit before tax if the above items had been 5%, 10% and 15% higher or lower in the years indicated, assuming all other variables were held constant. – 220 – THIS APPLICATION PROOF IS IN DRAFT FORM. The information contained herein is incomplete and is subject to change. This Application Proof must be read in conjunction with the section headed “Warning” on the cover of this Application Proof. FINANCIAL INFORMATION (i) Cost of goods sold (excluding other direct costs): For the year ended 31 December 2014 2015 HK$’000 HK$’000 (ii) If costs of goods sold (excluding other direct costs) had been 5% higher/lower Decrease/increase in profit before tax -/+1,238 -/+1,638 If costs of goods sold (excluding other direct costs) had been 10% higher/lower Decrease/increase in profit before tax -/+2,476 -/+3,276 If costs of goods sold (excluding other direct costs) had been 15% higher/lower Decrease/increase in profit before tax -/+3,714 -/+4,914 Employee benefits expenses (including directors’ remuneration): For the year ended 31 December 2014 2015 HK$’000 HK$’000 If employee benefits expense had been 5% higher/lower Decrease/increase in profit before tax -/+492 -/+610 If employee benefits expense had been 10% higher/lower Decrease/increase in profit before tax -/+984 -/+1,219 If employee benefits expense had been 15% higher/lower Decrease/increase in profit before tax -/+1,475 -/+1,829 – 221 – THIS APPLICATION PROOF IS IN DRAFT FORM. The information contained herein is incomplete and is subject to change. This Application Proof must be read in conjunction with the section headed “Warning” on the cover of this Application Proof. FINANCIAL INFORMATION (iii) Operating lease charges of rented premises: For the year ended 31 December 2014 2015 HK$’000 HK$’000 If operating lease charges had been 5% higher/lower Decrease/increase in profit before tax -/+322 -/+373 If operating lease charges had been 10% higher/lower Decrease/increase in profit before tax -/+644 -/+747 If operating lease charges had been 15% higher/lower Decrease/increase in profit before tax -/+965 -/+1,120 CONTINGENT LIABILITIES As at 31 December 2014 and 2015, the Group did not have any significant contingent liabilities. INDEBTEDNESS At the close of business on [29 February 2016], being the latest practicable date on which indebtedness information was available to the Group, the Group had outstanding total bank loans of approximately HK$[3.6] million. The effective contractual interest rate of the Group’s borrowings was ranged from [4.2]% to [5.0]% per annum. All of the Group’s bank borrowings were guaranteed by the Directors. [Such personal guarantees provided by the Directors will be released upon the [REDACTED].] As at [29 February 2016], finance lease payables of approximately HK$[0.2] million were secured by motor vehicles of the Group and personal guarantee provided by a Director. [Such personal guarantee will be released upon the [REDACTED].] To the best knowledge and belief of the Directors, the Group will not have difficulties in obtaining and/or renewing banking facilities. Based on the business and financial performance of the Group, the Directors are not aware of any circumstances in which the Group’s ability to obtain external financing in the future may be affected by the recent global financial market volatility and credit tightening, and they expect the Group’s banking facilities to be renewed after [REDACTED]. – 222 – THIS APPLICATION PROOF IS IN DRAFT FORM. The information contained herein is incomplete and is subject to change. This Application Proof must be read in conjunction with the section headed “Warning” on the cover of this Application Proof. FINANCIAL INFORMATION Save as disclosed above, and apart from the amount due to related parties, the Group did not have, at the close of business on [29 February 2016], any loan capital issued and outstanding or agreed to be issued, bank overdrafts, loan or other similar indebtedness, liabilities under acceptances or acceptance credit, debentures, hire purchase commitments, mortgages and charges, material contingent liabilities or guarantees outstanding. [REDACTED] EXPENSES Based on the [REDACTED] of HK$[REDACTED] (being the mid-point of the [REDACTED] range stated in this document), the total expenses in connection with the [REDACTED] are estimated to be approximately HK$[REDACTED] million, of which approximately HK$[REDACTED] million is directly attributable to the issue of [REDACTED] under the [REDACTED] and is expected to be accounted for as a deduction from equity. For the remaining [REDACTED] expenses of approximately HK$[REDACTED] million, approximately HK$3.9 million was charged to the consolidated statement of comprehensive income for the year ended 31 December 2015, and approximately HK$[REDACTED] million will be charged to the consolidated statement of comprehensive income for the year ending 31 December 2016. WORKING CAPITAL [The Directors are of the opinion that, taking into account the financial resources available to the Group, including the estimated net proceeds of the [REDACTED], the banking facilities available to the Group and the internally generated funds, that the Group has sufficient working capital for the present requirements for at least the next twelve months from the date in this document.] – 223 – THIS APPLICATION PROOF IS IN DRAFT FORM. The information contained herein is incomplete and is subject to change. This Application Proof must be read in conjunction with the section headed “Warning” on the cover of this Application Proof. FINANCIAL INFORMATION CAPITAL EXPENDITURE AND COMMITMENT The Group’s capital expenditures principally consisted of purchase of plant and equipment. The Group primarily funded its capital expenditures through cash flows generated from operations and bank borrowings. The following table sets forth the Group’s capital expenditure during the Track Record Period: For the year ended 31 December 2014 2015 HK$’000 HK$’000 Furniture and fixtures Office equipment Motor vehicles Leasehold improvements 44 61 – 422 71 96 – 128 Total 527 295 As at 31 December 2014 and 2015, the Group did not have significant capital commitment. OPERATING LEASE COMMITMENTS The Group leases various properties of retail stores, offices and warehouses under non-cancellable operating lease agreements. The lease agreements are in general for a period of two years, and certain of these lease arrangements are renewable at the end of the lease period with either pre-set increment rate or market rate to be agreed with landlord. The operating leases of certain retail store properties also call for additional rentals, which will be based on a certain percentage of revenue of the operation being undertaken therein pursuant to the terms and conditions as stipulated in the respective lease agreements. As the future revenue of these retail stores could not be accurately determined as at the reporting date, the relevant contingent rentals have not been included. – 224 – THIS APPLICATION PROOF IS IN DRAFT FORM. The information contained herein is incomplete and is subject to change. This Application Proof must be read in conjunction with the section headed “Warning” on the cover of this Application Proof. FINANCIAL INFORMATION At 31 December 2014 and 2015, the total future minimum lease payments under non-cancellable operating leases are payable as follows: As at 31 December 2014 2015 HK$’000 HK$’000 Within one year In the second to fifth years inclusive 4,597 1,024 6,297 3,467 5,621 9,764 The Group’s operating lease commitments increased from approximately HK$5.6 million as at 31 December 2014 to approximately HK$9.8 million as at 31 December 2015, which was mainly due to the majority of the Group’s lease agreements were entered into in 2015 with a period of two years in general, and hence they were yet to be renewed as at 31 December 2014. The operating lease commitment under an operating lease payable to a related party is as follows: As at 31 December 2014 2015 HK$’000 HK$’000 Within one year In the second to fifth years inclusive – – 420 105 – 525 Please refer to the section headed “Connected transactions” in this document for details of the lease agreement entered into with the related party. OFF-BALANCE SHEET TRANSACTIONS Save for the operating lease commitments and contingent liabilities as disclosed in the sub-sections headed “Operating lease commitments” and “Contingent liabilities” in this section and the Accountants’ Report set out in Appendix I to this document, the Group had not entered into any material off-balance sheet transactions or arrangements as at the Latest Practicable Date. – 225 – THIS APPLICATION PROOF IS IN DRAFT FORM. The information contained herein is incomplete and is subject to change. This Application Proof must be read in conjunction with the section headed “Warning” on the cover of this Application Proof. FINANCIAL INFORMATION PROPERTY INTERESTS As at the Latest Practicable Date, no single property owned by the Group had a carrying value exceeding 15% of the total assets, the details of which are set out in the sub-section headed “Business — Properties” in this document. DISTRIBUTABLE RESERVES As at 31 December 2015, the Company had no distributable reserves available for distribution to the Shareholders. DIVIDEND AND DIVIDEND POLICY For the year ended 31 December 2015, a subsidiary of the Group declared dividend of HK$17.0 million. The Directors consider that there is no material adverse impact on the Group’s financial and liquidity position arising out of the dividend payment. Dividends may be paid out by way of cash or by other means that the Directors consider appropriate. Declaration and payment of any dividends would require the recommendation of the Board and will be at their discretion. In addition, any final dividend for a financial year will be subject to Shareholders’ approval. The Company currently does not have any specific dividend policy. A decision to declare or to pay any dividend in the future, and the amount of any dividends, depends on a number of factors, including the Group’s results of operations, financial condition, the payment by the Group’s subsidiaries of cash dividends to the Group, and other factors the Board may deem relevant. There will be no assurance that the Company will be able to declare or distribute any dividend in the amount set out in any plan of the Board or at all. The dividend distribution record in the past may not be used as a reference or basis to determine the level of dividends that may be declared or paid by the Board in the future. UNAUDITED PRO FORMA STATEMENT OF ADJUSTED NET TANGIBLE ASSETS For illustrative purpose only, the pro forma financial information prepared in accordance with paragraph 31 of Chapter 7 of the GEM Listing Rules is set out herein to provide the investors with further information to assess the financial performance of the Group after taking into account the adjusted net tangible assets of the Group to illustrate the financial position of the Group after completion of the [REDACTED] and to illustrate the performance of the Group had the [REDACTED] been completed on 31 December 2015. The unaudited pro forma financial information has been prepared, on the basis of the notes set out below, to illustrate how the [REDACTED] may have affected the net tangible assets attributable to owners of the Company had it occurred as of 31 December 2015. It has been prepared for illustrative purpose only and, because of its nature, may not give a true picture of the financial position of the Group. – 226 – THIS APPLICATION PROOF IS IN DRAFT FORM. The information contained herein is incomplete and is subject to change. This Application Proof must be read in conjunction with the section headed “Warning” on the cover of this Application Proof. FINANCIAL INFORMATION Audited consolidated net tangible assets attributable to owners of the Company as of 31 December 2015 (Note 1) HK$’000 Unaudited pro Estimated net Unaudited pro forma adjusted net proceeds from forma adjusted net tangible assets the [REDACTED] tangible assets per Share (Note 2) (Note 3) HK$’000 HK$’000 HK$ Based on the [REDACTED] of [HK$[REDACTED]] per share 28,616 [REDACTED] [REDACTED] [REDACTED] Based on the [REDACTED] of [HK$[REDACTED]] per share 28,616 [REDACTED] [REDACTED] [REDACTED] Notes: (1) The audited consolidated net tangible assets attributable to owners of the Company as of 31 December 2015 is extracted from the audited consolidated net assets of HK$28,616,000 as of 31 December 2015, as shown in the accountants’ report, the text of which is set out in Appendix I to this document. (2) The adjustment to the pro forma statement of net tangible assets reflects the estimated proceeds from the [REDACTED] to be received by the Company. The estimated proceeds from the [REDACTED] is based on the [REDACTED] of [HK$[REDACTED]] and [HK$[REDACTED]], respectively, being the lower and higher end price of the stated [REDACTED] range, and [REDACTED] Shares, net of underwriting fee of approximately [REDACTED] million and [REDACTED] million, respectively and other estimated issue expenses approximately [REDACTED] million payable by the Company. (3) The unaudited pro forma adjusted net tangible assets and the amounts per Share are on the basis that [REDACTED] shares are expected to be in issue following the [REDACTED] (including [REDACTED] shares newly issued upon the [REDACTED]) had been completed on 31 December 2015 and respective [REDACTED] of [HK$[REDACTED]] and [HK$[REDACTED]] per Share. (4) No adjustment has been made to the unaudited pro forma adjusted consolidated net tangible assets of the Group attributable to owners of the Company to reflect any trading result or other transactions of the Group entered into subsequent to 31 December 2015. CAPITAL RISK MANAGEMENT AND FINANCIAL RISK MANAGEMENT Capital risk management The Group’s objectives when managing capital are to safeguard the Group’s ability to continue as a going concern and to maximise the return to the shareholders through the optimisation of the debt and equity balance. The Group sets the amount of capital in proportion to risk. The Group manages the capital structure and makes adjustments to it in the light of changes in economic conditions and the risk characteristics of the underlying assets. In order to maintain or adjust the capital structure, the Group may adjust the payment of dividends, issue new shares, buy-back shares, raise new debts, – 227 – THIS APPLICATION PROOF IS IN DRAFT FORM. The information contained herein is incomplete and is subject to change. This Application Proof must be read in conjunction with the section headed “Warning” on the cover of this Application Proof. FINANCIAL INFORMATION redeem existing debts or sell assets to reduce debts. The Group monitors capital on the basis of the gearing ratio which is the total borrowings divided by the total equity of the Company. Total borrowings comprises bank loans and finance lease payables. The Group’s policy is to keep the gearing ratio at a reasonable level. The Group is not subject to any externally imposed capital requirements. Further details on the Group’s capital risk management policies and practices are set out in note 25 to the Accountants’ Report in Appendix I to this document. Financial risk management The Group is exposed to a variety of financial risks: market risk (including foreign exchange risk and cash flow and fair value interest rate risk), credit risk and liquidity risk. The Group’s overall risk management programme focuses on the unpredictability of financial markets and seeks to minimise potential adverse effects on the Group’s financial performance. The Group does not use derivative financial instruments to hedge its risk exposures to changes in foreign exchange rates and interest rates. Further details on the Group’s financial risk management policies and practices are set out in note 6 to the Accountants’ Report in Appendix I to this document. DISCLOSURE UNDER CHAPTER 17 OF THE GEM LISTING RULES The Directors have confirmed that, save as disclosed above, as at the Latest Practicable Date, they were not aware of any circumstances which would give rise to a disclosure requirement under Rules 17.15 to 17.21 of the GEM Listing Rules. MATERIAL ADVERSE CHANGE Save as disclosed in the sub-section headed “Summary – Recent development since 31 December 2015” in this document, the Directors confirm that, up to the date in this document, there had been no material adverse change in the financial or trading positions or prospect of the Group since 31 December 2015, being the date to which the latest audited financial statements of the Group were made up, and there had been no event since 31 December 2015 which would materially affect the information shown in the Accountant’s Report set out in Appendix I to this document. – 228 – THIS APPLICATION PROOF IS IN DRAFT FORM. The information contained herein is incomplete and is subject to change. This Application Proof must be read in conjunction with the section headed “Warning” on the cover of this Application Proof. UNDERWRITING [REDACTED] – 229 – THIS APPLICATION PROOF IS IN DRAFT FORM. The information contained herein is incomplete and is subject to change. This Application Proof must be read in conjunction with the section headed “Warning” on the cover of this Application Proof. UNDERWRITING [REDACTED] – 230 – THIS APPLICATION PROOF IS IN DRAFT FORM. The information contained herein is incomplete and is subject to change. This Application Proof must be read in conjunction with the section headed “Warning” on the cover of this Application Proof. UNDERWRITING [REDACTED] – 231 – THIS APPLICATION PROOF IS IN DRAFT FORM. The information contained herein is incomplete and is subject to change. This Application Proof must be read in conjunction with the section headed “Warning” on the cover of this Application Proof. UNDERWRITING [REDACTED] Commission and expenses The [REDACTED] will receive an underwriting commission of [REDACTED]% of the aggregate [REDACTED] of all [REDACTED]. The Sponsor will receive a financial advisory and documentation fee in relation to the [REDACTED] and will be reimbursed for their expenses. Such commission, advisory and documentation fee and expenses, together with the [REDACTED] fees, SFC transaction levy, legal and other professional fees, printing and other expenses relating to the [REDACTED] which are estimated to amount in aggregate to approximately HK$[REDACTED] million and are to be borne by the Company. [REDACTED]’s interest in the Company Save as disclosed in this document and as provided for under the [REDACTED], the [REDACTED] have no shareholding interests in any member of the Group nor has any right (whether legally enforceable or not) to subscribe for or nominate persons to subscribe for securities in any member of the Group. [REDACTED] – 232 – THIS APPLICATION PROOF IS IN DRAFT FORM. The information contained herein is incomplete and is subject to change. This Application Proof must be read in conjunction with the section headed “Warning” on the cover of this Application Proof. UNDERWRITING [REDACTED] MINIMUM PUBLIC FLOAT The Directors and the [REDACTED] will ensure that there will be a minimum 25% of the total issued Shares held in public hands in accordance with Rule 11.23(9) of the GEM Listing Rules after completion of the [REDACTED]. – 233 – THIS APPLICATION PROOF IS IN DRAFT FORM. The information contained herein is incomplete and is subject to change. This Application Proof must be read in conjunction with the section headed “Warning” on the cover of this Application Proof. STRUCTURE AND CONDITIONS OF THE [REDACTED] [REDACTED] – 234 – THIS APPLICATION PROOF IS IN DRAFT FORM. The information contained herein is incomplete and is subject to change. This Application Proof must be read in conjunction with the section headed “Warning” on the cover of this Application Proof. STRUCTURE AND CONDITIONS OF THE [REDACTED] [REDACTED] – 235 – THIS APPLICATION PROOF IS IN DRAFT FORM. The information contained herein is incomplete and is subject to change. This Application Proof must be read in conjunction with the section headed “Warning” on the cover of this Application Proof. STRUCTURE AND CONDITIONS OF THE [REDACTED] [REDACTED] – 236 – THIS APPLICATION PROOF IS IN DRAFT FORM. The information contained herein is incomplete and is subject to change. This Application Proof must be read in conjunction with the section headed “Warning” on the cover of this Application Proof. APPENDIX I ACCOUNTANTS’ REPORT The following is the text of a report, prepared for the sole purpose of inclusion in this document, from the independent reporting accountants, RSM Hong Kong, Certified Public Accountants, Hong Kong. RSM Hong Kong 29th Floor Lee Garden Two 28 Yun Ping Road Causeway Bay Hong Kong [●] 2016 The Board of Directors Fit Boxx Holdings Limited Ample Capital Limited Dear Sirs, We set out below our report on the financial information (the “Financial Information”) of Fit Boxx Holdings Limited (the “Company”) and its subsidiaries (hereinafter collectively referred to as the “Group”) for each of the two years ended 31 December 2014 and 2015 (the “Relevant Periods”) for inclusion in the document dated [●] 2016 issued by the Company (the “Document”) in connection with the [REDACTED] of shares of the Company on the Growth Enterprise Market of the Stock Exchange of Hong Kong Limited. The Company was incorporated as an exempted company in the Cayman Islands under the Companies Law of the Cayman Islands on 14 May 2015. Pursuant to a group reorganisation as more fully explained in the paragraph headed “Reorganisation” in the “History, Reorganisation and Group Structure” section in the Document (the “Group Reorganisation”), the Company became the holding company of the Group since 10 December 2015. – I-1 – THIS APPLICATION PROOF IS IN DRAFT FORM. The information contained herein is incomplete and is subject to change. This Application Proof must be read in conjunction with the section headed “Warning” on the cover of this Application Proof. APPENDIX I ACCOUNTANTS’ REPORT As at the date of this report, the Company has the following subsidiaries: Name Place of Date of incorporation/ incorporation/ establishment establishment Issued and paid up capital/ registered capital Percentage of ownership interest 2014 Fit Boxx Co. Ltd. (“Fit Boxx BVI”) 2015 20 May 2015 HK$2 – Fit Boxx Trading Hong Kong Company Limited (“Fit Boxx HK”) 18 June 2009 HK$5,510,000 100% 100% Sales and distribution of fitness equipment, beauty gadgets and other health care products PRC 偉博進出口貿易 (深圳)有限公司* (“Fit Boxx Shenzhen”) 31 October 2012 RMB500,000 100% 100% Sales and distribution of beauty gadgets and accessories * BVI Principal activities – Investment holding This subsidiary is registered as wholly-owned foreign enterprise under the PRC laws. All the companies now comprising the Group have adopted 31 December as their financial year end date. We acted as auditors of all the companies now comprising the Group for the Relevant Periods except as disclosed below. The statutory financial statements of Fit Boxx HK for the year ended 31 December 2014 have been prepared in accordance with Hong Kong Financial Reporting Standards (“HKFRSs”) issued by Hong Kong Institute of Certified Public Accountants (the “HKICPA”) and were audited by Alan Chan & Company, certified public accountants registered in Hong Kong, in accordance with Hong Kong Standards on Auditing (“HKSA”) issued by the HKICPA. The statutory financial statements of Fit Boxx Shenzhen for the years ended 31 December 2014 and 2015 have been prepared in accordance with the relevant accounting principles and financial regulations applicable to companies established in the People’s Republic of China (the “PRC”) and were audited by 深圳市永明會計師事務所有限責任公司, certified public accountants registered in the PRC. No audited financial statements of Fit Boxx BVI have been prepared since incorporation as there is no statutory audit requirement in the country of its incorporation. – I-2 – THIS APPLICATION PROOF IS IN DRAFT FORM. The information contained herein is incomplete and is subject to change. This Application Proof must be read in conjunction with the section headed “Warning” on the cover of this Application Proof. APPENDIX I ACCOUNTANTS’ REPORT For the purpose of this report, the directors of the Company have prepared the consolidated financial statements of the Group for the Relevant Periods in accordance with HKFRSs issued by the HKICPA (the “HKFRS Financial Statements”). We have performed our independent audit on the HKFRS Financial Statements in accordance with HKSA issued by the HKICPA and have examined the HKFRS Financial Statements in accordance with Auditing Guideline 3.340 “Prospectuses and the Reporting Accountant” issued by the HKICPA. The Financial Information has been prepared from the HKFRS Financial Statements in accordance with HKFRSs and on the basis of presentation set out in note 2 to the Financial Information. No adjustments were considered necessary for the purpose of preparing our report for inclusion in the Document. The directors of the Company are responsible for the preparation of the HKFRS Financial Statements and the contents of the Document in which this report is included. It is our responsibility to compile the Financial Information set out in this report from the HKFRS Financial Statements, to form an independent opinion on the Financial Information and to report our opinion to you. In our opinion, for the purpose of this report and on the basis of presentation set out in note 2 to the Financial Information, the Financial Information gives a true and fair view of the state of affairs of the Company and of the Group as at 31 December 2014 and 2015 and of the Group’s results and cash flows for the Relevant Periods. – I-3 – THIS APPLICATION PROOF IS IN DRAFT FORM. The information contained herein is incomplete and is subject to change. This Application Proof must be read in conjunction with the section headed “Warning” on the cover of this Application Proof. APPENDIX I ACCOUNTANTS’ REPORT FINANCIAL INFORMATION A. CONSOLIDATED STATEMENT OF PROFIT OR LOSS AND OTHER COMPREHENSIVE INCOME Note 7 Revenue Cost of goods sold Gross profit Other income Selling and distribution expenses Administrative expenses 8 Year ended 31 December 2014 2015 HK$’000 HK$’000 67,465 (25,450) 84,744 (33,540) 42,015 5 (22,693) (6,184) 51,204 98 (25,296) (12,998) 13,008 (334) Profit from operations Finance costs 9 13,143 (99) Profit before tax Income tax expense 10 13,044 (1,626) 12,674 (3,205) Profit for the year attributable to owners of the Company 11 11,418 9,469 Other comprehensive income after tax: Item that may be reclassified to profit or loss: Exchange differences on translating foreign operations 4 Total comprehensive income for the year attributable to owners of the Company (204) 11,422 9,265 N/A N/A 15 Earnings per share Basic – I-4 – THIS APPLICATION PROOF IS IN DRAFT FORM. The information contained herein is incomplete and is subject to change. This Application Proof must be read in conjunction with the section headed “Warning” on the cover of this Application Proof. APPENDIX I B. ACCOUNTANTS’ REPORT CONSOLIDATED STATEMENT OF FINANCIAL POSITION Note Non-current assets Plant and equipment Long-term rental deposits 16 At 31 December 2014 2015 HK$’000 HK$’000 1,679 694 979 1,446 2,373 2,425 18 19 22,483 5,084 14,624 3,142 13(b) 20 6,005 2,889 6,782 5,224 3,985 13,908 43,243 40,883 8,278 7,835 250 161 4,302 3,392 4,292 1,224 163 3,019 20,826 12,090 Net current assets 22,417 28,793 Total assets less current liabilities 24,790 31,218 472 242 2,523 79 714 2,602 24,076 28,616 10 24,066 1 28,615 24,076 28,616 Current assets Inventories Trade receivables Prepayments, deposits and other receivables Due from directors Bank and cash balances Current liabilities Trade payables Accruals and other payables Bank loans Finance lease payables Current tax liabilities 21 22 23 Non-current liabilities Bank loans Finance lease payables 22 23 NET ASSETS Capital and reserves Share capital Reserves 25 27 TOTAL EQUITY – I-5 – THIS APPLICATION PROOF IS IN DRAFT FORM. The information contained herein is incomplete and is subject to change. This Application Proof must be read in conjunction with the section headed “Warning” on the cover of this Application Proof. APPENDIX I C. ACCOUNTANTS’ REPORT CONSOLIDATED STATEMENT OF CHANGES IN EQUITY Share Share capital premium HK$’000 HK$’000 (note (note 25) 27(b)(i)) At 1 January 2014 Foreign currency translation Statutory Other reserve reserve reserve HK$’000 HK$’000 HK$’000 (note (note (note 27(b)(ii)) 27(b)(iii)) 27(b)(iv)) Retained profits HK$’000 Total HK$’000 10 – 5 – – 12,639 12,654 Total comprehensive income for the year Transfer to statutory reserve – – 4 – – 11,418 11,422 – – – 106 – (106) – Changes in equity for the year – – 4 106 – 11,312 11,422 At 31 December 2014 and 1 January 2015 10 – 9 106 – 23,951 24,076 5,500 – – – – – 5,500 (5,510) – – – 5,510 – – 0 – – – – – 0 1 6,774 – – – – 6,775 – – (204) – – 9,469 9,265 – – – 231 – (231) – – – – – – (17,000) (17,000) Changes in equity for the year (9) 6,774 (204) 231 5,510 (7,762) 4,540 At 31 December 2015 1 6,774 (195) 337 5,510 16,189 28,616 Issue of shares of Fit Boxx HK before Group Reorganisation Effect of Group Reorganisation Issue of shares of the Company on Group Reorganisation (note 25(iv) Issue of shares of the Company (note 25(v)) Total comprehensive income for the year Transfer to statutory reserve Dividends paid (note 14) – I-6 – THIS APPLICATION PROOF IS IN DRAFT FORM. The information contained herein is incomplete and is subject to change. This Application Proof must be read in conjunction with the section headed “Warning” on the cover of this Application Proof. APPENDIX I D. ACCOUNTANTS’ REPORT CONSOLIDATED STATEMENT OF CASH FLOWS Note CASH FLOWS FROM OPERATING ACTIVITIES Profit before tax Adjustments for: Written-off of bad debts Depreciation Finance costs Bank interest income Written-off of plant and equipment Year ended 31 December 2014 2015 HK$’000 HK$’000 13,044 11 11 9 8 11 Operating profit before working capital changes (Increase)/decrease in inventories (Increase)/decrease in trade receivables Increase in amounts due from directors Increase in long-term rental deposits paid (Increase)/decrease in prepayments, deposits and other receivables Increase/(decrease) in trade payables Increase in accruals and other payables – 978 99 (1) 327 12,674 226 772 334 (4) 222 14,447 (4,039) 14,224 7,859 (2,877) 1,716 (2,894) (11,891) (117) (752) (3,812) 776 2,868 (4,886) 5,020 1,957 Cash generated from operations Finance lease charges paid Interest paid Income taxes paid 8,596 (35) (64) (350) 9,003 (23) (311) (4,476) Net cash generated from operating activities 8,147 4,193 CASH FLOWS FROM INVESTING ACTIVITIES Purchase of plant and equipment Interest received Net cash used in investing activities – I-7 – 16 (527) 1 (295) 4 (526) (291) THIS APPLICATION PROOF IS IN DRAFT FORM. The information contained herein is incomplete and is subject to change. This Application Proof must be read in conjunction with the section headed “Warning” on the cover of this Application Proof. APPENDIX I ACCOUNTANTS’ REPORT Note CASH FLOWS FROM FINANCING ACTIVITIES Issue of shares Bank loans raised Repayment of bank loans Repayment of capital element of finance lease payables Decrease in amounts due to directors Dividends paid Net cash (used in)/generated from financing activities NET INCREASE IN CASH AND CASH EQUIVALENTS Effect of foreign exchange rate changes 25 28 Year ended 31 December 2014 2015 HK$’000 HK$’000 – 800 (772) 6,775 4,000 (975) (154) (3,028) – (161) – (6,200) (3,154) 3,439 4,467 7,341 4 (215) CASH AND CASH EQUIVALENTS AT 1 JANUARY 2,311 6,782 CASH AND CASH EQUIVALENTS AT 31 DECEMBER 6,782 13,908 ANALYSIS OF CASH AND CASH EQUIVALENTS Bank and cash balances 6,782 13,908 – I-8 – THIS APPLICATION PROOF IS IN DRAFT FORM. The information contained herein is incomplete and is subject to change. This Application Proof must be read in conjunction with the section headed “Warning” on the cover of this Application Proof. APPENDIX I E. ACCOUNTANTS’ REPORT NOTES TO THE FINANCIAL INFORMATION 1. GENERAL INFORMATION The Company was incorporated in the Cayman Islands with limited liability. The address of its registered office is Cricket Square, Hutchins Drive, P. O. Box 2681, Grand Cayman KY1-1111, Cayman Islands. The address of its principal place of business is Flat F, 3/F., Hung Wai Industrial Building, 3 Hi Yip Street, Yuen Long, the New Territories, Hong Kong. In the opinion of the directors of the Company, Faith Elite Limited, a company incorporated in Anguilla with limited liability, is the immediate and ultimate holding company and Mr. Li Hon Ming and Mr. Chan Yiu Kwong are the ultimate controlling parties. 2. BASIS OF PRESENTATION OF THE FINANCIAL INFORMATION Pursuant to the Group Reorganisation as more fully explained in the paragraph headed “Reorganisation” in the “History, Reorganisation and Group Structure” section in the Document, the Company became the holding company of the companies now comprising the Group on 10 December 2015. As the Group Reorganisation involved only the insertion of new holding companies at the top of the existing group and did not result in any change in economic substance, the Financial Information for the Relevant Periods has been prepared as a continuation of the existing group using the principles of merger accounting.] The consolidated statement of profit or loss and other comprehensive income, the consolidated statement of changes in equity and the consolidated statement of cash flows are prepared as if the group structure had been in existence throughout the Relevant Periods. The consolidated statement of financial position as at 31 December 2014 and 2015 presents the assets and liabilities of the companies now comprising the group as if the current group structure had been in existence at those dates. 3. ADOPTION OF NEW AND REVISED HONG KONG FINANCIAL REPORTING STANDARDS (a) Application of new and revised HKFRSs During the Relevant Periods, the Group has adopted all the new and revised HKFRSs issued by the HKICPA that are relevant to its operations and effective for accounting year beginning on 1 January 2015: Amendment to HKAS 24 (Annual Improvements to HKFRSs 2010–2012 Cycle) The amendment clarifies how payments to entities providing key management personnel services are to be disclosed. This amendment had no effect on the Group’s Financial Information. Amendment to HKFRS 8 (Annual Improvements to HKFRSs 2010–2012 Cycle) The amendment requires disclosure of the judgments made by management in applying the aggregation criteria to operating segments, and clarifies that reconciliations of the total of the reportable segments’ assets to the entity’s assets are required only if the segment assets are reported regularly. These clarifications had no effect on the Group’s Financial Information. (b) New and revised HKFRSs in issue but not yet effective The Group has not early applied new and revised HKFRSs that have been issued but are not yet effective for the financial year beginning on 1 January 2015. The directors anticipate that the new and revised HKFRSs will be adopted in the Group’s Financial Information when they become effective. The Group is in the process of assessing, where applicable, the potential effect of all new and revised HKFRSs that will be effective in future periods but is not yet in a position to state whether these new and revised HKFRSs would have a material impact on its results of operations and financial position. – I-9 – THIS APPLICATION PROOF IS IN DRAFT FORM. The information contained herein is incomplete and is subject to change. This Application Proof must be read in conjunction with the section headed “Warning” on the cover of this Application Proof. APPENDIX I ACCOUNTANTS’ REPORT Financial Instruments 1 Revenue from Contracts with Customers 1 Disclosure Initiative 2 Annual Improvements to HKFRSs 2012-2014 Cycle 2 HKFRS 9 HKFRS 15 Amendments to HKAS 1 Amendments to HKFRSs 1 2 4. Effective for annual periods beginning on or after 1 January 2018, with earlier application permitted. Effective for annual periods beginning on or after 1 January 2016, with earlier application permitted. SIGNIFICANT ACCOUNTING POLICIES The Financial Information has been prepared under the historical cost convention. The preparation of Financial Information in conformity with HKFRSs requires the use of certain critical accounting estimates. It also requires management to exercise its judgment in the process of applying the Group’s accounting policies. The areas involving a higher degree of judgment or complexity, or areas where assumptions and estimates are significant to the Financial Information are disclosed in note 5. The significant accounting policies applied in the preparation of the Financial Information are set out below. (a) Consolidation The Financial Information includes the financial statements of the Company and its subsidiaries made up to 31 December. Subsidiaries are entities over which the Group has control. The Group controls an entity when it is exposed, or has rights, to variable returns from its involvement with the entity and has the ability to affect those returns through its power over the entity. The Group has power over an entity when the Group has existing rights that give it the current ability to direct the relevant activities, i.e. activities that significantly affect the entity’s returns. When assessing control, the Group considers its potential voting rights as well as potential voting rights held by other parties. A potential voting right is considered only if the holder has the practical ability to exercise that right. Subsidiaries are consolidated from the date on which control is transferred to the Group. They are de-consolidated from the date the control ceases. Intragroup transactions, balances and unrealised profits are eliminated. Unrealised losses are also eliminated unless the transaction provides evidence of an impairment of the asset transferred. Accounting policies of subsidiaries have been changed where necessary to ensure consistency with the policies adopted by the Group. (b) Merger accounting for business combination under common control The consolidated financial statements incorporate the financial statements of the combining entities as if they had been combined from the date when they first came under the control of the controlling party. The consolidated statement of profit or loss and other comprehensive income and consolidated statement of cash flows include the results and cash flows of the combining entities from the earliest date presented or since the date when the combining entities first came under the common control, where this is a shorter period, regardless of the date of the common control combination. The consolidated statement of financial position has been prepared to present the assets and liabilities of the combining entities as if the Group structure as at 31 December 2015 had been in existence at the end of each reporting period. The net assets of the combining entities are consolidated using the existing book values from the controlling party’s perspective. No amount is recognised in respect of goodwill or gain on bargain purchase at the time of common control combination, to the extent of the continuation of the controlling party’s interest. There was no adjustment made to the net assets nor the net profit or loss of any combining entities in order to achieve consistency of the Group’s accounting policies. – I-10 – THIS APPLICATION PROOF IS IN DRAFT FORM. The information contained herein is incomplete and is subject to change. This Application Proof must be read in conjunction with the section headed “Warning” on the cover of this Application Proof. APPENDIX I (c) ACCOUNTANTS’ REPORT Foreign currency translation (i) Functional and presentation currency Items included in the financial statements of each of the Group’s entities are measured using the currency of the primary economic environment in which the entity operates (the “functional currency”). The consolidated financial statements are presented in Hong Kong dollars (“HK$”), which is the Company’s presentation currency and the functional currency. (ii) Transactions and balances in each entity’s financial statements Transactions in foreign currencies are translated into the functional currency on initial recognition using the exchange rates prevailing on the transaction dates. Monetary assets and liabilities in foreign currencies are translated at the exchange rates at the end of each reporting period. Gains and losses resulting from this translation policy are recognised in profit or loss. Non-monetary items that are measured at fair value in foreign currencies are translated using the exchange rates at the dates when the fair values are determined. When a gain or loss on a non-monetary item is recognised in other comprehensive income, any exchange component of that gain or loss is recognised in other comprehensive income. When a gain or loss on a non-monetary item is recognised in profit or loss, any exchange component of that gain or loss is recognised in profit or loss. (iii) Translation on consolidation The results and financial position of all the Group entities that have a functional currency different from the Company’s presentation currency are translated into the Company’s presentation currency as follows: – Assets and liabilities for each statement of financial position presented are translated at the closing rate at the date of that statement of financial position; – Income and expenses are translated at average exchange rates for the period (unless this average is not a reasonable approximation of the cumulative effect of the rates prevailing on the transaction dates, in which case income and expenses are translated at the exchange rates on the transaction dates); and – All resulting exchange differences are recognised in other comprehensive income and accumulated in the foreign currency translation reserve. On consolidation, exchange differences arising from the translation of monetary items that form part of the net investment in foreign entities are recognised in other comprehensive income and accumulated in the foreign currency translation reserve. When a foreign operation is sold, such exchange differences are reclassified to consolidated profit or loss as part of the gain or loss on disposal. Goodwill and fair value adjustments arising on the acquisition of a foreign entity are treated as assets and liabilities of the foreign entity and translated at the closing rate. – I-11 – THIS APPLICATION PROOF IS IN DRAFT FORM. The information contained herein is incomplete and is subject to change. This Application Proof must be read in conjunction with the section headed “Warning” on the cover of this Application Proof. APPENDIX I (d) ACCOUNTANTS’ REPORT Plant and equipment Plant and equipment, held for use in the production or supply of goods or services, or for administrative purposes are stated in the consolidated statement of financial position at cost, less subsequent accumulated depreciation and subsequent accumulated impairment losses if any. Subsequent costs are included in the asset’s carrying amount or recognised as a separate asset, as appropriate, only when it is probable that future economic benefits associated with the item will flow to the Group and the cost of the item can be measured reliably. All other repairs and maintenance are recognised in profit or loss during the period in which they are incurred. Depreciation of plant and equipment is calculated at rates sufficient to write off their cost less their residual values over the estimated useful lives on a straight-line basis. The principal annual rates are as follows: Furniture and fixtures Office equipment Motor vehicles Leasehold improvements 20% 20% 30% 20% The residual values, useful lives and depreciation method are reviewed and adjusted, if appropriate, at the end of each reporting period. The gain or loss on disposal of plant and equipment is the difference between the net sales proceeds and the carrying amount of the relevant asset, and is recognised in profit or loss. (e) Leases The Group as lessee (i) Operating leases Leases that do not substantially transfer to the Group all the risks and rewards of ownership of assets are accounted for as operating leases. Lease payments (net of any incentives received from the lessor) are recognised as an expense on a straight-line basis over the lease term. (ii) Finance leases Leases that substantially transfer to the Group all the risks and rewards of ownership of assets are accounted for as finance leases. At the commencement of the lease term, a finance lease is capitalised at the lower of the fair value of the leased asset and the present value of the minimum lease payments, each determined at the inception of the lease. The corresponding liability to the lessor is included in the consolidated statement of financial position as finance lease payable. Lease payments are apportioned between the finance charge and the reduction of the outstanding liability. The finance charge is allocated to each period during the lease term so as to produce a constant periodic rate of interest on the remaining balance of the liability. Assets under finance leases are depreciated the same as owned assets over the shorter of the lease term and their estimated useful lives. – I-12 – THIS APPLICATION PROOF IS IN DRAFT FORM. The information contained herein is incomplete and is subject to change. This Application Proof must be read in conjunction with the section headed “Warning” on the cover of this Application Proof. APPENDIX I (f) ACCOUNTANTS’ REPORT Inventories Inventories are stated at the lower of cost and net realisable value. Cost is determined using the first-in, first-out basis. The cost of finished goods comprises raw materials, direct labour and an appropriate proportion of all production overhead expenditure, and where appropriate, subcontracting charges. Net realisable value is the estimated selling price in the ordinary course of business, less the estimated costs of completion and the estimated costs necessary to make the sale. (g) Recognition and derecognition of financial instruments Financial assets and financial liabilities are recognised in the consolidated statement of financial position when the Group becomes a party to the contractual provisions of the instruments. Financial assets are derecognised when the contractual rights to receive cash flows from the assets expire; the Group transfers substantially all the risks and rewards of ownership of the assets; or the Group neither transfers nor retains substantially all the risks and rewards of ownership of the assets but has not retained control on the assets. On derecognition of a financial asset, the difference between the asset’s carrying amount and the sum of the consideration received and the cumulative gain or loss that had been recognised in other comprehensive income is recognised in profit or loss. Financial liabilities are derecognised when the obligation specified in the relevant contract is discharged, cancelled or expires. The difference between the carrying amount of the financial liability derecognised and the consideration paid is recognised in profit or loss. Financial assets and liabilities are offset and the net amount reported in the balance sheet when there is a legally enforceable right to offset the recognised amounts and there is an intention to settle on a net basis or realise the asset and settle the liability simultaneously. The legally enforceable right must not be contingent on future events and must be enforceable in the normal course of business and in the event of default, insolvency or bankruptcy of the company or the counterparty. (h) Financial assets Financial assets are recognised and derecognised on a trade date basis where the purchase or sale of an financial asset is under a contract whose terms require delivery of the financial assets within the timeframe established by the market concerned, and are initially measured at fair value, plus directly attributable transaction costs except in the case of financial assets at fair value through profit or loss. The Group classifies its financial assets in loans and receivables. The classification depends on the purpose for which the financial assets were acquired. Management determines the classification of its financial assets at initial recognition. (i) Loans and receivables Loans and receivables are non-derivative financial assets with fixed or determinable payments that are not quoted in an active market. These assets are carried at amortised cost using the effective interest method (except for short-term receivables where interest is immaterial) minus any reduction for impairment or uncollectibility. Typically trade and other receivables, bank balances and cash are classified in this category. – I-13 – THIS APPLICATION PROOF IS IN DRAFT FORM. The information contained herein is incomplete and is subject to change. This Application Proof must be read in conjunction with the section headed “Warning” on the cover of this Application Proof. APPENDIX I (i) ACCOUNTANTS’ REPORT Trade and other receivables Trade and other receivables are recognised initially at fair value and subsequently measured at amortised cost using the effective interest method, less allowance for impairment. (j) Cash and cash equivalents For the purpose of the consolidated statement of cash flows, cash and cash equivalents represent cash at bank and on hand, demand deposits with banks and other financial institutions, and short-term highly liquid investments which are readily convertible into known amounts of cash and subject to an insignificant risk of change in value. Bank overdrafts which are repayable on demand and form an integral part of the Group’s cash management are also included as a component of cash and cash equivalents. (k) Financial liabilities and equity instruments Financial liabilities and equity instruments are classified according to the substance of the contractual arrangements entered into and the definitions of a financial liability and an equity instrument under HKFRSs. An equity instrument is any contract that evidences a residual interest in the assets of the Group after deducting all of its liabilities. The accounting policies adopted for specific financial liabilities and equity instruments are set out below. (i) Borrowings Borrowings are recognised initially at fair value, net of transaction costs incurred, and subsequently measured at amortised cost using the effective interest method. Borrowings are classified as current liabilities unless the Group has an unconditional right to defer settlement of the liability for at least 12 months after the reporting period. (ii) Trade and other payables Trade and other payables are stated initially at their fair value and subsequently measured at amortised cost using the effective interest method unless the effect of discounting would be immaterial, in which case they are stated at cost. (iii) Equity instruments Equity instruments issued by the Company are recorded at the proceeds received, net of direct issue costs. (l) Revenue recognition Revenue is measured at the fair value of the consideration received or receivable and is recognised when it is probable that the economic benefits will flow to the Group and the amount of revenue can be measured reliably. (i) sales of goods Revenue from the sales of goods is recognised on the transfer of significant risks and rewards of ownership, which generally coincides with the time when the goods are delivered and the title has passed to the customers. (ii) interest income Interest income is recognised on a time-proportion basis using the effective interest method. – I-14 – THIS APPLICATION PROOF IS IN DRAFT FORM. The information contained herein is incomplete and is subject to change. This Application Proof must be read in conjunction with the section headed “Warning” on the cover of this Application Proof. APPENDIX I (m) ACCOUNTANTS’ REPORT Employee benefits (i) Employee leave entitlements Employee entitlements to annual leave and long service leave are recognised when they accrue to employees. A provision is made for the estimated liability for annual leave and long service leave as a result of services rendered by employees up to the end of the reporting period. Employee entitlements to sick leave and maternity leave are not recognised until the time of leave. (ii) Pension obligations The Group contributes to defined contribution retirement schemes which are available to all employees. Contributions to the schemes by the Group and employees are calculated as a percentage of employees’ basic salaries. The retirement benefit scheme cost charged to profit or loss represents contributions payable by the Group to the funds. (iii) Termination benefits Termination benefits are recognised at the earlier of the dates when the Group can no longer withdraw the offer of those benefits and when the Group recognises restructuring costs and involves the payment of termination benefits. (n) Borrowing costs All borrowing costs are recognised in profit or loss in the period in which they are incurred. (o) Taxation Income tax represents the sum of the current tax and deferred tax. The tax currently payable is based on taxable profit for the year. Taxable profit differs from profit recognised in profit or loss because of items of income or expense that are taxable or deductible in other years and items that are never taxable or deductible. The Group’s liability for current tax is calculated using tax rates that have been enacted or substantively enacted by the end of the reporting period. Deferred tax is recognised on differences between the carrying amounts of assets and liabilities in the Financial Information and the corresponding tax bases used in the computation of taxable profit. Deferred tax liabilities are generally recognised for all taxable temporary differences and deferred tax assets are recognised to the extent that it is probable that taxable profits will be available against which deductible temporary differences, unused tax losses or unused tax credits can be utilised. Such assets and liabilities are not recognised if the temporary difference arises from goodwill or from the initial recognition (other than in a business combination) of other assets and liabilities in a transaction that affects neither the taxable profit nor the accounting profit. Deferred tax liabilities are recognised for taxable temporary differences arising on investments in subsidiaries, except where the Group is able to control the reversal of the temporary difference and it is probable that the temporary difference will not reverse in the foreseeable future. The carrying amount of deferred tax assets is reviewed at the end of each reporting period and reduced to the extent that it is no longer probable that sufficient taxable profits will be available to allow all or part of the asset to be recovered. – I-15 – THIS APPLICATION PROOF IS IN DRAFT FORM. The information contained herein is incomplete and is subject to change. This Application Proof must be read in conjunction with the section headed “Warning” on the cover of this Application Proof. APPENDIX I ACCOUNTANTS’ REPORT Deferred tax is calculated at the tax rates that are expected to apply in the period when the liability is settled or the asset is realised, based on tax rates that have been enacted or substantively enacted by the end of the reporting period. Deferred tax is recognised in profit or loss, except when it relates to items recognised in other comprehensive income or directly in equity, in which case the deferred tax is also recognised in other comprehensive income or directly in equity. The measurement of deferred tax assets and liabilities reflects the tax consequences that would follow from the manner in which the Group expects, at the end of the reporting period, to recover or settle the carrying amount of its assets and liabilities. Deferred tax assets and liabilities are offset when there is a legally enforceable right to set off current tax assets against current tax liabilities and when they relate to income taxes levied by the same taxation authority and the Group intends to settle its current tax assets and liabilities on a net basis. (p) Impairment of non-financial assets The carrying amounts of non-financial assets are reviewed at each reporting date for indications of impairment and where an asset is impaired, it is written down as an expense through the consolidated statement of profit or loss to its estimated recoverable amount. The recoverable amount is determined for an individual asset, unless the asset does not generate cash inflows that are largely independent of those from other assets or groups of assets. If this is the case, recoverable amount is determined for the cash-generating unit to which the asset belongs. Recoverable amount is the higher of value in use and the fair value less costs of disposal of the individual asset or the cash-generating unit. Value in use is the present value of the estimated future cash flows of the asset or cash-generating unit. Present values are computed using pre-tax discount rates that reflect the time value of money and the risks specific to the asset or cash-generating unit whose impairment is being measured. Impairment losses for cash-generating units are allocated first against the goodwill of the unit and then pro rata amongst the other assets of the cash-generating unit. Subsequent increases in the recoverable amount caused by changes in estimates are credited to profit or loss to the extent that they reverse the impairment. (q) Impairment of financial assets At the end of each reporting period, the Group assesses whether its financial assets (other than those at fair value through profit or loss) are impaired, based on objective evidence that, as a result of one or more events that occurred after the initial recognition, the estimated future cash flows of the (group of) financial asset(s) have been affected. In addition, for trade receivables that are assessed not to be impaired individually, the Group assesses them collectively for impairment, based on the Group’s past experience of collecting payments, an increase in the delayed payments in the portfolio, observable changes in economic conditions that correlate with default on receivables, etc. Only for trade receivables, the carrying amount is reduced through the use of an allowance account and subsequent recoveries of amounts previously written off are credited against the allowance account. Changes in the carrying amount of the allowance account are recognised in profit or loss. – I-16 – THIS APPLICATION PROOF IS IN DRAFT FORM. The information contained herein is incomplete and is subject to change. This Application Proof must be read in conjunction with the section headed “Warning” on the cover of this Application Proof. APPENDIX I ACCOUNTANTS’ REPORT For all other financial assets, the carrying amount is directly reduced by the impairment loss. For financial assets measured at amortised cost, if the amount of the impairment loss decreases in a subsequent period and the decrease can be related objectively to an event occurring after the impairment was recognised, the previously recognised impairment loss is reversed (either directly or by adjusting the allowance account for trade receivables) through profit or loss. However, the reversal must not result in a carrying amount that exceeds what the amortised cost of the financial asset would have been had the impairment not been recognised at the date the impairment is reversed. (r) Provisions and contingent liabilities Provisions are recognised for liabilities of uncertain timing or amount when the Group has a present legal or constructive obligation arising as a result of a past event, it is probable that an outflow of economic benefits will be required to settle the obligation and a reliable estimate can be made. Where the time value of money is material, provisions are stated at the present value of the expenditures expected to settle the obligation. Where it is not probable that an outflow of economic benefits will be required, or the amount cannot be estimated reliably, the obligation is disclosed as a contingent liability, unless the probability of outflow is remote. Possible obligations, whose existence will only be confirmed by the occurrence or non-occurrence of one or more future events are also disclosed as contingent liabilities unless the probability of outflow is remote. (s) Events after the reporting period Events after the reporting period that provide additional information about the Group’s position at the end of the reporting period or those that indicate the going concern assumption is not appropriate are adjusting events and are reflected in the Financial Information. Events after the reporting period that are not adjusting events are disclosed in the notes to the Financial Information when material. 5. KEY SOURCES OF ESTIMATION UNCERTAINTY The key assumptions concerning the future, and other key sources of estimation uncertainty at the end of the reporting period, that have a significant risk of causing a material adjustment to the carrying amounts of assets and liabilities within the next financial year, are discussed below. (a) Plant and equipment and depreciation The Group determines the estimated useful lives, residual values and related depreciation charges for the Group’s plant and equipment. This estimate is based on the historical experience of the actual useful lives and residual values of plant and equipment of similar nature and functions. The Group will revise the depreciation charge where useful lives and residual values are different to those previously estimated, or it will write-off or write-down technically obsolete or non-strategic assets that have been abandoned. As at 31 December 2014 and 2015, the carrying amount of plant and equipment were approximately HK$1,679,000 and HK$979,000 respectively. (b) Income taxes The Group is subject to income taxes in HK and the PRC. Significant estimates are required in determining the provision for income taxes. There are many transactions and calculations for which the ultimate tax determination is uncertain during the ordinary course of business. Where the final tax outcome of these matters is different from the amounts that were initially recorded, such differences will impact the income tax and deferred tax provisions in the period in which such determination is made. Approximately HK$1,626,000 and HK$3,205,000 of income taxes were charged to profit or loss based on the estimated profit from operations for the years ended 31 December 2014 and 2015 respectively. – I-17 – THIS APPLICATION PROOF IS IN DRAFT FORM. The information contained herein is incomplete and is subject to change. This Application Proof must be read in conjunction with the section headed “Warning” on the cover of this Application Proof. APPENDIX I (c) ACCOUNTANTS’ REPORT Impairment loss for bad and doubtful debts The Group makes impairment loss for bad and doubtful debts based on assessments of the recoverability of the trade and other receivables, including the current creditworthiness and the past collection history of each debtor. Impairments arise where events or changes in circumstances indicate that the balances may not be collectible. The identification of bad and doubtful debts, in particular of a loss event, requires the use of judgment and estimates. Where the actual result is different from the original estimate, such difference will impact the carrying value of the trade and other receivables and doubtful debt expenses in the year in which such estimate has been changed. As at 31 December 2014 and 2015, no accumulated impairment loss for bad and doubtful debts was made except that bad debts of HK$226,000 were written off for the year ended 31 December 2015. (d) Allowance for slow-moving inventories Allowance for slow-moving inventories is made based on the aging and estimated net realisable value of inventories. The assessment of the allowance amount involves judgment and estimates. Where the actual outcome in future is different from the original estimate, such difference will impact the carrying value of inventories and allowance charge/write-back in the period in which such estimate has been changed. No allowance for slow-moving inventories was made for the years ended 31 December 2014 and 2015 respectively. 6. FINANCIAL RISK MANAGEMENT The Group’s activities expose it to a variety of financial risks: foreign currency risk, credit risk, liquidity risk and interest rate risk. The Group’s overall risk management programme focuses on the unpredictability of financial markets and seeks to minimise potential adverse effects on the Group’s financial performance. (a) Foreign currency risk The Group has minimal exposure to foreign currency risk as most of its business transactions, assets and liabilities are principally denominated in HK$, US dollars (“US$”) and Renminbi (“RMB”). The Group does not expect any significant exposure to foreign currency risk as HK$ is pegged to US$ and it is not considered likely that there will be a material fluctuation in the US$/HK$ exchange rate. The Group currently does not have a foreign currency hedging policy in respect of foreign currency transactions, assets and liabilities. The Group monitors its foreign currency exposure closely and will consider hedging significant foreign currency exposure should the need arise. (b) Credit risk The Group’s credit risk is primarily attributable to its trade receivables, other receivables and bank and cash balances. The Group have certain concentrations of credit risk as 65% and 48% of the total trade receivables were due from the Group’s five largest customers as at 31 December 2014 and 2015 respectively. It has policies in place to ensure that sales are made to customers with an appropriate credit history. The credit risk on bank and cash balances is limited because the counterparties are banks with high credit-ratings assigned by international credit-rating agencies. – I-18 – THIS APPLICATION PROOF IS IN DRAFT FORM. The information contained herein is incomplete and is subject to change. This Application Proof must be read in conjunction with the section headed “Warning” on the cover of this Application Proof. APPENDIX I (c) ACCOUNTANTS’ REPORT Liquidity risk The Group’s policy is to regularly monitor current and expected liquidity requirements to ensure that it maintains sufficient reserves of cash to meet its liquidity requirements in the short and longer term. The maturity analysis based on contractual undiscounted cash flows of the Group’s non-derivative financial liabilities is as follows: (d) Less than 1 year HK$’000 Between 1 and 2 years HK$’000 Between 2 and 5 years HK$’000 Total HK$’000 At 31 December 2014 Trade payables Accruals and other payables Bank loans Finance lease payables 8,278 7,643 307 184 – – 307 175 – – 205 83 8,278 7,643 819 442 At 31 December 2015 Trade payables Accruals and other payables Bank loans Finance lease payables 3,392 4,102 1,475 175 – – 1,373 83 – – 1,363 – 3,392 4,102 4,211 258 Interest rate risk The Group’s exposure to interest rate risk arises from its bank deposits and bank borrowing. These deposits and borrowings bear interests at variable rates. At 31 December 2014 and 2015, if interest rates had been 1% lower with all other variables held constant, consolidated profit after tax for the years and equity would have been approximately HK$28,000 and HK$99,000 respectively lower, arising mainly as a result of lower interest income on bank balance. At 31 December 2014 and 2015, if interest rates had been 1% higher with all other variables held constant, consolidated profit after tax for the years and equity would have been approximately HK$28,000 and HK$99,000 respectively higher, arising mainly as a result of higher interest income on bank balance. (e) Categories of financial instruments at end of each reporting period At 31 December 2014 2015 HK$’000 HK$’000 Financial assets: Loans and receivables (including cash and cash equivalents) 18,542 24,812 Financial liabilities: Financial liabilities measured at amortised cost 17,046 11,483 – I-19 – THIS APPLICATION PROOF IS IN DRAFT FORM. The information contained herein is incomplete and is subject to change. This Application Proof must be read in conjunction with the section headed “Warning” on the cover of this Application Proof. APPENDIX I (f) ACCOUNTANTS’ REPORT Fair values The carrying amounts of the Group’s financial assets and financial liabilities as reflected in the consolidated statement of financial position approximate their respective fair values. 7. REVENUE AND SEGMENT INFORMATION (a) The Group’s revenue represents sales of goods to customers. (b) Segment information The Group has three reportable segments as follows: (i) Fitness equipment – (ii) Beauty gadgets – (iii) Other health care products – Sale of treadmills, exercise bikes, elliptical trainers, steppers and other fitness accessories Sale of beauty gadgets such as hair removal, wrinkle reduction, skin lifting, etc, and other beauty accessories Sale of massage devices, inflated bath tub, electric blankets, ergonomic chairs and limb-support compression wears The Group’s reportable segments are strategic business units that offer different products and services. They are managed separately because each business requires different sales and marketing strategies. The accounting policies of the operating segments are the same as those described in note 4 to the Financial Information. Segment profits or losses do not include corporate income and expenses. As segment assets and liabilities are not prepared and provided regularly to the Group’s most senior management and accordingly no segment assets or liabilities are presented. (i) Information about operating segment profit or loss, assets and liabilities: Fitness equipment HK$’000 Beauty gadgets HK$’000 Other health care products HK$’000 Year ended 31 December 2014 Revenue from external customers Segment profit 23,919 14,815 41,373 26,212 2,173 988 67,465 42,015 Year ended 31 December 2015 Revenue from external customers Segment profit 22,463 13,665 60,706 36,530 1,575 1,009 84,744 51,204 – I-20 – Total HK$’000 THIS APPLICATION PROOF IS IN DRAFT FORM. The information contained herein is incomplete and is subject to change. This Application Proof must be read in conjunction with the section headed “Warning” on the cover of this Application Proof. APPENDIX I ACCOUNTANTS’ REPORT (ii) Reconciliations of segment profit or loss: Year ended 31 December 2014 2015 HK$’000 HK$’000 Profit or loss Total profit or loss of reportable segments Unallocated amounts: Other income Selling and distribution expenses Administrative expenses Finance costs Consolidated profit before tax (iii) 42,015 51,204 5 (22,693) (6,184) (99) 98 (25,296) (12,998) (334) 13,044 12,674 Geographical information: The Group’s revenue from external customers by reference to the location of customers and information about its non-current assets by reference to the geographical location of assets are detailed below: Year ended 31 December 2014 2015 HK$’000 HK$’000 Revenue Hong Kong PRC except Hong Kong 50,843 16,622 64,527 20,217 Consolidated total 67,465 84,744 Year ended 31 December 2014 2015 HK$’000 HK$’000 (iv) Non-current assets Hong Kong PRC except Hong Kong 2,354 19 2,395 30 Consolidated total 2,373 2,425 Information about major customers: The revenue attributed by each customer is less than 10% of the Group’s total revenue for the years ended 31 December 2014 and 2015 respectively. – I-21 – THIS APPLICATION PROOF IS IN DRAFT FORM. The information contained herein is incomplete and is subject to change. This Application Proof must be read in conjunction with the section headed “Warning” on the cover of this Application Proof. APPENDIX I 8. ACCOUNTANTS’ REPORT OTHER INCOME Year ended 31 December 2014 2015 HK$’000 HK$’000 Bank interest income Others 9. 1 4 4 94 5 98 FINANCE COSTS Year ended 31 December 2014 2015 HK$’000 HK$’000 Finance lease charges Bank loans Others 10. 35 58 6 23 306 5 99 334 INCOME TAX EXPENSE (a) Income tax has been recognised in the consolidated profit or loss as following: Year ended 31 December 2014 2015 HK$’000 HK$’000 Current tax – Hong Kong Provision for the year Over-provision in prior year Current tax – PRC Provision for the year 1,966 (751) 2,435 – 1,215 2,435 411 770 1,626 3,205 Hong Kong profits tax has been provided at a rate of 16.5% on the estimated assessable profit for the years ended 31 December 2014 and 2015. PRC enterprise income tax has been provided at applicable income tax rate of 25% on the assessable profit for the years ended 31 December 2014 and 2015. – I-22 – THIS APPLICATION PROOF IS IN DRAFT FORM. The information contained herein is incomplete and is subject to change. This Application Proof must be read in conjunction with the section headed “Warning” on the cover of this Application Proof. APPENDIX I (b) ACCOUNTANTS’ REPORT The reconciliation between the income tax expense and the product of profit before tax multiplied by the applicable tax rates is as follows: Year ended 31 December 2014 2015 HK$’000 HK$’000 Profit before tax 11. 13,044 12,674 Tax calculated at 16.5% Tax effect of expenses that are not deductible Tax effect of temporary differences not recognised Tax effect of utilisation of tax losses not previously recognised Difference in tax rates of subsidiary Over-provision in prior year 2,152 106 58 2,091 795 57 Income tax expense 1,626 (119) 180 (751) – 262 – 3,205 PROFIT FOR THE YEAR The Group’s profit for the year is stated after charging the following: Year ended 31 December 2014 2015 HK$’000 HK$’000 Auditor ’s remuneration – Provision for the year – Under-provision in prior years Bad debts written off Cost of inventories sold Depreciation Written-off of plant and equipment [REDACTED] expenses Net foreign exchange loss Operating lease charges in respect of land and buildings – I-23 – 30 – 30 – 25,450 978 327 – 47 6,435 38 5 43 226 33,540 772 222 3,851 79 7,468 THIS APPLICATION PROOF IS IN DRAFT FORM. The information contained herein is incomplete and is subject to change. This Application Proof must be read in conjunction with the section headed “Warning” on the cover of this Application Proof. APPENDIX I 12. ACCOUNTANTS’ REPORT EMPLOYEE BENEFITS EXPENSE Year ended 31 December 2014 2015 HK$’000 HK$’000 Salaries, bonuses and allowances Retirement benefit scheme contributions 9,341 494 9,835 11,631 560 12,191 The five highest paid individuals included two directors for the years ended 31 December 2014 (2015: two) whose emoluments are reflected in the analysis presented in note 13. The emoluments of the remaining three (2015: three) individuals are set out below: Year ended 31 December 2014 2015 HK$’000 HK$’000 Salaries, bonuses and allowances Retirement benefit scheme contributions 1,061 48 1,115 52 1,109 1,167 These three highest paid individuals’ emoluments fell within HK$Nil to HK$1,000,000. 13. BENEFITS AND INTERESTS OF DIRECTORS (a) Directors’ emoluments The emoluments of each director were as follows: Name of director Fees HK$’000 Salaries, allowances Retirement and benefit benefits scheme in kind contributions HK$’000 HK$’000 Total HK$’000 Year ended 31 December 2014 Executive directors Chan Yiu Kwong Li Hon Ming Lo Wing Sang – – – 413 443 – 17 17 – 430 460 – Independent non-executive director So Alan Wai Sing Ho Long Chin Matthew Wong King Lung – – – – – – – – – – – – Total – 856 34 890 – I-24 – THIS APPLICATION PROOF IS IN DRAFT FORM. The information contained herein is incomplete and is subject to change. This Application Proof must be read in conjunction with the section headed “Warning” on the cover of this Application Proof. APPENDIX I ACCOUNTANTS’ REPORT Name of director Fees HK$’000 Salaries, allowances Retirement and benefit benefits scheme in kind contributions HK$’000 HK$’000 Total HK$’000 Year ended 31 December 2015 Executive directors Chan Yiu Kwong Li Hon Ming Lo Wing Sang – – – 600 444 – 21 18 – 621 462 – Independent non-executive director So Alan Wai Sing Ho Long Chin Matthew Wong King Lung – – – – – – – – – – – – Total – 1,044 39 1,083 None of the directors waived or agreed to waive any emoluments during the years ended 31 December 2014 and 2015. (b) Amounts due from/(to) directors Amounts due from/(to) directors are as follows: Name Chan Yiu Kwong Li Hon Ming At 1 January 2014 HK$’000 The Group At 31 December 2014 HK$’000 At 31 December 2015 HK$’000 (1,046) (1,982) 2,403 486 1,035 2,950 2,408 486 3,486 2,950 (3,028) 2,889 3,985 2,894 6,436 Maximum amount outstanding during the year 2014 2015 HK$’000 HK$’000 All the above amounts are unsecured, interest-free and will be fully settled before [REDACTED]. – I-25 – THIS APPLICATION PROOF IS IN DRAFT FORM. The information contained herein is incomplete and is subject to change. This Application Proof must be read in conjunction with the section headed “Warning” on the cover of this Application Proof. APPENDIX I (c) ACCOUNTANTS’ REPORT Directors’ material interests in transactions, arrangements or contracts During the years ended 31 December 2014 and 2015, the Company entered into the following transactions: Name of parties contracted with Nature of contracts (i) (ii) (iii) Li Hon Ming Cao Xiao Wei Zhu Zhengfang Distribution Distribution Distribution (iv) Diva 100 Company Limited Distribution (v) Exodus Technology Limited IT maintenance fee (vi) Poon Suet Fan Rental The contracting party and nature of directors’ interests Director Spouse of Chan Yiu Kwong Mother-in-law of Chan Yiu Kwong Controlled by Cao Xiao Wei and spouse of Li Hon Ming Controlled by brother of Chan Yiu Kwong Mother of ChanYiu Kwong Save for the aforementioned transactions, no other transactions, arrangements and contracts of significance to which the Company was a party and in which a director of the Company had a material interest, whether directly or indirectly, subsisted at the end of the year or at any time during the years. 14. DIVIDENDS Interim dividends 2014 HK$’000 2015 HK$’000 – 17,000 During the year ended 31 December 2015, Fit Boxx HK declared interim dividends to its then shareholders amounted to HK$17,000,000. The rates of dividend and number of shares ranking for dividends are not presented as such information is not meaningful having regard to the purpose of this report. 15. EARNINGS PER SHARE Earnings per share information is not presented as its inclusion, for the purpose of this financial information, is not considered meaningful due to the Group Reorganisation and the basis of presentation of the results of the Group for the Relevant Periods as further explained in note 2 to the Financial Information. – I-26 – THIS APPLICATION PROOF IS IN DRAFT FORM. The information contained herein is incomplete and is subject to change. This Application Proof must be read in conjunction with the section headed “Warning” on the cover of this Application Proof. APPENDIX I 16. ACCOUNTANTS’ REPORT PLANT AND EQUIPMENT Furniture and fixtures HK$’000 Office equipment HK$’000 Cost At 1 January 2014 Additions Written-off 384 44 (41) 429 61 (14) 1,667 – – 1,946 422 (618) 4,426 527 (673) At 31 December 2014 and 1 January 2015 Additions Written-off Exchange difference 387 71 – – 476 96 (17) (2) 1,667 – – – 1,750 128 (362) – 4,280 295 (379) (2) At 31 December 2015 458 553 1,667 1,516 4,194 Accumulated depreciation At 1 January 2014 Charge for the year Written-off 184 77 (30) 207 98 (7) 798 454 – 780 349 (309) 1,969 978 (346) At 31 December 2014 and 1 January 2015 Charge for the year Written-off Exchange difference 231 77 – – 298 86 (12) (1) 1,252 325 – – 820 284 (145) – 2,601 772 (157) (1) At 31 December 2015 308 371 1,577 959 3,215 Carrying amount At 31 December 2015 150 182 90 557 979 At 31 December 2014 156 178 415 930 1,679 Motor Leasehold vehicles improvements HK$’000 HK$’000 Total HK$’000 At 31 December 2014 and 2015, the carrying amount of motor vehicles held by the Group under finance leases amounted to HK$167,000 and HK$29,000 respectively. – I-27 – THIS APPLICATION PROOF IS IN DRAFT FORM. The information contained herein is incomplete and is subject to change. This Application Proof must be read in conjunction with the section headed “Warning” on the cover of this Application Proof. APPENDIX I 17. ACCOUNTANTS’ REPORT INVESTMENTS IN SUBSIDIARIES The Company At 31 December 2014 2015 HK$’000 HK$’000 Unlisted investments, at cost – 21,911 The amount due from a subsidiary is unsecured, interest-free and repayable on demand. 18. INVENTORIES At 31 December 2014 2015 HK$’000 HK$’000 Finished goods 19. 22,483 14,624 TRADE RECEIVABLES The aging analysis of the Group’s trade receivables, based on the delivery of goods and net of allowance, is as follows: At 31 December 2014 2015 HK$’000 HK$’000 Up to 30 days 31 to 60 days 61 to 90 days 91 to 180 days Over 180 days 3,663 959 177 61 224 2,142 659 112 228 1 5,084 3,142 As of 31 December 2014 and 2015, trade receivables of approximately HK$426,000 and HK$404,000 respectively were past due but not impaired. These relate to a number of independent customers for whom there is no recent history of default. The aging analysis of these trade receivable is as follows: At 31 December 2014 2015 HK$’000 HK$’000 Up to 30 days 31 to 60 days 61 to 90 days 91 to 180 days Over 180 days – I-28 – 137 61 4 3 221 210 149 35 10 – 426 404 THIS APPLICATION PROOF IS IN DRAFT FORM. The information contained herein is incomplete and is subject to change. This Application Proof must be read in conjunction with the section headed “Warning” on the cover of this Application Proof. APPENDIX I ACCOUNTANTS’ REPORT The carrying amounts of the Group’s trade receivables are denominated in the following currencies: At 31 December 2014 2015 HK$’000 HK$’000 HK$ RMB 4,991 93 2,830 312 5,084 3,142 The Group’s trading terms with wholesales customers are mainly on credit. The credit terms generally range from 30 to 60 days. Each customer has a credit limit. The Group seek to maintain strict control over its outstanding receivables. Overdue balances are reviewed regularly by the management. For individual retail customers, sales are made on “cash on delivery” except for certain individuals that, due to their long-standing business relationships with the Group, who are given 30-60 days of credit period. 20. BANK AND CASH BALANCES The carrying amounts of the Group’s bank and cash balances are denominated in the following currencies: At 31 December 2014 2015 HK$’000 HK$’000 HK$ RMB 6,260 522 13,404 504 6,782 13,908 As at 31 December 2014 and 2015, the bank and cash balances of the Group denominated in RMB amounted to approximately HK$522,000 and HK$504,000 respectively. Conversion of RMB into foreign currencies is subject to the PRC’s Foreign Exchange Control Regulations and Administration of Settlement, Sale and Payment of Foreign Exchange Regulations. 21. TRADE PAYABLES The aging analysis of the Group’s trade payables, based on goods receipt date, is as follows: At 31 December 2014 2015 HK$’000 HK$’000 Up to 30 days 31 to 60 days 61 to 90 days 91 to 180 days – I-29 – 1,535 5,872 151 720 1,486 1,803 103 – 8,278 3,392 THIS APPLICATION PROOF IS IN DRAFT FORM. The information contained herein is incomplete and is subject to change. This Application Proof must be read in conjunction with the section headed “Warning” on the cover of this Application Proof. APPENDIX I ACCOUNTANTS’ REPORT The carrying amounts of the Group’s trade payables are denominated in the following currencies: At 31 December 2014 2015 HK$’000 HK$’000 HK$ US$ 810 7,468 701 2,691 Total 8,278 3,392 Payments to suppliers are generally made within 30 to 60 days after shipment of goods from suppliers. 22. BANK LOANS At 31 December 2014 2015 HK$’000 HK$’000 Bank loans 722 3,747 The Group’s bank loans are repayable as follows: At 31 December 2014 2015 HK$’000 HK$’000 Within one year More than one year but not exceeding two years More than two years, but not more than five years Less: Amount due for settlement within 12 months Amount due for settlement after 12 months 250 274 198 1,224 1,223 1,300 722 3,747 (250) (1,224) 472 2,523 The Group’s bank loans are arranged at the following average interest rates: At 31 December 2014 Bank loans 9.4% 2015 8.6% As at 31 December 2014 and 2015, bank loans of approximately HK$722,000 and HK$3,747,000 respectively are arranged at the above fixed interest rates and expose the Group to fair value interests rate risk. As at 31 December 2014 and 2015, the Group’s bank loans are secured by personal guarantee from directors of the Group (note 31 (c)(i)). – I-30 – THIS APPLICATION PROOF IS IN DRAFT FORM. The information contained herein is incomplete and is subject to change. This Application Proof must be read in conjunction with the section headed “Warning” on the cover of this Application Proof. APPENDIX I 23. ACCOUNTANTS’ REPORT FINANCE LEASE PAYABLES Minimum lease payments At 31 December 2014 2015 HK$’000 HK$’000 Within one year In the second to fifth years, inclusive 184 258 175 83 Less: Future finance charges 442 (39) 258 (16) Present value of lease obligations 403 242 Present value of minimum lease payments At 31 December 2014 2015 HK$’000 HK$’000 161 242 163 79 403 N/A 242 N/A 403 242 Less: Amount due for settlement within 12 months (161) (163) Amount due for settlement after 12 months 242 79 The motor vehicles under finance leases are contracted for an average lease term of 5 years. At 31 December 2014 and 2015, the average effective interest rates were 7.2% and 7.2% respectively. Interest rates are fixed at the contract dates and thus expose the Group to fair value interest rate risk. All leases are on a fixed repayment basis and no arrangements have been entered into for contingent rental payments. At the end of each lease term, the Group has the option to purchase the motor vehicles at nominal prices. At 31 December 2014 and 2015, the Group’s finance lease payables are secured by the lessor ’s title to the leased assets and personal guarantee from one of the directors of the Group (note 31(c)(ii)). 24. RETIREMENT BENEFIT SCHEME CONTRIBUTIONS The Group operates a mandatory provident fund scheme (the “MPF Scheme”) under the Hong Kong Mandatory Provident Fund Schemes Ordinance for all qualifying employees in Hong Kong. The Group’s contributions to the MPF Scheme are calculated at 5% of the salaries and wages subject to a monthly maximum amount of contribution of HK$1,500 (before 1 June 2014: HK$1,250) per employee and vest fully with employees when contributed into the MPF Scheme. The employees of the Group’s subsidiary established in the PRC are members of a central pension scheme operated by the local municipal government. This subsidiary is required to contribute certain percentage of the employees’ basic salaries and wages to the central pension scheme to fund the retirement benefits. The local municipal government undertakes to assume the retirement benefits obligations of all existing and future retired employees of this subsidiary. The only obligation of this subsidiary with respect to the central pension scheme is to meet the required contributions under the pension scheme. – I-31 – THIS APPLICATION PROOF IS IN DRAFT FORM. The information contained herein is incomplete and is subject to change. This Application Proof must be read in conjunction with the section headed “Warning” on the cover of this Application Proof. APPENDIX I 25. ACCOUNTANTS’ REPORT SHARE CAPITAL Authorised shares capital of the Company: Number of Shares Ordinary shares of HK$0.01 each (note i & iii) Amount HK$ 39,000,000 390,000 Number of shares issued Nominal value of fully paid shares HK$ At 14 May 2015 (date of incorporation) (note ii) Share subdivision (note iii) Issue of shares on Group Reorganisation (note iv) Issue of shares (note v) 1 99 11,142 8,758 1 – 111 88 At 31 December 2015 20,000 200 Issued and fully paid: Notes: (i) The Company was incorporated in Cayman Islands on 14 May 2015 with an authorised share capital of HK$390,000 divided into 390,000 shares of HK$1.00 each. (ii) On 14 May 2015, the incorporation date of the Company, 1 share was allotted and issued fully paid. (iii) On 12 June 2015, pursuant to the written resolutions passed by the Company’s shareholders, every issued and unissued share of HK$1.00 each in the share capital of the Company be subdivided into 100 shares of HK$0.01 each, such that the Company’s authorised share capital of HK$390,000 was subdivided into 39,000,000 shares of HK$0.01 each. (iv) Pursuant to the share sale and purchase agreement dated 10 December 2015, the Company allotted 9,900 shares to Faith Elite Limited (“Faith Elite”), credited as fully paid. On the same date, pursuant to the Share Sale and Purchase Agreement, the Company allotted 733 shares and 509 shares to National Pride Limited (“National Pride”) and Prime View Enterprises Limited (“Prime View”), credited as fully paid respectively. (v) Pursuant to two subscription agreements dated 11 December 2015 entered into between the Company with each of Global Excellent Inc Limited (“Global Excellent”) and Hang Kong Investment Consulting Limited (“Hang Kong”) respectively, each of Global Excellent and Hang Kong agreed to subscribe for 1,292 shares at the consideration of HK$3,387,500. [On the same date], an additional of 5,206 shares, 571 shares and 397 shares were issued and allotted to Faith Elite, National Pride and Prime View respectively as par value, credited as fully paid respectively. The Group’s objectives when managing capital are to safeguard the Group’s ability to continue as a going concern and to maximise the return to the shareholders through the optimisation of the debt and equity balance. – I-32 – THIS APPLICATION PROOF IS IN DRAFT FORM. The information contained herein is incomplete and is subject to change. This Application Proof must be read in conjunction with the section headed “Warning” on the cover of this Application Proof. APPENDIX I ACCOUNTANTS’ REPORT The Group sets the amount of capital in proportion to risk. The Group manages the capital structure and makes adjustments to it in the light of changes in economic conditions and the risk characteristics of the underlying assets. In order to maintain or adjust the capital structure, the Group may adjust the payment of dividends, issue new shares, buy-back shares, raise new debts, redeem existing debts or sell assets to reduce debts. The Group monitors capital on the basis of the gearing ratio which is the total borrowings divided by the total equity of the Company. Total borrowings comprises bank loans and finance lease payables. The Group’s policy is to keep the gearing ratio at a reasonable level. The Group’s gearing ratio at the end of each reporting period were as follows: Year ended 31 December 2014 2015 HK$’000 HK$’000 Bank loans Finance lease payables Total borrowings Total equity 722 403 3,747 242 1,125 3,989 24,076 28,616 0.05 0.14 Gearing ratio The Group is not subject to any externally imposed capital requirements. 26. STATEMENT OF FINANCIAL POSITION AND RESERVE MOVEMENT OF THE COMPANY (a) Statement of financial position of the Company Note At 31 December 2014 2015 HK$’000 HK$’000 Non-current assets Investments in subsidiaries – 21,911 Current assets Due from a subsidiary – 6,732 TOTAL ASSETS – 28,643 – – 1 28,642 – 28,643 Capital and reserves Share capital Reserves 26(b) TOTAL EQUITY – I-33 – THIS APPLICATION PROOF IS IN DRAFT FORM. The information contained herein is incomplete and is subject to change. This Application Proof must be read in conjunction with the section headed “Warning” on the cover of this Application Proof. APPENDIX I (b) ACCOUNTANTS’ REPORT Reserve movement of the Company At 14 May 2015 (date of incorporation) Issue of shares on Group Reorganisation (note 25 (iv)) Issue of shares (note 25(v)) Total comprehensive income for the year At 31 December 2015 27. Share premium HK$’000 (note 27(b)(i)) Other reserve HK$’000 (note 27(b)(iv)) Retained profits HK$’000 Total HK$’000 – – – – – 6,774 21,910 – – – 21,910 6,774 – – (42) 6,774 21,910 (42) (42) 28,642 RESERVES (a) The Group The amounts of the Group’s reserves and movements therein are presented in the consolidated statement of profit or loss and other comprehensive income and consolidated statement of changes in equity. (b) Nature and purpose of reserves (i) Share premium account Under the Companies Law of the Cayman Islands, the funds in the share premium account of the Company are distributable to the shareholders of the Company provided that immediately following the date on which the dividend is proposed to be distributed, the Company will be in a position to pay off its debts as they fall due in the ordinary course of business. (ii) Foreign currency translation reserve The foreign currency translation reserve comprises all foreign exchange differences arising from the translation of the financial statements of foreign operations. The reserve is dealt with in accordance with the accounting policies set out in note 4(b) to the Financial Information. (iii) Statutory reserve The statutory reserve, which is non-distributable, is appropriated from the profit after taxation of the Group’s PRC subsidiary under the applicable laws and regulations in the PRC. (iv) Other reserve Other reserves of the Group represents the capital contributions from equity holders of certain subsidiaries now comprising the Group before the completion of the Group Reorganisation. – I-34 – THIS APPLICATION PROOF IS IN DRAFT FORM. The information contained herein is incomplete and is subject to change. This Application Proof must be read in conjunction with the section headed “Warning” on the cover of this Application Proof. APPENDIX I 28. ACCOUNTANTS’ REPORT NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED STATEMENT OF CASH FLOWS (a) Major non-cash transaction The dividend of approximately HK$10,800,000 paid to then shareholders of Fit Boxx Trading Company Limited during year ended 31 December 2015 was settled by way of set-off against amounts due from directors. On 19 December 2014, HK$5,500,000 proceeds from share subscription of Fit Boxx HK were received and were included in other payables. The shares were subsequently allotted and issued on 11 February 2015. 29. CONTINGENT LIABILITIES As at 31 December 2014 and 2015, the Group did not have any significant contingent liabilities. 30. LEASE COMMITMENTS The Group as lessee The total future minimum lease payments under non-cancellable operating leases are payable as follows: At 31 December 2014 2015 HK$’000 HK$’000 Within one year In the second to fifth years inclusive 4,597 1,024 6,297 3,467 5,621 9,764 Operating lease payments represent rentals payable by the Group for certain of its offices, retail outlets and warehouses. Leases are negotiated for an average term of 2 years and rentals are fixed over the lease terms and include contingent rentals based on an agreed percentage of revenue generated from certain retail outlets. 31. MATERIAL RELATED PARTIES TRANSACTIONS (a) In addition to those related party transactions and balances disclosed elsewhere in note 13 to the Financial Information, the Group had the following material transactions with its related parties during the Relevant Periods: At 31 December 2014 2015 HK$’000 HK$’000 Sales of goods to a director (note 13 (c)(i)) Sales of goods to related parties (note 13 (c)(ii)-(iv)) Rental expenses charged by a related party (note 13 (c)(vi)) IT maintenance fee charged by a related party (note 13 (c)(v)) – I-35 – 250 7,389 14 1,428 – 315 42 159 THIS APPLICATION PROOF IS IN DRAFT FORM. The information contained herein is incomplete and is subject to change. This Application Proof must be read in conjunction with the section headed “Warning” on the cover of this Application Proof. APPENDIX I (b) ACCOUNTANTS’ REPORT The remuneration of directors and other members of key management during the year was as follows: At 31 December 2014 2015 HK$’000 HK$’000 Short-term benefits Post-employment benefits (c) 32. 856 34 1,113 39 890 1,152 Save as disclosed elsewhere in the Financial Information, the Group had the following financial guarantees from directors at the end of reporting period: (i) At 31 December 2014 and 2015, Li Hon Ming and Chan Yiu Kwong have guaranteed the banking facilities granted to Fit Boxx HK amounted to approximately HK$722,000 and HK$3,747,000 respectively. (ii) At 31 December 2014 and 2015, Mr. Li Hon Ming has guaranteed the finance lease payables of Fit Boxx HK amounted to approximately HK$403,000 and HK$242,000 respectively. EVENTS AFTER THE REPORTING PERIOD Save as disclosed above, no significant events took place up to the date of this report. [Subject to o/s] 33. SUBSEQUENT FINANCIAL STATEMENTS No audited financial statements have been prepared by the Company or any of its subsidiaries in respect of any period subsequent to 31 December 2015. Yours faithfully RSM Hong Kong Certified Public Accountants Hong Kong – I-36 – THIS APPLICATION PROOF IS IN DRAFT FORM. The information contained herein is incomplete and is subject to change. This Application Proof must be read in conjunction with the section headed “Warning” on the cover of this Application Proof. APPENDIX II UNAUDITED PRO FORMA FINANCIAL INFORMATION For illustrative purpose only, the pro forma financial information prepared in accordance with paragraph 31 of Chapter 7 of the GEM Listing Rules is set out herein to provide the investors with further information to assess the financial performance of the Group after taking into account the adjusted net tangible assets of the Group to illustrate the financial position of the Group after completion of the [REDACTED] and to illustrate the performance of the Group had the [REDACTED] been completed on 31 December 2015. A. UNAUDITED PRO FORMA ADJUSTED NET TANGIBLE ASSETS The unaudited pro forma financial information has been prepared, on the basis of the notes set out below, to illustrate how the [REDACTED] may have affected the net tangible assets attributable to owners of the Company had it occurred as of 31 December 2015. It has been prepared for illustrative purpose only and, because of its nature, may not give a true picture of the financial position of the Group. Audited consolidated net tangible assets attributable to owners of the Company as of 31 December 2015 (Note 1) HK$’000 Unaudited pro Estimated net Unaudited pro forma adjusted net proceeds from the forma adjusted net tangible assets [REDACTED] tangible assets per Share (Note 2) (Note 3) HK$’000 HK$’000 HK$ Based on the [REDACTED] of [HK$[REDACTED]] per share 28,616 [REDACTED] [REDACTED] [REDACTED] Based on the [REDACTED] of [HK$[REDACTED]] per share 28,616 [REDACTED] [REDACTED] [REDACTED] Notes: (1) The audited consolidated net tangible assets attributable to owners of the Company as of 31 December 2015 is extracted from the audited consolidated net assets of HK$28,616,000 as of 31 December 2015, as shown in the accountants’ report, the text of which is set out in Appendix I to this document. (2) The adjustment to the pro forma statement of net tangible assets reflects the estimated proceeds from the [REDACTED] to be received by the Company. The estimated proceeds from the [REDACTED] is based on the [REDACTED] of [HK$[REDACTED]] and [HK$[REDACTED]], respectively, being the lower and higher end price of the stated [REDACTED] range, and [REDACTED] Shares, net of underwriting fee of approximately [REDACTED] million and [REDACTED] million, respectively and other estimated issue expenses approximately [REDACTED] million payable by the Company. (3) The unaudited pro forma adjusted net tangible assets and the amounts per Share are on the basis that [REDACTED] shares are expected to be in issue following the [REDACTED] (including [REDACTED] shares newly issued upon the [REDACTED]) had been completed on 31 December 2015 and respective [REDACTED] of [HK$[REDACTED]] and [HK$[REDACTED]] per Share. (4) No adjustment has been made to the unaudited pro forma adjusted consolidated net tangible assets of the Group attributable to owners of the Company to reflect any trading result or other transactions of the Group entered into subsequent to 31 December 2015. – II-1 – THIS APPLICATION PROOF IS IN DRAFT FORM. The information contained herein is incomplete and is subject to change. This Application Proof must be read in conjunction with the section headed “Warning” on the cover of this Application Proof. APPENDIX II B. UNAUDITED PRO FORMA FINANCIAL INFORMATION ACCOUNTANT’S REPORT ON UNAUDITED PRO FORMA FINANCIAL INFORMATION [REDACTED] – II-2 – THIS APPLICATION PROOF IS IN DRAFT FORM. The information contained herein is incomplete and is subject to change. This Application Proof must be read in conjunction with the section headed “Warning” on the cover of this Application Proof. APPENDIX II UNAUDITED PRO FORMA FINANCIAL INFORMATION [REDACTED] – II-3 – THIS APPLICATION PROOF IS IN DRAFT FORM. The information contained herein is incomplete and is subject to change. This Application Proof must be read in conjunction with the section headed “Warning” on the cover of this Application Proof. APPENDIX II UNAUDITED PRO FORMA FINANCIAL INFORMATION [REDACTED] – II-4 – THIS APPLICATION PROOF IS IN DRAFT FORM. The information contained herein is incomplete and is subject to change. This Application Proof must be read in conjunction with the section headed “Warning” on the cover of this Application Proof. APPENDIX III SUMMARY OF THE CONSTITUTION OF THE COMPANY AND CAYMAN ISLANDS COMPANY LAW Set out below is a summary of certain provisions of the Memorandum and Articles of Association of the Company and of certain aspects of Cayman company law. The Company was incorporated in the Cayman Islands as an exempted company with limited liability on 14 May, 2015 under the Companies Law, Cap 22 (Law 3 of 1961, as consolidated and revised) of the Cayman Islands (the “Companies Law”). The Company’s constitutional documents consist of its memorandum of association (the “Memorandum”) and its articles of association (the “Articles”). 1. 2. MEMORANDUM OF ASSOCIATION (a) The Memorandum states, inter alia, that the liability of members of the Company is limited to the amount, if any, for the time being unpaid on the shares respectively held by them and that the objects for which the Company is established are unrestricted (including acting as an investment company), and that the Company shall have and be capable of exercising all the functions of a natural person of full capacity irrespective of any question of corporate benefit, as provided in section 27(2) of the Companies Law and in view of the fact that the Company is an exempted company that the Company will not trade in the Cayman Islands with any person, firm or corporation except in furtherance of the business of the Company carried on outside the Cayman Islands. (b) The Company may by special resolution alter its Memorandum with respect to any objects, powers or other matters specified therein. ARTICLES OF ASSOCIATION The Articles were conditionally adopted on [●] with effect from the [REDACTED]. The following is a summary of certain provisions of the Articles: (a) Shares (i) Classes of shares The share capital of the Company consists of ordinary shares. (ii) Variation of rights of existing shares or classes of shares Subject to the Companies Law, if at any time the share capital of the Company is divided into different classes of shares, all or any of the special rights attached to the shares or any class of shares may (unless otherwise provided for by the terms of issue of that class) be varied, modified or abrogated either with the consent in writing of the holders of not less than three-fourths in nominal value of the issued shares of that class or with the sanction of a special resolution passed at a separate general meeting of the holders of the shares of that class. To every such separate general meeting the – III-1 – THIS APPLICATION PROOF IS IN DRAFT FORM. The information contained herein is incomplete and is subject to change. This Application Proof must be read in conjunction with the section headed “Warning” on the cover of this Application Proof. APPENDIX III SUMMARY OF THE CONSTITUTION OF THE COMPANY AND CAYMAN ISLANDS COMPANY LAW provisions of the Articles relating to general meetings will mutatis mutandis apply, but so that the necessary quorum (other than at an adjourned meeting) shall be two persons holding or representing by proxy not less than one-third in nominal value of the issued shares of that class and at any adjourned meeting two holders present in person or by proxy (whatever the number of shares held by them) shall be a quorum. Every holder of shares of the class shall be entitled to one vote for every such share held by him. Any special rights conferred upon the holders of any shares or class of shares shall not, unless otherwise expressly provided in the rights attaching to the terms of issue of such shares, be deemed to be varied by the creation or issue of further shares ranking pari passu therewith. (iii) Alteration of capital The Company may by ordinary resolution of its members: (i) increase its share capital by the creation of new shares; (ii) consolidate all or any of its capital into shares of larger amount than its existing shares; (iii) divide its shares into several classes and attach to such shares any preferential, deferred, qualified or special rights, privileges, conditions or restrictions as the Company in general meeting or as the directors may determine; (iv) sub divide its shares or any of them into shares of smaller amount than is fixed by the Memorandum; or (v) cancel any shares which, at the date of passing of the resolution, have not been taken and diminish the amount of its capital by the amount of the shares so cancelled. The Company may reduce its share capital or any capital redemption reserve or other undistributable reserve in any way by special resolution. (iv) Transfer of shares All transfers of shares may be effected by an instrument of transfer in the usual or common form or in a form prescribed by The Stock Exchange of Hong Kong Limited (the “Stock Exchange”) or in such other form as the board may approve and which may be under hand or, if the transferor or transferee is a clearing house or its nominee(s), by hand or by machine imprinted signature or by such other manner of execution as the board may approve from time to time. – III-2 – THIS APPLICATION PROOF IS IN DRAFT FORM. The information contained herein is incomplete and is subject to change. This Application Proof must be read in conjunction with the section headed “Warning” on the cover of this Application Proof. APPENDIX III SUMMARY OF THE CONSTITUTION OF THE COMPANY AND CAYMAN ISLANDS COMPANY LAW The instrument of transfer shall be executed by or on behalf of the transferor and the transferee provided that the board may dispense with the execution of the instrument of transfer by the transferee. The transferor shall be deemed to remain the holder of the share until the name of the transferee is entered in the register of members in respect that share. The board may, in its absolute discretion, at any time transfer any share upon the principal register to any branch register or any share on any branch register to the principal register or any other branch register. The board may decline to recognise any instrument of transfer unless a fee (not exceeding the maximum sum as Stock Exchange may determine to be payable) determined by the Directors is paid to the Company, the instrument of transfer is properly stamped (if applicable), it is in respect of only one class of share and is lodged at the relevant registration office or registered office or such other place at which the principal register is kept accompanied by the relevant share certificate(s) and such other evidence as the board may reasonably require to show the right of the transferor to make the transfer (and if the instrument of transfer is executed by some other person on his behalf, the authority of that person so to do). The registration of transfers may be suspended and the register closed on giving notice by advertisement in any newspaper or by any other means in accordance with the requirements of the Stock Exchange, at such times and for such periods as the board may determine. The register of members must not be closed for periods exceeding in the whole thirty (30) days in any year. Subject to the above, fully paid shares are free from any restriction on transfer and free of all liens in favour of the Company. (v) Power of the Company to purchase its own shares The Company is empowered by the Companies Law and the Articles to purchase its own shares subject to certain restrictions and the board may only exercise this power on behalf of the Company subject to any applicable requirements imposed from time to time by Stock Exchange. Where the Company purchases for redemption a redeemable share, purchases not made through the market or by tender must be limited to a maximum price determined by the Company in general meeting. If purchases are by tender, tenders must be made available to all members alike. (vi) Power of any subsidiary of the Company to own shares in the Company There are no provisions in the Articles relating to ownership of shares in the Company by a subsidiary. – III-3 – THIS APPLICATION PROOF IS IN DRAFT FORM. The information contained herein is incomplete and is subject to change. This Application Proof must be read in conjunction with the section headed “Warning” on the cover of this Application Proof. APPENDIX III SUMMARY OF THE CONSTITUTION OF THE COMPANY AND CAYMAN ISLANDS COMPANY LAW (vii) Calls on shares and forfeiture of shares The board may from time to time make such calls upon the members in respect of any monies unpaid on the shares held by them respectively (whether on account of the nominal value of the shares or by way of premium). A call may be made payable either in one lump sum or by installments. If the sum payable in respect of any call or instalment is not paid on or before the day appointed for payment thereof, the person or persons from whom the sum is due shall pay interest on the same at such rate not exceeding twenty per cent. (20%) per annum as the board may agree to accept from the day appointed for the payment thereof to the time of actual payment, but the board may waive payment of such interest wholly or in part. The board may, if it thinks fit, receive from any member willing to advance the same, either in money or money’s worth, all or any part of the monies uncalled and unpaid or installments payable upon any shares held by him, and upon all or any of the monies so advanced the Company may pay interest at such rate (if any) as the board may decide. If a member fails to pay any call on the day appointed for payment thereof, the board may serve not less than fourteen (14) clear days’ notice on him requiring payment of so much of the call as is unpaid, together with any interest which may have accrued and which may still accrue up to the date of actual payment and stating that, in the event of non-payment at or before the time appointed, the shares in respect of which the call was made will be liable to be forfeited. If the requirements of any such notice are not complied with, any share in respect of which the notice has been given may at any time thereafter, before the payment required by the notice has been made, be forfeited by a resolution of the board to that effect. Such forfeiture will include all dividends and bonuses declared in respect of the forfeited share and not actually paid before the forfeiture. A person whose shares have been forfeited shall cease to be a member in respect of the forfeited shares but shall, notwithstanding, remain liable to pay to the Company all monies which, at the date of forfeiture, were payable by him to the Company in respect of the shares, together with (if the board shall in its discretion so require) interest thereon from the date of forfeiture until the date of actual payment at such rate not exceeding twenty per cent. (20%) per annum as the board determines. – III-4 – THIS APPLICATION PROOF IS IN DRAFT FORM. The information contained herein is incomplete and is subject to change. This Application Proof must be read in conjunction with the section headed “Warning” on the cover of this Application Proof. APPENDIX III (b) SUMMARY OF THE CONSTITUTION OF THE COMPANY AND CAYMAN ISLANDS COMPANY LAW Directors (i) Appointment, retirement and removal At each annual general meeting, one third of the Directors for the time being (or if their number is not a multiple of three, then the number nearest to but not less than one third) shall retire from office by rotation provided that every Director shall be subject to retirement at an annual general meeting at least once every three years. The Directors to retire by rotation shall include any Director who wishes to retire and not offer himself for re-election. Any further Directors so to retire shall be those who have been longest in office since their last re-election or appointment but as between persons who became or were last re-elected Directors on the same day those to retire will (unless they otherwise agree among themselves) be determined by lot. Neither a Director nor an alternate Director is required to hold any shares in the Company by way of qualification. Further, there are no provisions in the Articles relating to retirement of Directors upon reaching any age limit. The Directors have the power to appoint any person as a Director either to fill a casual vacancy on the board or as an addition to the existing board. Any Director appointed to fill a casual vacancy shall hold office until the first general meeting of members after his appointment and be subject to re-election at such meeting and any Director appointed as an addition to the existing board shall hold office only until the next following annual general meeting of the Company and shall then be eligible for re-election. A Director may be removed by an ordinary resolution of the Company before the expiration of his period of office (but without prejudice to any claim which such Director may have for damages for any breach of any contract between him and the Company) and members of the Company may by ordinary resolution appoint another in his place. Unless otherwise determined by the Company in general meeting, the number of Directors shall not be less than two. There is no maximum number of Directors. The office of director shall be vacated if: (aa) he resigns by notice in writing delivered to the Company; (bb) he becomes of unsound mind or dies; (cc) without special leave, he is absent from meetings of the board for six (6) consecutive months, and the board resolves that his office is vacated; – III-5 – THIS APPLICATION PROOF IS IN DRAFT FORM. The information contained herein is incomplete and is subject to change. This Application Proof must be read in conjunction with the section headed “Warning” on the cover of this Application Proof. APPENDIX III SUMMARY OF THE CONSTITUTION OF THE COMPANY AND CAYMAN ISLANDS COMPANY LAW (dd) he becomes bankrupt or has a receiving order made against him or suspends payment or compounds with his creditors; (ee) he is prohibited from being a director by law; or (ff) he ceases to be a director by virtue of any provision of law or is removed from office pursuant to the Articles. The board may appoint one or more of its body to be managing director, joint managing director, or deputy managing director or to hold any other employment or executive office with the Company for such period and upon such terms as the board may determine and the board may revoke or terminate any of such appointments. The board may delegate any of its powers, authorities and discretions to committees consisting of such Director or Directors and other persons as the board thinks fit, and it may from time to time revoke such delegation or revoke the appointment of and discharge any such committees either wholly or in part, and either as to persons or purposes, but every committee so formed must, in the exercise of the powers, authorities and discretions so delegated, conform to any regulations that may from time to time be imposed upon it by the board. (ii) Power to allot and issue shares and warrants Subject to the provisions of the Companies Law and the Memorandum and Articles and to any special rights conferred on the holders of any shares or class of shares, any share may be issued (a) with or have attached thereto such rights, or such restrictions, whether with regard to dividend, voting, return of capital, or otherwise, as the Company may by ordinary resolution determine (or, in the absence of any such determination or so far as the same may not make specific provision, as the board may determine), or (b) on terms that, at the option of the Company or the holder thereof, it is liable to be redeemed. The board may issue warrants conferring the right upon the holders thereof to subscribe for any class of shares or securities in the capital of the Company on such terms as it may determine. Subject to the provisions of the Companies Law and the Articles and, where applicable, the rules of Stock Exchange and without prejudice to any special rights or restrictions for the time being attached to any shares or any class of shares, all unissued shares in the Company are at the disposal of the board, which may offer, allot, grant options over or otherwise dispose of them to such persons, at such times, for such consideration and on such terms and conditions as it in its absolute discretion thinks fit, but so that no shares shall be issued at a discount. – III-6 – THIS APPLICATION PROOF IS IN DRAFT FORM. The information contained herein is incomplete and is subject to change. This Application Proof must be read in conjunction with the section headed “Warning” on the cover of this Application Proof. APPENDIX III SUMMARY OF THE CONSTITUTION OF THE COMPANY AND CAYMAN ISLANDS COMPANY LAW Neither the Company nor the board is obliged, when making or granting any allotment of, offer of, option over or disposal of shares, to make, or make available, any such allotment, offer, option or shares to members or others with registered addresses in any particular territory or territories being a territory or territories where, in the absence of a registration statement or other special formalities, this would or might, in the opinion of the board, be unlawful or impracticable. Members affected as a result of the foregoing sentence shall not be, or be deemed to be, a separate class of members for any purpose whatsoever. (iii) Power to dispose of the assets of the Company or any of its subsidiaries There are no specific provisions in the Articles relating to the disposal of the assets of the Company or any of its subsidiaries. The Directors may, however, exercise all powers and do all acts and things which may be exercised or done or approved by the Company and which are not required by the Articles or the Companies Law to be exercised or done by the Company in general meeting. (iv) Borrowing powers The board may exercise all the powers of the Company to raise or borrow money, to mortgage or charge all or any part of the undertaking, property and assets and uncalled capital of the Company and, subject to the Companies Law, to issue debentures, bonds and other securities of the Company, whether outright or as collateral security for any debt, liability or obligation of the Company or of any third party. (v) Remuneration The ordinary remuneration of the Directors is to be determined by the Company in general meeting, such sum (unless otherwise directed by the resolution by which it is voted) to be divided amongst the Directors in such proportions and in such manner as the board may agree or, failing agreement, equally, except that any Director holding office for part only of the period in respect of which the remuneration is payable shall only rank in such division in proportion to the time during such period for which he held office. The Directors are also entitled to be prepaid or repaid all travelling, hotel and incidental expenses reasonably expected to be incurred or incurred by them in attending any board meetings, committee meetings or general meetings or separate meetings of any class of shares or of debentures of the Company or otherwise in connection with the discharge of their duties as Directors. Any Director who, by request, goes or resides abroad for any purpose of the Company or who performs services which in the opinion of the board go beyond the ordinary duties of a Director may be paid such extra remuneration as the board may determine and such extra remuneration shall be in addition – III-7 – THIS APPLICATION PROOF IS IN DRAFT FORM. The information contained herein is incomplete and is subject to change. This Application Proof must be read in conjunction with the section headed “Warning” on the cover of this Application Proof. APPENDIX III SUMMARY OF THE CONSTITUTION OF THE COMPANY AND CAYMAN ISLANDS COMPANY LAW to or in substitution for any ordinary remuneration as a Director. An executive Director appointed to be a managing director, joint managing director, deputy managing director or other executive officer shall receive such remuneration and such other benefits and allowances as the board may from time to time decide. Such remuneration may be either in addition to or in lieu of his remuneration as a Director. The board may establish or concur or join with other companies (being subsidiary companies of the Company or companies with which it is associated in business) in establishing and making contributions out of the Company’s monies to any schemes or funds for providing pensions, sickness or compassionate allowances, life assurance or other benefits for employees (which expression as used in this and the following paragraph shall include any Director or ex-Director who may hold or have held any executive office or any office of profit with the Company or any of its subsidiaries) and ex-employees of the Company and their dependents or any class or classes of such persons. The board may pay, enter into agreements to pay or make grants of revocable or irrevocable, and either subject or not subject to any terms or conditions, pensions or other benefits to employees and ex-employees and their dependents, or to any of such persons, including pensions or benefits additional to those, if any, to which such employees or ex-employees or their dependents are or may become entitled under any such scheme or fund as is mentioned in the previous paragraph. Any such pension or benefit may, as the board considers desirable, be granted to an employee either before and in anticipation of, or upon or at any time after, his actual retirement. (vi) Compensation or payments for loss of office Pursuant to the Articles, payments to any Director or past Director of any sum by way of compensation for loss of office or as consideration for or in connection with his retirement from office (not being a payment to which the Director is contractually entitled) must be approved by the Company in general meeting. (vii) Loans and provision of security for loans to Directors The Company must not make any loan, directly or indirectly, to a Director or his close associate(s) if and to the extent it would be prohibited by the Companies Ordinance (Chapter 622 of the laws of Hong Kong) as if the Company were a company incorporated in Hong Kong. – III-8 – THIS APPLICATION PROOF IS IN DRAFT FORM. The information contained herein is incomplete and is subject to change. This Application Proof must be read in conjunction with the section headed “Warning” on the cover of this Application Proof. APPENDIX III SUMMARY OF THE CONSTITUTION OF THE COMPANY AND CAYMAN ISLANDS COMPANY LAW (viii) Disclosure of interests in contracts with the Company or any of its subsidiaries A Director may hold any other office or place of profit with the Company (except that of the auditor of the Company) in conjunction with his office of Director for such period and upon such terms as the board may determine, and may be paid such extra remuneration therefor in addition to any remuneration provided for by or pursuant to the Articles. A Director may be or become a director or other officer of, or otherwise interested in, any company promoted by the Company or any other company in which the Company may be interested, and shall not be liable to account to the Company or the members for any remuneration, profits or other benefits received by him as a director, officer or member of, or from his interest in, such other company. The board may also cause the voting power conferred by the shares in any other company held or owned by the Company to be exercised in such manner in all respects as it thinks fit, including the exercise thereof in favour of any resolution appointing the Directors or any of them to be directors or officers of such other company, or voting or providing for the payment of remuneration to the directors or officers of such other company. No Director or proposed or intended Director shall be disqualified by his office from contracting with the Company, either with regard to his tenure of any office or place of profit or as vendor, purchaser or in any other manner whatsoever, nor shall any such contract or any other contract or arrangement in which any Director is in any way interested be liable to be avoided, nor shall any Director so contracting or being so interested be liable to account to the Company or the members for any remuneration, profit or other benefits realised by any such contract or arrangement by reason of such Director holding that office or the fiduciary relationship thereby established. A Director who to his knowledge is in any way, whether directly or indirectly, interested in a contract or arrangement or proposed contract or arrangement with the Company must declare the nature of his interest at the meeting of the board at which the question of entering into the contract or arrangement is first taken into consideration, if he knows his interest then exists, or in any other case, at the first meeting of the board after he knows that he is or has become so interested. – III-9 – THIS APPLICATION PROOF IS IN DRAFT FORM. The information contained herein is incomplete and is subject to change. This Application Proof must be read in conjunction with the section headed “Warning” on the cover of this Application Proof. APPENDIX III SUMMARY OF THE CONSTITUTION OF THE COMPANY AND CAYMAN ISLANDS COMPANY LAW A Director shall not vote (nor be counted in the quorum) on any resolution of the board approving any contract or arrangement or other proposal in which he or any of his close associates is materially interested, but this prohibition does not apply to any of the following matters, namely: (aa) any contract or arrangement for giving to such Director or his close associate(s) any security or indemnity in respect of money lent by him or any of his close associates or obligations incurred or undertaken by him or any of his close associates at the request of or for the benefit of the Company or any of its subsidiaries; (bb) any contract or arrangement for the giving of any security or indemnity to a third party in respect of a debt or obligation of the Company or any of its subsidiaries for which the Director or his close associate(s) has himself/themselves assumed responsibility in whole or in part whether alone or jointly under a guarantee or indemnity or by the giving of security; (cc) any contract or arrangement concerning an offer of shares or debentures or other securities of or by the Company or any other company which the Company may promote or be interested in for subscription or purchase, where the Director or his close associate(s) is/are or is/are to be interested as a participant in the underwriting or sub-underwriting of the offer; (dd) any contract or arrangement in which the Director or his close associate(s) is/are interested in the same manner as other holders of shares or debentures or other securities of the Company by virtue only of his/their interest in shares or debentures or other securities of the Company; or (ee) (c) any proposal or arrangement concerning the adoption, modification or operation of a share option scheme, a pension fund or retirement, death, or disability benefits scheme or other arrangement which relates both to Directors, his close associates and employees of the Company or of any of its subsidiaries and does not provide in respect of any Director, or his close associate(s), as such any privilege or advantage not accorded generally to the class of persons to which such scheme or fund relates. Proceedings of the Board The board may meet for the despatch of business, adjourn and otherwise regulate its meetings as it considers appropriate. Questions arising at any meeting shall be determined by a majority of votes. In the case of an equality of votes, the chairman of the meeting shall have an additional or casting vote. – III-10 – THIS APPLICATION PROOF IS IN DRAFT FORM. The information contained herein is incomplete and is subject to change. This Application Proof must be read in conjunction with the section headed “Warning” on the cover of this Application Proof. APPENDIX III (d) SUMMARY OF THE CONSTITUTION OF THE COMPANY AND CAYMAN ISLANDS COMPANY LAW Alterations to constitutional documents and the Company’s name The Articles may be rescinded, altered or amended by the Company in general meeting by special resolution. The Articles state that a special resolution shall be required to alter the provisions of the Memorandum, to amend the Articles or to change the name of the Company. (e) Meetings of members (i) Special and ordinary resolutions A special resolution of the Company must be passed by a majority of not less than three-fourths of the votes cast by such members as, being entitled so to do, vote in person or, in the case of such members as are corporations, by their duly authorised representatives or, where proxies are allowed, by proxy at a general meeting of which notice has been duly given in accordance with the Articles. Under the Companies Law, a copy of any special resolution must be forwarded to the Registrar of Companies in the Cayman Islands within fifteen (15) days of being passed. An ordinary resolution is defined in the Articles to mean a resolution passed by a simple majority of the votes of such members of the Company as, being entitled to do so, vote in person or, in the case of corporations, by their duly authorised representatives or, where proxies are allowed, by proxy at a general meeting of which notice has been duly given held in accordance with the Articles. (ii) Voting rights and right to demand a poll Subject to any special rights or restrictions as to voting for the time being attached to any shares, at any general meeting on a poll every member present in person or by proxy or, in the case of a member being a corporation, by its duly authorised representative shall have one vote for every fully paid share of which he is the holder but so that no amount paid up or credited as paid up on a share in advance of calls or installments is treated for the foregoing purposes as paid up on the share. A member entitled to more than one vote need not use all his votes or cast all the votes he uses in the same way. At any general meeting a resolution put to the vote of the meeting is to be decided by way of a poll save that the chairman of the meeting may in good faith, allow a resolution which relates purely to a procedural or administrative matter to be voted on by a show of hands in which case every member present in person (or being a corporation, is present by a duly authorised representative), or by proxy(ies) shall have one vote provided that – III-11 – THIS APPLICATION PROOF IS IN DRAFT FORM. The information contained herein is incomplete and is subject to change. This Application Proof must be read in conjunction with the section headed “Warning” on the cover of this Application Proof. APPENDIX III SUMMARY OF THE CONSTITUTION OF THE COMPANY AND CAYMAN ISLANDS COMPANY LAW where more than one proxy is appointed by a member which is a clearing house (or its nominee(s)), each such proxy shall have one vote on a show of hands. If a recognised clearing house (or its nominee(s)) is a member of the Company it may authorise such person or persons as it thinks fit to act as its representative(s) at any meeting of the Company or at any meeting of any class of members of the Company provided that, if more than one person is so authorised, the authorisation shall specify the number and class of shares in respect of which each such person is so authorised. A person authorised pursuant to this provision shall be deemed to have been duly authorised without further evidence of the facts and be entitled to exercise the same powers on behalf of the recognised clearing house (or its nominee(s)) as if such person was the registered holder of the shares of the Company held by that clearing house (or its nominee(s)) including, where a show of hands is allowed, the right to vote individually on a show of hands. Where the Company has any knowledge that any shareholder is, under the rules of the Stock Exchange, required to abstain from voting on any particular resolution of the Company or restricted to voting only for or only against any particular resolution of the Company, any votes cast by or on behalf of such shareholder in contravention of such requirement or restriction shall not be counted. (iii) Annual general meetings The Company must hold an annual general meeting of the Company every year within a period of not more than fifteen (15) months after the holding of the last preceding annual general meeting or a period of not more than eighteen (18) months from the date of adoption of the Articles, unless a longer period would not infringe the rules of the Stock Exchange. (iv) Notices of meetings and business to be conducted An annual general meeting must be called by notice of not less than twenty-one (21) days and not less than twenty (20) business days. All other general meetings must be called by notice of at least fourteen (14) days and not less than ten (10) business days. The notice is exclusive of the day on which it is served or deemed to be served and of the day for which it is given, and must specify the time and place of the meeting and, in the case of special business, the general nature of that business. In addition notice of every general meeting, must be given to all members of the Company other than to such members as, under the provisions of the Articles or the terms of issue of the shares they hold, are not entitled to receive such notices from the Company, and also to the auditors for the time being of the Company. – III-12 – THIS APPLICATION PROOF IS IN DRAFT FORM. The information contained herein is incomplete and is subject to change. This Application Proof must be read in conjunction with the section headed “Warning” on the cover of this Application Proof. APPENDIX III SUMMARY OF THE CONSTITUTION OF THE COMPANY AND CAYMAN ISLANDS COMPANY LAW Any notice to be given to or by any person pursuant to the Articles may be served on or delivered to any member of the Company personally, by post to such member ’s registered address or by advertisement in newspapers published daily and circulating generally in Hong Kong and in accordance with the requirements of the Stock Exchange. Subject to compliance with Cayman Islands law and the rules of the Stock Exchange, notice may also be served or delivered by the Company to any member by electronic means. All business that is transacted at an extraordinary general meeting and at an annual general meeting is deemed special, save that in the case of an annual general meeting, each the following business is deemed an ordinary business: (aa) the declaration and sanctioning of dividends; (bb) the consideration and adoption of the accounts and balance sheet and the reports of the directors and the auditors; (cc) the election of directors in place of those retiring; (dd) the appointment of auditors and other officers; (ee) the fixing of the remuneration of the directors and of the auditors; (ff) the granting of any mandate or authority to the directors to offer, allot, grant options over or otherwise dispose of the unissued shares of the Company representing not more than twenty per cent (20%) in nominal value of its existing issued share capital; and (gg) the granting of any mandate or authority to the directors to repurchase securities of the Company. (v) Quorum for meetings and separate class meetings No business shall be transacted at any general meeting unless a quorum is present when the meeting proceeds to business, but the absence of a quorum shall not preclude the appointment of a chairman. The quorum for a general meeting shall be two members present in person (or, in the case of a member being a corporation, by its duly authorised representative) or by proxy and entitled to vote. In respect of a separate class meeting (other than an adjourned meeting) convened to sanction the modification of class rights the necessary quorum shall be two persons holding or representing by proxy not less than one-third in nominal value of the issued shares of that class. – III-13 – THIS APPLICATION PROOF IS IN DRAFT FORM. The information contained herein is incomplete and is subject to change. This Application Proof must be read in conjunction with the section headed “Warning” on the cover of this Application Proof. APPENDIX III (vi) SUMMARY OF THE CONSTITUTION OF THE COMPANY AND CAYMAN ISLANDS COMPANY LAW Proxies Any member of the Company entitled to attend and vote at a meeting of the Company is entitled to appoint another person as his proxy to attend and vote instead of him. A member who is the holder of two or more shares may appoint more than one proxy to represent him and vote on his behalf at a general meeting of the Company or at a class meeting. A proxy need not be a member of the Company and is entitled to exercise the same powers on behalf of a member who is an individual and for whom he acts as proxy as such member could exercise. In addition, a proxy is entitled to exercise the same powers on behalf of a member which is a corporation and for which he acts as proxy as such member could exercise if it were an individual member. Votes may be given either personally (or, in the case of a member being a corporation, by its duly authorised representative) or by proxy. (f) Accounts and audit The board shall cause true accounts to be kept of the sums of money received and expended by the Company, and the matters in respect of which such receipt and expenditure take place, and of the property, assets, credits and liabilities of the Company and of all other matters required by the Companies Law or necessary to give a true and fair view of the Company’s affairs and to explain its transactions. The accounting records must be kept at the registered office or at such other place or places as the board decides and shall always be open to inspection by any Director. No member (other than a Director) shall have any right to inspect any accounting record or book or document of the Company except as conferred by law or authorised by the board or the Company in general meeting. However, an exempted company must make available at its registered office in electronic form or any other medium, copies of its books of account or parts thereof as may be required of it upon service of an order or notice by the Tax Information Authority pursuant to the Tax Information Authority Law of the Cayman Islands. A copy of every balance sheet and profit and loss account (including every document required by law to be annexed thereto) which is to be laid before the Company at its general meeting, together with a printed copy of the Directors’ report and a copy of the auditors’ report, shall not less than twenty-one (21) days before the date of the meeting and at the same time as the notice of annual general meeting be sent to every person entitled to receive notices of general meetings of the Company under the provisions of the Articles; however, subject to compliance with all applicable laws, including the rules of the Stock Exchange, the Company may send to such persons summarised financial statements derived from the Company’s annual accounts and the directors’ report instead provided that any such person may by notice in writing served on the Company, demand that the Company sends to him, in addition to summarised financial statements, a complete printed copy of the Company’s annual financial statement and the directors’ report thereon. – III-14 – THIS APPLICATION PROOF IS IN DRAFT FORM. The information contained herein is incomplete and is subject to change. This Application Proof must be read in conjunction with the section headed “Warning” on the cover of this Application Proof. APPENDIX III SUMMARY OF THE CONSTITUTION OF THE COMPANY AND CAYMAN ISLANDS COMPANY LAW At the annual general meeting or at a subsequent extraordinary general meeting in each year, the members shall appoint an auditor to audit the accounts of the Company and such auditor shall hold office until the next annual general meeting. The remuneration of the auditors shall be fixed by the Company in general meeting or in such manner as the members may determine. The financial statements of the Company shall be audited by the auditor in accordance with generally accepted auditing standards which be those of a country or jurisdiction other than the Cayman Islands.. The auditor shall make a written report thereon in accordance with generally accepted auditing standards and the report of the auditor must be submitted to the members in general meeting. (g) Dividends and other methods of distribution The Company in general meeting may declare dividends in any currency to be paid to the members but no dividend shall be declared in excess of the amount recommended by the board. The Articles provide dividends may be declared and paid out of the profits of the Company, realised or unrealised, or from any reserve set aside from profits which the directors determine is no longer needed. With the sanction of an ordinary resolution dividends may also be declared and paid out of share premium account or any other fund or account which can be authorised for this purpose in accordance with the Companies Law. Except in so far as the rights attaching to, or the terms of issue of, any share may otherwise provide, (i) all dividends shall be declared and paid according to the amounts paid up on the shares in respect whereof the dividend is paid but no amount paid up on a share in advance of calls shall for this purpose be treated as paid up on the share and (ii) all dividends shall be apportioned and paid pro rata according to the amount paid up on the shares during any portion or portions of the period in respect of which the dividend is paid. The Directors may deduct from any dividend or other monies payable to any member or in respect of any shares all sums of money (if any) presently payable by him to the Company on account of calls or otherwise. Whenever the board or the Company in general meeting has resolved that a dividend be paid or declared on the share capital of the Company, the board may further resolve either (a) that such dividend be satisfied wholly or in part in the form of an allotment of shares credited as fully paid up, provided that the shareholders entitled thereto will be entitled to elect to receive such dividend (or part thereof) in cash in lieu of such allotment, or (b) that shareholders entitled to such dividend will be entitled to elect to receive an allotment of shares credited as fully paid up in lieu of the whole or such part of the dividend as the board may think fit. – III-15 – THIS APPLICATION PROOF IS IN DRAFT FORM. The information contained herein is incomplete and is subject to change. This Application Proof must be read in conjunction with the section headed “Warning” on the cover of this Application Proof. APPENDIX III SUMMARY OF THE CONSTITUTION OF THE COMPANY AND CAYMAN ISLANDS COMPANY LAW The Company may also upon the recommendation of the board by an ordinary resolution resolve in respect of any one particular dividend of the Company that it may be satisfied wholly in the form of an allotment of shares credited as fully paid up without offering any right to shareholders to elect to receive such dividend in cash in lieu of such allotment. Any dividend, interest or other sum payable in cash to the holder of shares may be paid by cheque or warrant sent through the post addressed to the holder at his registered address, or in the case of joint holders, addressed to the holder whose name stands first in the register of the Company in respect of the shares at his address as appearing in the register or addressed to such person and at such addresses as the holder or joint holders may in writing direct. Every such cheque or warrant shall, unless the holder or joint holders otherwise direct, be made payable to the order of the holder or, in the case of joint holders, to the order of the holder whose name stands first on the register in respect of such shares, and shall be sent at his or their risk and payment of the cheque or warrant by the bank on which it is drawn shall constitute a good discharge to the Company. Any one of two or more joint holders may give effectual receipts for any dividends or other moneys payable or property distributable in respect of the shares held by such joint holders. Whenever the board or the Company in general meeting has resolved that a dividend be paid or declared the board may further resolve that such dividend be satisfied wholly or in part by the distribution of specific assets of any kind. All dividends or bonuses unclaimed for one year after having been declared may be invested or otherwise made use of by the board for the benefit of the Company until claimed and the Company shall not be constituted a trustee in respect thereof. All dividends or bonuses unclaimed for six years after having been declared may be forfeited by the board and shall revert to the Company. No dividend or other monies payable by the Company on or in respect of any share shall bear interest against the Company. (h) Inspection of corporate records Pursuant to the Articles, the register and branch register of members shall be open to inspection for at least two (2) hours during business hours by members without charge, or by any other person upon a maximum payment of HK$2.50 or such lesser sum specified by the board, at the registered office or such other place at which the register is kept in accordance with the Companies Law or, upon a maximum payment of HK$1.00 or such lesser sum specified by the board, at the office where the branch register of members is kept, unless the register is closed in accordance with the Articles. – III-16 – THIS APPLICATION PROOF IS IN DRAFT FORM. The information contained herein is incomplete and is subject to change. This Application Proof must be read in conjunction with the section headed “Warning” on the cover of this Application Proof. APPENDIX III (i) SUMMARY OF THE CONSTITUTION OF THE COMPANY AND CAYMAN ISLANDS COMPANY LAW Rights of minorities in relation to fraud or oppression There are no provisions in the Articles relating to rights of minority shareholders in relation to fraud or oppression. However, certain remedies are available to shareholders of the Company under Cayman Islands law, as summarised in paragraph 3(f) of this Appendix. (j) Procedures on liquidation A resolution that the Company be wound up by the court or be wound up voluntarily shall be a special resolution. Subject to any special rights, privileges or restrictions as to the distribution of available surplus assets on liquidation for the time being attached to any class or classes of shares: (i) if the Company is wound up and the assets available for distribution amongst the members of the Company shall be more than sufficient to repay the whole of the capital paid up at the commencement of the winding up, the excess shall be distributed pari passu amongst such members in proportion to the amount paid up on the shares held by them respectively; and (ii) if the Company is wound up and the assets available for distribution amongst the members as such shall be insufficient to repay the whole of the paid-up capital, such assets shall be distributed so that, as nearly as may be, the losses shall be borne by the members in proportion to the capital paid up, or which ought to have been paid up, at the commencement of the winding up on the shares held by them respectively. If the Company is wound up (whether the liquidation is voluntary or by the court) the liquidator may, with the authority of a special resolution and any other sanction required by the Companies Law divide among the members in specie or kind the whole or any part of the assets of the Company whether the assets shall consist of property of one kind or shall consist of properties of different kinds and the liquidator may, for such purpose, set such value as he deems fair upon any one or more class or classes of property to be divided as aforesaid and may determine how such division shall be carried out as between the members or different classes of members. The liquidator may, with the like authority, vest any part of the assets in trustees upon such trusts for the benefit of members as the liquidator, with the like authority, shall think fit, but so that no contributory shall be compelled to accept any shares or other property in respect of which there is a liability. – III-17 – THIS APPLICATION PROOF IS IN DRAFT FORM. The information contained herein is incomplete and is subject to change. This Application Proof must be read in conjunction with the section headed “Warning” on the cover of this Application Proof. APPENDIX III (k) SUMMARY OF THE CONSTITUTION OF THE COMPANY AND CAYMAN ISLANDS COMPANY LAW Subscription rights reserve The Articles provide that to the extent that it is not prohibited by and is in compliance with the Companies Law, if warrants to subscribe for shares have been issued by the Company and the Company does any act or engages in any transaction which would result in the subscription price of such warrants being reduced below the par value of a share, a subscription rights reserve shall be established and applied in paying up the difference between the subscription price and the par value of a share on any exercise of the warrants. 3. CAYMAN ISLANDS COMPANY LAW The Company is incorporated in the Cayman Islands subject to the Companies Law and, therefore, operates subject to Cayman Islands law. Set out below is a summary of certain provisions of Cayman company law, although this does not purport to contain all applicable qualifications and exceptions or to be a complete review of all matters of Cayman company law and taxation, which may differ from equivalent provisions in jurisdictions with which interested parties may be more familiar: (a) Company operations As an exempted company, the Company’s operations must be conducted mainly outside the Cayman Islands. The Company is required to file an annual return each year with the Registrar of Companies of the Cayman Islands and pay a fee which is based on the amount of its authorised share capital. (b) Share capital The Companies Law provides that where a company issues shares at a premium, whether for cash or otherwise, a sum equal to the aggregate amount of the value of the premiums on those shares shall be transferred to an account, to be called the “share premium account”. At the option of a company, these provisions may not apply to premiums on shares of that company allotted pursuant to any arrangement in consideration of the acquisition or cancellation of shares in any other company and issued at a premium. The Companies Law provides that the share premium account may be applied by the company subject to the provisions, if any, of its memorandum and articles of association in (a) paying distributions or dividends to members; (b) paying up unissued shares of the company to be issued to members as fully paid bonus shares; (c) the redemption and repurchase of shares (subject to the provisions of section 37 of the Companies Law); (d) writing-off the preliminary expenses of the company; and (e) writing-off the expenses of, or the commission paid or discount allowed on, any issue of shares or debentures of the company. – III-18 – THIS APPLICATION PROOF IS IN DRAFT FORM. The information contained herein is incomplete and is subject to change. This Application Proof must be read in conjunction with the section headed “Warning” on the cover of this Application Proof. APPENDIX III SUMMARY OF THE CONSTITUTION OF THE COMPANY AND CAYMAN ISLANDS COMPANY LAW No distribution or dividend may be paid to members out of the share premium account unless immediately following the date on which the distribution or dividend is proposed to be paid, the company will be able to pay its debts as they fall due in the ordinary course business. The Companies Law provides that, subject to confirmation by the Grand Court of the Cayman Islands (the “Court”), a company limited by shares or a company limited by guarantee and having a share capital may, if so authorised by its articles of association, by special resolution reduce its share capital in any way. (c) Financial assistance to purchase shares of a company or its holding company There is no statutory restriction in the Cayman Islands on the provision of financial assistance by a company to another person for the purchase of, or subscription for, its own or its holding company’s shares. Accordingly, a company may provide financial assistance if the directors of the company consider, in discharging their duties of care and acting in good faith, for a proper purpose and in the interests of the company, that such assistance can properly be given. Such assistance should be on an arm’s-length basis. (d) Purchase of shares and warrants by a company and its subsidiaries A company limited by shares or a company limited by guarantee and having a share capital may, if so authorised by its articles of association, issue shares which are to be redeemed or are liable to be redeemed at the option of the company or a shareholder and the Companies Law expressly provides that it shall be lawful for the rights attaching to any shares to be varied, subject to the provisions of the company’s articles of association, so as to provide that such shares are to be or are liable to be so redeemed. In addition, such a company may, if authorised to do so by its articles of association, purchase its own shares, including any redeemable shares. However, if the articles of association do not authorise the manner and terms of purchase, a company cannot purchase any of its own shares unless the manner and terms of purchase have first been authorised by an ordinary resolution of the company. At no time may a company redeem or purchase its shares unless they are fully paid. A company may not redeem or purchase any of its shares if, as a result of the redemption or purchase, there would no longer be any issued shares of the company other than shares held as treasury shares. A payment out of capital by a company for the redemption or purchase of its own shares is not lawful unless immediately following the date on which the payment is proposed to be made, the company shall be able to pay its debts as they fall due in the ordinary course of business. Shares purchased by a company is to be treated as cancelled unless, subject to the memorandum and articles of association of the company, the directors of the company resolve to hold such shares in the name of the company as treasury shares prior to the purchase. Where shares of a company are held as treasury shares, the – III-19 – THIS APPLICATION PROOF IS IN DRAFT FORM. The information contained herein is incomplete and is subject to change. This Application Proof must be read in conjunction with the section headed “Warning” on the cover of this Application Proof. APPENDIX III SUMMARY OF THE CONSTITUTION OF THE COMPANY AND CAYMAN ISLANDS COMPANY LAW company shall be entered in the register of members as holding those shares, however, notwithstanding the foregoing, the company is not be treated as a member for any purpose and must not exercise any right in respect of the treasury shares, and any purported exercise of such a right shall be void, and a treasury share must not be voted, directly or indirectly, at any meeting of the company and must not be counted in determining the total number of issued shares at any given time, whether for the purposes of the company’s articles of association or the Companies Law. A company is not prohibited from purchasing and may purchase its own warrants subject to and in accordance with the terms and conditions of the relevant warrant instrument or certificate. There is no requirement under Cayman Islands law that a company’s memorandum or articles of association contain a specific provision enabling such purchases and the directors of a company may rely upon the general power contained in its memorandum of association to buy and sell and deal in personal property of all kinds. Under Cayman Islands law, a subsidiary may hold shares in its holding company and, in certain circumstances, may acquire such shares. (e) Dividends and distributions The Companies Law permits, subject to a solvency test and the provisions, if any, of the company’s memorandum and articles of association, the payment of dividends and distributions out of the share premium account. With the exception of the foregoing, there are no statutory provisions relating to the payment of dividends. Based upon English case law, which is regarded as persuasive in the Cayman Islands, dividends may be paid only out of profits. No dividend may be declared or paid, and no other distribution (whether in cash or otherwise) of the company’s assets (including any distribution of assets to members on a winding up) may be made to the company, in respect of a treasury share. (f) Protection of minorities and shareholders’ suits The Courts ordinarily would be expected to follow English case law precedents which permit a minority shareholder to commence a representative action against or derivative actions in the name of the company to challenge (a) an act which is ultra vires the company or illegal, (b) an act which constitutes a fraud against the minority and the wrongdoers are themselves in control of the company, and (c) an irregularity in the passing of a resolution which requires a qualified (or special) majority. In the case of a company (not being a bank) having a share capital divided into shares, the Court may, on the application of members holding not less than one fifth of the shares of the company in issue, appoint an inspector to examine into the affairs of the company and to report thereon in such manner as the Court shall direct. – III-20 – THIS APPLICATION PROOF IS IN DRAFT FORM. The information contained herein is incomplete and is subject to change. This Application Proof must be read in conjunction with the section headed “Warning” on the cover of this Application Proof. APPENDIX III SUMMARY OF THE CONSTITUTION OF THE COMPANY AND CAYMAN ISLANDS COMPANY LAW Any shareholder of a company may petition the Court which may make a winding up order if the Court is of the opinion that it is just and equitable that the company should be wound up or, as an alternative to a winding up order, (a) an order regulating the conduct of the company’s affairs in the future, (b) an order requiring the company to refrain from doing or continuing an act complained of by the shareholder petitioner or to do an act which the shareholder petitioner has complained it has omitted to do, (c) an order authorising civil proceedings to be brought in the name and on behalf of the company by the shareholder petitioner on such terms as the Court may direct, or (d) an order providing for the purchase of the shares of any shareholders of the company by other shareholders or by the company itself and, in the case of a purchase by the company itself, a reduction of the company’s capital accordingly. Generally claims against a company by its shareholders must be based on the general laws of contract or tort applicable in the Cayman Islands or their individual rights as shareholders as established by the company’s memorandum and articles of association. (g) Disposal of assets The Companies Law contains no specific restrictions on the power of directors to dispose of assets of a company. However, as a matter of general law, every officer of a company, which includes a director, managing director and secretary, in exercising his powers and discharging his duties must do so honestly and in good faith with a view to the best interests of the company and exercise the care, diligence and skill that a reasonably prudent person would exercise in comparable circumstances. (h) Accounting and auditing requirements A company must cause proper books of account to be kept with respect to (i) all sums of money received and expended by the company and the matters in respect of which the receipt and expenditure takes place; (ii) all sales and purchases of goods by the company; and (iii) the assets and liabilities of the company. Proper books of account shall not be deemed to be kept if there are not kept such books as are necessary to give a true and fair view of the state of the company’s affairs and to explain its transactions. An exempted company must make available at its registered office in electronic form or any other medium, copies of its books of account or parts thereof as may be required of it upon service of an order or notice by the Tax Information Authority pursuant to the Tax Information Authority Law of the Cayman Islands. (i) Exchange control There are no exchange control regulations or currency restrictions in the Cayman Islands. – III-21 – THIS APPLICATION PROOF IS IN DRAFT FORM. The information contained herein is incomplete and is subject to change. This Application Proof must be read in conjunction with the section headed “Warning” on the cover of this Application Proof. APPENDIX III (j) SUMMARY OF THE CONSTITUTION OF THE COMPANY AND CAYMAN ISLANDS COMPANY LAW Taxation Pursuant to section 6 of the Tax Concessions Law (2011 Revision) of the Cayman Islands, the Company has obtained an undertaking from the Governor-in-Cabinet: (1) that no law which is enacted in the Cayman Islands imposing any tax to be levied on profits, income, gains or appreciation shall apply to the Company or its operations; and (2) that the aforesaid tax or any tax in the nature of estate duty or inheritance tax shall not be payable on or in respect of the shares, debentures or other obligations of the Company. The undertaking for the Company is for a period of twenty years from 9 June, 2015. The Cayman Islands currently levy no taxes on individuals or corporations based upon profits, income, gains or appreciations and there is no taxation in the nature of inheritance tax or estate duty. There are no other taxes likely to be material to the Company levied by the Government of the Cayman Islands save for certain stamp duties which may be applicable, from time to time, on certain instruments executed in or brought within the jurisdiction of the Cayman Islands. The Cayman Islands are a party to a double tax treaty entered into with the United Kingdom in 2010 but otherwise is not party to any double tax treaties. (k) Stamp duty on transfers No stamp duty is payable in the Cayman Islands on transfers of shares of Cayman Islands companies except those which hold interests in land in the Cayman Islands. (l) Loans to directors There is no express provision in the Companies Law prohibiting the making of loans by a company to any of its directors. (m) Inspection of corporate records Members of the Company have no general right under the Companies Law to inspect or obtain copies of the register of members or corporate records of the Company. They will, however, have such rights as may be set out in the Company’s Articles. – III-22 – THIS APPLICATION PROOF IS IN DRAFT FORM. The information contained herein is incomplete and is subject to change. This Application Proof must be read in conjunction with the section headed “Warning” on the cover of this Application Proof. APPENDIX III (n) SUMMARY OF THE CONSTITUTION OF THE COMPANY AND CAYMAN ISLANDS COMPANY LAW Register of members An exempted company may maintain its principal register of members and any branch registers at such locations, whether within or without the Cayman Islands, as the directors may, from time to time, think fit. A branch register must be kept in the same manner in which a principal register is by the Companies Law required or permitted to be kept. The company shall cause to be kept at the place where the company’s principal register is kept a duplicate of any branch register duly entered up from time to time. There is no requirement under the Companies Law for an exempted company to make any returns of members to the Registrar of Companies of the Cayman Islands. The names and addresses of the members are, accordingly, not a matter of public record and are not available for public inspection. However, an exempted company shall make available at its registered office, in electronic form or any other medium, such register of members, including any branch register of members, as may be required of it upon service of an order or notice by the Tax Information Authority pursuant to the Tax Information Authority Law of the Cayman Islands. (o) Register of Directors and Officers The Company is required to maintain at its registered office a register of directors and officers which is not available for inspection by the public. A copy of such register must be filed with the Registrar of Companies in the Cayman Islands and any change must be notified to the Registrar within sixty (60) days of any change in such directors or officers. (p) Winding up A company may be wound up (a) compulsorily by order of the Court, (b) voluntarily, or (c) under the supervision of the Court. The Court has authority to order winding up in a number of specified circumstances including where the members of the company have passed a special resolution requiring the company to be wound up by the Court, or where the company is unable to pay its debts, or where it is, in the opinion of the Court, just and equitable to do so. Where a petition is presented by members of the company as contributories on the ground that it is just and equitable that the company should be wound up, the Court has the jurisdiction to make certain other orders as an alternative to a winding-up order, such as making an order regulating the conduct of the company’s affairs in the future, making an order authorising civil proceedings to be brought in the name and on behalf of the company by the petitioner on such terms as the Court may direct, or making an order providing for the purchase of the shares of any of the members of the company by other members or by the company itself. – III-23 – THIS APPLICATION PROOF IS IN DRAFT FORM. The information contained herein is incomplete and is subject to change. This Application Proof must be read in conjunction with the section headed “Warning” on the cover of this Application Proof. APPENDIX III SUMMARY OF THE CONSTITUTION OF THE COMPANY AND CAYMAN ISLANDS COMPANY LAW A company (save with respect to a limited duration company) may be wound up voluntarily when the company so resolves by special resolution or when the company in general meeting resolves by ordinary resolution that it be wound up voluntarily because it is unable to pay its debts as they fall due. In the case of a voluntary winding up, such company is obliged to cease to carry on its business (except so far as it may be beneficial for its winding up) from the time of passing the resolution for voluntary winding up or upon the expiry of the period or the occurrence of the event referred to above. For the purpose of conducting the proceedings in winding up a company and assisting the Court therein, there may be appointed an official liquidator or official liquidators; and the court may appoint to such office such person, either provisionally or otherwise, as it thinks fit, and if more persons than one are appointed to such office, the Court must declare whether any act required or authorised to be done by the official liquidator is to be done by all or any one or more of such persons. The Court may also determine whether any and what security is to be given by an official liquidator on his appointment; if no official liquidator is appointed, or during any vacancy in such office, all the property of the company shall be in the custody of the Court. As soon as the affairs of the company are fully wound up, the liquidator must make a report and an account of the winding up, showing how the winding up has been conducted and how the property of the company has been disposed of, and thereupon call a general meeting of the company for the purposes of laying before it the account and giving an explanation thereof. This final general meeting must be called by at least 21 days’ notice to each contributory in any manner authorised by the company’s articles of association and published in the Gazette. (q) Reconstructions There are statutory provisions which facilitate reconstructions and amalgamations approved by a majority in number representing seventy-five per cent. (75%) in value of shareholders or class of shareholders or creditors, as the case may be, as are present at a meeting called for such purpose and thereafter sanctioned by the Court. Whilst a dissenting shareholder would have the right to express to the Court his view that the transaction for which approval is sought would not provide the shareholders with a fair value for their shares, the Court is unlikely to disapprove the transaction on that ground alone in the absence of evidence of fraud or bad faith on behalf of management. – III-24 – THIS APPLICATION PROOF IS IN DRAFT FORM. The information contained herein is incomplete and is subject to change. This Application Proof must be read in conjunction with the section headed “Warning” on the cover of this Application Proof. APPENDIX III (r) SUMMARY OF THE CONSTITUTION OF THE COMPANY AND CAYMAN ISLANDS COMPANY LAW Take-overs Where an offer is made by a company for the shares of another company and, within four (4) months of the offer, the holders of not less than ninety per cent. (90%) of the shares which are the subject of the offer accept, the offeror may at any time within two (2) months after the expiration of the said four (4) months, by notice in the prescribed manner require the dissenting shareholders to transfer their shares on the terms of the offer. A dissenting shareholder may apply to the Court within one (1) month of the notice objecting to the transfer. The burden is on the dissenting shareholder to show that the Court should exercise its discretion, which it will be unlikely to do unless there is evidence of fraud or bad faith or collusion as between the offeror and the holders of the shares who have accepted the offer as a means of unfairly forcing out minority shareholders. (s) Indemnification Cayman Islands law does not limit the extent to which a company’s articles of association may provide for indemnification of officers and directors, except to the extent any such provision may be held by the Court to be contrary to public policy (e.g. for purporting to provide indemnification against the consequences of committing a crime). 4. GENERAL Conyers Dill & Pearman, the Company’s special legal counsel on Cayman Islands law, have sent to the Company a letter of advice summarising certain aspects of Cayman Islands company law. This letter, together with a copy of the Companies Law, is available for inspection as referred to in the sub-section headed “Appendix V — Documents available for inspection” in this document. Any person wishing to have a detailed summary of Cayman Islands company law or advice on the differences between it and the laws of any jurisdiction with which he is more familiar is recommended to seek independent legal advice. – III-25 – THIS APPLICATION PROOF IS IN DRAFT FORM. The information contained herein is incomplete and is subject to change. This Application Proof must be read in conjunction with the section headed “Warning” on the cover of this Application Proof. APPENDIX IV STATUTORY AND GENERAL INFORMATION A. FURTHER INFORMATION ABOUT THE COMPANY AND ITS SUBSIDIARIES 1. Incorporation of the Company The Company was incorporated in the Cayman Islands under the Cayman Companies Law as an exempted company with limited liability on 14 May 2015. The Company has established its principal place of business in Hong Kong at Room 2207, 22/F. Park-In Commercial Centre, 56 Dundas Street, Mongkok, Kowloon, Hong Kong and was registered as a non-Hong Kong company under Part 16 of the Companies Ordinance on 23 July, 2015. The Company has appointed Mr. Chan as the authorised representative of the Company for the acceptance of service of process and notices in Hong Kong. As the Company was incorporated in the Cayman Islands, it operates subject to the Cayman Companies Law and to its constitution comprising the Memorandum and the Articles. A summary of various provisions of the Company’s constitution and certain relevant aspects of the Cayman Companies Law is set out in Appendix III to this document. 2. Changes in Share Capital of the Company (a) As of the date of incorporation of the Company, its authorised share capital was HK$390,000 divided into 390,000 Shares of HK$1 each. At the time of its incorporation, one Share was allotted and issued to the initial subscriber, which was transferred to Faith Elite on the same date. (b) On 12 June 2015, every issued and unissued share of HK$1.00 each in the share capital of the Company was subdivided into 100 shares of HK$0.01 each with the effect that the authorised share capital of the Company became HK$390,000 divided into 39,000,000 shares and the issued share of HK$1.00 held by Faith Elite divided into 100 Shares. (c) On 6 January 2016, the Company issued and allotted an additional of 15,106 Shares, 906 Shares, 1,304 Shares, 1,292 Shares and 1,292 Shares to each of Faith Elite, Prime View, National Pride, Global Excellent and Hang Kong, respectively. (d) Assuming that the [REDACTED] becomes unconditional and the issue of the Shares pursuant to the [REDACTED] and the Capitalisation Issue mentioned herein are made, but not taking into account of any Shares which may be issued upon the exercise of the [REDACTED] and any Shares which may be issued upon the exercise of any options which may be granted under the Share Option Scheme, the authorised share capital of the Company will be HK$[REDACTED] divided into [REDACTED] Shares and the issued share capital of the Company will be HK$[REDACTED] divided into [REDACTED] Shares fully paid or credited as fully paid and [REDACTED] Shares will remain unissued. Other than pursuant to any options which may be granted under the Share Option Scheme, the exercise of the [REDACTED] or the – IV-1 – THIS APPLICATION PROOF IS IN DRAFT FORM. The information contained herein is incomplete and is subject to change. This Application Proof must be read in conjunction with the section headed “Warning” on the cover of this Application Proof. APPENDIX IV STATUTORY AND GENERAL INFORMATION exercise of the general mandate to issue Shares referred to in the paragraph headed “A. Further information about the company and its subsidiaries — 3. Written Resolutions of the Shareholders passed on [●]” in this Appendix, there is no present intention to issue any part of the authorised but unissued share capital of the Company and, without prior approval of the Shareholders in general meeting, no issue of Shares will be made which would effectively alter the control of the Company. (e) 3. Save as disclosed herein, there has been no alteration in the share capital of the Company since its incorporation. Written Resolutions of the Shareholders passed on [●] On [●], written resolutions of the Shareholders were passed pursuant to which, among others: (a) the authorised share capital of the Company was increased from HK$390,000 to [REDACTED] by the creation of an additional [REDACTED] Shares with effect from the date of the written resolutions; (b) The Company approved and adopted the Articles and the Memorandum with effect from the date of the written resolutions; (c) conditional on (A) the Listing Department granting the [REDACTED] of, and permission to deal in, the Shares in issue and the Shares to be issued as mentioned herein (including any Shares which may be issued pursuant to the [REDACTED], the Capitalisation Issue, the [REDACTED] and the Share Option Scheme); and (B) the entering into of the [REDACTED] between the [REDACTED] (for itself and on behalf of the [REDACTED]) and the Company; and (C) the obligations of the [REDACTED] under the [REDACTED] becoming unconditional (including, if relevant, as a result of the waiver of any condition(s) by the [REDACTED] (for itself and on behalf of the [REDACTED])) and the [REDACTED] not being terminated in accordance with its terms or otherwise, in each case on or before the date determined in accordance with the terms of the [REDACTED]: (i) the [REDACTED] was approved and the Directors were authorised to effect the same and to allot and issue the [REDACTED] pursuant to the [REDACTED]; (ii) the [REDACTED] was approved and the Directors were authorised to allot and issue any Shares which may be required to be issued if the [REDACTED] is exercised; (iii) the rules of the Share Option Scheme, the principal terms of which are set out in the sub-section headed “D. Share Option Scheme” below, were approved and adopted and the Directors were authorised, at their – IV-2 – THIS APPLICATION PROOF IS IN DRAFT FORM. The information contained herein is incomplete and is subject to change. This Application Proof must be read in conjunction with the section headed “Warning” on the cover of this Application Proof. APPENDIX IV STATUTORY AND GENERAL INFORMATION absolute discretion, to grant options to subscribe for Shares under the Share Option Scheme and to allot, issue and deal with Shares issued pursuant thereunder and to take all such steps as they consider necessary or desirable to implement the Share Option Scheme and to vote on any matter connected therewith notwithstanding that they or any of them may be interested in the same; and (iv) (d) conditional upon the share premium amount of the Company having sufficient balance or being credited as a result of the [REDACTED], the Directors were authorised to capitalise the amount of HK$[REDACTED] from the amount standing to the credit of the share premium account of the Company to pay up in full at par [REDACTED] Shares for allotment and issue to the person(s) whose name(s) appears on the register of members of the Company on the date of the written resolutions (or as they may direct) on a pro rata basis. The Shares to be allotted and issued pursuant to the Capitalisation Issue will rank pari passu in all respects with the existing issued Shares. a general unconditional mandate was given to the Directors authorising them to exercise all the powers of the Company to allot, issue and deal in (otherwise than by way of rights issue or an issue of Shares upon the exercise of the [REDACTED] or any subscription or conversion rights attaching to any warrants or any securities which are convertible into Shares or pursuant to the exercise of any options which may be granted under the Share Option Scheme, or any other option scheme or similar arrangement for the time being adopted for the grant or issue to officers and/or employees of the Company and/or any of its subsidiaries or any other person of Share or rights to acquire Shares or any scrip dividend schemes or similar arrangements providing for the allotment and issue of Shares in lieu of the whole or part of a dividend on Shares in accordance with the Articles or a specific authority granted by the Shareholders in general meeting) any unissued Shares with a total nominal value not exceeding 20% of the aggregate of the total nominal value of the share capital of the Company in issue immediately following completion of the [REDACTED] and the Capitalisation Issue (excluding any Shares that may be issued upon exercise of the [REDACTED] or any options which may be granted under the Share Option Scheme), such mandate to remain in effect until whichever is the earliest of: (i) the conclusion of the next annual general meeting of the Company; (ii) the expiration of the period within which the next annual general meeting of the Company is required by the Articles or any applicable laws of the Cayman Islands to be held; or (iii) the passing of an ordinary resolution of the Shareholders in general meeting revoking, varying or renewing such mandate. – IV-3 – THIS APPLICATION PROOF IS IN DRAFT FORM. The information contained herein is incomplete and is subject to change. This Application Proof must be read in conjunction with the section headed “Warning” on the cover of this Application Proof. APPENDIX IV (e) (f) 4. STATUTORY AND GENERAL INFORMATION a general unconditional mandate was given to the Directors authorising them to exercise all powers of the Company to repurchase on the Stock Exchange or on any other stock exchange on which the Shares may be listed, and which is recognised by the SFC and the Stock Exchange for this purpose, such number of Shares with a total nominal value not exceeding 10% of the aggregate of the total nominal value of the share capital of the Company in issue immediately following completion of the [REDACTED] and the Capitalisation Issue (excluding any Shares that may be issued upon exercise of the [REDACTED] and options which may be granted under the Share Option Scheme), such mandate to remain in effect until whichever is the earliest of: (i) the conclusion of the next annual general meeting of the Company; (ii) the expiration of the period within which the next annual general meeting of the Company is required by the Articles or applicable laws of the Cayman Islands to be held; or (iii) the passing of an ordinary resolution of the Shareholders in general meeting revoking, varying or renewing such mandate; the general unconditional mandate mentioned in paragraph (d) above was extended by the addition to the aggregate nominal value of the share capital of the Company which may be allotted or agreed conditionally or unconditionally to be allotted by the Directors pursuant to such general mandate of an amount representing the aggregate nominal value of the share capital of the Company repurchased by the Company pursuant to the mandate to repurchase Shares referred to in paragraph (e) above provided that such extended amount shall not exceed 10% of the aggregate of the total nominal value of the share capital of the Company in issue immediately following completion of the [REDACTED] and the Capitalisation Issue (excluding any Shares that may be issued upon exercise of the [REDACTED] or any options which may be granted under the Share Option Scheme). Corporate Reorganisation In preparation for the [REDACTED], the companies comprising the Group underwent the Reorganisation to rationalise the corporate structure of the Group. For further details, please refer to the sub-section headed “History, Reorganisation and Group Structure — Reorganisation” in this document. 5. Changes in Share Capital of Subsidiaries Save as disclosed in the sub-sections headed “Corporate History of the Group” and “Reorganisation” both under the section headed “History, Reorganisation and Group Structure” in this document, there has been no alteration in the share capital of any of the subsidiaries of the Company within the two years preceding the date in this document. – IV-4 – THIS APPLICATION PROOF IS IN DRAFT FORM. The information contained herein is incomplete and is subject to change. This Application Proof must be read in conjunction with the section headed “Warning” on the cover of this Application Proof. APPENDIX IV 6. STATUTORY AND GENERAL INFORMATION Particulars of the subsidiaries Particulars of the subsidiaries are set forth in the Accountant’s Report, the text of which is set forth in Appendix I to this document. 7. Repurchase of the securities This paragraph includes the information required by the Stock Exchange to be included in this document concerning the repurchase by the Company of its own securities. (a) Provisions of the GEM Listing Rules The GEM Listing Rules permit companies whose primary listing is on the Stock Exchange to repurchase their securities on the Stock Exchange subject to certain restrictions, the most important of which are summarised below: (i) Shareholders’ Approval All proposed repurchases of securities on the Stock Exchange by a company with its primary listing on the Stock Exchange must be approved in advance by an ordinary resolution, either by way of general mandate or by specific approval in relation to specific transactions. Note: (ii) Pursuant to the written resolutions of the Shareholders passed on [●], a general unconditional mandate (the “Repurchase Mandate”) was given to the Directors authorising any repurchase by the Company of Shares as described above in the paragraph headed “A. Further information about the Company — Written resolutions of the Shareholders passed on [●]” in this Appendix. Source of Funds Any repurchases must be financed out of funds legally available for the purpose in accordance with the Memorandum and the Articles and the applicable laws and regulations of the Cayman Islands. (b) Funding of Purchases In repurchasing securities, the Company may only apply funds legally available for such purpose in accordance with the Memorandum, the Articles and the applicable laws and regulations of the Cayman Islands. Pursuant to the Repurchase Mandate, repurchases will be made out of funds of the Company legally permitted to be utilized in this connection, including profits and share premium of the Company or out of a fresh issue of Shares made for the purpose of the repurchase or, subject to the Cayman Companies Law, out of capital and, in the case of any premium payable on the repurchase, out of the profits of the Company or from sums standing to the credit of the share premium account of the Company or, subject to the Cayman Companies Law, out of capital of the Company. The Company – IV-5 – THIS APPLICATION PROOF IS IN DRAFT FORM. The information contained herein is incomplete and is subject to change. This Application Proof must be read in conjunction with the section headed “Warning” on the cover of this Application Proof. APPENDIX IV STATUTORY AND GENERAL INFORMATION may not repurchase securities on the Stock Exchange for a consideration other than cash or for settlement otherwise than in accordance with the trading rules of the Stock Exchange from time to time. (c) Reasons for Repurchases Repurchases of Shares will only be made when the Directors believe that such a repurchase will benefit the Company and the Shareholders as a whole. Such repurchases may, depending on market conditions and funding arrangements at that time, lead to an enhancement of the net asset value of the Company and/or its earnings per Share. (d) Exercise of the Repurchase Mandate Exercise in full of the Repurchase Mandate, on the basis of [REDACTED] Shares in issue immediately after completion of the [REDACTED] and the Capitalisation Issue (but taking no account of any Shares which may be issued upon the exercise of the [REDACTED] and any options which may be granted under the Share Option Scheme), could accordingly result in up to [REDACTED] Shares being repurchased by the Company during the course of the period (the “Relevant Period”) prior to the earliest of: (e) (i) the conclusion of the next annual general meeting of the Company; (ii) the expiration of the period within which the next annual general meeting of the Company is required by the Articles and the applicable laws and regulations of the Cayman Islands to be held; or (iii) the revocation, variation or renewal of the Repurchase Mandate by ordinary resolution of the Shareholders in general meeting. General None of the Directors or, to the best of their knowledge having made all reasonable enquiries, any of their respective close associates (as defined in the GEM Listing Rules), has any present intention, if the Repurchase Mandate is approved by the Shareholders, to sell any Shares to the Company or its subsidiaries. There might be a material adverse impact on the working capital or gearing position of the Company (as compared with the position disclosed in this document) in the event that the Repurchase Mandate is exercised in full. However, the Directors do not propose to exercise the Repurchase Mandate to such extent as would, in the circumstances, have a material adverse effect on the working capital requirements of the Company or on its gearing levels which in the opinion of the Directors are from time to time appropriate for the Company. – IV-6 – THIS APPLICATION PROOF IS IN DRAFT FORM. The information contained herein is incomplete and is subject to change. This Application Proof must be read in conjunction with the section headed “Warning” on the cover of this Application Proof. APPENDIX IV STATUTORY AND GENERAL INFORMATION The Directors have undertaken to the Stock Exchange that, so far as the same may be applicable, they will exercise the Repurchase Mandate in accordance with the GEM Listing Rules, the Memorandum, the Articles and all the applicable laws and regulations of the Cayman Islands. If as a result of a repurchase of Shares, a Shareholder ’s proportionate interest in the voting rights of the Company increases, such increase will be treated as an acquisition for the purposes of the Takeovers Code. As a result, a Shareholder, or a group of Shareholders acting in concert (within the meaning under the Takeovers Code), depending on the level of increase in the interest of the Shareholder(s), could obtain or consolidate control of the Company and become(s) obliged to make a mandatory offer in accordance with Rule 26 of the Takeovers Code as a result of a repurchase of Shares made after the [REDACTED]. Save as aforesaid, the Directors are not aware of any other consequence under the Takeovers Code as a result of a repurchase of Shares made immediately after the [REDACTED]. No connected person (as defined in the GEM Listing Rules) of the Company has notified the Company that he has a present intention to sell any Shares to the Company or has undertaken not to do so, if the Repurchase Mandate is exercised. B. FURTHER INFORMATION ABOUT THE BUSINESS 1. Summary of Material Contracts The following contracts (not being contracts in the ordinary course of business of the Group) have been entered into by members of the Group within the two years preceding the date in this document and are or may be material: (a) the Deed of Non-Competition; (b) the Deed of Indemnity; and (c) the [REDACTED]. – IV-7 – THIS APPLICATION PROOF IS IN DRAFT FORM. The information contained herein is incomplete and is subject to change. This Application Proof must be read in conjunction with the section headed “Warning” on the cover of this Application Proof. APPENDIX IV 2. Intellectual Property Rights of the Group (a) Trademarks (i) No. STATUTORY AND GENERAL INFORMATION Trademark As of the Latest Practicable Date, the Group was the registered owner of the following trademarks registered in Hong Kong: Registration No. Trademark Owner Class Valid Period 1. 301039329 Fit Boxx HK 28 25 January 2008 – 24 January 2018 2. 301326104 Fit Boxx HK 35 17 April 2009 – 16 April 2019 3. 301423025 Fit Boxx HK 20 9 September 2009 – 8 September 2019 4. 302397367 Fit Boxx HK 35 5 October 2012 – 4 October 2022 5. 302451519 Fit Boxx HK 10 30 November 2012 – 29 November 2022 6. 303246309 Fit Boxx HK 35 22 December 2014 – 21 December 2024 7. 303327228 Fit Boxx HK 35 12 March 2015 – 11 March 2025 – IV-8 – THIS APPLICATION PROOF IS IN DRAFT FORM. The information contained herein is incomplete and is subject to change. This Application Proof must be read in conjunction with the section headed “Warning” on the cover of this Application Proof. APPENDIX IV (ii) STATUTORY AND GENERAL INFORMATION As of the Latest Practicable Date, the Group was the registered owner of the following trademarks registered in the PRC: Registration No. Trademark Owner Class 1. 9763150 Fit Boxx Shenzhen 28 21 September 2012 – 20 September 2022 2. 9785435 Fit Boxx Shenzhen 10 28 September 2012 – 27 September 2022 3. 9765492 Fit Boxx Shenzhen 8 21 September 2012 – 20 September 2022 4. 9785436 Fit Boxx Shenzhen 10 28 September 2012 – 27 September 2022 5. 14291419 14291445 Fit Boxx Shenzhen 8, 10 No. Trademark Valid Period 21 May 2015 – 20 May 2025 As of the Latest Practicable Date, the Group had made application to register the following trademark: Trademark Place of Application Applicant Class Date of Application Application No. the PRC Fit Boxx Shenzhen 35 15 June 2015 17201205 the PRC Fit Boxx Shenzhen 33 15 June 2015 17201198 the PRC Fit Boxx Shenzhen 21 15 June 2015 17201199 – IV-9 – THIS APPLICATION PROOF IS IN DRAFT FORM. The information contained herein is incomplete and is subject to change. This Application Proof must be read in conjunction with the section headed “Warning” on the cover of this Application Proof. APPENDIX IV Place of Application Trademark (b) STATUTORY AND GENERAL INFORMATION Applicant Class the PRC Fit Boxx Shenzhen 8 the PRC Fit Boxx Shenzhen the PRC Date of Application Application No. 15 June 2015 17201200 38 14 August 2015 17666504 Fit Boxx Shenzhen 35 14 August 2015 17666505 the PRC Fit Boxx Shenzhen 35 14 August 2015 17666503 the PRC Fit Boxx Shenzhen 35 15 June 2015 17201206 Domain Names As of the Latest Practicable Date, the Group was the registered proprietor of the following domain names: Registrant Domain Name Date of Registration Expiry Date Fit Fit Fit Fit Fit fitbox.com fitboxx.com fitboxxmacau.com cosmoboxx.com everlasthk.com 27 April 2002 30 October 2006 14 June 2011 18 January 2012 19 March 2012 27 April 2018 30 October 2024 14 June 2016 18 January 2018 19 March 2020 Boxx Boxx Boxx Boxx Boxx HK HK HK HK HK – IV-10 – THIS APPLICATION PROOF IS IN DRAFT FORM. The information contained herein is incomplete and is subject to change. This Application Proof must be read in conjunction with the section headed “Warning” on the cover of this Application Proof. APPENDIX IV STATUTORY AND GENERAL INFORMATION C. FURTHER INFORMATION ABOUT THE DIRECTORS AND SUBSTANTIAL SHAREHOLDERS 1. Disclosure of Interests (a) Interests and short positions of directors in the share capital and the associated corporations Immediately following completion of the [REDACTED] and the Capitalisation Issue (taking no account of Shares which may be issued pursuant to the exercise of the [REDACTED] and options which may be granted under the Share Option Scheme), the interests or short positions of each of the Directors and the chief executives in the share capital, underlying shares and debentures of the Company which, once the Shares are listed, will have to be notified to the Company and the Stock Exchange pursuant to Divisions 7 and 8 of Part XV of the SFO (including interests and short positions which he is taken or deemed to have taken under such provisions of the SFO) or which will be required, pursuant to section 352 of the SFO, to be entered in the register required to be kept therein or which, once the Shares are listed, will be required pursuant to Rules 5.54 to 5.68 of the GEM Listing Rules to be notified to the Company and the Stock Exchange are set out as follows: Interests in the Company Name Nature of interest Mr. Chan Interest of a controlled corporation Interest of a controlled corporation Mr. Li Number of Shares [REDACTED] Shares [REDACTED] Shares Approximate percentage of shareholding [REDACTED] [REDACTED] Note: (1) The letter “L” denotes the person’s long position in the Shares. (2) Faith Elite is held as to 50% and 50% by each of Mr. Chan and Mr. Li, hence each of Mr. Chan and Mr. Li is deemed to be interested in [REDACTED] Shares and [REDACTED] Shares which are beneficially owned by Faith Elite. – IV-11 – THIS APPLICATION PROOF IS IN DRAFT FORM. The information contained herein is incomplete and is subject to change. This Application Proof must be read in conjunction with the section headed “Warning” on the cover of this Application Proof. APPENDIX IV (b) STATUTORY AND GENERAL INFORMATION Interests and short positions of substantial shareholders in the share capital of the Company So far as the Directors are aware, immediately following completion of the [REDACTED] and the Capitalisation Issue (but taking no account of Shares which may be issued pursuant to the exercise of the [REDACTED] and options which may be granted under the Share Option Scheme), in addition to the interests disclosed under the section headed “C. Further information about the Directors and Substantial Shareholders — 1. Disclosure of interests — (a) Interest and short positions of directors in the share capital and the associated corporations ” above, the persons (not being a director or chief executive of the Company) who will have interests or short positions in the Shares and underlying Shares which are required to be disclosed to the Company and the Stock Exchange under the provisions of Divisions 2 and 3 of Part XV of the SFO are as follows: Name Nature of interest Faith Elite Beneficial owner Mr. Chan (2) Interest of a controlled corporation Interest of a controlled corporation Mr. Li (2) Number of Shares (1) [REDACTED] Shares [REDACTED] Shares [REDACTED] Shares Approximate percentage of shareholding [REDACTED] [REDACTED] [REDACTED] Note: (1) The letter “L” denotes the person’s long position in the Shares (2) Faith Elite is held as to 50% and 50% by each of Mr. Chan and Mr. Li, hence each of Mr. Chan and Mr. Li is deemed to be interested in [REDACTED] Shares and [REDACTED] Shares which are beneficially owned by Faith Elite. Save as disclosed herein but taking no account of any Shares which may be issued pursuant to the exercise of the [REDACTED] and the options which may be granted under the Share Option Scheme, the Directors are not aware of any person (not being a director or chief executive of the Company) who will immediately following completion of the [REDACTED] have interests or short positions in the Shares and underlying Shares which would fall to be disclosed to the Company and the Stock Exchange under the provisions of Divisions 2 and 3 of Part XV of the SFO or who will immediately following completion of the [REDACTED] be, directly or indirectly, interested in 10% or more of the nominal value of any class of share capital in any associated corporations of the Company carrying rights to vote in all circumstances at general meetings of associated corporation of the Company. – IV-12 – THIS APPLICATION PROOF IS IN DRAFT FORM. The information contained herein is incomplete and is subject to change. This Application Proof must be read in conjunction with the section headed “Warning” on the cover of this Application Proof. APPENDIX IV 2. STATUTORY AND GENERAL INFORMATION Directors’ Service Contracts and Remuneration (a) Directors’ Service Contracts Each of the executive Directors has entered into a service contract with the Company for a term of three years commencing from the [REDACTED], which will be renewable automatically for sucessive terms of one year each commencing from the next day after the expiry of the then current term of the appointment, unless terminated by not less than three months’ notice in writing served by either party on the other. Each of the independent non-executive Directors has entered into a letter of appointment with the Company for a term of three years commencing from the [REDACTED], subject to termination in certain circumstances as stipulated in the letter of appointment. (b) Directors’ remuneration For the year ended 31 December 2014 and 2015, the aggregate amount paid to the Directors as remuneration (including fees, salaries, contribution to retirement benefit scheme and discretionary performance related bonus) were approximately HK$0.9 million and HK$1.1 million respectively. For the year ending 31 December 2016, the estimated total compensation payable to the Directors amounts to HK1.4 million (excluding any discretionary bonus). There was no arrangement under which a Director has waived or agreed to waive any emoluments for each of the three financial years immediately preceding the issue in this document. – IV-13 – THIS APPLICATION PROOF IS IN DRAFT FORM. The information contained herein is incomplete and is subject to change. This Application Proof must be read in conjunction with the section headed “Warning” on the cover of this Application Proof. APPENDIX IV STATUTORY AND GENERAL INFORMATION Under the arrangements currently proposed, conditional upon the [REDACTED], the basic annual remuneration (excluding any discretionary bonus) payable by the Group to each of the Directors is as follows: Annual remuneration (HK$) 3. Executive Directors Mr. Chan Mr. Li Mr. Lo Wing Sang 960,000 960,000 600,000 Independent non-executive Directors Mr. So Alan Wai Shing Mr. Ho Long Chin Matthew Mr. Wong King Lung 180,000 144,000 144,000 Disclaimers Save as disclosed in this document: (a) none of the Directors nor any of the persons whose names are listed in the paragraph headed “E. Other information — 7. Consents of experts” in this Appendix has any direct or indirect interest in the promotion of, or in any assets which have been, within the two years immediately preceding the date in this document, acquired or disposed of by or leased to any member of the Group, or are proposed to be acquired or disposed of by or leased to any member of the Group; (b) none of the Directors nor any of the persons whose names are listed in the paragraph headed “E. Other information — 7. Consents of experts” in this Appendix is materially interested in any contract or arrangement subsisting at the date in this document which is significant in relation to the business of the Group; (c) none of the Directors is materially interested in any contract or arrangement subsisting at the date in this document which is significant in relation to the business of the Group taken as a whole; (d) none of the Directors or their associates (as defined in the GEM Listing Rules) or existing shareholders or the Company (who, to the knowledge of the Directors, owns more than 5% of the issued share capital) has any interest in any of the five largest customers of the Company; and (e) none of the Directors or their associates (as defined in the GEM Listing Rules) or the existing shareholders of the Company (who, to the knowledge of the Directors, owns more than 5% of the issued share capital) has any interest in any or the five largest suppliers of the Company. – IV-14 – THIS APPLICATION PROOF IS IN DRAFT FORM. The information contained herein is incomplete and is subject to change. This Application Proof must be read in conjunction with the section headed “Warning” on the cover of this Application Proof. APPENDIX IV D. STATUTORY AND GENERAL INFORMATION SHARE OPTION SCHEME The following is a summary of the principal terms of the Share Option Scheme conditionally approved and adopted by the written resolutions of the Shareholders passed on [●]. The Directors confirm that the terms of the Share Option Scheme comply with the requirements under Chapter 23 of the GEM Listing Rules. (a) Purpose The purpose of the Share Option Scheme is to provide incentive or reward to Eligible Persons (as defined in paragraph (b) below) for their contribution to, and continuing efforts to promote the interests of, the Group and for such other purposes as the Board may approve from time to time. (b) Who may join The Board may, at its absolute discretion, offer eligible persons (being any director or employee (whether full time or part time), consultant or advisor of the Group who in the sole discretion of the Board has contributed to and/or will contribute to the Group) (the “Eligible Persons”) to subscribe for such number of Shares in accordance with the terms of the Share Option Scheme. (c) Maximum number of Shares The maximum aggregate number of Shares which may be issued upon exercise of all outstanding options granted and yet to be exercised under the Share Option Scheme and any other share option schemes of the Company, must not, in aggregate, exceed 10% of the total number of Shares in issue from time to time. No options may be granted under the Share Option Scheme and any other share option schemes of the Company if this will result in such limit being exceeded. (d) Price of Shares Subject to any adjustments made, the subscription price for a Share in respect of any particular option granted under the Share Option Scheme (which shall be payable upon exercise of the option) shall be a price solely determined by the Board, provided that it shall not less than the nominal value of the Shares. – IV-15 – THIS APPLICATION PROOF IS IN DRAFT FORM. The information contained herein is incomplete and is subject to change. This Application Proof must be read in conjunction with the section headed “Warning” on the cover of this Application Proof. APPENDIX IV (e) STATUTORY AND GENERAL INFORMATION Granting options to connected persons Any grant of options to a Director, chief executive or substantial shareholder of the Company or any of their respective associates is required to be approved by the independent non-executive Directors (excluding any independent non-executive Director who is a proposed grantee of the options). If the Company proposes to grant options to a Substantial Shareholder or an independent non-executive Director of the Company or their respective associates which will result in the number and value of Shares issued and to be issued upon exercise of all options granted and to be granted (including options exercised, cancelled and outstanding) to such person in the 12-month period up to and including the date of the offer of such grant in aggregate exceeding: (i) 0.1% of the Shares in issue at the relevant time of grant; and (ii) HK$5 million, based on the closing price of the Shares as stated in the daily quotations sheets issued by the Stock Exchange at the date of each grant, such grant shall not be valid unless: (A) a circular containing the details of the grant has been dispatched to the Shareholders in a manner complying with, and containing the matters specified in, the relevant provisions of Chapter 23 of the GEM Listing Rules (including in particular, a recommendation from the independent non-executive Directors (excluding the independent non-executive Director who is the prospective grantee) to the independent Shareholders as to voting); and (B) the grant has been approved by the Shareholders in general meeting (taken on a poll), at which all Connected Persons abstained from voting in favor at such meeting. (f) Restrictions on the time of grant of options No offer to grant option shall be made after a price-sensitive event has occurred or a price sensitive matter has been the subject of a decision until such price-sensitive information has been announced pursuant to the requirements of the GEM Listing Rules. In particular, no options may be offered to be granted during the period commencing one month immediately preceding the earlier of (i) the date of the Board meeting (as such date is first notified by the Company to the Stock Exchange in accordance with the GEM Listing Rules) for the approval of the Company’s results for any year, half-year, quarterly or any other interim period (whether or not required under the GEM Listing Rules); and (ii) the deadline for the Company to publish an announcement of its results for any year or half year under the GEM Listing Rules, or quarterly or any other interim period (whether or not required under the GEM Listing Rules) and ending on the date of actual publication of the results announcement. The period which no option may be granted will cover any period of delay in the publication of results announcement. (g) Rights are personal to grantee An option is personal to the grantee and shall not be assignable nor transferable, and no grantee shall in any way sell, transfer, charge, mortgage, encumber or create any interest (legal or beneficial) in favor of any third party over or in relation to any option. – IV-16 – THIS APPLICATION PROOF IS IN DRAFT FORM. The information contained herein is incomplete and is subject to change. This Application Proof must be read in conjunction with the section headed “Warning” on the cover of this Application Proof. APPENDIX IV (h) STATUTORY AND GENERAL INFORMATION Time of exercise of option Subject to the provisions of the GEM Listing Rules and other applicable laws and regulations, the Board may in its absolute discretion when offering the grant of an option impose any conditions, restrictions or limitations in relation thereto in addition to those set forth in the Share Option Scheme as the Board may think fit (to be stated in the offer Letter) including (without prejudice to the generality of the foregoing) qualifying and/or continuing eligibility criteria, conditions, restrictions or limitations relating to the achievement of performance, operating or financial targets by the Company and/or the grantee, the satisfactory performance or maintenance by the grantee of certain conditions or obligations or the time or period before the right to exercise the option in respect of all or any of the Shares shall vest provided that such terms or conditions shall not be inconsistent with any other terms or conditions of the Share Option Scheme. For the avoidance of doubt, subject to such terms and conditions as the Board may determine as aforesaid (including such terms and conditions in relation to their vesting, exercise or otherwise) there is no minimum period for which an option must be held before it can be exercised and no performance target which need to be achieved by the grantee before the option can be exercised. The date of grant of any particular option is the date on which the offer relating to such option is duly accepted by the grantee in accordance with the Share Option Scheme. An option may be exercised according to the terms of the Share Option Scheme and the offer in whole or in part by the grantee (or his personal representatives) before its expiry by giving notice in writing to the Company stating that the option is to be exercised and the number of Shares in respect of which it is exercised provided that the number of Shares shall be equal to the size of a board lot for dealing in Shares on the Stock Exchange or an integral multiple thereof. Such notice must be accompanied by a remittance for the full amount of the subscription price for the Shares in respect of which the notice is given. The period during which an option may be exercised will be determined by the Board at its absolute discretion, save that no option may be exercised more than 10 years from the date of grant. No option may be granted more than 3 years after the date of approval of the Share Option Scheme. Subject to earlier termination by the Company in general meeting, the Share Option Scheme shall be valid and effective for a period of 3 years from the date of adoption of the Share Option Scheme by Shareholders by resolution at a general meeting. (i) Performance target The Board may from time to time require a particular grantee to achieve certain performance targets specified at the time of grant before any option granted under the Share Option Scheme can be exercised. There are no specific performance targets stipulated under the terms of the Share Option Scheme and the Board is currently unable to determine such restriction on the exercise of the options granted under the Share Option Scheme. – IV-17 – THIS APPLICATION PROOF IS IN DRAFT FORM. The information contained herein is incomplete and is subject to change. This Application Proof must be read in conjunction with the section headed “Warning” on the cover of this Application Proof. APPENDIX IV (j) STATUTORY AND GENERAL INFORMATION Rights on ceasing to be an Eligible Person In the event of the grantee ceasing to be an Eligible Person for any reason other than ceasing (1) by reason of summary dismissal for misconduct or other breach of the terms of his employment or other contract constituting him an Eligible Person, or appears either to be unable to pay or to have no reasonable prospect of being able to pay his debts or has become insolvent or has made any arrangements or composition with his creditors generally or on which he has been convicted of any criminal offence involving his integrity or honesty or (2) by death or permanent disability the option may be exercised within one month after the date of such cessation, which date shall be (i) if he is an employee or director of the Company or any subsidiary, his last actual working day with the Company or any subsidiary whether salary is paid in lieu of notice or not; or (ii) if he is not an employee of the Company or any subsidiary, the date on which the relationship constituting him an Eligible Person ceases. (k) Rights on death or permanent disability In the event that the grantee of an outstanding option dies or becomes permanently disabled before exercising the option in full or at all, the option may be exercised up to the entitlement of such grantee or, if appropriate, in the circumstances described in paragraphs (n), (o) and (q), an election made by his personal representatives within twelve months after the date of his death or permanent disability. (l) Lapse of option on misconduct, bankruptcy or dismissal etc. If a grantee ceases to be an Eligible Person by reason of summary dismissal for misconduct or other breach of the terms of his employment or other contract constituting him an Eligible Person, or appears either to be unable to pay or to have no reasonable prospect of being able to pay his debts or has become insolvent or has made any arrangements or composition with his creditors generally or on which he has been convicted of any criminal offence involving his integrity or honesty, the right to exercise the option (to the extent not already exercised) shall terminate immediately. (m) Rights on a general offer by way of a take-over If a general offer by way of a take-over is made to all the Shareholders (or all such Shareholders other than the offeror and/or any person controlled by the offeror and/or any person acting in association or concert with the offeror) and such offer becomes or is declared unconditional, the Company shall forthwith notify all the grantees and any grantee (or his personal representatives) may by notice in writing to the Company within 21 days after such offer becoming or being declared unconditional exercise the option to its full extent or to the extent specified in such notice. – IV-18 – THIS APPLICATION PROOF IS IN DRAFT FORM. The information contained herein is incomplete and is subject to change. This Application Proof must be read in conjunction with the section headed “Warning” on the cover of this Application Proof. APPENDIX IV (n) STATUTORY AND GENERAL INFORMATION Rights on a general offer by way of a scheme of arrangement If a general offer by way of a scheme of arrangement is made to all the Shareholders and the scheme has been approved by the necessary number of Shareholders at the requisite meetings, the Company shall forthwith notify the grantees and any grantee (or his personal representatives) may thereafter (but before such time as shall be notified by the Company) by notice in writing to the Company exercise the option to its full extent or to the extent specified in such notice. (o) Rights on a compromise or arrangement If a compromise or arrangement between the Company and its Shareholders or creditors is proposed for the purposes of or in connection with a scheme for the reconstruction of the Company or its amalgamation with any other company or companies, the Company shall give notice thereof to the grantee (together with a notice of the existence of the provisions of this paragraph) on the same date or soon after it dispatches the notice to each member or creditor of the Company summoning the meeting to consider such a compromise or arrangement, and thereupon the grantee (or his personal representatives) may forthwith and until the expiry of the period commencing with such date and ending with the earlier of 2 months thereafter and the date on which such compromise or arrangement is sanctioned by the court of competent jurisdiction, exercise any of his options whether in full or in part, but the exercise of an option as aforesaid shall be conditional upon such compromise or arrangement being sanctioned by the court of competent jurisdiction and becoming effective. Upon such compromise or arrangement become effective, all options shall lapse except insofar as previously exercised under the Share Option Scheme. The Company may require the grantee (or his personal representatives) to transfer or otherwise deal with the Shares issued as a result of the exercise of options in these circumstances so as to place the grantee in the same position as nearly as would have been the case had such Shares been subject to such compromise or arrangement. – IV-19 – THIS APPLICATION PROOF IS IN DRAFT FORM. The information contained herein is incomplete and is subject to change. This Application Proof must be read in conjunction with the section headed “Warning” on the cover of this Application Proof. APPENDIX IV (p) STATUTORY AND GENERAL INFORMATION Rights on winding-up In the event a notice is given by the Company to its Shareholders to convene a general meeting for the purposes of considering, and if thought fit, approving a resolution to voluntarily wind-up the Company other than for the purpose of a reconstruction, amalgamation or scheme of arrangement, the Company shall on the same date as or soon after it dispatches such notice to each member of the Company give notice thereof to all grantees (together with a notice of the existence of the provisions of this paragraph) and thereupon, each grantee (or his personal representatives) shall be entitled to exercise all or any of his options at any time not later than four business days prior to the proposed general meeting of the Company by giving notice in writing to the Company, accompanied by a remittance for the full amount of the aggregate subscription price for the Shares in respect of which the notice is given whereupon the Company shall as soon as possible and, in any event, no later than one business day immediately prior to the date of the proposed general meeting referred to above, allot the relevant Shares to the grantee credited as fully paid. (q) Lapse of the options The right to exercise an option (to the extent not already exercised) shall terminate immediately upon the earliest of: (i) the expiry of the option period; (ii) the expiry of any of the periods referred to in paragraph (k), (l) or (n); (iii) subject to the scheme of arrangement becoming effective, the expiry of the period referred to in paragraph (o); (iv) subject to the compromise or arrangement referred to in paragraph (p); (v) the date on which the grantee ceases to be an Eligible Person by reason of summary dismissal for misconduct or other breach of the terms of his employment or other contract constituting him an Eligible Person, or appears either to be unable to pay or to have no reasonable prospect of being able to pay his debts or has become insolvent or has made any arrangements or composition with his creditors generally or on which he has been convicted of any criminal offence involving his integrity or honesty; (vi) subject to paragraph (q), the date of the commencement of the voluntary winding-up of the Company; – IV-20 – THIS APPLICATION PROOF IS IN DRAFT FORM. The information contained herein is incomplete and is subject to change. This Application Proof must be read in conjunction with the section headed “Warning” on the cover of this Application Proof. APPENDIX IV STATUTORY AND GENERAL INFORMATION (vii) the date on which the grantee commits a breach of paragraph (h); (viii) the date on which the option is cancelled by the Board as provided in paragraph (v); or (ix) the non-fulfillment of any condition referred to in paragraph (x) on or before the date specified therein. The Company shall owe no liability to any grantee for the lapse of any option under this paragraph (r). (r) Ranking of Shares The Shares to be allotted and issued upon the exercise of an option shall be subject to the Company’s Memorandum and Articles of Association and the laws of the Cayman Island for the time being in force and shall rank pari passu in all respects with the fully-paid Shares in issue of the Company as of the date of allotment and will entitle the holders to participate in all dividends or other distributions paid or made on or after the date of allotment other than any dividend or other distribution previously declared or recommended or resolved to be paid or made if the record date therefore shall be on or before the date of allotment and issue. (s) Effect of alterations to share capital In the event of any alteration to the capital structure of the Company arising from capitalisation of profits or reserves, rights issue, consolidation, redenomination, subdivision or reduction of the share capital of the Company in accordance with the legal requirements or requirements of the Stock Exchange other than any alteration in the capital structure of the Company as a result of an issue of Shares as consideration in a transaction to which the Company is a party. Adjustment (if any) shall be made to (a) the number or nominal amount of Shares subject to the option so far as unexercised; and/or (b) the subscription price for the Shares subject to the option so far as unexercised; and/or (c) the Shares to which the option relates; or any combination thereof as the Auditors or the independent financial advisors to the Company (acting as expert not arbitrator) shall at the request of the Company certify in writing to the Board either generally or as regards any particular grantee that the adjustments are in compliance with Rule 23.03(13) of the GEM Listing Rules and the notes thereto. Any such adjustments must give a grantee the same proportion of the equity capital of the Company as to which that grantee was previously entitled, and any adjustments so made shall be in compliance with the GEM Listing Rules and such applicable guidance and/or interpretation of the GEM Listing Rules from time to time issued by the Stock Exchange (including, without limitation, the supplemental guidance attached to the letter of the Stock Exchange dated 5 September 2005 to all issuers relating to share option scheme) and any future guidance/interpretation of the GEM Listing Rules issued by the Stock Exchange from time to time (but no such alterations shall be – IV-21 – THIS APPLICATION PROOF IS IN DRAFT FORM. The information contained herein is incomplete and is subject to change. This Application Proof must be read in conjunction with the section headed “Warning” on the cover of this Application Proof. APPENDIX IV STATUTORY AND GENERAL INFORMATION made the effect of which would be to enable a Share to be issued at less than its nominal value. The capacity of the Auditors or the independent financial advisors to the Company in this paragraph is that of experts and not of arbitrators and their certification shall, in the absence of manifest error, be final and binding on the Company and the grantees. The costs of the Auditors or the independent financial advisors to the Company shall be borne by the Company. Notice of such adjustment shall be given to the Grantees by the Company. (t) Alteration of Share Option Scheme The Share Option Scheme may be altered in any respect by resolution of the Board except that the provisions of the Share Option Scheme as to: (u) (i) the definitions of “Eligible Person” and “grantee” in the Share Option Scheme; and (ii) the provisions relating to the matters set out in Rule 23.03 of the GEM Listing Rules which shall not be altered to the advantage of grantees or prospective grantees except with the prior approval of the Shareholders in general meeting (with participants and their respective associates abstained from voting). No such alterations shall operate to affect adversely the terms of issue of any option granted or agreed to be granted prior to such alterations except with the consent or sanction in writing of such majority of the grantees as would be required of the Shareholders under the bye-laws for the time being of the Company for a variation of the rights attached to the Shares. Any change to the authority of the Board in relation to any alterations to the terms of the Share Option Scheme must be approved by the Shareholders in general meeting. Any alterations to the provisions of the Share Option Scheme which are of a material nature or any change to the terms of options granted must be approved by the Shareholders in general meeting except where the alterations take effect automatically under the existing provisions of the Share Option Scheme. Any amended terms of the Scheme or the options must comply with Chapter 23 of the GEM Listing Rules. Cancellation of options The Board may cancel an option granted but not exercised with the approval of the grantee of such option. No options may be granted to an Eligible Person in place of his cancelled options unless there are available unissued options (excluding the cancelled options) within the limit set out in paragraph (c) above from time to time. – IV-22 – THIS APPLICATION PROOF IS IN DRAFT FORM. The information contained herein is incomplete and is subject to change. This Application Proof must be read in conjunction with the section headed “Warning” on the cover of this Application Proof. APPENDIX IV (v) STATUTORY AND GENERAL INFORMATION Termination of the Share Option Scheme The Company, by resolution in general meeting, or the Board may at any time terminate the operation of the Share Option Scheme and in such event no further option will be offered but in all other respects the provisions of the Share Option Scheme shall remain in full force and effect and options granted prior to such termination shall continue to be valid and exercisable in accordance with the Share Option Scheme. (w) Conditions of the Share Option Scheme The Share Option Scheme is conditional upon: (x) (i) the Listing Committee granting approval of the [REDACTED] of, and permission to deal in, any Shares which may fall to be allotted and issued pursuant to the exercise of any such options; (ii) the passing of the resolutions by the Shareholders to approve and adopt the Share Option Scheme and to authorise the Board to grant Options under the Share Option Scheme and to allot and issue Shares pursuant to the exercise of any options; and (iii) the commencement of dealings in the Shares on the Stock Exchange. Disclosure in annual and interim reports The Company will disclose details of the Share Option Scheme in its annual and interim reports including the number of options, date of grant, exercise price, exercise period, vesting period and (if appropriate) a valuation of options granted during the financial year/period in the annual/interim/quarterly reports in accordance with the GEM Listing Rules in force from time to time. – IV-23 – THIS APPLICATION PROOF IS IN DRAFT FORM. The information contained herein is incomplete and is subject to change. This Application Proof must be read in conjunction with the section headed “Warning” on the cover of this Application Proof. APPENDIX IV STATUTORY AND GENERAL INFORMATION E. OTHER INFORMATION 1. Tax and Other Indemnity Indemnity on estate duty and taxation The Controlling Shareholders (the “Indemnifiers”) have, pursuant to the Deed of Indemnity, given indemnities on a joint and several basis in favour of the Company (for itself and as trustee as its subsidiaries and jointly-controlled company) in connection with, among other things: (a) any taxation which might be payable by any member of the Group in respect of any income, profits or gains earned, accrued or received or alleged to have been earned, accrued or received on or before the date on which the [REDACTED] becomes unconditional (the “Effective Date”); (b) all costs (including all legal costs), expenses or other liabilities which any member of the Group may reasonably incur in connection with: (c) (i) the investigation, assessment or the contesting of any claim; (ii) the settlement of any claim under the Deed of Indemnity; (iii) any legal proceedings in which any member of the Group claims under or in respect of the Deed of Indemnity and in which judgment is given for any member of the Group; (iv) the enforcement of any such settlement or judgment; (v) the implementation of the Reorganisation and/or disposal or acquisition of the equity interest in any member of the Group since the date of incorporation of each member of the Group and up to the Effective Date; (vi) any non-compliance with the applicable laws, rules or regulations by the Company and/or any member of the Group on or before the Effective Date; all costs (including all legal costs), expenses or other liabilities which any member of the Group may reasonably incur in connection with: (i) any unlawful use of the real properties leased by any company of the Group and/or non-compliance by the relevant company of the Group of any relevant land, construction or user regulations applicable to the properties leased by the relevant company of the Group on or before the Effective Date; – IV-24 – THIS APPLICATION PROOF IS IN DRAFT FORM. The information contained herein is incomplete and is subject to change. This Application Proof must be read in conjunction with the section headed “Warning” on the cover of this Application Proof. APPENDIX IV STATUTORY AND GENERAL INFORMATION (ii) any rectifying works carried out by any of the landlord of the premises or third party or the Group on which a relevant building order/notice was served where the shops of the Group are located to remove any unauthorised building work (as defined under section 14 of the Buildings Ordinance) which has been erected by any member of the Group or the landlord of the premises on or before the Effective Date; and (iii) any possible or alleged violation or non-compliance by any member of the Group with any Hong Kong or PRC laws or regulations on or before the Effective Date, including but not limited in relation to (i) non-compliance with the Companies Ordinance (Cap.622 of the Laws of Hong Kong); and (ii) the PRC laws and regulations in relation to the participation of social welfare scheme (including housing provident fund and social insurance). The Indemnifiers will however, not be liable under the Deed of Indemnity for taxation where: (a) to the extent (if any) to which provision, reserve or allowance has been made for such taxation liabilities and claims in the audited consolidated accounts of the Company for the Track Record Period as set out in Appendix I to this document (the “Accounts”); (b) to the extent such taxation liabilities and claims falling on any of the members of the Group in respect of their current accounting periods or any accounting period commencing on or after the Effective Date would not have arisen but for some act or omission of, or transaction voluntarily effected by, any of the members of the Group (whether alone or in conjunction with some other act, omission or transaction, whenever occurring) with the prior written consent or agreement or acquiescence of the Indemnifiers other than any such act, omission or transaction: (c) (i) carried out or effected in the ordinary course of business or in the ordinary course of acquiring and disposing of capital assets after the Effective Date, or (ii) carried out, made or entered into pursuant to a legally binding commitment created on or before the Effective Date or pursuant to any statement of intention made in this document; or to the extent of any provision, reserve or allowance made for such taxation liabilities in the Accounts which is finally established to be an over-provision or an excessive reserve or allowance, in which case the Indemnifiers’ liability (if any) in respect of such taxation liabilities shall – IV-25 – THIS APPLICATION PROOF IS IN DRAFT FORM. The information contained herein is incomplete and is subject to change. This Application Proof must be read in conjunction with the section headed “Warning” on the cover of this Application Proof. APPENDIX IV STATUTORY AND GENERAL INFORMATION be reduced by an amount not exceeding such provision, reserve or allowance, provided that the amount of any such provision, reserve or allowance applied pursuant to this paragraph to reduce the Indemnifiers’ liability in respect of such taxation liabilities shall not be available in respect of any such liability arising thereafter and for the avoidance of doubt, such over-provision or excess provision, reserve or allowance shall only be applied to reduce the liability of the Indemnifiers under the Deed of Indemnity and none of the members of the Group shall in any circumstances be liable to pay the Indemnifiers any such excess; or (d) to the extent that any taxation liabilities and claims arises or is incurred as a result of the imposition of such taxation liabilities as a consequence of any retrospective change in the law, rules and regulations or the interpretation or practice thereof by the Hong Kong Inland Revenue Department or the taxation authority of the PRC or any other relevant authority (whether in Hong Kong, the BVI, the PRC or any other part of the world) coming into force after the Effective Date or to the extent that such taxation liabilities and claims arise or is increased by an increase in rates of such taxation liabilities after the Effective Date with retrospective effect. The Directors have been advised that no material liability for estate duty is likely to fall on the Company or any of its subsidiaries under the laws of the Cayman Islands, the BVI, Hong Kong or the PRC, being jurisdictions in which one or more of the companies comprising the Group are incorporated. 2. Litigation As at the Latest Practicable Date, no member of the Group was engaged in any litigation or arbitration of material importance and no litigation or claim of material importance is known to the Directors to be pending or threatened against any member of the Group. 3. Sponsor The Sponsor has made an application on behalf of the Company to the Listing Department for [REDACTED] of, and permission to deal in, the Shares in issue and Shares to be issued as mentioned herein (including any Shares falling to be issued pursuant to the exercise of the [REDACTED] and pursuant to the exercise of any options which may be granted under the Share Option Scheme). The Sponsor is independent from the Company pursuant to Rule 6A.07 of the GEM Listing Rules. The total amount of fees payable to the Sponsor by the Company for sponsoring the [REDACTED] of the Shares on the Stock Exchange is HK$4.5 million. – IV-26 – THIS APPLICATION PROOF IS IN DRAFT FORM. The information contained herein is incomplete and is subject to change. This Application Proof must be read in conjunction with the section headed “Warning” on the cover of this Application Proof. APPENDIX IV 4. STATUTORY AND GENERAL INFORMATION Preliminary Expenses The preliminary expenses are estimated to be approximately HK$42,588 and are payable by the Company. 5. Promoter The Company has no promoter for the purpose of the GEM Listing Rules. Save as disclosed above, within the two years immediately preceding the date in this document, no cash, securities or other benefits have been paid, allotted or given to any promoters in connection with the [REDACTED] or the related transactions described in this document. 6. Qualifications of Experts The following are the qualifications of the experts who have given opinion or advice which are contained in this document: 7. Name Qualification Ample Capital Limited A licensed corporation under the SFO to engage in type 4 (advising on securities), type 6 (advising on corporate finance) and type 9 (asset management) of the regulated activities as defined under the SFO RSM Hong Kong Certified public accountants Conyers Dill & Pearman Cayman Islands attorneys-at-law Jun He Law Offices PRC legal advisors to the Company Jun He Law Offices (Hong Kong branch) Hong Kong Company Mr. Julian Yeung Hong Kong barrister-at-law Euromonitor International Limited Industry Consultants legal advisors to the Consents of Experts Each of the experts named in paragraph 6 above has given and has not withdrawn its consent to the issue in this document with the inclusion of its report and/or letter and/or summary of valuations and/or opinion and/or data (as the case may be) and references to its name included in the form and context in which it respectively appears. None of the experts named in paragraph 6 above has any shareholding interests in the Group or any right or option (whether legally enforceable or not) to subscribe for, or to nominate persons to subscribe for, securities in any member of the Group. – IV-27 – THIS APPLICATION PROOF IS IN DRAFT FORM. The information contained herein is incomplete and is subject to change. This Application Proof must be read in conjunction with the section headed “Warning” on the cover of this Application Proof. APPENDIX IV 8. STATUTORY AND GENERAL INFORMATION Binding Effect This document shall have the effect, if an application is made in pursuance hereof, of rendering all persons concerned bound by all of the provisions (other than the penal provisions) of sections 44A and 44B of the Companies (Winding Up and Miscellaneous Provisions) Ordinance insofar as applicable. 9. Agency fees or commission received The [REDACTED] will receive an underwriting commission, and the Sponsor will receive a documentation fee, as referred to under the sub-section headed “Underwriting — Commissions and expenses” in this document. 10. Miscellaneous (a) Save as disclosed in this document, within the two years immediately preceding the date in this document: (i) no share or loan capital of the Company or any of its subsidiaries has been issued or agreed to be issued fully or partly paid either for cash or for a consideration other than cash; (ii) no share or loan capital of the Company or any of its subsidiaries is under option or is agreed conditionally or unconditionally to be put under option; (iii) no commissions, discounts, brokerages or other special terms have been granted or agreed to be granted in connection with the issue or sale of any share or loan capital of the Company or any of its subsidiaries; (iv) no founders, management or deferred shares of the Company or any of its subsidiaries have been issued or agreed to be issued; and (v) no commission has been paid or is payable for subscription, agreeing to subscribe, procuring subscription or agreeing to procure subscription of any share in the Company or any of its subsidiaries. (b) Save as disclosed in this document, since 31 December 2015, being the date of the latest audited consolidated financial results as set out in “the Accountants’ Report set out in Appendix I” to this document, there has been no material adverse change in the financial or trading position or prospects of the Group. (c) There has not been any interruption in the business of the Group which may have or has had a significant effect on the financial position of the Group in the 12 months preceding the date in this document. – IV-28 – THIS APPLICATION PROOF IS IN DRAFT FORM. The information contained herein is incomplete and is subject to change. This Application Proof must be read in conjunction with the section headed “Warning” on the cover of this Application Proof. APPENDIX IV 11. STATUTORY AND GENERAL INFORMATION (d) Subject to the provisions of the Cayman Companies Law, the register of members of the Company will be maintained in the Cayman Islands by [REDACTED] and a branch register of members of the Company will be maintained in Hong Kong by [REDACTED]. Unless the Directors otherwise agree, all transfer and other documents of title of Shares must be lodged for registration with and registered by the Hong Kong share registrar in Hong Kong and may not be lodged in the Cayman Islands. All necessary arrangements have been made to enable the Shares to be admitted into CCASS for clearing and settlement. (e) No Company within the Group is presently listed on any stock exchange or traded on any trading system. (f) There are no arrangements in existence under which future dividends are to be or agreed to be waived. (g) The Directors have been advised that, the Chinese name of the Company has been registered in the Cayman Islands as a dual foreign name in accordance with the Cayman Companies Law. Bilingual Document The English language and Chinese language versions in this document are being published separately in reliance upon the exemption provided by Section 4 of the Companies Ordinance (Exemption of Companies and Prospectuses from Compliance with Provisions) Notice (Chapter 32L of the Laws of Hong Kong). – IV-29 – THIS APPLICATION PROOF IS IN DRAFT FORM. The information contained herein is incomplete and is subject to change. This Application Proof must be read in conjunction with the section headed “Warning” on the cover of this Application Proof. APPENDIX V DOCUMENTS DELIVERED TO THE REGISTRAR OF COMPANIES AND AVAILABLE FOR INSPECTION DOCUMENTS DELIVERED TO THE REGISTRAR OF COMPANIES The documents attached to the copy in this document delivered to the Registrar of Companies in Hong Kong for registration were the written consents referred to in the paragraph headed “Appendix IV — E. Other Information — 7. Consents of Experts” in this document, and copies of the material contracts referred to in the paragraph headed “Appendix IV — B. Further Information About The Business — 1. Summary of Material Contracts” in this document. DOCUMENTS AVAILABLE FOR INSPECTION Copies of the following documents will be available for inspection at the offices of Jun He Law Offices at Suite 3701-10, 37/F, Jardine House, 1 Connaught Place Central, Hong Kong during normal business hours from 9:00 a.m. to 1:00 p.m. and 2:00 p.m. to 5:00 p.m. up to and including the date which is 14 days from the date in this document. 1. the Memorandum of Association and Articles of Association of the Company; 2. the Accountants’ Report prepared by RSM Hong Kong, the text of which is set out in Appendix I to this document; 3. the report prepared by RSM Hong Kong in respect of the unaudited pro forma financial information, the text of which is set out in Appendix II to this document; 4. the audited consolidated financial statements of the companies comprising the Group for the two years ended 31 December 2015 (or for the period since their respective dates of incorporation where they are shorter); 5. the PRC legal opinion issued by Jun He Law Offices, the PRC legal advisers, in relation to the PRC law; 6. the letter of advice prepared by Conyers Dill & Pearman, the Cayman Islands legal advisers, summarising certain aspects of the Cayman Islands company law as referred to in Appendix III to this document; 7. the material contracts referred to in the paragraph headed “Appendix IV — B. Further Information About The Business — 1. Summary of Material Contracts” in this document; 8. the written consents referred to in the paragraph headed “Appendix IV — E. Other Information — 7. Consents of Experts” in this document; 9. the rules of the Share Option Scheme; – V-1 – THIS APPLICATION PROOF IS IN DRAFT FORM. The information contained herein is incomplete and is subject to change. This Application Proof must be read in conjunction with the section headed “Warning” on the cover of this Application Proof. APPENDIX V DOCUMENTS DELIVERED TO THE REGISTRAR OF COMPANIES AND AVAILABLE FOR INSPECTION 10. the service agreements and letters of appointment referred to in the paragraph headed “Appendix IV — C. Further Information About The Directors and Substantial Shareholders — 2. Directors’ Service Contracts and Remuneration” in this document; 11. the Cayman Companies Law. – V-2 –